services: postgresql: Add postgresql-role-service-type.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nikita Gillmann@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2020 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2021 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019, 2020 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
78 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Naga Malleswari@*
79 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Brice Waegeneire@*
80 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 R Veera Kumar@*
81 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Pierre Langlois@*
82 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 pinoaffe@*
83 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 André Batista@*
84 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Alexandru-Sergiu Marton@*
85 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 raingloom@*
86 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Daniel Brooks@*
87 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 John Soo@*
88 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jonathan Brielmaier@*
89
90 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
91 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
92 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
93 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
94 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
95 Documentation License''.
96 @end copying
97
98 @dircategory System administration
99 @direntry
100 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
101 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
102 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
103 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
104 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
105 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
106 @end direntry
107
108 @dircategory Software development
109 @direntry
110 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
111 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
112 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
113 @end direntry
114
115 @titlepage
116 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
117 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
118 @author The GNU Guix Developers
119
120 @page
121 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
122 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
123 @value{UPDATED} @*
124
125 @insertcopying
126 @end titlepage
127
128 @contents
129
130 @c *********************************************************************
131 @node Top
132 @top GNU Guix
133
134 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
135 package management tool written for the GNU system.
136
137 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
138 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
139 @c translation.
140 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
141 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
142 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
143 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
144 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
145 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining
146 @uref{https://translate.fedoraproject.org/projects/guix/documentation-manual,
147 Weblate}.
148
149 @menu
150 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
151 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
152 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
153 * Getting Started:: Your first steps.
154 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
155 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
156 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
157 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
158 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
159 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
160 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
161 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
162 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
163 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
164 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
165 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
166
167 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
168 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
169 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
170 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
171
172 @detailmenu
173 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
174
175 Introduction
176
177 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
178 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
179
180 Installation
181
182 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
183 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
184 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
185 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
186 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
187 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
188 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
189
190 Setting Up the Daemon
191
192 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
193 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
194 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
195
196 System Installation
197
198 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
199 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
200 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
201 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
202 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
203 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
204 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
205 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
206 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
207
208 Manual Installation
209
210 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
211 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
212
213 Package Management
214
215 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
216 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
217 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
218 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
219 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
220 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
221 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
222 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
223 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
224 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
225
226 Substitutes
227
228 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
229 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
230 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
231 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
232 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
233 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
234 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
235
236 Channels
237
238 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
239 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
240 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
241 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
242 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
243 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
244 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
245 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
246 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
247 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
248
249 Development
250
251 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
252 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
253 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
254 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
255
256 Programming Interface
257
258 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
259 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
260 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
261 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
262 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
263 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
264 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
265 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
266 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
267 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
268 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile.
269
270 Defining Packages
271
272 * package Reference:: The package data type.
273 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
274
275 Utilities
276
277 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
278 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
279 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
280 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
281 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
282 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
283 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
284 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
285 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
286 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
287 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
288 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
289 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
290 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
291 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
292
293 Invoking @command{guix build}
294
295 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
296 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
297 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
298 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
299
300 System Configuration
301
302 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
303 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
304 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
305 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
306 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
307 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
308 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
309 * Services:: Specifying system services.
310 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
311 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
312 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
313 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
314 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
315 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
316 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
317 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
318 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
319
320 Services
321
322 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
323 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
324 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
325 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
326 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
327 * X Window:: Graphical display.
328 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
329 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
330 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
331 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
332 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
333 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
334 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
335 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
336 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
337 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
338 * Web Services:: Web servers.
339 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
340 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
341 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
342 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
343 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
344 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
345 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
346 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
347 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
348 * Game Services:: Game servers.
349 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
350 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
351 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
352 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
353 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
354
355 Defining Services
356
357 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
358 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
359 * Service Reference:: API reference.
360 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
361
362 Installing Debugging Files
363
364 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
365 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
366
367 Bootstrapping
368
369 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
370 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
371
372 @end detailmenu
373 @end menu
374
375 @c *********************************************************************
376 @node Introduction
377 @chapter Introduction
378
379 @cindex purpose
380 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
381 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
382 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
383 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
384 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
385 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
386 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
387
388 @cindex Guix System
389 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
390 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
391 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
392 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
393 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
394 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
395 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
396 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
397 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
398 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
399
400 @menu
401 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
402 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
403 @end menu
404
405 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
406 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
407
408 @cindex user interfaces
409 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
410 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
411 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage
412 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
413 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
414 @cindex build daemon
415 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
416 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
417 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
418
419 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
420 @cindex customization, of packages
421 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
422 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
423 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
424 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
425 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
426 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
427 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
428 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
429
430 @cindex functional package management
431 @cindex isolation
432 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
433 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
434 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
435 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
436 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
437 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
438 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
439 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
440 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
441 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
442 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
443 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
444 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
445 explicit inputs are visible.
446
447 @cindex store
448 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
449 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
450 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
451 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
452 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
453 input yields a different directory name.
454
455 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
456 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
457 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
458
459
460 @node GNU Distribution
461 @section GNU Distribution
462
463 @cindex Guix System
464 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
465 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
466 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
467 users of that software}.}. The
468 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
469 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
470 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
471 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
472 Guix@tie{}System.
473
474 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
475 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
476 list of available packages can be browsed
477 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
478 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
479
480 @example
481 guix package --list-available
482 @end example
483
484 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
485 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
486 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
487 tools that help users exert that freedom.
488
489 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
490
491 @table @code
492
493 @item x86_64-linux
494 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel.
495
496 @item i686-linux
497 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel.
498
499 @item armhf-linux
500 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
501 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
502 and Linux-Libre kernel.
503
504 @item aarch64-linux
505 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
506
507 @item i586-gnu
508 @uref{https://hurd.gnu.org, GNU/Hurd} on the Intel 32-bit architecture
509 (IA32).
510
511 This configuration is experimental and under development. The easiest
512 way for you to give it a try is by setting up an instance of
513 @code{hurd-vm-service-type} on your GNU/Linux machine
514 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, @code{hurd-vm-service-type}}).
515 @xref{Contributing}, on how to help!
516
517 @item mips64el-linux (deprecated)
518 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
519 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
520 supported; in particular, there is no ongoing work to ensure that this
521 architecture still works. Should someone decide they wish to revive this
522 architecture then the code is still available.
523
524 @end table
525
526 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
527 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
528 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
529 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
530 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
531 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
532 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
533
534 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
535 @code{mips64el-linux}.
536
537 @noindent
538 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
539 @pxref{Porting}.
540
541 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
542 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
543
544
545 @c *********************************************************************
546 @node Installation
547 @chapter Installation
548
549 @cindex installing Guix
550
551 @quotation Note
552 We recommend the use of this
553 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
554 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
555 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
556 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
557 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
558 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
559 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
560 as the root user.
561 @end quotation
562
563 @cindex foreign distro
564 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
565 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
566 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
567 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
568 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
569
570 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
571 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
572
573 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
574 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
575 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
576 ready to use it.
577
578 @menu
579 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
580 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
581 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
582 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
583 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
584 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
585 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
586 @end menu
587
588 @node Binary Installation
589 @section Binary Installation
590
591 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
592 @cindex installer script
593 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
594 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
595 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
596 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
597 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
598
599 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
600 @quotation Note
601 We recommend the use of this
602 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
603 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
604 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
605 user. As root, you can thus run this:
606
607 @example
608 cd /tmp
609 wget https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh
610 chmod +x guix-install.sh
611 ./guix-install.sh
612 @end example
613
614 When you're done, @pxref{Application Setup} for extra configuration you
615 might need, and @ref{Getting Started} for your first steps!
616 @end quotation
617
618 Installing goes along these lines:
619
620 @enumerate
621 @item
622 @cindex downloading Guix binary
623 Download the binary tarball from
624 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz},
625 where @code{x86_64-linux} can be replaced with @code{i686-linux} for an
626 @code{i686} (32-bits) machine already running the kernel Linux, and so on
627 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
628
629 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
630 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
631 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
632
633 @example
634 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
635 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
636 @end example
637
638 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
639 then run this command to import it:
640
641 @example
642 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
643 -qO - | gpg --import -
644 @end example
645
646 @noindent
647 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
648
649 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
650 signature!'' is normal.
651
652 @c end authentication part
653
654 @item
655 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
656 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
657
658 @example
659 # cd /tmp
660 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
661 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz
662 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
663 @end example
664
665 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
666 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
667 step).
668
669 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
670 would overwrite its own essential files.
671
672 The @option{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
673 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
674 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
675 versions are fine).
676 They stem from the fact that all the
677 files in the archive have their modification time set to 1 (which
678 means January 1st, 1970). This is done on purpose to make sure the
679 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
680 reproducible.
681
682 @item
683 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
684 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
685
686 @example
687 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
688 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
689 ~root/.config/guix/current
690 @end example
691
692 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @env{PATH} and other relevant
693 environment variables:
694
695 @example
696 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
697 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
698 @end example
699
700 @item
701 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
702 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
703
704 @item
705 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
706
707 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
708 with these commands:
709
710 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
711 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
712 @c files into place.
713 @c
714 @c See this thread for more information:
715 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
716
717 @example
718 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/gnu-store.mount \
719 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
720 /etc/systemd/system/
721 # systemctl enable --now gnu-store.mount guix-daemon
722 @end example
723
724 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
725
726 @example
727 # initctl reload-configuration
728 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
729 /etc/init/
730 # start guix-daemon
731 @end example
732
733 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
734
735 @example
736 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
737 --build-users-group=guixbuild
738 @end example
739
740 @item
741 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
742 for instance with:
743
744 @example
745 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
746 # cd /usr/local/bin
747 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
748 @end example
749
750 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
751 there:
752
753 @example
754 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
755 # cd /usr/local/share/info
756 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
757 do ln -s $i ; done
758 @end example
759
760 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
761 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
762 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
763 Info search path).
764
765 @item
766 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
767 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
768 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
769
770 @example
771 # guix archive --authorize < \
772 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
773 @end example
774
775 @item
776 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
777 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
778 @end enumerate
779
780 Voilà, the installation is complete!
781
782 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
783 the root profile:
784
785 @example
786 # guix install hello
787 @end example
788
789 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
790 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
791
792 @example
793 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
794 @end example
795
796 @noindent
797 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
798
799 @example
800 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
801 --profile-name=current-guix guix
802 @end example
803
804 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
805
806 @node Requirements
807 @section Requirements
808
809 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
810 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
811 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
812 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
813
814 @cindex official website
815 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
816 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
817
818 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
819
820 @itemize
821 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
822 2.2.x;
823 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
824 0.1.0 or later;
825 @item
826 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
827 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
828 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
829 @item
830 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
831 or later;
832 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zlib/guile-zlib, Guile-zlib};
833 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-lzlib/guile-lzlib, Guile-lzlib};
834 @item @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-avahi/, Guile-Avahi};
835 @item
836 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
837 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, version 0.3.0
838 or later;
839 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON}
840 4.3.0 or later;
841 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
842 @end itemize
843
844 The following dependencies are optional:
845
846 @itemize
847 @item
848 @c Note: We need at least 0.13.0 for #:nodelay.
849 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
850 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
851 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
852 version 0.13.0 or later.
853
854 @item
855 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zstd/guile-zstd, Guile-zstd}, for zstd
856 compression and decompression in @command{guix publish} and for
857 substitutes (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
858
859 @item
860 @uref{https://ngyro.com/software/guile-semver.html, Guile-Semver} for
861 the @code{crate} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
862
863 @item
864 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
865 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
866 @end itemize
867
868 Unless @option{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
869 following packages are also needed:
870
871 @itemize
872 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
873 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
874 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
875 C++11 standard.
876 @end itemize
877
878 @cindex state directory
879 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
880 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
881 using the @option{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
882 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
883 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
884 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
885 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
886 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
887
888 @node Running the Test Suite
889 @section Running the Test Suite
890
891 @cindex test suite
892 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
893 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
894 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
895 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
896 suite, type:
897
898 @example
899 make check
900 @end example
901
902 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
903 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
904 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
905 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
906 cache.
907
908 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
909 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
910
911 @example
912 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
913 @end example
914
915 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
916 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
917 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
918
919 @example
920 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
921 @end example
922
923 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
924 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
925 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
926 your message.
927
928 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
929 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
930 Guix is already installed, using:
931
932 @example
933 make check-system
934 @end example
935
936 @noindent
937 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
938
939 @example
940 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
941 @end example
942
943 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
944 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
945 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
946 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
947 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
948 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
949
950 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
951 all the details.
952
953 @node Setting Up the Daemon
954 @section Setting Up the Daemon
955
956 @cindex daemon
957 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
958 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
959 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
960 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
961 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
962 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
963 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
964
965 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
966 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
967 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
968
969 @menu
970 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
971 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
972 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
973 @end menu
974
975 @node Build Environment Setup
976 @subsection Build Environment Setup
977
978 @cindex build environment
979 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
980 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
981 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
982 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
983 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
984 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
985 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
986
987 @cindex build users
988 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
989 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
990 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
991 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
992 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
993 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
994 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
995 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
996 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
997 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
998
999 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
1000 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
1001
1002 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
1003 @c for why `-G' is needed.
1004 @example
1005 # groupadd --system guixbuild
1006 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
1007 do
1008 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
1009 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
1010 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
1011 guixbuilder$i;
1012 done
1013 @end example
1014
1015 @noindent
1016 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
1017 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
1018 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
1019 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
1020 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
1021 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
1022 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
1023
1024 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
1025 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
1026 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
1027 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
1028 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
1029 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
1030 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
1031 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
1032
1033 @example
1034 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1035 @end example
1036
1037 @cindex chroot
1038 @noindent
1039 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
1040 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
1041 environment contains nothing but:
1042
1043 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
1044 @itemize
1045 @item
1046 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
1047 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
1048 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
1049 can only be created if the host has them.};
1050
1051 @item
1052 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
1053 since a separate PID name space is used;
1054
1055 @item
1056 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
1057 user @file{nobody};
1058
1059 @item
1060 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
1061
1062 @item
1063 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
1064 @code{127.0.0.1};
1065
1066 @item
1067 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
1068 @end itemize
1069
1070 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
1071 @i{via} the @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
1072 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
1073 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
1074 This way, the value of @env{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1075 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1076 capture the name of their build tree.
1077
1078 @vindex http_proxy
1079 @vindex https_proxy
1080 The daemon also honors the @env{http_proxy} and @env{https_proxy}
1081 environment variables for HTTP and HTTPS downloads it performs, be it
1082 for fixed-output derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes
1083 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1084
1085 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1086 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @option{--disable-chroot}.
1087 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1088 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1089 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1090 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1091 @emph{pure} functions.
1092
1093
1094 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1095 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1096
1097 @cindex offloading
1098 @cindex build hook
1099 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1100 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1101 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1102 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1103 present.}. When that feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build
1104 machines is read from @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build
1105 is requested, for instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to
1106 offload it to one of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the
1107 derivation, in particular its system types---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
1108 A single machine can have multiple system types, either because its
1109 architecture natively supports it, via emulation
1110 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, Transparent Emulation with QEMU}),
1111 or both. Missing prerequisites for the build are
1112 copied over SSH to the target machine, which then proceeds with the
1113 build; upon success the output(s) of the build are copied back to the
1114 initial machine. The offload facility comes with a basic scheduler that
1115 attempts to select the best machine. The best machine is chosen among
1116 the available machines based on criteria such as:
1117
1118 @enumerate
1119 @item
1120 The availability of a build slot. A build machine can have as many
1121 build slots (connections) as the value of the @code{parallel-builds}
1122 field of its @code{build-machine} object.
1123
1124 @item
1125 Its relative speed, as defined via the @code{speed} field of its
1126 @code{build-machine} object.
1127
1128 @item
1129 Its load. The normalized machine load must be lower than a threshold
1130 value, configurable via the @code{overload-threshold} field of its
1131 @code{build-machine} object.
1132
1133 @item
1134 Disk space availability. More than a 100 MiB must be available.
1135 @end enumerate
1136
1137 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1138
1139 @lisp
1140 (list (build-machine
1141 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1142 (systems (list "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux"))
1143 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1144 (user "bob")
1145 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1146
1147 (build-machine
1148 (name "armeight.example.org")
1149 (systems (list "aarch64-linux"))
1150 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1151 (user "alice")
1152 (private-key
1153 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1154 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1155 @end lisp
1156
1157 @noindent
1158 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1159 the @code{x86_64} and @code{i686} architectures and one for the
1160 @code{aarch64} architecture.
1161
1162 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1163 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1164 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1165 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1166 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1167 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1168 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1169 detailed below.
1170
1171 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1172 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1173 builds. The important fields are:
1174
1175 @table @code
1176
1177 @item name
1178 The host name of the remote machine.
1179
1180 @item systems
1181 The system types the remote machine supports---e.g., @code{(list
1182 "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux")}.
1183
1184 @item user
1185 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1186 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1187 allow non-interactive logins.
1188
1189 @item host-key
1190 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1191 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1192 long string that looks like this:
1193
1194 @example
1195 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1196 @end example
1197
1198 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1199 key can be found in a file such as
1200 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1201
1202 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1203 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1204 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1205 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1206
1207 @example
1208 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1209 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1210 @end example
1211
1212 @end table
1213
1214 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1215
1216 @table @asis
1217
1218 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1219 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1220
1221 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1222 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1223 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1224
1225 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1226 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1227
1228 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1229 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1230 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1231
1232 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1233 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1234
1235 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1236 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1237 to on that machine.
1238
1239 @item @code{overload-threshold} (default: @code{0.6})
1240 The load threshold above which a potential offload machine is
1241 disregarded by the offload scheduler. The value roughly translates to
1242 the total processor usage of the build machine, ranging from 0.0 (0%) to
1243 1.0 (100%). It can also be disabled by setting
1244 @code{overload-threshold} to @code{#f}.
1245
1246 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1247 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1248
1249 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1250 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1251 machines with a higher speed factor.
1252
1253 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1254 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1255 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1256 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1257 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1258
1259 @end table
1260 @end deftp
1261
1262 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1263 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1264
1265 @example
1266 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1267 @end example
1268
1269 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1270 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1271 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1272 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1273 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1274
1275 @example
1276 # guix archive --generate-key
1277 @end example
1278
1279 @noindent
1280 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1281 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1282
1283 @example
1284 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1285 @end example
1286
1287 @noindent
1288 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1289
1290 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1291 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1292 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1293 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1294 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1295
1296 @cindex offload test
1297 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1298 master node:
1299
1300 @example
1301 # guix offload test
1302 @end example
1303
1304 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1305 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guix is
1306 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1307 from it, and report any error in the process.
1308
1309 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1310 command line:
1311
1312 @example
1313 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1314 @end example
1315
1316 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1317 regular expression like this:
1318
1319 @example
1320 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1321 @end example
1322
1323 @cindex offload status
1324 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1325 main node:
1326
1327 @example
1328 # guix offload status
1329 @end example
1330
1331
1332 @node SELinux Support
1333 @subsection SELinux Support
1334
1335 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1336 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1337 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1338 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1339 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1340 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1341 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1342 be used on Guix System.
1343
1344 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1345 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1346 To install the policy run this command as root:
1347
1348 @example
1349 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1350 @end example
1351
1352 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1353 mechanism provided by your system.
1354
1355 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1356 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1357 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1358 command:
1359
1360 @example
1361 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1362 @end example
1363
1364 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1365 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1366 operations.
1367
1368 @subsubsection Limitations
1369 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1370
1371 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1372 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1373 the Guix daemon.
1374
1375 @enumerate
1376 @item
1377 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1378 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1379 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1380 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1381
1382 @item
1383 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1384 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1385 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1386 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1387 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1388 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1389 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1390 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1391 reading and following these links.
1392
1393 @item
1394 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1395 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1396 differently from files.
1397
1398 @item
1399 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1400 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1401 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1402 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1403 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1404 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1405 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1406 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1407 allowed for processes in that domain.
1408
1409 You will need to relabel the store directory after all upgrades to
1410 @file{guix-daemon}, such as after running @code{guix pull}. Assuming the
1411 store is in @file{/gnu}, you can do this with @code{restorecon -vR /gnu},
1412 or by other means provided by your operating system.
1413
1414 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1415 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1416 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1417 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1418 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1419 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1420 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1421 @end enumerate
1422
1423 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1424 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1425
1426 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1427 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1428 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1429 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1430
1431 @example
1432 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1433 @end example
1434
1435 @noindent
1436 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1437
1438 @cindex chroot
1439 @cindex container, build environment
1440 @cindex build environment
1441 @cindex reproducible builds
1442 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1443 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1444 @option{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1445 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1446 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1447 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1448 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1449 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1450 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1451 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1452 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1453
1454 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1455 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1456 its @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1457 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1458 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1459
1460 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1461 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1462 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1463
1464 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1465 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands). The
1466 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1467 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1468 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1469
1470 The following command-line options are supported:
1471
1472 @table @code
1473 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1474 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1475 the Daemon, build users}).
1476
1477 @item --no-substitutes
1478 @cindex substitutes
1479 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1480 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1481 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1482
1483 When the daemon runs with @option{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1484 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1485 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1486
1487 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1488 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1489 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1490 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1491 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1492
1493 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1494 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1495
1496 @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}, for more information on
1497 how to configure the daemon to get substitutes from other servers.
1498
1499 @cindex offloading
1500 @item --no-offload
1501 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1502 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1503 builds to remote machines.
1504
1505 @item --cache-failures
1506 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1507
1508 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1509 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1510 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1511 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1512
1513 @item --cores=@var{n}
1514 @itemx -c @var{n}
1515 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1516 as available.
1517
1518 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1519 as the @option{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1520 guix build}).
1521
1522 The effect is to define the @env{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1523 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1524 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1525
1526 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1527 @itemx -M @var{n}
1528 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1529 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1530 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1531 Setup}), or simply fail.
1532
1533 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1534 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1535 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1536
1537 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1538
1539 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1540 Build Options, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
1541
1542 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1543 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1544 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1545
1546 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1547
1548 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1549 Build Options, @option{--timeout}}).
1550
1551 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1552 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1553 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1554 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1555 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1556
1557 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1558 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1559 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1560
1561 @item --debug
1562 Produce debugging output.
1563
1564 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1565 overridden by clients, for example the @option{--verbosity} option of
1566 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1567
1568 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1569 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1570
1571 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1572 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1573 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1574 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1575 needs.
1576
1577 @item --disable-chroot
1578 Disable chroot builds.
1579
1580 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1581 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1582 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1583 account.
1584
1585 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1586 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1587 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1588
1589 Unless @option{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1590 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1591 them with Bzip2 by default.
1592
1593 @item --discover[=yes|no]
1594 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
1595 and DNS-SD.
1596
1597 This feature is still experimental. However, here are a few
1598 considerations.
1599
1600 @enumerate
1601 @item
1602 It might be faster/less expensive than fetching from remote servers;
1603 @item
1604 There are no security risks, only genuine substitutes will be used
1605 (@pxref{Substitute Authentication});
1606 @item
1607 An attacker advertising @command{guix publish} on your LAN cannot serve
1608 you malicious binaries, but they can learn what software you’re
1609 installing;
1610 @item
1611 Servers may serve substitute over HTTP, unencrypted, so anyone on the
1612 LAN can see what software you’re installing.
1613 @end enumerate
1614
1615 It is also possible to enable or disable substitute server discovery at
1616 run-time by running:
1617
1618 @example
1619 herd discover guix-daemon on
1620 herd discover guix-daemon off
1621 @end example
1622
1623 @item --disable-deduplication
1624 @cindex deduplication
1625 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1626
1627 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1628 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1629 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1630 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1631 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1632 this optimization.
1633
1634 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1635 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1636 derivations.
1637
1638 @cindex GC roots
1639 @cindex garbage collector roots
1640 When set to @code{yes}, the GC will keep the outputs of any live
1641 derivation available in the store---the @file{.drv} files. The default
1642 is @code{no}, meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are
1643 reachable from a GC root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC
1644 roots.
1645
1646 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1647 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1648 corresponding to live outputs.
1649
1650 When set to @code{yes}, as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1651 derivations---i.e., @file{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1652 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1653 items in their store. Setting it to @code{no} saves a bit of disk
1654 space.
1655
1656 In this way, setting @option{--gc-keep-derivations} to @code{yes} causes
1657 liveness to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting
1658 @option{--gc-keep-outputs} to @code{yes} causes liveness to flow from
1659 derivations to outputs. When both are set to @code{yes}, the effect is
1660 to keep all the build prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries,
1661 and other build-time tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of
1662 whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC root. This is
1663 convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1664
1665 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1666 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1667 kernel's @command{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1668
1669 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1670 on the kernel version number.
1671
1672 @item --lose-logs
1673 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1674 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1675
1676 @item --system=@var{system}
1677 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1678 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1679 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1680
1681 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1682 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1683 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1684 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1685 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1686
1687 @table @code
1688 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1689 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1690 creating it if needed.
1691
1692 @item --listen=localhost
1693 @cindex daemon, remote access
1694 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1695 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1696 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1697 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1698 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1699
1700 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1701 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1702 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1703 @end table
1704
1705 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1706 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1707 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1708 by setting the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1709 (@pxref{The Store, @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1710
1711 @quotation Note
1712 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1713 @option{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1714 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1715 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1716 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1717 @end quotation
1718
1719 When @option{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1720 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1721 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1722 @end table
1723
1724
1725 @node Application Setup
1726 @section Application Setup
1727
1728 @cindex foreign distro
1729 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1730 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1731 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1732
1733 @subsection Locales
1734
1735 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1736 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1737 @vindex LOCPATH
1738 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1739 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1740 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1741 available with Guix and then define the @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1742 variable:
1743
1744 @example
1745 $ guix install glibc-locales
1746 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1747 @end example
1748
1749 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1750 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1751 917@tie{}MiB@. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1752 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1753
1754 The @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @env{LOCPATH}
1755 (@pxref{Locale Names, @env{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1756 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1757
1758 @enumerate
1759 @item
1760 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1761 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1762 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1763 incompatible locale data.
1764
1765 @item
1766 libc suffixes each entry of @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1767 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1768 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1769 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1770 data in the right format.
1771 @end enumerate
1772
1773 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1774 versions may be incompatible.
1775
1776 @subsection Name Service Switch
1777
1778 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1779 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1780 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1781 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1782 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1783 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1784 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1785 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1786 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1787 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1788
1789 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1790 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1791 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1792 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1793 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1794
1795 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1796 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1797 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1798 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1799 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1800 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1801 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1802 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1803 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1804 Reference Manual}).
1805
1806 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1807 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1808 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1809 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1810 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1811 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1812 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1813 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1814 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1815
1816 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1817 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1818 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1819 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1820
1821 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1822 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1823 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1824 themselves.
1825
1826 @subsection X11 Fonts
1827
1828 @cindex fonts
1829 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1830 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1831 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1832 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1833 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1834 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1835 @code{font-gnu-freefont}.
1836
1837 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1838 @cindex font cache
1839 Once you have installed or removed fonts, or when you notice an
1840 application that does not find fonts, you may need to install Fontconfig
1841 and to force an update of its font cache by running:
1842
1843 @example
1844 guix install fontconfig
1845 fc-cache -rv
1846 @end example
1847
1848 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1849 graphical applications, consider installing
1850 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1851 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1852 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1853 for Chinese languages:
1854
1855 @example
1856 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1857 @end example
1858
1859 @cindex @code{xterm}
1860 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1861 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1862 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1863
1864 @example
1865 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1866 @end example
1867
1868 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1869 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1870
1871 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1872 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1873 @example
1874 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1875 @end example
1876
1877 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1878 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1879 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1880
1881
1882 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1883
1884 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1885 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1886 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1887
1888 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1889 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1890 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1891 information.
1892
1893 @subsection Emacs Packages
1894
1895 @cindex @code{emacs}
1896 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the Elisp files are placed
1897 under the @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/} directory of the profile in
1898 which they are installed. The Elisp libraries are made available to
1899 Emacs through the @env{EMACSLOADPATH} environment variable, which is
1900 set when installing Emacs itself.
1901
1902 Additionally, autoload definitions are automatically evaluated at the
1903 initialization of Emacs, by the Guix-specific
1904 @code{guix-emacs-autoload-packages} procedure. If, for some reason, you
1905 want to avoid auto-loading the Emacs packages installed with Guix, you
1906 can do so by running Emacs with the @option{--no-site-file} option
1907 (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1908
1909
1910 @node Upgrading Guix
1911 @section Upgrading Guix
1912
1913 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1914
1915 To upgrade Guix, run:
1916
1917 @example
1918 guix pull
1919 @end example
1920
1921 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1922
1923 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1924 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1925 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1926
1927 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1928
1929 @example
1930 sudo -i guix pull
1931 @end example
1932
1933 @noindent
1934 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1935 tool):
1936
1937 @example
1938 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1939 @end example
1940
1941 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1942 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1943
1944 @c TODO What else?
1945
1946 @c *********************************************************************
1947 @node System Installation
1948 @chapter System Installation
1949
1950 @cindex installing Guix System
1951 @cindex Guix System, installation
1952 This section explains how to install Guix System
1953 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1954 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1955 @pxref{Installation}.
1956
1957 @ifinfo
1958 @quotation Note
1959 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1960 @c installation image.
1961 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1962 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1963 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1964 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1965
1966 Alternatively, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1967 available.
1968 @end quotation
1969 @end ifinfo
1970
1971 @menu
1972 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1973 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1974 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1975 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1976 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1977 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1978 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1979 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1980 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1981 @end menu
1982
1983 @node Limitations
1984 @section Limitations
1985
1986 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1987 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1988 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1989
1990 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1991 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1992
1993 @itemize
1994 @item
1995 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1996 may be missing.
1997
1998 @item
1999 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
2000 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
2001 missing.
2002 @end itemize
2003
2004 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
2005 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
2006 info.
2007
2008
2009 @node Hardware Considerations
2010 @section Hardware Considerations
2011
2012 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
2013 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
2014 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
2015 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
2016 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
2017 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
2018 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
2019 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
2020 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
2021
2022 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
2023 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
2024 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
2025 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
2026 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
2027 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
2028 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
2029 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
2030 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
2031
2032 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
2033 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
2034 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
2035 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
2036 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
2037 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
2038
2039 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
2040 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
2041 about their support in GNU/Linux.
2042
2043
2044 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
2045 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
2046
2047 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
2048 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
2049 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz},
2050 where you can replace @code{x86_64-linux} with one of:
2051
2052 @table @code
2053 @item x86_64-linux
2054 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
2055
2056 @item i686-linux
2057 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
2058 @end table
2059
2060 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
2061 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
2062 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
2063
2064 @example
2065 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2066 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2067 @end example
2068
2069 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
2070 then run this command to import it:
2071
2072 @example
2073 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
2074 -qO - | gpg --import -
2075 @end example
2076
2077 @noindent
2078 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
2079
2080 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
2081 signature!'' is normal.
2082
2083 @c end duplication
2084
2085 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
2086 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
2087
2088 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
2089
2090 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
2091
2092 @enumerate
2093 @item
2094 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2095
2096 @example
2097 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2098 @end example
2099
2100 @item
2101 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
2102 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
2103 copy the image with:
2104
2105 @example
2106 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX status=progress
2107 sync
2108 @end example
2109
2110 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
2111 @end enumerate
2112
2113 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
2114
2115 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
2116
2117 @enumerate
2118 @item
2119 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2120
2121 @example
2122 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2123 @end example
2124
2125 @item
2126 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
2127 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
2128 copy the image with:
2129
2130 @example
2131 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso
2132 @end example
2133
2134 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2135 @end enumerate
2136
2137 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2138
2139 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2140 the USB stick or DVD@. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2141 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2142 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2143 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2144
2145 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2146 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2147
2148
2149 @node Preparing for Installation
2150 @section Preparing for Installation
2151
2152 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2153 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternatively,
2154 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2155 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2156 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2157
2158 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2159 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2160 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2161 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2162 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2163 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2164 with the middle button.
2165
2166 @quotation Note
2167 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2168 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2169 ``Networking'' section below.
2170 @end quotation
2171
2172 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2173 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2174
2175 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2176 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2177
2178 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2179 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2180 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2181 the networking dialog.
2182
2183 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2184
2185 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2186 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2187 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2188 things.
2189
2190 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2191
2192 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2193 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2194
2195 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2196
2197 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2198 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2199 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2200 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2201
2202
2203 @node Manual Installation
2204 @section Manual Installation
2205
2206 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2207 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2208 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2209 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2210 Installation}).
2211
2212 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2213 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2214 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2215 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2216 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2217
2218 @menu
2219 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2220 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2221 @end menu
2222
2223 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2224 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2225
2226 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2227 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2228 guide you through this.
2229
2230 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2231
2232 @cindex keyboard layout
2233 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2234 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2235 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2236
2237 @example
2238 loadkeys dvorak
2239 @end example
2240
2241 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2242 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2243 more information.
2244
2245 @subsubsection Networking
2246
2247 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2248
2249 @example
2250 ifconfig -a
2251 @end example
2252
2253 @noindent
2254 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2255
2256 @example
2257 ip address
2258 @end example
2259
2260 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2261 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2262 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2263 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2264 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2265
2266 @table @asis
2267 @item Wired connection
2268 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2269 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2270
2271 @example
2272 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2273 @end example
2274
2275 @noindent
2276 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2277
2278 @example
2279 ip link set @var{interface} up
2280 @end example
2281
2282 @item Wireless connection
2283 @cindex wireless
2284 @cindex WiFi
2285 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2286 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2287 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2288 @command{nano}:
2289
2290 @example
2291 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2292 @end example
2293
2294 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2295 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2296 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2297
2298 @example
2299 network=@{
2300 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2301 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2302 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2303 @}
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2307 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2308 network interface you want to use):
2309
2310 @example
2311 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2312 @end example
2313
2314 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2315 @end table
2316
2317 @cindex DHCP
2318 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2319 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2320
2321 @example
2322 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2323 @end example
2324
2325 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2326
2327 @example
2328 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2329 @end example
2330
2331 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2332 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2333
2334 @cindex proxy, during system installation
2335 If you need HTTP and HTTPS access to go through a proxy, run the
2336 following command:
2337
2338 @example
2339 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon @var{URL}
2340 @end example
2341
2342 @noindent
2343 where @var{URL} is the proxy URL, for example
2344 @code{http://example.org:8118}.
2345
2346 @cindex installing over SSH
2347 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2348 an SSH server:
2349
2350 @example
2351 herd start ssh-daemon
2352 @end example
2353
2354 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2355 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2356
2357 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2358
2359 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2360 then format the target partition(s).
2361
2362 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2363 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2364 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2365 the partition layout you want:
2366
2367 @example
2368 cfdisk
2369 @end example
2370
2371 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2372 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2373 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2374 manual}).
2375
2376 @cindex EFI, installation
2377 @cindex UEFI, installation
2378 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2379 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2380 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2381 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2382
2383 @example
2384 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2385 @end example
2386
2387 @quotation Note
2388 @vindex grub-bootloader
2389 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2390 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2391 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2392 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2393 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2394 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2395 bootloaders.
2396 @end quotation
2397
2398 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2399 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2400 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, JFS, and F2FS file systems. In
2401 particular, code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these
2402 file system types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2403 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2404
2405 @example
2406 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2407 @end example
2408
2409 For the root file system, ext4 is the most widely used format. Other
2410 file systems, such as Btrfs, support compression, which is reported to
2411 nicely complement file deduplication that the daemon performs
2412 independently of the file system (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2413 deduplication}).
2414
2415 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2416 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2417 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2418 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2419 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2420 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2421
2422 @example
2423 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2424 @end example
2425
2426 @cindex encrypted disk
2427 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2428 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2429 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2430 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information). Assuming you want to
2431 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2432 be along these lines:
2433
2434 @example
2435 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2436 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2437 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2438 @end example
2439
2440 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2441 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2442 root file system):
2443
2444 @example
2445 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2446 @end example
2447
2448 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2449 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2450 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2451 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2452
2453 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2454 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2455 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2456 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2457
2458 @example
2459 mkswap /dev/sda3
2460 swapon /dev/sda3
2461 @end example
2462
2463 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2464 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2465 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2466 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2467 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2468 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2469
2470 @example
2471 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2472 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2473 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2474 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2475 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2476 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2477 @end example
2478
2479 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2480 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2481 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2482
2483 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2484 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2485
2486 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2487 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2488
2489 @example
2490 herd start cow-store /mnt
2491 @end example
2492
2493 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2494 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2495 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2496 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2497 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2498
2499 Next, you have to edit a file and
2500 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2501 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2502 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2503 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2504 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2505 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2506 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2507 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2508 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2509
2510 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2511 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2512 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2513 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2514 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2515 something along these lines:
2516
2517 @example
2518 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2519 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2520 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2521 @end example
2522
2523 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2524 in particular:
2525
2526 @itemize
2527 @item
2528 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2529 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2530 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2531 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2532 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2533 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2534 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2535 configuration.
2536
2537 @item
2538 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2539 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2540 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2541 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2542
2543 @item
2544 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2545 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2546 @end itemize
2547
2548 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2549 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2550 under @file{/mnt}):
2551
2552 @example
2553 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2554 @end example
2555
2556 @noindent
2557 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2558 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2559 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2560 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2561
2562 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2563 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2564 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2565 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2566 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2567 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2568 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2569
2570
2571 @node After System Installation
2572 @section After System Installation
2573
2574 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2575 system whenever you want by running, say:
2576
2577 @example
2578 guix pull
2579 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2580 @end example
2581
2582 @noindent
2583 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2584 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2585 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2586
2587 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2588 @quotation Note
2589 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2590 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2591 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @env{PATH} unchanged. To
2592 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2593
2594 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2595 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is ran
2596 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2597 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2598 @end quotation
2599
2600 Now, @pxref{Getting Started}, and
2601 join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2602 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2603
2604
2605 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2606 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2607
2608 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2609 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2610 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2611 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2612 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2613 section is for you.
2614
2615 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2616 disk image, follow these steps:
2617
2618 @enumerate
2619 @item
2620 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2621 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2622
2623 @item
2624 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2625 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2626
2627 @example
2628 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2629 @end example
2630
2631 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2632 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2633
2634 @item
2635 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2636
2637 @example
2638 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2639 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2640 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2641 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2642 @end example
2643
2644 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2645 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2646
2647 @item
2648 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2649 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2650 @end enumerate
2651
2652 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2653 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2654 that.
2655
2656 @node Building the Installation Image
2657 @section Building the Installation Image
2658
2659 @cindex installation image
2660 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2661 system} command, specifically:
2662
2663 @example
2664 guix system image -t iso9660 gnu/system/install.scm
2665 @end example
2666
2667 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2668 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2669 about the installation image.
2670
2671 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2672
2673 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2674 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2675
2676 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2677 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2678 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2679
2680 @example
2681 guix system image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2682 @end example
2683
2684 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2685 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2686
2687 @c *********************************************************************
2688 @node Getting Started
2689 @chapter Getting Started
2690
2691 Presumably, you've reached this section because either you have
2692 installed Guix on top of another distribution (@pxref{Installation}), or
2693 you've installed the standalone Guix System (@pxref{System
2694 Installation}). It's time for you to get started using Guix and this
2695 section aims to help you do that and give you a feel of what it's like.
2696
2697 Guix is about installing software, so probably the first thing you'll
2698 want to do is to actually look for software. Let's say you're looking
2699 for a text editor, you can run:
2700
2701 @example
2702 guix search text editor
2703 @end example
2704
2705 This command shows you a number of matching @dfn{packages}, each time
2706 showing the package's name, version, a description, and additional info.
2707 Once you've found out the one you want to use, let's say Emacs (ah ha!),
2708 you can go ahead and install it (run this command as a regular user,
2709 @emph{no need for root privileges}!):
2710
2711 @example
2712 guix install emacs
2713 @end example
2714
2715 You've installed your first package, congrats! In the process, you've
2716 probably noticed that Guix downloaded pre-built binaries; or, if you
2717 explicitly chose to @emph{not} use pre-built binaries, then probably
2718 Guix is still building software (@pxref{Substitutes}, for more info).
2719
2720 Unless you're using Guix System, the @command{guix install} command must
2721 have printed this hint:
2722
2723 @example
2724 hint: Consider setting the necessary environment variables by running:
2725
2726 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile"
2727 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2728
2729 Alternately, see `guix package --search-paths -p "$HOME/.guix-profile"'.
2730 @end example
2731
2732 Indeed, you must now tell your shell where @command{emacs} and other
2733 programs installed with Guix are to be found. Pasting the two lines
2734 above will do just that: it will add
2735 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin}---which is where the installed package
2736 is---to the @code{PATH} environment variable. You can paste these two
2737 lines in your shell so they take effect right away, but more importantly
2738 you should add them to @file{~/.bash_profile} (or equivalent file if you
2739 do not use Bash) so that environment variables are set next time you
2740 spawn a shell. You only need to do this once and other search paths
2741 environment variables will be taken care of similarly---e.g., if you
2742 eventually install @code{python} and Python libraries, @code{PYTHONPATH}
2743 will be defined.
2744
2745 You can go on installing packages at your will. To list installed
2746 packages, run:
2747
2748 @example
2749 guix package --list-installed
2750 @end example
2751
2752 To remove a package, you would unsurprisingly run @command{guix remove}.
2753 A distinguishing feature is the ability to @dfn{roll back} any operation
2754 you made---installation, removal, upgrade---by simply typing:
2755
2756 @example
2757 guix package --roll-back
2758 @end example
2759
2760 This is because each operation is in fact a @dfn{transaction} that
2761 creates a new @dfn{generation}. These generations and the difference
2762 between them can be displayed by running:
2763
2764 @example
2765 guix package --list-generations
2766 @end example
2767
2768 Now you know the basics of package management!
2769
2770 @quotation Going further
2771 @xref{Package Management}, for more about package management. You may
2772 like @dfn{declarative} package management with @command{guix package
2773 --manifest}, managing separate @dfn{profiles} with @option{--profile},
2774 deleting old generations, collecting garbage, and other nifty features
2775 that will come in handy as you become more familiar with Guix. If you
2776 are a developer, @pxref{Development} for additional tools. And if
2777 you're curious, @pxref{Features}, to peek under the hood.
2778 @end quotation
2779
2780 Once you've installed a set of packages, you will want to periodically
2781 @emph{upgrade} them to the latest and greatest version. To do that, you
2782 will first pull the latest revision of Guix and its package collection:
2783
2784 @example
2785 guix pull
2786 @end example
2787
2788 The end result is a new @command{guix} command, under
2789 @file{~/.config/guix/current/bin}. Unless you're on Guix System, the
2790 first time you run @command{guix pull}, be sure to follow the hint that
2791 the command prints and, similar to what we saw above, paste these two
2792 lines in your terminal and @file{.bash_profile}:
2793
2794 @example
2795 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.config/guix/current"
2796 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2797 @end example
2798
2799 @noindent
2800 You must also instruct your shell to point to this new @command{guix}:
2801
2802 @example
2803 hash guix
2804 @end example
2805
2806 At this point, you're running a brand new Guix. You can thus go ahead
2807 and actually upgrade all the packages you previously installed:
2808
2809 @example
2810 guix upgrade
2811 @end example
2812
2813 As you run this command, you will see that binaries are downloaded (or
2814 perhaps some packages are built), and eventually you end up with the
2815 upgraded packages. Should one of these upgraded packages not be to your
2816 liking, remember you can always roll back!
2817
2818 You can display the exact revision of Guix you're currently using by
2819 running:
2820
2821 @example
2822 guix describe
2823 @end example
2824
2825 The information it displays is @emph{all it takes to reproduce the exact
2826 same Guix}, be it at a different point in time or on a different
2827 machine.
2828
2829 @quotation Going further
2830 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information. @xref{Channels}, on
2831 how to specify additional @dfn{channels} to pull packages from, how to
2832 replicate Guix, and more. You may also find @command{time-machine}
2833 handy (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
2834 @end quotation
2835
2836 If you installed Guix System, one of the first things you'll want to do
2837 is to upgrade your system. Once you've run @command{guix pull} to get
2838 the latest Guix, you can upgrade the system like this:
2839
2840 @example
2841 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2842 @end example
2843
2844 Upon completion, the system runs the latest versions of its software
2845 packages. When you eventually reboot, you'll notice a sub-menu in the
2846 bootloader that reads ``Old system generations'': it's what allows you
2847 to boot @emph{an older generation of your system}, should the latest
2848 generation be ``broken'' or otherwise unsatisfying. Just like for
2849 packages, you can always @emph{roll back} to a previous generation
2850 @emph{of the whole system}:
2851
2852 @example
2853 sudo guix system roll-back
2854 @end example
2855
2856 There are many things you'll probably want to tweak on your system:
2857 adding new user accounts, adding new system services, fiddling with the
2858 configuration of those services, etc. The system configuration is
2859 @emph{entirely} described in the @file{/etc/config.scm} file.
2860 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, to learn how to change it.
2861
2862 Now you know enough to get started!
2863
2864 @quotation Resources
2865 The rest of this manual provides a reference for all things Guix. Here
2866 are some additional resources you may find useful:
2867
2868 @itemize
2869 @item
2870 @xref{Top,,, guix-cookbook, The GNU Guix Cookbook}, for a list of
2871 ``how-to'' style of recipes for a variety of applications.
2872
2873 @item
2874 The @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/guix-refcard.pdf, GNU Guix Reference
2875 Card} lists in two pages most of the commands and options you'll ever
2876 need.
2877
2878 @item
2879 The web site contains @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/en/videos/,
2880 instructional videos} covering topics such as everyday use of Guix, how
2881 to get help, and how to become a contributor.
2882
2883 @item
2884 @xref{Documentation}, to learn how to access documentation on your
2885 computer.
2886 @end itemize
2887
2888 We hope you will enjoy Guix as much as the community enjoys building it!
2889 @end quotation
2890
2891 @c *********************************************************************
2892 @node Package Management
2893 @chapter Package Management
2894
2895 @cindex packages
2896 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2897 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2898 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2899 features.
2900
2901 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2902 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2903 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2904 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2905 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2906 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2907 with it):
2908
2909 @example
2910 guix install emacs-guix
2911 @end example
2912
2913 @menu
2914 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2915 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2916 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2917 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2918 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2919 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2920 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2921 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2922 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2923 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2924 @end menu
2925
2926 @node Features
2927 @section Features
2928
2929 Here we assume you've already made your first steps with Guix
2930 (@pxref{Getting Started}) and would like to get an overview about what's
2931 going on under the hood.
2932
2933 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2934 own directory---something that resembles
2935 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2936
2937 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2938 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2939 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2940 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2941
2942 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2943 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2944 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2945 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2946 simply continues to point to
2947 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2948 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2949
2950 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2951 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2952 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2953
2954 @cindex transactions
2955 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2956 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2957 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2958 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2959 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2960 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2961
2962 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2963 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2964 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2965 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2966 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2967 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2968 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2969
2970 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2971 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2972 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2973 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2974 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2975 collected.
2976
2977 @cindex reproducibility
2978 @cindex reproducible builds
2979 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2980 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2981 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2982 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2983 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2984 given package installation matches the current state of their
2985 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2986 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2987 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2988 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2989
2990 @cindex substitutes
2991 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2992 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2993 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2994 downloads it and unpacks it;
2995 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2996 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2997 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2998 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2999 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
3000
3001 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
3002 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
3003 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
3004 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
3005 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3006
3007 @cindex replication, of software environments
3008 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
3009 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
3010 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
3011 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
3012 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
3013 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
3014 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
3015
3016 @node Invoking guix package
3017 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
3018
3019 @cindex installing packages
3020 @cindex removing packages
3021 @cindex package installation
3022 @cindex package removal
3023 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
3024 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
3025 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
3026 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
3027 is:
3028
3029 @example
3030 guix package @var{options}
3031 @end example
3032
3033 @cindex transactions
3034 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
3035 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
3036 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
3037 want to roll back.
3038
3039 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
3040 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
3041
3042 @example
3043 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
3044 @end example
3045
3046 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
3047 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
3048
3049 @itemize
3050 @item
3051 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
3052 @item
3053 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
3054 @item
3055 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
3056 @item
3057 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
3058 @item
3059 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
3060 @end itemize
3061
3062 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
3063 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
3064 package} directly.
3065
3066 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
3067 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
3068 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
3069 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
3070
3071 @cindex profile
3072 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
3073 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
3074 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
3075 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @env{PATH} environment
3076 variable, and so on.
3077 @cindex search paths
3078 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
3079 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
3080 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
3081 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
3082
3083 @example
3084 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
3085 source "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
3086 @end example
3087
3088 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
3089 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
3090 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
3091 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
3092 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
3093 @option{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
3094 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
3095 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
3096 package}.
3097
3098 The @var{options} can be among the following:
3099
3100 @table @code
3101
3102 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
3103 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
3104 Install the specified @var{package}s.
3105
3106 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
3107 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
3108 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
3109 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected).
3110
3111 If no version number is specified, the
3112 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
3113 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
3114 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
3115 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
3116 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
3117 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3118
3119 @cindex propagated inputs
3120 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
3121 that automatically get installed along with the required package
3122 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
3123 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
3124 package definitions).
3125
3126 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
3127 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
3128 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
3129 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
3130 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
3131 also been explicitly installed by the user.
3132
3133 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
3134 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
3135 @option{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
3136 environment variable definitions are reported here.
3137
3138 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
3139 @itemx -e @var{exp}
3140 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
3141
3142 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
3143 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
3144 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
3145 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
3146
3147 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
3148 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
3149 multiple-output package.
3150
3151 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
3152 @itemx -f @var{file}
3153 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
3154
3155 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
3156 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
3157
3158 @lisp
3159 @include package-hello.scm
3160 @end lisp
3161
3162 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
3163 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
3164 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
3165 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3166
3167 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
3168 package definitions. Running @code{guix package -f} on
3169 @file{hello.json} with the following contents would result in installing
3170 the package @code{greeter} after building @code{myhello}:
3171
3172 @example
3173 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
3174 @end example
3175
3176 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
3177 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
3178 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
3179
3180 As for @option{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
3181 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
3182 @samp{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
3183 @code{glibc}.
3184
3185 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3186 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3187 @cindex upgrading packages
3188 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
3189 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
3190 @var{regexp}. Also see the @option{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
3191
3192 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
3193 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
3194 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
3195 pull}).
3196
3197 @cindex package transformations, upgrades
3198 When upgrading, package transformations that were originally applied
3199 when creating the profile are automatically re-applied (@pxref{Package
3200 Transformation Options}). For example, assume you first installed Emacs
3201 from the tip of its development branch with:
3202
3203 @example
3204 guix install emacs-next --with-branch=emacs-next=master
3205 @end example
3206
3207 Next time you run @command{guix upgrade}, Guix will again pull the tip
3208 of the Emacs development branch and build @code{emacs-next} from that
3209 checkout.
3210
3211 Note that transformation options such as @option{--with-branch} and
3212 @option{--with-source} depend on external state; it is up to you to
3213 ensure that they work as expected. You can also discard a
3214 transformations that apply to a package by running:
3215
3216 @example
3217 guix install @var{package}
3218 @end example
3219
3220 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3221 When used together with the @option{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
3222 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
3223 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
3224 substring ``emacs'':
3225
3226 @example
3227 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
3228 @end example
3229
3230 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
3231 @itemx -m @var{file}
3232 @cindex profile declaration
3233 @cindex profile manifest
3234 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
3235 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
3236 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
3237
3238 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
3239 constructing it through a sequence of @option{--install} and similar
3240 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
3241 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
3242 so on.
3243
3244 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
3245 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
3246 of packages:
3247
3248 @findex packages->manifest
3249 @lisp
3250 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
3251
3252 (packages->manifest
3253 (list emacs
3254 guile-2.0
3255 ;; Use a specific package output.
3256 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
3257 @end lisp
3258
3259 @findex specifications->manifest
3260 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
3261 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
3262 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
3263 instead provide regular package specifications and let
3264 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
3265 objects, like this:
3266
3267 @lisp
3268 (specifications->manifest
3269 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
3270 @end lisp
3271
3272 @item --roll-back
3273 @cindex rolling back
3274 @cindex undoing transactions
3275 @cindex transactions, undoing
3276 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
3277 the last transaction.
3278
3279 When combined with options such as @option{--install}, roll back occurs
3280 before any other actions.
3281
3282 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
3283 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
3284 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
3285
3286 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
3287 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
3288 generations in a profile is always linear.
3289
3290 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3291 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3292 @cindex generations
3293 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3294
3295 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3296 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3297 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3298 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
3299 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
3300
3301 The difference between @option{--roll-back} and
3302 @option{--switch-generation=-1} is that @option{--switch-generation} will
3303 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
3304 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
3305
3306 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
3307 @cindex search paths
3308 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
3309 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
3310 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
3311 of the installed packages.
3312
3313 For example, GCC needs the @env{CPATH} and @env{LIBRARY_PATH}
3314 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
3315 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
3316 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
3317 library are installed in the profile, then @option{--search-paths} will
3318 suggest setting these variables to @file{@var{profile}/include} and
3319 @file{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
3320
3321 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
3322 shell:
3323
3324 @example
3325 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
3326 @end example
3327
3328 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
3329 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
3330 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
3331 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
3332
3333 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
3334 of several profiles. Consider this example:
3335
3336 @example
3337 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
3338 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
3339 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
3340 @end example
3341
3342 The last command above reports about the @env{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
3343 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
3344 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
3345
3346
3347 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3348 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3349 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
3350
3351 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
3352 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
3353 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
3354 installed:
3355
3356 @example
3357 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
3358 @dots{}
3359 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
3360 Hello, world!
3361 @end example
3362
3363 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
3364 siblings that point to specific generations:
3365
3366 @example
3367 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
3368 @end example
3369
3370 @item --list-profiles
3371 List all the user's profiles:
3372
3373 @example
3374 $ guix package --list-profiles
3375 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
3376 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
3377 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
3378 /home/charlie/tmp/test
3379 @end example
3380
3381 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
3382
3383 @cindex collisions, in a profile
3384 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
3385 @cindex profile collisions
3386 @item --allow-collisions
3387 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3388
3389 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3390 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3391 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3392
3393 @item --bootstrap
3394 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3395 useful to distribution developers.
3396
3397 @end table
3398
3399 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3400 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3401 availability of packages:
3402
3403 @table @option
3404
3405 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3406 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3407 @anchor{guix-search}
3408 @cindex searching for packages
3409 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3410 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3411 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3412 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3413 GNU recutils manual}).
3414
3415 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3416 command, for instance:
3417
3418 @example
3419 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3420 name: jemalloc
3421 version: 4.5.0
3422 relevance: 6
3423
3424 name: glibc
3425 version: 2.25
3426 relevance: 1
3427
3428 name: libgc
3429 version: 7.6.0
3430 relevance: 1
3431 @end example
3432
3433 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3434 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3435
3436 @example
3437 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3438 name: elfutils
3439
3440 name: gmp
3441 @dots{}
3442 @end example
3443
3444 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3445 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3446 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3447 the @command{guix search} alias):
3448
3449 @example
3450 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3451 name: gnubg
3452 @dots{}
3453 @end example
3454
3455 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3456 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3457 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3458 keyboards.
3459
3460 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3461 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3462 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3463
3464 @example
3465 $ guix search crypto library | \
3466 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3467 @end example
3468
3469 @noindent
3470 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3471 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3472
3473 @item --show=@var{package}
3474 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3475 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3476 recutils manual}).
3477
3478 @example
3479 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3480 name: python
3481 version: 2.7.6
3482
3483 name: python
3484 version: 3.3.5
3485 @end example
3486
3487 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3488 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3489 @example
3490 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3491 name: python
3492 version: 3.4.3
3493 @end example
3494
3495
3496
3497 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3498 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3499 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3500 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3501 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3502
3503 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3504 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3505 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3506 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3507 the store.
3508
3509 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3510 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3511 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3512 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3513 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3514
3515 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3516 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3517 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3518
3519 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3520 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3521 @cindex generations
3522 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3523 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3524 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3525 shown.
3526
3527 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3528 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3529 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3530 location of this package in the store.
3531
3532 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3533 generations. Valid patterns include:
3534
3535 @itemize
3536 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3537 generation numbers. For instance, @option{--list-generations=1} returns
3538 the first one.
3539
3540 And @option{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3541 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3542
3543 @item @emph{Ranges}. @option{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3544 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3545 a range must be smaller than its end.
3546
3547 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3548 @option{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3549 second one.
3550
3551 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3552 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3553 duration. For example, @option{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3554 that are up to 20 days old.
3555 @end itemize
3556
3557 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3558 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3559 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3560 one.
3561
3562 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3563 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3564 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3565 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3566 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3567
3568 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3569 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3570
3571 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3572 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3573
3574 @end table
3575
3576 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3577 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3578 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3579 @option{--with-source}, and preserves them across upgrades
3580 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3581
3582 @node Substitutes
3583 @section Substitutes
3584
3585 @cindex substitutes
3586 @cindex pre-built binaries
3587 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3588 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3589 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3590 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3591 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3592
3593 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3594 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3595 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3596 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3597
3598 @menu
3599 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3600 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3601 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
3602 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3603 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3604 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3605 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3606 @end menu
3607
3608 @node Official Substitute Server
3609 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3610
3611 @cindex build farm
3612 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3613 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3614 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3615 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3616 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3617 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3618 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3619 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3620 option}).
3621
3622 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3623 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3624 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3625 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3626 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3627
3628 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3629 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3630 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3631 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3632 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3633 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3634 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3635 other substitute server.
3636
3637 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3638 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3639
3640 @cindex security
3641 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3642 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3643 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3644 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3645 mirror thereof, you
3646 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3647 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3648 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3649 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3650
3651 @quotation Note
3652 If you are using Guix System, you can skip this section: Guix System
3653 authorizes substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} by default.
3654 @end quotation
3655
3656 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3657 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3658 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3659 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3660 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3661 Then, you can run something like this:
3662
3663 @example
3664 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3665 @end example
3666
3667 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3668 should change from something like:
3669
3670 @example
3671 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3672 The following derivations would be built:
3673 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3674 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3675 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3676 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3677 @dots{}
3678 @end example
3679
3680 @noindent
3681 to something like:
3682
3683 @example
3684 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3685 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3686 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3687 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3688 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3689 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3690 @dots{}
3691 @end example
3692
3693 @noindent
3694 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3695 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3696 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and will be downloaded, when
3697 possible, for future builds.
3698
3699 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3700 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3701 @code{guix-daemon} with @option{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3702 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3703 @option{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package},
3704 @command{guix build}, and other command-line tools.
3705
3706 @node Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3707 @subsection Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3708
3709 @cindex substitute servers, adding more
3710 Guix can look up and fetch substitutes from several servers. This is
3711 useful when you are using packages from additional channels for which
3712 the official server does not have substitutes but another server
3713 provides them. Another situation where this is useful is when you would
3714 prefer to download from your organization's substitute server, resorting
3715 to the official server only as a fallback or dismissing it altogether.
3716
3717 You can give Guix a list of substitute server URLs and it will check
3718 them in the specified order. You also need to explicitly authorize the
3719 public keys of substitute servers to instruct Guix to accept the
3720 substitutes they sign.
3721
3722 On Guix System, this is achieved by modifying the configuration of the
3723 @code{guix} service. Since the @code{guix} service is part of the
3724 default lists of services, @code{%base-services} and
3725 @code{%desktop-services}, you can use @code{modify-services} to change
3726 its configuration and add the URLs and substitute keys that you want
3727 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}).
3728
3729 As an example, suppose you want to fetch substitutes from
3730 @code{guix.example.org} and to authorize the signing key of that server,
3731 in addition to the default @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. The
3732 resulting operating system configuration will look something like:
3733
3734 @lisp
3735 (operating-system
3736 ;; @dots{}
3737 (services
3738 ;; Assume we're starting from '%desktop-services'. Replace it
3739 ;; with the list of services you're actually using.
3740 (modify-services %desktop-services
3741 (guix-service-type config =>
3742 (guix-configuration
3743 (inherit config)
3744 (substitute-urls
3745 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
3746 %default-substitute-urls))
3747 (authorized-keys
3748 (append (list (local-file "./key.pub"))
3749 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))))))
3750 @end lisp
3751
3752 This assumes that the file @file{key.pub} contains the signing key of
3753 @code{guix.example.org}. With this change in place in your operating
3754 system configuration file (say @file{/etc/config.scm}), you can
3755 reconfigure and restart the @code{guix-daemon} service or reboot so the
3756 changes take effect:
3757
3758 @example
3759 $ sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
3760 $ sudo herd restart guix-daemon
3761 @end example
3762
3763 If you're running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', you would instead take
3764 the following steps to get substitutes from additional servers:
3765
3766 @enumerate
3767 @item
3768 Edit the service configuration file for @code{guix-daemon}; when using
3769 systemd, this is normally
3770 @file{/etc/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}. Add the
3771 @option{--substitute-urls} option on the @command{guix-daemon} command
3772 line and list the URLs of interest (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,
3773 @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}}):
3774
3775 @example
3776 @dots{} --substitute-urls='https://guix.example.org https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'
3777 @end example
3778
3779 @item
3780 Restart the daemon. For systemd, it goes like this:
3781
3782 @example
3783 systemctl daemon-reload
3784 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
3785 @end example
3786
3787 @item
3788 Authorize the key of the new server (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
3789
3790 @example
3791 guix archive --authorize < key.pub
3792 @end example
3793
3794 Again this assumes @file{key.pub} contains the public key that
3795 @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign substitutes.
3796 @end enumerate
3797
3798 Now you're all set! Substitutes will be preferably taken from
3799 @code{https://guix.example.org}, using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
3800 as a fallback. Of course you can list as many substitute servers as you
3801 like, with the caveat that substitute lookup can be slowed down if too
3802 many servers need to be contacted.
3803
3804 Note that there are also situations where one may want to add the URL of
3805 a substitute server @emph{without} authorizing its key.
3806 @xref{Substitute Authentication}, to understand this fine point.
3807
3808 @node Substitute Authentication
3809 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3810
3811 @cindex digital signatures
3812 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3813 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3814 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3815
3816 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3817 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3818 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3819 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3820 with this option:
3821
3822 @example
3823 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3824 @end example
3825
3826 @noindent
3827 @cindex reproducible builds
3828 If the ACL contains only the key for @samp{b.example.org}, and if
3829 @samp{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3830 then Guix will download substitutes from @samp{a.example.org} because it
3831 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3832 @samp{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3833 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3834 below).
3835
3836 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3837 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3838 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3839 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3840 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3841 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys).
3842
3843 @node Proxy Settings
3844 @subsection Proxy Settings
3845
3846 @vindex http_proxy
3847 @vindex https_proxy
3848 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS@. The @env{http_proxy} and
3849 @env{https_proxy} environment variables can be set in the environment of
3850 @command{guix-daemon} and are honored for downloads of substitutes.
3851 Note that the value of those environment variables in the environment
3852 where @command{guix build}, @command{guix package}, and other client
3853 commands are run has @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3854
3855 @node Substitution Failure
3856 @subsection Substitution Failure
3857
3858 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3859 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3860 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3861 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3862 etc.
3863
3864 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3865 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3866 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3867 @option{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3868 option @option{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @option{--fallback} was
3869 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3870 considered to have failed. However, if @option{--fallback} was given,
3871 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3872 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3873 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3874 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3875 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3876 @option{--fallback} was given.
3877
3878 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3879 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3880 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3881 by a server.
3882
3883 @node On Trusting Binaries
3884 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3885
3886 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3887 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3888 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3889 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3890 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3891 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3892 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3893 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3894 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3895 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3896
3897 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3898 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3899 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3900 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3901 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3902 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3903 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3904 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3905 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3906 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3907 @command{guix build --check}}).
3908
3909 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3910 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3911 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3912
3913 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3914 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3915
3916 @cindex multiple-output packages
3917 @cindex package outputs
3918 @cindex outputs
3919
3920 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3921 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3922 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3923 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3924 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3925 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3926 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3927 files.
3928
3929 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3930 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3931 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3932 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3933 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3934 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3935 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3936
3937 @example
3938 guix install glib
3939 @end example
3940
3941 @cindex documentation
3942 The command to install its documentation is:
3943
3944 @example
3945 guix install glib:doc
3946 @end example
3947
3948 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3949 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3950 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3951 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3952 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3953 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3954 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3955 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3956 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3957
3958 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3959 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3960 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3961 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3962 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3963 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3964 guix package}).
3965
3966
3967 @node Invoking guix gc
3968 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3969
3970 @cindex garbage collector
3971 @cindex disk space
3972 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3973 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3974 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3975 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3976 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3977
3978 @cindex GC roots
3979 @cindex garbage collector roots
3980 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3981 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3982 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3983 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3984 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3985 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3986 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3987 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3988
3989 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3990 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3991 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3992 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3993 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3994
3995 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3996 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3997 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3998
3999 @example
4000 guix gc -F 5G
4001 @end example
4002
4003 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
4004 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
4005 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
4006 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
4007 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
4008 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
4009 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
4010
4011 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
4012 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
4013 files (the @option{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
4014 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
4015 options are as follows:
4016
4017 @table @code
4018 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
4019 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
4020 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
4021 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
4022 specified.
4023
4024 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
4025 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4026 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
4027 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
4028
4029 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
4030
4031 @item --free-space=@var{free}
4032 @itemx -F @var{free}
4033 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
4034 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
4035 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
4036
4037 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
4038 nothing and exit immediately.
4039
4040 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
4041 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
4042 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
4043 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
4044 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
4045
4046 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
4047 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
4048 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
4049
4050 @example
4051 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
4052 @end example
4053
4054 @item --delete
4055 @itemx -D
4056 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
4057 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
4058 they are still live.
4059
4060 @item --list-failures
4061 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
4062
4063 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
4064 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
4065 @option{--cache-failures}}).
4066
4067 @item --list-roots
4068 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
4069 roots.
4070
4071 @item --list-busy
4072 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
4073 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
4074
4075 @item --clear-failures
4076 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
4077
4078 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
4079 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
4080
4081 @item --list-dead
4082 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
4083 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
4084
4085 @item --list-live
4086 Show the list of live store files and directories.
4087
4088 @end table
4089
4090 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
4091
4092 @table @code
4093
4094 @item --references
4095 @itemx --referrers
4096 @cindex package dependencies
4097 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
4098 as arguments.
4099
4100 @item --requisites
4101 @itemx -R
4102 @cindex closure
4103 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
4104 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
4105 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
4106 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
4107
4108 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
4109 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
4110 the graph of references.
4111
4112 @item --derivers
4113 @cindex derivation
4114 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
4115 (@pxref{Derivations}).
4116
4117 For example, this command:
4118
4119 @example
4120 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
4121 @end example
4122
4123 @noindent
4124 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
4125 installed in your profile.
4126
4127 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
4128 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
4129 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
4130 @end table
4131
4132 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
4133 store and to control disk usage.
4134
4135 @table @option
4136
4137 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
4138 @cindex integrity, of the store
4139 @cindex integrity checking
4140 Verify the integrity of the store.
4141
4142 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
4143 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
4144
4145 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
4146 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
4147
4148 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
4149 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
4150 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
4151 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
4152 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
4153
4154 @cindex repairing the store
4155 @cindex corruption, recovering from
4156 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
4157 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
4158 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
4159 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
4160 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
4161 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
4162 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
4163
4164 @item --optimize
4165 @cindex deduplication
4166 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
4167 @dfn{deduplication}.
4168
4169 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
4170 import, unless it was started with @option{--disable-deduplication}
4171 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
4172 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
4173 @option{--disable-deduplication}.
4174
4175 @end table
4176
4177 @node Invoking guix pull
4178 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
4179
4180 @cindex upgrading Guix
4181 @cindex updating Guix
4182 @cindex @command{guix pull}
4183 @cindex pull
4184 @cindex security, @command{guix pull}
4185 @cindex authenticity, of code obtained with @command{guix pull}
4186 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
4187 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
4188 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
4189 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
4190 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
4191 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
4192 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized. @command{guix
4193 pull} ensures that the code it downloads is @emph{authentic} by
4194 verifying that commits are signed by Guix developers.
4195
4196 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
4197 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
4198
4199 @enumerate
4200 @item
4201 the @option{--channels} option;
4202 @item
4203 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
4204 @item
4205 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
4206 @item
4207 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
4208 variable.
4209 @end enumerate
4210
4211 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
4212 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
4213 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
4214 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
4215 become available.
4216
4217 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
4218 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
4219 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
4220 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
4221 versa.
4222
4223 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
4224 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
4225 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
4226 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
4227 (@pxref{Documentation}):
4228
4229 @example
4230 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
4231 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
4232 @end example
4233
4234 The @option{--list-generations} or @option{-l} option lists past generations
4235 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
4236
4237 @example
4238 $ guix pull -l
4239 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
4240 guix 65956ad
4241 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4242 branch: origin/master
4243 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
4244
4245 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
4246 guix e0cc7f6
4247 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4248 branch: origin/master
4249 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
4250 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
4251 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
4252 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
4253 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
4254
4255 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
4256 guix 844cc1c
4257 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4258 branch: origin/master
4259 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
4260 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
4261 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
4262 @end example
4263
4264 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
4265 describe the current status of Guix.
4266
4267 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
4268 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
4269 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
4270 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
4271
4272 @example
4273 $ guix pull --roll-back
4274 switched from generation 3 to 2
4275 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
4276 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4277 @end example
4278
4279 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
4280 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
4281 @example
4282 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
4283 switched from generation 3 to 2
4284 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
4285 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4286 @end example
4287
4288 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
4289 but it supports the following options:
4290
4291 @table @code
4292 @item --url=@var{url}
4293 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4294 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4295 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4296 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4297 string), or @var{branch}.
4298
4299 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4300 @cindex configuration file for channels
4301 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
4302 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
4303 @option{--channels} option (see below).
4304
4305 @item --channels=@var{file}
4306 @itemx -C @var{file}
4307 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
4308 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
4309 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
4310 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
4311 information.
4312
4313 @cindex channel news
4314 @item --news
4315 @itemx -N
4316 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
4317 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
4318 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
4319
4320 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
4321 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
4322 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
4323
4324 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4325 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
4326 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
4327 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
4328 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
4329 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4330
4331 @item --roll-back
4332 @cindex rolling back
4333 @cindex undoing transactions
4334 @cindex transactions, undoing
4335 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
4336 undo the last transaction.
4337
4338 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
4339 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
4340 @cindex generations
4341 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
4342
4343 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
4344 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
4345 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
4346 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
4347 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
4348
4349 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4350 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
4351 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
4352 one.
4353
4354 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
4355 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
4356 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
4357 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
4358 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
4359
4360 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
4361
4362 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
4363 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
4364
4365 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
4366 current generation only.
4367
4368 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4369 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4370 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
4371
4372 @item --dry-run
4373 @itemx -n
4374 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
4375 substituted but do not actually do it.
4376
4377 @item --allow-downgrades
4378 Allow pulling older or unrelated revisions of channels than those
4379 currently in use.
4380
4381 @cindex downgrade attacks, protection against
4382 By default, @command{guix pull} protects against so-called ``downgrade
4383 attacks'' whereby the Git repository of a channel would be reset to an
4384 earlier or unrelated revision of itself, potentially leading you to
4385 install older, known-vulnerable versions of software packages.
4386
4387 @quotation Note
4388 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4389 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
4390 @end quotation
4391
4392 @item --disable-authentication
4393 Allow pulling channel code without authenticating it.
4394
4395 @cindex authentication, of channel code
4396 By default, @command{guix pull} authenticates code downloaded from
4397 channels by verifying that its commits are signed by authorized
4398 developers, and raises an error if this is not the case. This option
4399 instructs it to not perform any such verification.
4400
4401 @quotation Note
4402 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4403 @option{--disable-authentication}.
4404 @end quotation
4405
4406 @item --system=@var{system}
4407 @itemx -s @var{system}
4408 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4409 the system type of the build host.
4410
4411 @item --bootstrap
4412 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
4413 useful to Guix developers.
4414 @end table
4415
4416 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
4417 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
4418 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
4419 information.
4420
4421 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
4422 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4423
4424 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4425 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4426
4427 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4428 @cindex pinning, channels
4429 @cindex replicating Guix
4430 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4431
4432 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4433 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4434 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4435 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4436 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4437 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4438
4439 The general syntax is:
4440
4441 @example
4442 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4443 @end example
4444
4445 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4446 @command{guix} command of the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4447 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @item --url=@var{url}
4451 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4452 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4453 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4454 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4455 string), or @var{branch}.
4456
4457 @item --channels=@var{file}
4458 @itemx -C @var{file}
4459 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4460 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4461 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4462 @end table
4463
4464 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4465 latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4466
4467 @example
4468 guix time-machine -- build hello
4469 @end example
4470
4471 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4472 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4473 Time travel works in both directions!
4474
4475 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4476 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4477 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4478
4479 @node Inferiors
4480 @section Inferiors
4481
4482 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4483 @quotation Note
4484 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4485 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4486 @end quotation
4487
4488 @cindex inferiors
4489 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4490 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4491 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4492 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4493 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4494
4495 @cindex inferior packages
4496 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4497 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4498 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4499 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4500 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4501
4502 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4503 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4504 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4505 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4506 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4507 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4508 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4509 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4510 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4511
4512 @lisp
4513 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4514 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4515
4516 (define channels
4517 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4518 ;; extract guile-json.
4519 (list (channel
4520 (name 'guix)
4521 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4522 (commit
4523 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4524
4525 (define inferior
4526 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4527 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4528
4529 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4530 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4531 (packages->manifest
4532 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4533 (specification->package "guile")))
4534 @end lisp
4535
4536 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4537 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4538 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4539
4540 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4541 inferior:
4542
4543 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4544 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4545 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4546 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4547 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4548
4549 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4550 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4551 @end deffn
4552
4553 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4554 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4555 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4556 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4557 the inferior could not be launched.
4558 @end deffn
4559
4560 @cindex inferior packages
4561 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4562 packages.
4563
4564 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4565 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4566 @end deffn
4567
4568 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4569 [@var{version}]
4570 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4571 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4572 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4573 @end deffn
4574
4575 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4576 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4577 @end deffn
4578
4579 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4580 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4581 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4582 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4583 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4584 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4585 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4586 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4587 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4588 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4589 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4590 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4591 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4592 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4593 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4594 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4595 these procedures.
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4599 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4600 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4601 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4602 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4603 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4604 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4605 declaration, and so on.
4606
4607 @node Invoking guix describe
4608 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4609
4610 @cindex reproducibility
4611 @cindex replicating Guix
4612 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4613 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4614 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4615 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4616 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4617 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4618 command answers these questions.
4619
4620 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4621 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4622 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4623
4624 @example
4625 $ guix describe
4626 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4627 guix e0fa68c
4628 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4629 branch: master
4630 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4631 @end example
4632
4633 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4634 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4635 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4636 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4637 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4638 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4639 also to replicate it.
4640
4641 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4642 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4643
4644 @example
4645 $ guix describe -f channels
4646 (list (channel
4647 (name 'guix)
4648 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4649 (commit
4650 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")
4651 (introduction
4652 (make-channel-introduction
4653 "9edb3f66fd807b096b48283debdcddccfea34bad"
4654 (openpgp-fingerprint
4655 "BBB0 2DDF 2CEA F6A8 0D1D E643 A2A0 6DF2 A33A 54FA")))))
4656 @end example
4657
4658 @noindent
4659 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4660 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4661 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4662 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4663 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4664 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4665
4666 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4667 follows:
4668
4669 @table @code
4670 @item --format=@var{format}
4671 @itemx -f @var{format}
4672 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4673
4674 @table @code
4675 @item human
4676 produce human-readable output;
4677 @item channels
4678 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4679 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4680 guix pull});
4681 @item channels-sans-intro
4682 like @code{channels}, but omit the @code{introduction} field; use it to
4683 produce a channel specification suitable for Guix version 1.1.0 or
4684 earlier---the @code{introduction} field has to do with channel
4685 authentication (@pxref{Channels, Channel Authentication}) and is not
4686 supported by these older versions;
4687 @item json
4688 @cindex JSON
4689 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4690 @item recutils
4691 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4692 @end table
4693
4694 @item --list-formats
4695 Display available formats for @option{--format} option.
4696
4697 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4698 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4699 Display information about @var{profile}.
4700 @end table
4701
4702 @node Invoking guix archive
4703 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4704
4705 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4706 @cindex archive
4707 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4708 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4709 a machine that runs Guix.
4710 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4711 to the store on another machine.
4712
4713 @quotation Note
4714 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4715 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4716 @end quotation
4717
4718 @cindex exporting store items
4719 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4720
4721 @example
4722 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4723 @end example
4724
4725 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4726 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4727 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4728 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4729 output of @code{emacs}:
4730
4731 @example
4732 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4733 @end example
4734
4735 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4736 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4737 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4738
4739 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4740 one would run:
4741
4742 @example
4743 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4744 @end example
4745
4746 @noindent
4747 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4748 to another like this:
4749
4750 @example
4751 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4752 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4753 @end example
4754
4755 @noindent
4756 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4757 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4758 @option{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on
4759 the target machine. The @option{--missing} option can help figure out
4760 which items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4761 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4762 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4763
4764 @cindex nar, archive format
4765 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4766 @cindex nar bundle, archive format
4767 Each store item is written in the @dfn{normalized archive} or @dfn{nar}
4768 format (described below), and the output of @command{guix archive
4769 --export} (and input of @command{guix archive --import}) is a @dfn{nar
4770 bundle}.
4771
4772 The nar format is
4773 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4774 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4775 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4776 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4777 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4778 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4779 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4780 deterministic.
4781
4782 That nar bundle format is essentially the concatenation of zero or more
4783 nars along with metadata for each store item it contains: its file name,
4784 references, corresponding derivation, and a digital signature.
4785
4786 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4787 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4788 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4789 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4790 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4791
4792 The main options are:
4793
4794 @table @code
4795 @item --export
4796 Export the specified store files or packages (see below). Write the
4797 resulting archive to the standard output.
4798
4799 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4800 @option{--recursive} is passed.
4801
4802 @item -r
4803 @itemx --recursive
4804 When combined with @option{--export}, this instructs @command{guix archive}
4805 to include dependencies of the given items in the archive. Thus, the
4806 resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure of the
4807 exported store items.
4808
4809 @item --import
4810 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4811 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4812 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4813 keys (see @option{--authorize} below).
4814
4815 @item --missing
4816 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4817 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4818 the store.
4819
4820 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4821 @cindex signing, archives
4822 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4823 archives can be exported with @option{--export}. This
4824 operation is usually instantaneous but it can take time if the system's
4825 entropy pool needs to be refilled. On Guix System,
4826 @code{guix-service-type} takes care of generating this key pair the
4827 first boot.
4828
4829 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4830 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4831 key, which must be kept secret). When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4832 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4833 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4834 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4835 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4836 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4837 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4838
4839 @item --authorize
4840 @cindex authorizing, archives
4841 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4842 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4843 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4844
4845 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4846 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4847 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4848 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4849 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4850 (SPKI)}.
4851
4852 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4853 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4854 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4855 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4856 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4857
4858 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4859 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4860
4861 @example
4862 $ wget -O - \
4863 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/gzip/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4864 | gunzip | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4865 @end example
4866
4867 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4868 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4869 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4870 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4871 unsafe.
4872
4873 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4874 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers
4875 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
4876
4877 @item --list
4878 @itemx -t
4879 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4880 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4881 this example:
4882
4883 @example
4884 $ wget -O - \
4885 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4886 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4887 @end example
4888
4889 @end table
4890
4891 @c *********************************************************************
4892 @node Channels
4893 @chapter Channels
4894
4895 @cindex channels
4896 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4897 @cindex configuration file for channels
4898 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
4899 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
4900 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
4901 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
4902 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
4903 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
4904 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
4905 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
4906 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used
4907 to @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
4908 Guix is able to take into account security concerns and deal with authenticated
4909 updates.
4910
4911 @menu
4912 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
4913 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
4914 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
4915 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
4916 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
4917 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
4918 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
4919 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
4920 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
4921 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
4922 @end menu
4923
4924 @node Specifying Additional Channels
4925 @section Specifying Additional Channels
4926
4927 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
4928 @cindex variant packages (channels)
4929 You can specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. To use a channel, write
4930 @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct @command{guix pull} to pull from it
4931 @emph{in addition} to the default Guix channel(s):
4932
4933 @vindex %default-channels
4934 @lisp
4935 ;; Add variant packages to those Guix provides.
4936 (cons (channel
4937 (name 'variant-packages)
4938 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git"))
4939 %default-channels)
4940 @end lisp
4941
4942 @noindent
4943 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
4944 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
4945 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
4946 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
4947 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
4948 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
4949 modules:
4950
4951 @example
4952 $ guix pull --list-generations
4953 @dots{}
4954 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
4955 guix d894ab8
4956 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4957 branch: master
4958 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
4959 variant-packages dd3df5e
4960 repository URL: https://example.org/variant-packages.git
4961 branch: master
4962 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
4963 11 new packages: variant-gimp, variant-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
4964 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
4965 @end example
4966
4967 @noindent
4968 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
4969 both Guix and packages from the @code{variant-personal-packages} channel. Among
4970 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{variant-gimp} and
4971 @code{variant-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
4972 @code{variant-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
4973
4974 @node Using a Custom Guix Channel
4975 @section Using a Custom Guix Channel
4976
4977 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
4978 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
4979 suppose you want to update from another copy of the Guix repository at
4980 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
4981 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
4982
4983 @lisp
4984 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use another repo.
4985 (list (channel
4986 (name 'guix)
4987 (url "https://example.org/another-guix.git")
4988 (branch "super-hacks")))
4989 @end lisp
4990
4991 @noindent
4992 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
4993 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}. The authentication concern is
4994 addressed below ((@pxref{Channel Authentication}).
4995
4996 @node Replicating Guix
4997 @section Replicating Guix
4998
4999 @cindex pinning, channels
5000 @cindex replicating Guix
5001 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
5002 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
5003 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
5004 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
5005 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
5006
5007 @lisp
5008 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
5009 (list (channel
5010 (name 'guix)
5011 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
5012 (commit "6298c3ffd9654d3231a6f25390b056483e8f407c"))
5013 (channel
5014 (name 'variant-packages)
5015 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git")
5016 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
5017 @end lisp
5018
5019 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
5020 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
5021 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
5022 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
5023 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
5024
5025 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
5026 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
5027 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
5028 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
5029 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
5030 package it defines.
5031
5032 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
5033 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
5034 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
5035 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
5036
5037 @node Channel Authentication
5038 @section Channel Authentication
5039
5040 @anchor{channel-authentication}
5041 @cindex authentication, of channel code
5042 The @command{guix pull} and @command{guix time-machine} commands
5043 @dfn{authenticate} the code retrieved from channels: they make sure each
5044 commit that is fetched is signed by an authorized developer. The goal
5045 is to protect from unauthorized modifications to the channel that would
5046 lead users to run malicious code.
5047
5048 As a user, you must provide a @dfn{channel introduction} in your
5049 channels file so that Guix knows how to authenticate its first commit.
5050 A channel specification, including its introduction, looks something
5051 along these lines:
5052
5053 @lisp
5054 (channel
5055 (name 'some-channel)
5056 (url "https://example.org/some-channel.git")
5057 (introduction
5058 (make-channel-introduction
5059 "6f0d8cc0d88abb59c324b2990bfee2876016bb86"
5060 (openpgp-fingerprint
5061 "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5062 @end lisp
5063
5064 The specification above shows the name and URL of the channel. The call
5065 to @code{make-channel-introduction} above specifies that authentication
5066 of this channel starts at commit @code{6f0d8cc@dots{}}, which is signed
5067 by the OpenPGP key with fingerprint @code{CABB A931@dots{}}.
5068
5069 For the main channel, called @code{guix}, you automatically get that
5070 information from your Guix installation. For other channels, include
5071 the channel introduction provided by the channel authors in your
5072 @file{channels.scm} file. Make sure you retrieve the channel
5073 introduction from a trusted source since that is the root of your trust.
5074
5075 If you're curious about the authentication mechanics, read on!
5076
5077 @node Creating a Channel
5078 @section Creating a Channel
5079
5080 @cindex personal packages (channels)
5081 @cindex channels, for personal packages
5082 Let's say you have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages
5083 that you think would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but
5084 would like to have these packages transparently available to you at the
5085 command line. You would first write modules containing those package
5086 definitions (@pxref{Package Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and
5087 then you and anyone else can use it as an additional channel to get packages
5088 from. Neat, no?
5089
5090 @c What follows stems from discussions at
5091 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
5092 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
5093 @quotation Warning
5094 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
5095 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
5096 of caution:
5097
5098 @itemize
5099 @item
5100 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
5101 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
5102 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
5103 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
5104 process.
5105
5106 @item
5107 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
5108 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
5109 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
5110 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
5111 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
5112 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
5113 either.
5114
5115 @item
5116 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
5117 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
5118 @end itemize
5119
5120 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
5121 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
5122 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
5123 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
5124 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
5125 @end quotation
5126
5127 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
5128 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
5129 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
5130 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
5131 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
5132 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
5133 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
5134 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
5135 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
5136 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5137
5138 As a channel author, consider bundling authentication material with your
5139 channel so that users can authenticate it. @xref{Channel
5140 Authentication}, and @ref{Specifying Channel Authorizations}, for info
5141 on how to do it.
5142
5143
5144 @node Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5145 @section Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5146
5147 @cindex subdirectory, channels
5148 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
5149 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
5150 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
5151
5152 @lisp
5153 (channel
5154 (version 0)
5155 (directory "guix"))
5156 @end lisp
5157
5158 @node Declaring Channel Dependencies
5159 @section Declaring Channel Dependencies
5160
5161 @cindex dependencies, channels
5162 @cindex meta-data, channels
5163 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
5164 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
5165 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
5166 the channel repository.
5167
5168 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
5169
5170 @lisp
5171 (channel
5172 (version 0)
5173 (dependencies
5174 (channel
5175 (name 'some-collection)
5176 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git")
5177
5178 ;; The 'introduction' bit below is optional: you would
5179 ;; provide it for dependencies that can be authenticated.
5180 (introduction
5181 (channel-introduction
5182 (version 0)
5183 (commit "a8883b58dc82e167c96506cf05095f37c2c2c6cd")
5184 (signer "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5185 (channel
5186 (name 'some-other-collection)
5187 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
5188 (branch "testing"))))
5189 @end lisp
5190
5191 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
5192 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
5193 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
5194 channels are available.
5195
5196 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
5197 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
5198 dependencies to a minimum.
5199
5200 @node Specifying Channel Authorizations
5201 @section Specifying Channel Authorizations
5202
5203 @cindex channel authorizations
5204 @anchor{channel-authorizations}
5205 As we saw above, Guix ensures the source code it pulls from channels
5206 comes from authorized developers. As a channel author, you need to
5207 specify the list of authorized developers in the
5208 @file{.guix-authorizations} file in the channel's Git repository. The
5209 authentication rule is simple: each commit must be signed by a key
5210 listed in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its parent
5211 commit(s)@footnote{Git commits form a @dfn{directed acyclic graph}
5212 (DAG). Each commit can have zero or more parents; ``regular'' commits
5213 have one parent and merge commits have two parent commits. Read
5214 @uref{https://eagain.net/articles/git-for-computer-scientists/, @i{Git
5215 for Computer Scientists}} for a great overview.} The
5216 @file{.guix-authorizations} file looks like this:
5217
5218 @lisp
5219 ;; Example '.guix-authorizations' file.
5220
5221 (authorizations
5222 (version 0) ;current file format version
5223
5224 (("AD17 A21E F8AE D8F1 CC02 DBD9 F8AE D8F1 765C 61E3"
5225 (name "alice"))
5226 ("2A39 3FFF 68F4 EF7A 3D29 12AF 68F4 EF7A 22FB B2D5"
5227 (name "bob"))
5228 ("CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"
5229 (name "charlie"))))
5230 @end lisp
5231
5232 Each fingerprint is followed by optional key/value pairs, as in the
5233 example above. Currently these key/value pairs are ignored.
5234
5235 This authentication rule creates a chicken-and-egg issue: how do we
5236 authenticate the first commit? Related to that: how do we deal with
5237 channels whose repository history contains unsigned commits and lack
5238 @file{.guix-authorizations}? And how do we fork existing channels?
5239
5240 @cindex channel introduction
5241 Channel introductions answer these questions by describing the first
5242 commit of a channel that should be authenticated. The first time a
5243 channel is fetched with @command{guix pull} or @command{guix
5244 time-machine}, the command looks up the introductory commit and verifies
5245 that it is signed by the specified OpenPGP key. From then on, it
5246 authenticates commits according to the rule above.
5247
5248 Additionally, your channel must provide all the OpenPGP keys that were
5249 ever mentioned in @file{.guix-authorizations}, stored as @file{.key}
5250 files, which can be either binary or ``ASCII-armored''. By default,
5251 those @file{.key} files are searched for in the branch named
5252 @code{keyring} but you can specify a different branch name in
5253 @code{.guix-channel} like so:
5254
5255 @lisp
5256 (channel
5257 (version 0)
5258 (keyring-reference "my-keyring-branch"))
5259 @end lisp
5260
5261 To summarize, as the author of a channel, there are three things you have
5262 to do to allow users to authenticate your code:
5263
5264 @enumerate
5265 @item
5266 Export the OpenPGP keys of past and present committers with @command{gpg
5267 --export} and store them in @file{.key} files, by default in a branch
5268 named @code{keyring} (we recommend making it an @dfn{orphan branch}).
5269
5270 @item
5271 Introduce an initial @file{.guix-authorizations} in the channel's
5272 repository. Do that in a signed commit (@pxref{Commit Access}, for
5273 information on how to sign Git commits.)
5274
5275 @item
5276 Advertise the channel introduction, for instance on your channel's web
5277 page. The channel introduction, as we saw above, is the commit/key
5278 pair---i.e., the commit that introduced @file{.guix-authorizations}, and
5279 the fingerprint of the OpenPGP used to sign it.
5280 @end enumerate
5281
5282 Before pushing to your public Git repository, you can run @command{guix
5283 git-authenticate} to verify that you did sign all the commits you are
5284 about to push with an authorized key:
5285
5286 @example
5287 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer}
5288 @end example
5289
5290 @noindent
5291 where @var{commit} and @var{signer} are your channel introduction.
5292 @xref{Invoking guix git authenticate}, for details.
5293
5294 Publishing a signed channel requires discipline: any mistake, such as an
5295 unsigned commit or a commit signed by an unauthorized key, will prevent
5296 users from pulling from your channel---well, that's the whole point of
5297 authentication! Pay attention to merges in particular: merge commits
5298 are considered authentic if and only if they are signed by a key present
5299 in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of @emph{both} branches.
5300
5301 @node Primary URL
5302 @section Primary URL
5303
5304 @cindex primary URL, channels
5305 Channel authors can indicate the primary URL of their channel's Git
5306 repository in the @file{.guix-channel} file, like so:
5307
5308 @lisp
5309 (channel
5310 (version 0)
5311 (url "https://example.org/guix.git"))
5312 @end lisp
5313
5314 This allows @command{guix pull} to determine whether it is pulling code
5315 from a mirror of the channel; when that is the case, it warns the user
5316 that the mirror might be stale and displays the primary URL@. That way,
5317 users cannot be tricked into fetching code from a stale mirror that does
5318 not receive security updates.
5319
5320 This feature only makes sense for authenticated repositories, such as
5321 the official @code{guix} channel, for which @command{guix pull} ensures
5322 the code it fetches is authentic.
5323
5324 @node Writing Channel News
5325 @section Writing Channel News
5326
5327 @cindex news, for channels
5328 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
5329 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
5330 an email, but that's not convenient.
5331
5332 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
5333 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
5334 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
5335 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
5336
5337 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
5338 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
5339
5340 @lisp
5341 (channel
5342 (version 0)
5343 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
5344 @end lisp
5345
5346 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
5347 something like this:
5348
5349 @lisp
5350 (channel-news
5351 (version 0)
5352 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
5353 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
5354 (fr "Oh la la"))
5355 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
5356 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
5357 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
5358 (title (en "Added a great package")
5359 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
5360 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
5361 @end lisp
5362
5363 While the news file is using the Scheme syntax, avoid naming it with a
5364 @file{.scm} extension or else it will get picked up when building the
5365 channel and yield an error since it is not a valid module.
5366 Alternatively, you can move the channel module to a subdirectory and
5367 store the news file in another directory.
5368
5369 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
5370 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
5371 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
5372 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
5373
5374 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
5375 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
5376 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
5377 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
5378 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
5379
5380 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
5381 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
5382 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
5383 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
5384 file containing the strings to translate:
5385
5386 @example
5387 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.txt
5388 @end example
5389
5390 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
5391 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
5392
5393
5394 @c *********************************************************************
5395 @node Development
5396 @chapter Development
5397
5398 @cindex software development
5399 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
5400 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
5401 this chapter is about.
5402
5403 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
5404 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
5405 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
5406 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
5407 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
5408
5409 @menu
5410 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
5411 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
5412 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
5413 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
5414 @end menu
5415
5416 @node Invoking guix environment
5417 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5418
5419 @cindex reproducible build environments
5420 @cindex development environments
5421 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5422 @cindex environment, package build environment
5423 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5424 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5425 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5426 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5427 environment to use them.
5428
5429 The general syntax is:
5430
5431 @example
5432 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5433 @end example
5434
5435 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5436 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5437
5438 @example
5439 guix environment guile
5440 @end example
5441
5442 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5443 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an
5444 augmented version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was
5445 run in. It contains the necessary search paths for building the given
5446 package added to the existing environment variables. To create
5447 a ``pure'' environment, in which the original environment variables have
5448 been unset, use the @option{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes
5449 wrongfully augment environment variables such as @env{PATH} in their
5450 @file{~/.bashrc} file. As a consequence, when @command{guix
5451 environment} launches it, Bash may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby
5452 introducing ``impurities'' in these environment variables. It is an
5453 error to define such environment variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead,
5454 they should be defined in @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by
5455 log-in shells. @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference
5456 Manual}, for details on Bash start-up files.}.
5457
5458 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5459 @command{guix environment} defines the @env{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5460 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5461 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5462 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5463 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5464
5465 @example
5466 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5467 then
5468 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5469 fi
5470 @end example
5471
5472 @noindent
5473 ...@: or to browse the profile:
5474
5475 @example
5476 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5477 @end example
5478
5479 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5480 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5481 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5482 and Emacs are available:
5483
5484 @example
5485 guix environment guile emacs
5486 @end example
5487
5488 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5489 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5490 command from the rest of the arguments:
5491
5492 @example
5493 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5494 @end example
5495
5496 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5497 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5498 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5499 NumPy:
5500
5501 @example
5502 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5503 @end example
5504
5505 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5506 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5507 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5508 @option{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5509 @option{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5510 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5511 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5512 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5513 additionally includes Git and strace:
5514
5515 @example
5516 guix environment --pure guix --ad-hoc git strace
5517 @end example
5518
5519 @cindex container
5520 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5521 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5522 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
5523 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5524 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5525 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5526 working directory are mounted:
5527
5528 @example
5529 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5530 @end example
5531
5532 @quotation Note
5533 The @option{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5534 @end quotation
5535
5536 @cindex certificates
5537 Another typical use case for containers is to run security-sensitive
5538 applications such as a web browser. To run Eolie, we must expose and
5539 share some files and directories; we include @code{nss-certs} and expose
5540 @file{/etc/ssl/certs/} for HTTPS authentication; finally we preserve the
5541 @env{DISPLAY} environment variable since containerized graphical
5542 applications won't display without it.
5543
5544 @example
5545 guix environment --preserve='^DISPLAY$' --container --network \
5546 --expose=/etc/machine-id \
5547 --expose=/etc/ssl/certs/ \
5548 --share=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/ \
5549 --ad-hoc eolie nss-certs dbus -- eolie
5550 @end example
5551
5552 The available options are summarized below.
5553
5554 @table @code
5555 @item --root=@var{file}
5556 @itemx -r @var{file}
5557 @cindex persistent environment
5558 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
5559 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
5560 register it as a garbage collector root.
5561
5562 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
5563 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
5564
5565 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
5566 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
5567 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
5568 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
5569 gc}, for more on GC roots.
5570
5571 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5572 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5573 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5574 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5575
5576 For example, running:
5577
5578 @example
5579 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5580 @end example
5581
5582 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5583 PETSc package.
5584
5585 Running:
5586
5587 @example
5588 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5589 @end example
5590
5591 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
5592
5593 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
5594 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5595
5596 @example
5597 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5598 @end example
5599
5600 @item --load=@var{file}
5601 @itemx -l @var{file}
5602 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5603 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5604
5605 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5606 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5607
5608 @lisp
5609 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5610 @end lisp
5611
5612 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5613 @itemx -m @var{file}
5614 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
5615 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
5616 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
5617
5618 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
5619 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
5620 manifest files.
5621
5622 @item --ad-hoc
5623 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5624 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5625 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5626 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5627
5628 For instance, the command:
5629
5630 @example
5631 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5632 @end example
5633
5634 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5635 available.
5636
5637 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5638 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5639 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5640 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5641
5642 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5643 environment}. Packages appearing before @option{--ad-hoc} are
5644 interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be added to the
5645 environment, the default behavior. Packages appearing after are
5646 interpreted as packages that will be added to the environment directly.
5647
5648 @item --pure
5649 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
5650 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below). This has the effect of
5651 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
5652
5653 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
5654 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
5655 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
5656 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
5657 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
5658 several times.
5659
5660 @example
5661 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
5662 -- mpirun @dots{}
5663 @end example
5664
5665 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
5666 variables defined are @env{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
5667 with @samp{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@env{HOME},
5668 @env{USER}, etc.).
5669
5670 @item --search-paths
5671 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5672 environment.
5673
5674 @item --system=@var{system}
5675 @itemx -s @var{system}
5676 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5677
5678 @item --container
5679 @itemx -C
5680 @cindex container
5681 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5682 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5683 Additionally, unless overridden with @option{--user}, a dummy home
5684 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
5685 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5686
5687 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
5688 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
5689 @option{--user} is passed (see below).
5690
5691 @item --network
5692 @itemx -N
5693 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5694 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5695 device.
5696
5697 @item --link-profile
5698 @itemx -P
5699 For containers, link the environment profile to @file{~/.guix-profile}
5700 within the container and set @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT} to that.
5701 This is equivalent to making @file{~/.guix-profile} a symlink to the
5702 actual profile within the container.
5703 Linking will fail and abort the environment if the directory already
5704 exists, which will certainly be the case if @command{guix environment}
5705 was invoked in the user's home directory.
5706
5707 Certain packages are configured to look in @file{~/.guix-profile} for
5708 configuration files and data;@footnote{For example, the
5709 @code{fontconfig} package inspects @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts}
5710 for additional fonts.} @option{--link-profile} allows these programs to
5711 behave as expected within the environment.
5712
5713 @item --user=@var{user}
5714 @itemx -u @var{user}
5715 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
5716 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
5717 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
5718 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
5719 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
5720 need not exist on the system.
5721
5722 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @option{--share} and
5723 @option{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
5724 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
5725 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
5726
5727 @example
5728 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
5729 cd $HOME/wd
5730 guix environment --container --user=foo \
5731 --expose=$HOME/test \
5732 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
5733 @end example
5734
5735 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
5736 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
5737 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
5738
5739 @item --no-cwd
5740 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
5741 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
5742 directory within the container. If this is undesirable,
5743 @option{--no-cwd} will cause the current working directory to @emph{not}
5744 be automatically shared and will change to the user's home directory
5745 within the container instead. See also @option{--user}.
5746
5747 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5748 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5749 For containers, @option{--expose} (resp. @option{--share}) exposes the
5750 file system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
5751 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
5752 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5753 point in the container.
5754
5755 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5756 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5757 directory:
5758
5759 @example
5760 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
5761 @end example
5762
5763 @end table
5764
5765 @command{guix environment}
5766 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5767 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
5768 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5769
5770 @node Invoking guix pack
5771 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
5772
5773 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
5774 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
5775 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
5776 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
5777
5778 @quotation Note
5779 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5780 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5781 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5782 @end quotation
5783
5784 @cindex pack
5785 @cindex bundle
5786 @cindex application bundle
5787 @cindex software bundle
5788 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5789 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5790 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5791 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5792 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5793 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5794 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5795 that you pretend to be shipping.
5796
5797 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5798 their dependencies, you can run:
5799
5800 @example
5801 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5802 @dots{}
5803 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5804 @end example
5805
5806 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5807 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5808 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5809 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5810 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5811 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5812
5813 Users of this pack would have to run
5814 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5815 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5816 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5817
5818 @example
5819 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5820 @end example
5821
5822 @noindent
5823 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5824
5825 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5826 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5827 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5828 that case, you will want to use the @option{--relocatable} option (see
5829 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5830 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5831 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5832 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5833
5834 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5835 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5836 the following command:
5837
5838 @example
5839 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5840 @end example
5841
5842 @noindent
5843 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5844 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5845
5846 @example
5847 docker load < @var{file}
5848 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5849 @end example
5850
5851 @noindent
5852 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
5853 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
5854 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5855 documentation} for more information.
5856
5857 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5858 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5859 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5860 command:
5861
5862 @example
5863 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5864 @end example
5865
5866 @noindent
5867 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5868 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5869 @uref{https://www.sylabs.io/docs/, Singularity container execution
5870 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5871 @command{singularity exec}.
5872
5873 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5874
5875 @table @code
5876 @item --format=@var{format}
5877 @itemx -f @var{format}
5878 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5879
5880 The available formats are:
5881
5882 @table @code
5883 @item tarball
5884 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
5885 specified binaries and symlinks.
5886
5887 @item docker
5888 This produces a tarball that follows the
5889 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
5890 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
5891 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
5892 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
5893
5894 @item squashfs
5895 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
5896 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
5897 procfs.
5898
5899 @quotation Note
5900 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
5901 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
5902 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
5903 with something like:
5904
5905 @example
5906 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
5907 @end example
5908
5909 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
5910 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
5911 such file or directory'' message.
5912 @end quotation
5913 @end table
5914
5915 @cindex relocatable binaries
5916 @item --relocatable
5917 @itemx -R
5918 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
5919 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
5920
5921 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
5922 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
5923 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
5924 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
5925 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to
5926 other techniques if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially
5927 work anywhere---see below for the implications.
5928
5929 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
5930
5931 @example
5932 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
5933 @end example
5934
5935 @noindent
5936 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
5937 home directory as a normal user, run:
5938
5939 @example
5940 tar xf pack.tar.gz
5941 ./mybin/sh
5942 @end example
5943
5944 @noindent
5945 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
5946 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
5947 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
5948 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
5949 software on a non-Guix machine.
5950
5951 @quotation Note
5952 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
5953 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
5954 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
5955 turn it off.
5956
5957 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
5958 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
5959 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to another
5960 @dfn{execution engine} if user namespaces are not supported. The
5961 following execution engines are supported:
5962
5963 @table @code
5964 @item default
5965 Try user namespaces and fall back to PRoot if user namespaces are not
5966 supported (see below).
5967
5968 @item performance
5969 Try user namespaces and fall back to Fakechroot if user namespaces are
5970 not supported (see below).
5971
5972 @item userns
5973 Run the program through user namespaces and abort if they are not
5974 supported.
5975
5976 @item proot
5977 Run through PRoot. The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program
5978 provides the necessary
5979 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
5980 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
5981 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
5982 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
5983
5984 @item fakechroot
5985 Run through Fakechroot. @uref{https://github.com/dex4er/fakechroot/,
5986 Fakechroot} virtualizes file system accesses by intercepting calls to C
5987 library functions such as @code{open}, @code{stat}, @code{exec}, and so
5988 on. Unlike PRoot, it incurs very little overhead. However, it does not
5989 always work: for example, some file system accesses made from within the
5990 C library are not intercepted, and file system accesses made @i{via}
5991 direct syscalls are not intercepted either, leading to erratic behavior.
5992 @end table
5993
5994 @vindex GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE
5995 When running a wrapped program, you can explicitly request one of the
5996 execution engines listed above by setting the
5997 @env{GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE} environment variable accordingly.
5998 @end quotation
5999
6000 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
6001 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
6002 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
6003 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
6004 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
6005 pack.
6006
6007 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
6008 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
6009 do:
6010
6011 @example
6012 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
6013 @end example
6014
6015 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
6016 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
6017
6018 @example
6019 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
6020 docker run @var{image-id}
6021 @end example
6022
6023 @item --expression=@var{expr}
6024 @itemx -e @var{expr}
6025 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
6026
6027 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6028 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @option{--expression} in
6029 @command{guix build}}).
6030
6031 @item --manifest=@var{file}
6032 @itemx -m @var{file}
6033 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
6034 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
6035 case the manifests are concatenated.
6036
6037 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6038 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
6039 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
6040 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
6041 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
6042 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
6043 but not both.
6044
6045 @item --system=@var{system}
6046 @itemx -s @var{system}
6047 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
6048 the system type of the build host.
6049
6050 @item --target=@var{triplet}
6051 @cindex cross-compilation
6052 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
6053 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
6054 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6055
6056 @item --compression=@var{tool}
6057 @itemx -C @var{tool}
6058 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
6059 @code{zstd}, @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no
6060 compression.
6061
6062 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
6063 @itemx -S @var{spec}
6064 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
6065 appear several times.
6066
6067 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
6068 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
6069 symlink target.
6070
6071 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
6072 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
6073
6074 @item --save-provenance
6075 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
6076 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
6077 (@pxref{Channels}).
6078
6079 Provenance information is saved in the
6080 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
6081 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
6082 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
6083 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
6084
6085 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
6086 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
6087 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
6088 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
6089 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
6090
6091 @item --root=@var{file}
6092 @itemx -r @var{file}
6093 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
6094 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
6095 collector root.
6096
6097 @item --localstatedir
6098 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
6099 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
6100 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
6101 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
6102 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
6103
6104 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
6105 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
6106 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
6107 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
6108 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
6109
6110 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
6111 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
6112
6113 @item --derivation
6114 @itemx -d
6115 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
6116
6117 @item --bootstrap
6118 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
6119 useful to Guix developers.
6120 @end table
6121
6122 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
6123 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
6124 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6125
6126
6127 @node The GCC toolchain
6128 @section The GCC toolchain
6129
6130 @cindex GCC
6131 @cindex ld-wrapper
6132 @cindex linker wrapper
6133 @cindex toolchain, for C development
6134 @cindex toolchain, for Fortran development
6135
6136 If you need a complete toolchain for compiling and linking C or C++
6137 source code, use the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This package
6138 provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development, including GCC
6139 itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus debugging symbols
6140 in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker wrapper.
6141
6142 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
6143 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
6144 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
6145 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
6146 @env{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
6147
6148 The package @code{gfortran-toolchain} provides a complete GCC toolchain
6149 for Fortran development. For other languages, please use
6150 @samp{guix search gcc toolchain} (@pxref{guix-search,, Invoking guix package}).
6151
6152
6153 @node Invoking guix git authenticate
6154 @section Invoking @command{guix git authenticate}
6155
6156 The @command{guix git authenticate} command authenticates a Git checkout
6157 following the same rule as for channels (@pxref{channel-authentication,
6158 channel authentication}). That is, starting from a given commit, it
6159 ensures that all subsequent commits are signed by an OpenPGP key whose
6160 fingerprint appears in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its
6161 parent commit(s).
6162
6163 You will find this command useful if you maintain a channel. But in
6164 fact, this authentication mechanism is useful in a broader context, so
6165 you might want to use it for Git repositories that have nothing to do
6166 with Guix.
6167
6168 The general syntax is:
6169
6170 @example
6171 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer} [@var{options}@dots{}]
6172 @end example
6173
6174 By default, this command authenticates the Git checkout in the current
6175 directory; it outputs nothing and exits with exit code zero on success
6176 and non-zero on failure. @var{commit} above denotes the first commit
6177 where authentication takes place, and @var{signer} is the OpenPGP
6178 fingerprint of public key used to sign @var{commit}. Together, they
6179 form a ``channel introduction'' (@pxref{channel-authentication, channel
6180 introduction}). The options below allow you to fine-tune the process.
6181
6182 @table @code
6183 @item --repository=@var{directory}
6184 @itemx -r @var{directory}
6185 Open the Git repository in @var{directory} instead of the current
6186 directory.
6187
6188 @item --keyring=@var{reference}
6189 @itemx -k @var{reference}
6190 Load OpenPGP keyring from @var{reference}, the reference of a branch
6191 such as @code{origin/keyring} or @code{my-keyring}. The branch must
6192 contain OpenPGP public keys in @file{.key} files, either in binary form
6193 or ``ASCII-armored''. By default the keyring is loaded from the branch
6194 named @code{keyring}.
6195
6196 @item --stats
6197 Display commit signing statistics upon completion.
6198
6199 @item --cache-key=@var{key}
6200 Previously-authenticated commits are cached in a file under
6201 @file{~/.cache/guix/authentication}. This option forces the cache to be
6202 stored in file @var{key} in that directory.
6203
6204 @item --historical-authorizations=@var{file}
6205 By default, any commit whose parent commit(s) lack the
6206 @file{.guix-authorizations} file is considered inauthentic. In
6207 contrast, this option considers the authorizations in @var{file} for any
6208 commit that lacks @file{.guix-authorizations}. The format of @var{file}
6209 is the same as that of @file{.guix-authorizations}
6210 (@pxref{channel-authorizations, @file{.guix-authorizations} format}).
6211 @end table
6212
6213
6214 @c *********************************************************************
6215 @node Programming Interface
6216 @chapter Programming Interface
6217
6218 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
6219 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
6220 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
6221 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
6222 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
6223 turned into concrete build actions.
6224
6225 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
6226 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
6227 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
6228 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under specific
6229 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
6230
6231 @cindex derivation
6232 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
6233 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
6234 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
6235 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
6236 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
6237 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
6238 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
6239
6240 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
6241 package definitions.
6242
6243 @menu
6244 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6245 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
6246 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
6247 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
6248 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
6249 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
6250 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
6251 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
6252 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
6253 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
6254 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
6255 @end menu
6256
6257 @node Package Modules
6258 @section Package Modules
6259
6260 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
6261 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
6262 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
6263 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
6264 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
6265 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
6266 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
6267 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
6268 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
6269 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
6270 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6271
6272 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
6273 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
6274 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
6275 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
6276 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
6277 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
6278
6279 @cindex customization, of packages
6280 @cindex package module search path
6281 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
6282 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
6283 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
6284 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
6285 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
6286 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
6287 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
6288 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
6289
6290 @enumerate
6291 @item
6292 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
6293 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
6294 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
6295 environment variable described below.
6296
6297 @item
6298 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
6299 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
6300 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
6301 channels.
6302 @end enumerate
6303
6304 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
6305
6306 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6307 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
6308 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
6309 over the own modules of the distribution.
6310 @end defvr
6311
6312 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
6313 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
6314 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
6315 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
6316 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
6317 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
6318
6319 @node Defining Packages
6320 @section Defining Packages
6321
6322 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
6323 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
6324 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
6325 package looks like this:
6326
6327 @lisp
6328 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
6329 #:use-module (guix packages)
6330 #:use-module (guix download)
6331 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
6332 #:use-module (guix licenses)
6333 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
6334
6335 (define-public hello
6336 (package
6337 (name "hello")
6338 (version "2.10")
6339 (source (origin
6340 (method url-fetch)
6341 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6342 ".tar.gz"))
6343 (sha256
6344 (base32
6345 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
6346 (build-system gnu-build-system)
6347 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
6348 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
6349 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
6350 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
6351 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
6352 (license gpl3+)))
6353 @end lisp
6354
6355 @noindent
6356 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
6357 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
6358 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
6359 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6360 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
6361 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
6362 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
6363
6364 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
6365 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
6366 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
6367
6368 In the example above, @code{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
6369 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
6370 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
6371 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
6372 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6373
6374 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
6375
6376 @itemize
6377 @item
6378 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
6379 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
6380 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
6381 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
6382
6383 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
6384 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
6385
6386 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
6387 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
6388 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6389 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
6390 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
6391 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
6392
6393 @cindex patches
6394 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
6395 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
6396 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
6397
6398 @item
6399 @cindex GNU Build System
6400 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
6401 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @code{gnu-build-system}
6402 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
6403 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
6404 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
6405
6406 When you start packaging non-trivial software, you may need tools to
6407 manipulate those build phases, manipulate files, and so on. @xref{Build
6408 Utilities}, for more on this.
6409
6410 @item
6411 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
6412 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
6413 @code{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
6414 @option{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
6415
6416 @cindex quote
6417 @cindex quoting
6418 @findex '
6419 @findex quote
6420 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
6421 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
6422 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
6423 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
6424 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
6425 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6426 Manual}).
6427
6428 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
6429 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
6430 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
6431 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
6432 Reference Manual}).
6433
6434 @item
6435 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
6436 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
6437 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @code{gawk}
6438 variable; @code{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
6439
6440 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
6441 @findex `
6442 @findex quasiquote
6443 @cindex comma (unquote)
6444 @findex ,
6445 @findex unquote
6446 @findex ,@@
6447 @findex unquote-splicing
6448 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
6449 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
6450 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
6451 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
6452 Reference Manual}).
6453
6454 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
6455 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @code{gnu-build-system} takes care
6456 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
6457
6458 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
6459 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
6460 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
6461 @end itemize
6462
6463 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
6464
6465 Once a package definition is in place, the
6466 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
6467 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
6468 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
6469 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
6470 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
6471 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
6472 more information on how to test package definitions, and
6473 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
6474 for style conformance.
6475 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6476 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
6477 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
6478 in a ``channel''.
6479
6480 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
6481 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
6482 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
6483
6484 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
6485 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
6486 That derivation is stored in a @file{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
6487 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
6488 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
6489
6490 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
6491 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
6492 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6493
6494 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
6495 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
6496 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
6497 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
6498 (@pxref{The Store}).
6499 @end deffn
6500
6501 @noindent
6502 @cindex cross-compilation
6503 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
6504 package for some other system:
6505
6506 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
6507 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
6508 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
6509 @var{system} to @var{target}.
6510
6511 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
6512 and operating system, such as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"}
6513 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6514 @end deffn
6515
6516 Once you have package definitions, you can easily define @emph{variants}
6517 of those packages. @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for more on that.
6518
6519 @menu
6520 * package Reference:: The package data type.
6521 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
6522 @end menu
6523
6524
6525 @node package Reference
6526 @subsection @code{package} Reference
6527
6528 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
6529 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6530
6531 @deftp {Data Type} package
6532 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
6533
6534 @table @asis
6535 @item @code{name}
6536 The name of the package, as a string.
6537
6538 @item @code{version}
6539 The version of the package, as a string.
6540
6541 @item @code{source}
6542 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
6543 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
6544 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
6545 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
6546 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6547 @code{local-file}}).
6548
6549 @item @code{build-system}
6550 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
6551 Systems}).
6552
6553 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6554 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
6555 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
6556
6557 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6558 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6559 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6560 @cindex inputs, of packages
6561 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
6562 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
6563 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
6564 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
6565 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
6566 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
6567 inputs:
6568
6569 @lisp
6570 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
6571 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
6572 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
6573 @end lisp
6574
6575 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
6576 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
6577 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
6578 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
6579 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
6580 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
6581
6582 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
6583 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
6584 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
6585 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
6586
6587 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
6588 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
6589 specified packages will be automatically installed to profiles
6590 (@pxref{Features, the role of profiles in Guix}) alongside the package
6591 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
6592 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
6593 propagated inputs).
6594
6595 For example this is necessary when packaging a C/C++ library that needs
6596 headers of another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers
6597 to another one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
6598
6599 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
6600 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
6601 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
6602 more. When packaging libraries written in those languages, ensure they
6603 can find library code they depend on at run time by listing run-time
6604 dependencies in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
6605
6606 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
6607 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
6608 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
6609
6610 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6611 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6612 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
6613 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
6614
6615 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
6616 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
6617 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
6618 for details.
6619
6620 @item @code{synopsis}
6621 A one-line description of the package.
6622
6623 @item @code{description}
6624 A more elaborate description of the package.
6625
6626 @item @code{license}
6627 @cindex license, of packages
6628 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
6629 or a list of such values.
6630
6631 @item @code{home-page}
6632 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
6633
6634 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @code{%supported-systems})
6635 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
6636 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
6637
6638 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
6639 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
6640 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
6641 automatically corrected.
6642 @end table
6643 @end deftp
6644
6645 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
6646 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
6647 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
6648
6649 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
6650 cross-compiling:
6651
6652 @lisp
6653 (package
6654 (name "guile")
6655 ;; ...
6656
6657 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
6658 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
6659 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
6660 `(("self" ,this-package))
6661 '())))
6662 @end lisp
6663
6664 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
6665 @end deffn
6666
6667 Because packages are regular Scheme objects that capture a complete
6668 dependency graph and associated build procedures, it is often useful to
6669 write procedures that take a package and return a modified version
6670 thereof according to some parameters. Below are a few examples.
6671
6672 @cindex tool chain, choosing a package's tool chain
6673 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-with-c-toolchain @var{package} @var{toolchain}
6674 Return a variant of @var{package} that uses @var{toolchain} instead of
6675 the default GNU C/C++ toolchain. @var{toolchain} must be a list of
6676 inputs (label/package tuples) providing equivalent functionality, such
6677 as the @code{gcc-toolchain} package.
6678
6679 The example below returns a variant of the @code{hello} package built
6680 with GCC@tie{}10.x and the rest of the GNU tool chain (Binutils and the
6681 GNU C Library) instead of the default tool chain:
6682
6683 @lisp
6684 (let ((toolchain (specification->package "gcc-toolchain@@10")))
6685 (package-with-c-toolchain hello `(("toolchain" ,toolchain))))
6686 @end lisp
6687
6688 The build tool chain is part of the @dfn{implicit inputs} of
6689 packages---it's usually not listed as part of the various ``inputs''
6690 fields and is instead pulled in by the build system. Consequently, this
6691 procedure works by changing the build system of @var{package} so that it
6692 pulls in @var{toolchain} instead of the defaults. @ref{Build Systems},
6693 for more on build systems.
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @node origin Reference
6697 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
6698
6699 This section documents @dfn{origins}. An @code{origin} declaration
6700 specifies data that must be ``produced''---downloaded, usually---and
6701 whose content hash is known in advance. Origins are primarily used to
6702 represent the source code of packages (@pxref{Defining Packages}). For
6703 that reason, the @code{origin} form allows you to declare patches to
6704 apply to the original source code as well as code snippets to modify it.
6705
6706 @deftp {Data Type} origin
6707 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
6708
6709 @table @asis
6710 @item @code{uri}
6711 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
6712 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
6713 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
6714 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
6715
6716 @cindex fixed-output derivations, for download
6717 @item @code{method}
6718 A monadic procedure that handles the given URI@. The procedure must
6719 accept at least three arguments: the value of the @code{uri} field and
6720 the hash algorithm and hash value specified by the @code{hash} field.
6721 It must return a store item or a derivation in the store monad
6722 (@pxref{The Store Monad}); most methods return a fixed-output derivation
6723 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6724
6725 Commonly used methods include @code{url-fetch}, which fetches data from
6726 a URL, and @code{git-fetch}, which fetches data from a Git repository
6727 (see below).
6728
6729 @item @code{sha256}
6730 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. This is
6731 equivalent to providing a @code{content-hash} SHA256 object in the
6732 @code{hash} field described below.
6733
6734 @item @code{hash}
6735 The @code{content-hash} object of the source---see below for how to use
6736 @code{content-hash}.
6737
6738 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
6739 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
6740 guix hash}).
6741
6742 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
6743 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
6744 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
6745 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
6746 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
6747 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
6748
6749 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
6750 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6751 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
6752
6753 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
6754 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
6755 @code{%current-target-system}.
6756
6757 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
6758 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
6759 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
6760 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
6761
6762 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
6763 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
6764 command.
6765
6766 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
6767 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
6768 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
6769 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
6770
6771 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
6772 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
6773 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
6774
6775 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
6776 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
6777 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
6778 @end table
6779 @end deftp
6780
6781 @deftp {Data Type} content-hash @var{value} [@var{algorithm}]
6782 Construct a content hash object for the given @var{algorithm}, and with
6783 @var{value} as its hash value. When @var{algorithm} is omitted, assume
6784 it is @code{sha256}.
6785
6786 @var{value} can be a literal string, in which case it is base32-decoded,
6787 or it can be a bytevector.
6788
6789 The following forms are all equivalent:
6790
6791 @lisp
6792 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj")
6793 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"
6794 sha256)
6795 (content-hash (base32
6796 "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"))
6797 (content-hash (base64 "kkb+RPaP7uyMZmu4eXPVkM4BN8yhRd8BTHLslb6f/Rc=")
6798 sha256)
6799 @end lisp
6800
6801 Technically, @code{content-hash} is currently implemented as a macro.
6802 It performs sanity checks at macro-expansion time, when possible, such
6803 as ensuring that @var{value} has the right size for @var{algorithm}.
6804 @end deftp
6805
6806 As we have seen above, how exactly the data an origin refers to is
6807 retrieved is determined by its @code{method} field. The @code{(guix
6808 download)} module provides the most common method, @code{url-fetch},
6809 described below.
6810
6811 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} url-fetch @var{url} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6812 [name] [#:executable? #f]
6813 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches data from @var{url} (a
6814 string, or a list of strings denoting alternate URLs), which is expected
6815 to have hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). By default,
6816 the file name is the base name of URL; optionally, @var{name} can
6817 specify a different file name. When @var{executable?} is true, make the
6818 downloaded file executable.
6819
6820 When one of the URL starts with @code{mirror://}, then its host part is
6821 interpreted as the name of a mirror scheme, taken from @file{%mirror-file}.
6822
6823 Alternatively, when URL starts with @code{file://}, return the
6824 corresponding file name in the store.
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 Likewise, the @code{(guix git-download)} module defines the
6828 @code{git-fetch} origin method, which fetches data from a Git version
6829 control repository, and the @code{git-reference} data type to describe
6830 the repository and revision to fetch.
6831
6832 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash}
6833 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6834 @code{<git-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6835 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6836 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#f}.
6837 @end deffn
6838
6839 @deftp {Data Type} git-reference
6840 This data type represents a Git reference for @code{git-fetch} to
6841 retrieve.
6842
6843 @table @asis
6844 @item @code{url}
6845 The URL of the Git repository to clone.
6846
6847 @item @code{commit}
6848 This string denotes either the commit to fetch (a hexadecimal string,
6849 either the full SHA1 commit or a ``short'' commit string; the latter is
6850 not recommended) or the tag to fetch.
6851
6852 @item @code{recursive?} (default: @code{#f})
6853 This Boolean indicates whether to recursively fetch Git sub-modules.
6854 @end table
6855
6856 The example below denotes the @code{v2.10} tag of the GNU@tie{}Hello
6857 repository:
6858
6859 @lisp
6860 (git-reference
6861 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6862 (commit "v2.10"))
6863 @end lisp
6864
6865 This is equivalent to the reference below, which explicitly names the
6866 commit:
6867
6868 @lisp
6869 (git-reference
6870 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6871 (commit "dc7dc56a00e48fe6f231a58f6537139fe2908fb9"))
6872 @end lisp
6873 @end deftp
6874
6875 For Mercurial repositories, the module @code{(guix hg-download)} defines
6876 the @code{hg-fetch} origin method and @code{hg-reference} data type for
6877 support of the Mercurial version control system.
6878
6879 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} hg-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6880 [name]
6881 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6882 @code{<hg-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6883 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6884 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#false}.
6885 @end deffn
6886
6887 @node Defining Package Variants
6888 @section Defining Package Variants
6889
6890 @cindex customizing packages
6891 @cindex variants, of packages
6892 One of the nice things with Guix is that, given a package definition,
6893 you can easily @emph{derive} variants of that package---for a different
6894 upstream version, with different dependencies, different compilation
6895 options, and so on. Some of these custom packages can be defined
6896 straight from the command line (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6897 This section describes how to define package variants in code. This can
6898 be useful in ``manifests'' (@pxref{profile-manifest,
6899 @option{--manifest}}) and in your own package collection
6900 (@pxref{Creating a Channel}), among others!
6901
6902 @cindex inherit, for package definitions
6903 As discussed earlier, packages are first-class objects in the Scheme
6904 language. The @code{(guix packages)} module provides the @code{package}
6905 construct to define new package objects (@pxref{package Reference}).
6906 The easiest way to define a package variant is using the @code{inherit}
6907 keyword together with @code{package}. This allows you to inherit from a
6908 package definition while overriding the fields you want.
6909
6910 For example, given the @code{hello} variable, which contains a
6911 definition for the current version of GNU@tie{}Hello, here's how you
6912 would define a variant for version 2.2 (released in 2006, it's
6913 vintage!):
6914
6915 @lisp
6916 (use-modules (gnu packages base)) ;for 'hello'
6917
6918 (define hello-2.2
6919 (package
6920 (inherit hello)
6921 (version "2.2")
6922 (source (origin
6923 (method url-fetch)
6924 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6925 ".tar.gz"))
6926 (sha256
6927 (base32
6928 "0lappv4slgb5spyqbh6yl5r013zv72yqg2pcl30mginf3wdqd8k9"))))))
6929 @end lisp
6930
6931 The example above corresponds to what the @option{--with-source} package
6932 transformation option does. Essentially @code{hello-2.2} preserves all
6933 the fields of @code{hello}, except @code{version} and @code{source},
6934 which it overrides. Note that the original @code{hello} variable is
6935 still there, in the @code{(gnu packages base)} module, unchanged. When
6936 you define a custom package like this, you are really @emph{adding} a
6937 new package definition; the original one remains available.
6938
6939 You can just as well define variants with a different set of
6940 dependencies than the original package. For example, the default
6941 @code{gdb} package depends on @code{guile}, but since that is an
6942 optional dependency, you can define a variant that removes that
6943 dependency like so:
6944
6945 @lisp
6946 (use-modules (gnu packages gdb) ;for 'gdb'
6947 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'alist-delete'
6948
6949 (define gdb-sans-guile
6950 (package
6951 (inherit gdb)
6952 (inputs (alist-delete "guile"
6953 (package-inputs gdb)))))
6954 @end lisp
6955
6956 The @code{alist-delete} call above removes the tuple from the
6957 @code{inputs} field that has @code{"guile"} as its first element
6958 (@pxref{SRFI-1 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6959 Manual}).
6960
6961 In some cases, you may find it useful to write functions
6962 (``procedures'', in Scheme parlance) that return a package based on some
6963 parameters. For example, consider the @code{luasocket} library for the
6964 Lua programming language. We want to create @code{luasocket} packages
6965 for major versions of Lua. One way to do that is to define a procedure
6966 that takes a Lua package and returns a @code{luasocket} package that
6967 depends on it:
6968
6969 @lisp
6970 (define (make-lua-socket name lua)
6971 ;; Return a luasocket package built with LUA.
6972 (package
6973 (name name)
6974 (version "3.0")
6975 ;; several fields omitted
6976 (inputs
6977 `(("lua" ,lua)))
6978 (synopsis "Socket library for Lua")))
6979
6980 (define-public lua5.1-socket
6981 (make-lua-socket "lua5.1-socket" lua-5.1))
6982
6983 (define-public lua5.2-socket
6984 (make-lua-socket "lua5.2-socket" lua-5.2))
6985 @end lisp
6986
6987 Here we have defined packages @code{lua5.1-socket} and
6988 @code{lua5.2-socket} by calling @code{make-lua-socket} with different
6989 arguments. @xref{Procedures,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
6990 more info on procedures. Having top-level public definitions for these
6991 two packages means that they can be referred to from the command line
6992 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6993
6994 @cindex package transformations
6995 These are pretty simple package variants. As a convenience, the
6996 @code{(guix transformations)} module provides a high-level interface
6997 that directly maps to the more sophisticated package transformation
6998 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}):
6999
7000 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} options->transformation @var{opts}
7001 Return a procedure that, when passed an object to build (package,
7002 derivation, etc.), applies the transformations specified by @var{opts} and returns
7003 the resulting objects. @var{opts} must be a list of symbol/string pairs such as:
7004
7005 @lisp
7006 ((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7007 (without-tests . "libgcrypt"))
7008 @end lisp
7009
7010 Each symbol names a transformation and the corresponding string is an argument
7011 to that transformation.
7012 @end deffn
7013
7014 For instance, a manifest equivalent to this command:
7015
7016 @example
7017 guix build guix \
7018 --with-branch=guile-gcrypt=master \
7019 --with-debug-info=zlib
7020 @end example
7021
7022 @noindent
7023 ... would look like this:
7024
7025 @lisp
7026 (use-modules (guix transformations))
7027
7028 (define transform
7029 ;; The package transformation procedure.
7030 (options->transformation
7031 '((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7032 (with-debug-info . "zlib"))))
7033
7034 (packages->manifest
7035 (list (transform (specification->package "guix"))))
7036 @end lisp
7037
7038 @cindex input rewriting
7039 @cindex dependency graph rewriting
7040 The @code{options->transformation} procedure is convenient, but it's
7041 perhaps also not as flexible as you may like. How is it implemented?
7042 The astute reader probably noticed that most package transformation
7043 options go beyond the superficial changes shown in the first examples of
7044 this section: they involve @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency
7045 graph of a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others.
7046
7047 Dependency graph rewriting, for the purposes of swapping packages in the
7048 graph, is what the @code{package-input-rewriting} procedure in
7049 @code{(guix packages)} implements.
7050
7051 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
7052 [@var{rewrite-name}] [#:deep? #t]
7053 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
7054 indirect dependencies, including implicit inputs when @var{deep?} is
7055 true, according to @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of
7056 package pairs; the first element of each pair is the package to replace,
7057 and the second one is the replacement.
7058
7059 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
7060 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @noindent
7064 Consider this example:
7065
7066 @lisp
7067 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7068 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
7069 ;; recursively.
7070 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
7071
7072 (define git-with-libressl
7073 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
7074 @end lisp
7075
7076 @noindent
7077 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
7078 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
7079 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
7080 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
7081 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
7082
7083 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
7084 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
7085
7086 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements} [#:deep? #t]
7087 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given
7088 @var{replacements} to all the package graph, including implicit inputs
7089 unless @var{deep?} is false. @var{replacements} is a list of
7090 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as
7091 @code{"gcc"} or @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching
7092 package and returns a replacement for that package.
7093 @end deffn
7094
7095 The example above could be rewritten this way:
7096
7097 @lisp
7098 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7099 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
7100 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
7101 @end lisp
7102
7103 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
7104 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
7105 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
7106
7107 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
7108 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
7109 graph.
7110
7111 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}] [#:deep? #f]
7112 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
7113 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
7114 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package. When @var{deep?} is true, @var{proc} is
7115 applied to implicit inputs as well.
7116 @end deffn
7117
7118
7119 @node Build Systems
7120 @section Build Systems
7121
7122 @cindex build system
7123 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
7124 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
7125 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
7126 dependencies of that build procedure.
7127
7128 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
7129 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
7130 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
7131
7132 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
7133 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
7134 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
7135 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
7136 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
7137 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
7138 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
7139 The @code{package-with-c-toolchain} is an example of a way to change the
7140 implicit inputs that a package's build system pulls in (@pxref{package
7141 Reference, @code{package-with-c-toolchain}}).
7142
7143 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
7144 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
7145 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
7146 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
7147 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
7148 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
7149 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
7150
7151 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
7152 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
7153 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
7154
7155 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
7156 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
7157 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
7158 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
7159
7160 @cindex build phases
7161 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
7162 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
7163 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
7164 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
7165 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
7166 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
7167
7168 @table @code
7169 @item unpack
7170 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
7171 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
7172 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
7173
7174 @item patch-source-shebangs
7175 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
7176 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
7177 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
7178
7179 @item configure
7180 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
7181 as @option{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
7182 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
7183
7184 @item build
7185 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
7186 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7187 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
7188
7189 @item check
7190 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
7191 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
7192 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
7193 check -j}.
7194
7195 @item install
7196 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
7197
7198 @item patch-shebangs
7199 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
7200
7201 @item strip
7202 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
7203 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
7204 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
7205 @end table
7206
7207 @vindex %standard-phases
7208 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
7209 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
7210 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
7211 procedure implements the actual phase.
7212
7213 @xref{Build Phases}, for more info on build phases and ways to customize
7214 them.
7215
7216 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
7217 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
7218 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
7219 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
7220 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
7221 have to mention them.
7222 @end defvr
7223
7224 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
7225 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
7226 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
7227 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
7228 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
7229
7230 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
7231 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
7232 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
7233 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
7234
7235 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
7236 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
7237 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
7238 parameters, respectively.
7239
7240 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
7241 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
7242 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
7243 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
7244 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
7245
7246 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
7247 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
7248 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
7249 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
7250 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
7251 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
7252 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
7253
7254 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
7255 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
7256 ``jar'' task will be run.
7257
7258 @end defvr
7259
7260 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
7261 @cindex Android distribution
7262 @cindex Android NDK build system
7263 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
7264 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
7265 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
7266
7267 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
7268 (header) files to the subdirectory @file{include} of the @code{out} output and
7269 their libraries to the subdirectory @file{lib} the @code{out} output.
7270
7271 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
7272 has no conflicting files.
7273
7274 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
7275 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
7276
7277 @end defvr
7278
7279 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
7280 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
7281 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
7282
7283 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
7284 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
7285 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
7286 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
7287
7288 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
7289 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
7290 ASDF@. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
7291 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
7292 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
7293 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
7294
7295 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
7296 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
7297 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
7298
7299 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
7300 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
7301 the @code{cl-} prefix.
7302
7303 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
7304 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
7305 They should be called in a build phase after the
7306 @code{create-asdf-configuration} phase, so that the system which was
7307 just built can be used within the resulting image. @code{build-program}
7308 requires a list of Common Lisp expressions to be passed as the
7309 @code{#:entry-program} argument.
7310
7311 By default, all the @file{.asd} files present in the sources are read to
7312 find system definitions. The @code{#:asd-files} parameter can be used
7313 to specify the list of @file{.asd} files to read. Furthermore, if the
7314 package defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be
7315 loaded before the tests are run if it is specified by the
7316 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
7317 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
7318 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
7319
7320 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
7321 naming conventions suggest, or if several systems must be compiled, the
7322 @code{#:asd-systems} parameter can be used to specify the list of system
7323 names.
7324
7325 @end defvr
7326
7327 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
7328 @cindex Rust programming language
7329 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
7330 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
7331 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
7332 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
7333
7334 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
7335 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
7336
7337 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
7338 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
7339 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
7340 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
7341 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
7342 should be added to the package definition via the
7343 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
7344
7345 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
7346 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
7347 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
7348 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
7349 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs the binaries
7350 defined by the crate.
7351 @end defvr
7352
7353 @defvr {Scheme Variable} chicken-build-system
7354 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system chicken)}. It
7355 builds @uref{https://call-cc.org/, CHICKEN Scheme} modules, also called
7356 ``eggs'' or ``extensions''. CHICKEN generates C source code, which then
7357 gets compiled by a C compiler, in this case GCC.
7358
7359 This build system adds @code{chicken} to the package inputs, as well as
7360 the packages of @code{gnu-build-system}.
7361
7362 The build system can't (yet) deduce the egg's name automatically, so just like
7363 with @code{go-build-system} and its @code{#:import-path}, you should define
7364 @code{#:egg-name} in the package's @code{arguments} field.
7365
7366 For example, if you are packaging the @code{srfi-1} egg:
7367
7368 @lisp
7369 (arguments '(#:egg-name "srfi-1"))
7370 @end lisp
7371
7372 Egg dependencies must be defined in @code{propagated-inputs}, not @code{inputs}
7373 because CHICKEN doesn't embed absolute references in compiled eggs.
7374 Test dependencies should go to @code{native-inputs}, as usual.
7375 @end defvr
7376
7377 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
7378 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
7379 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
7380 mostly just moving files around.
7381
7382 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
7383 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
7384 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
7385 @code{trivial-build-system}.
7386
7387 To further simplify the file installation process, an
7388 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
7389 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
7390 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
7391
7392 @itemize
7393 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
7394 @itemize
7395 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
7396 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
7397 @end itemize
7398
7399 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
7400 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
7401 as above.
7402 @itemize
7403 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
7404 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
7405 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
7406 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
7407 @itemize
7408 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
7409 at least one of the elements in the given list.
7410 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
7411 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
7412 list.
7413 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
7414 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
7415 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
7416 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
7417 on top of the inclusions.
7418 @end itemize
7419 @end itemize
7420 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
7421 @var{target}.
7422 @end itemize
7423
7424 Examples:
7425
7426 @itemize
7427 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
7428 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
7429 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
7430 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7431 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
7432 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7433 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
7434 @file{share/my-app/file}.
7435 @end itemize
7436 @end defvr
7437
7438
7439 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
7440 @cindex simple Clojure build system
7441 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
7442 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
7443 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
7444 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
7445 yet.
7446
7447 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
7448 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
7449 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
7450
7451 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
7452 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
7453 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
7454 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
7455 Other parameters are documented below.
7456
7457 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
7458 following phases changed:
7459
7460 @table @code
7461
7462 @item build
7463 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
7464 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
7465 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
7466 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
7467 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
7468 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
7469 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
7470 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
7471
7472 @item check
7473 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
7474 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
7475 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
7476 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
7477 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
7478 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
7479
7480 @item install
7481 This phase installs all jars built previously.
7482 @end table
7483
7484 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
7485
7486 @table @code
7487
7488 @item install-doc
7489 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
7490 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
7491 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
7492 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
7493 @end table
7494 @end defvr
7495
7496 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
7497 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
7498 implements the build procedure for packages using the
7499 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
7500
7501 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
7502 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
7503 parameter.
7504
7505 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
7506 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
7507 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
7508 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
7509 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
7510 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7511 @end defvr
7512
7513 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
7514 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
7515 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
7516 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
7517 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
7518 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
7519 system.
7520
7521 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
7522 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
7523 parameter.
7524
7525 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
7526 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
7527 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
7528
7529 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
7530 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
7531 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
7532
7533 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
7534 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
7535 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
7536 @code{dune}.
7537 @end defvr
7538
7539 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
7540 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
7541 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
7542 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
7543 Go build mechanisms}.
7544
7545 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
7546 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
7547 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
7548 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
7549 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
7550 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
7551 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
7552 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
7553 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
7554 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
7555
7556 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
7557 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
7558 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
7559 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
7560 @end defvr
7561
7562 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
7563 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
7564 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
7565
7566 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7567 @code{gnu-build-system}:
7568
7569 @table @code
7570 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
7571 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
7572 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
7573 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
7574 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
7575 that appropriately set the @env{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @env{GTK_PATH}
7576 environment variables.
7577
7578 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
7579 process by listing their names in the
7580 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
7581 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
7582 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
7583 GLib and GTK+.
7584
7585 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
7586 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
7587 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
7588 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
7589 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
7590 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
7591 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
7592 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
7593 @end table
7594
7595 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
7596 @end defvr
7597
7598 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
7599 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
7600 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
7601 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
7602 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
7603 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
7604 installs documentation.
7605
7606 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the
7607 @option{--target} option of @samp{guild compile}.
7608
7609 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
7610 their @code{native-inputs} field.
7611 @end defvr
7612
7613 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
7614 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It
7615 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/,
7616 julia} packages, which essentially is similar to running @samp{julia -e
7617 'using Pkg; Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where
7618 @env{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the paths to all Julia package inputs.
7619 Tests are run with @code{Pkg.test}.
7620
7621 Julia packages require the source @code{file-name} to be the real name of the
7622 package, correctly capitalized.
7623
7624 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
7625 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
7626 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
7627 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
7628
7629 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
7630 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
7631 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
7632 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
7633 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
7634 and their uuid.
7635 @end defvr
7636
7637 @defvr {Scheme Variable} maven-build-system
7638 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system maven)}. It implements
7639 a build procedure for @uref{https://maven.apache.org, Maven} packages. Maven
7640 is a dependency and lifecycle management tool for Java. A user of Maven
7641 specifies dependencies and plugins in a @file{pom.xml} file that Maven reads.
7642 When Maven does not have one of the dependencies or plugins in its repository,
7643 it will download them and use them to build the package.
7644
7645 The maven build system ensures that maven will not try to download any
7646 dependency by running in offline mode. Maven will fail if a dependency is
7647 missing. Before running Maven, the @file{pom.xml} (and subprojects) are
7648 modified to specify the version of dependencies and plugins that match the
7649 versions available in the guix build environment. Dependencies and plugins
7650 must be installed in the fake maven repository at @file{lib/m2}, and are
7651 symlinked into a proper repository before maven is run. Maven is instructed
7652 to use that repository for the build and installs built artifacts there.
7653 Changed files are copied to the @file{lib/m2} directory of the package output.
7654
7655 You can specify a @file{pom.xml} file with the @code{#:pom-file} argument,
7656 or let the build system use the default @file{pom.xml} file in the sources.
7657
7658 In case you need to specify a dependency's version manually, you can use the
7659 @code{#:local-packages} argument. It takes an association list where the key
7660 is the groupId of the package and its value is an association list where the
7661 key is the artifactId of the package and its value is the version you want to
7662 override in the @file{pom.xml}.
7663
7664 Some packages use dependencies or plugins that are not useful at runtime nor
7665 at build time in Guix. You can alter the @file{pom.xml} file to remove them
7666 using the @code{#:exclude} argument. Its value is an association list where
7667 the key is the groupId of the plugin or dependency you want to remove, and
7668 the value is a list of artifactId you want to remove.
7669
7670 You can override the default @code{jdk} and @code{maven} packages with the
7671 corresponding argument, @code{#:jdk} and @code{#:maven}.
7672
7673 The @code{#:maven-plugins} argument is a list of maven plugins used during
7674 the build, with the same format as the @code{inputs} fields of the package
7675 declaration. Its default value is @code{(default-maven-plugins)} which is
7676 also exported.
7677 @end defvr
7678
7679 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
7680 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
7681 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
7682
7683 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
7684 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
7685 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
7686 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
7687 output.
7688
7689 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
7690 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
7691 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
7692 @end defvr
7693
7694 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
7695 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
7696 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
7697 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
7698 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
7699 try some of them.
7700
7701 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
7702 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
7703 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
7704 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
7705 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
7706 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
7707 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
7708 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
7709 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
7710
7711 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
7712 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
7713 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
7714 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
7715
7716 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
7717 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
7718 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
7719
7720 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
7721 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
7722 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
7723 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
7724 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
7725 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
7726 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
7727
7728 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
7729 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
7730 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
7731 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
7732 libraries cannot be found and we use @env{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
7733 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
7734 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
7735 @end defvr
7736
7737 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
7738 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
7739 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
7740 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
7741 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
7742
7743 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
7744 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @env{PYTHONPATH}
7745 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
7746
7747 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
7748 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
7749 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
7750 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
7751 interpreter version.
7752
7753 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
7754 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
7755 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
7756 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
7757 @end defvr
7758
7759 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
7760 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
7761 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
7762 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
7763 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
7764 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
7765 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
7766 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
7767 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
7768 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
7769 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
7770 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
7771
7772 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
7773 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
7774 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7775
7776 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
7777 @end defvr
7778
7779 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
7780 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
7781 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
7782
7783 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7784 @code{cmake-build-system}:
7785
7786 @table @code
7787 @item check-setup
7788 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
7789 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
7790 For now this only sets some environment variables:
7791 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
7792 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
7793 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
7794
7795 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
7796 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
7797
7798 @item qt-wrap
7799 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
7800 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
7801 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
7802 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
7803 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
7804
7805 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
7806 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
7807 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
7808 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
7809 or such.
7810
7811 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
7812 @end table
7813 @end defvr
7814
7815 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
7816 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
7817 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
7818 packages, which essentially is little more than running @samp{R CMD
7819 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
7820 @env{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests are
7821 run after installation using the R function
7822 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
7823 @end defvr
7824
7825 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
7826 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
7827 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
7828 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
7829 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
7830 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
7831 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
7832 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
7833
7834 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
7835 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
7836 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7837 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
7838 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
7839 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7840 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
7841 @end defvr
7842
7843 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
7844 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
7845 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
7846 build system sets the @env{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
7847 files in the inputs.
7848
7849 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
7850 different engine and format can be specified with the
7851 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
7852 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
7853 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
7854 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
7855 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
7856 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
7857
7858 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
7859 install the built files under the texmf tree.
7860 @end defvr
7861
7862 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
7863 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
7864 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
7865 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
7866
7867 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
7868 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
7869 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
7870 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
7871 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
7872 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
7873 a traditional source release tarball.
7874
7875 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
7876 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
7877 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
7878 @end defvr
7879
7880 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
7881 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
7882 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
7883 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
7884 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
7885 script.
7886
7887 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
7888 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
7889 @code{#:python} parameter.
7890 @end defvr
7891
7892 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
7893 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
7894 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
7895 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
7896 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
7897 the package.
7898
7899 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
7900 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
7901 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
7902 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
7903 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
7904 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
7905 @end defvr
7906
7907 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
7908 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
7909 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
7910 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
7911 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
7912 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
7913 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
7914 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
7915 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
7916 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
7917 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
7918 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
7919 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
7920 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
7921
7922 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
7923 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
7924 @end defvr
7925
7926 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
7927 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
7928 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
7929 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
7930 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
7931
7932 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
7933 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
7934 @end defvr
7935
7936 @anchor{emacs-build-system}
7937 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
7938 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
7939 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
7940 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
7941
7942 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
7943 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
7944 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
7945 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. The Elisp
7946 package files are installed directly under @file{share/emacs/site-lisp}.
7947 @end defvr
7948
7949 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
7950 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
7951 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
7952 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
7953 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
7954 locations in the output directory.
7955 @end defvr
7956
7957 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
7958 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
7959 implements the build procedure for packages that use
7960 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
7961
7962 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
7963 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
7964 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
7965 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
7966 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
7967
7968 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
7969 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
7970
7971 @table @code
7972
7973 @item configure
7974 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
7975 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @option{--buildtype} is always set to
7976 @code{debugoptimized} unless something else is specified in
7977 @code{#:build-type}.
7978
7979 @item build
7980 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
7981 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
7982
7983 @item check
7984 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
7985 which is @code{"test"} by default.
7986
7987 @item install
7988 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
7989 @end table
7990
7991 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
7992
7993 @table @code
7994
7995 @item fix-runpath
7996 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
7997 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
7998 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
7999 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
8000 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
8001 required for the program to run.
8002
8003 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
8004 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8005 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8006
8007 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
8008 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8009 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8010 @end table
8011 @end defvr
8012
8013 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
8014 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
8015
8016 @cindex build phases
8017 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8018 following phases changed:
8019
8020 @table @code
8021
8022 @item configure
8023 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
8024 can be used to build the external kernel module.
8025
8026 @item build
8027 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
8028 kernel module.
8029
8030 @item install
8031 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
8032 kernel module.
8033 @end table
8034
8035 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
8036 the module (in the @code{arguments} form of a package using the
8037 @code{linux-module-build-system}, use the key @code{#:linux} to specify it).
8038 @end defvr
8039
8040 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
8041 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
8042 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
8043 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
8044 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
8045
8046 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
8047 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
8048 @code{node}.
8049 @end defvr
8050
8051 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
8052 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
8053 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
8054 and does not have a notion of build phases.
8055
8056 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
8057 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
8058
8059 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
8060 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
8061 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
8062 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
8063 @end defvr
8064
8065 @node Build Phases
8066 @section Build Phases
8067
8068 @cindex build phases, for packages
8069 Almost all package build systems implement a notion @dfn{build phases}:
8070 a sequence of actions that the build system executes, when you build the
8071 package, leading to the installed byproducts in the store. A notable
8072 exception is the ``bare-bones'' @code{trivial-build-system}
8073 (@pxref{Build Systems}).
8074
8075 As discussed in the previous section, those build systems provide a
8076 standard list of phases. For @code{gnu-build-system}, the standard
8077 phases include an @code{unpack} phase to unpack the source code tarball,
8078 a @command{configure} phase to run @code{./configure}, a @code{build}
8079 phase to run @command{make}, and (among others) an @code{install} phase
8080 to run @command{make install}; @pxref{Build Systems}, for a more
8081 detailed view of these phases. Likewise, @code{cmake-build-system}
8082 inherits these phases, but its @code{configure} phase runs
8083 @command{cmake} instead of @command{./configure}. Other build systems,
8084 such as @code{python-build-system}, have a wholly different list of
8085 standard phases. All this code runs on the @dfn{build side}: it is
8086 evaluated when you actually build the package, in a dedicated build
8087 process spawned by the build daemon (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
8088
8089 Build phases are represented as association lists or ``alists''
8090 (@pxref{Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where
8091 each key is a symbol for the name of the phase and the associated value
8092 is a procedure that accepts an arbitrary number of arguments. By
8093 convention, those procedures receive information about the build in the
8094 form of @dfn{keyword parameters}, which they can use or ignore.
8095
8096 For example, here is how @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
8097 @code{%standard-phases}, the variable holding its alist of build
8098 phases@footnote{We present a simplified view of those build phases, but
8099 do take a look at @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} to see all the
8100 details!}:
8101
8102 @lisp
8103 ;; The build phases of 'gnu-build-system'.
8104
8105 (define* (unpack #:key source #:allow-other-keys)
8106 ;; Extract the source tarball.
8107 (invoke "tar" "xvf" source))
8108
8109 (define* (configure #:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8110 ;; Run the 'configure' script. Install to output "out".
8111 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8112 (invoke "./configure"
8113 (string-append "--prefix=" out))))
8114
8115 (define* (build #:allow-other-keys)
8116 ;; Compile.
8117 (invoke "make"))
8118
8119 (define* (check #:key (test-target "check") (tests? #true)
8120 #:allow-other-keys)
8121 ;; Run the test suite.
8122 (if tests?
8123 (invoke "make" test-target)
8124 (display "test suite not run\n")))
8125
8126 (define* (install #:allow-other-keys)
8127 ;; Install files to the prefix 'configure' specified.
8128 (invoke "make" "install"))
8129
8130 (define %standard-phases
8131 ;; The list of standard phases (quite a few are omitted
8132 ;; for brevity). Each element is a symbol/procedure pair.
8133 (list (cons 'unpack unpack)
8134 (cons 'configure configure)
8135 (cons 'build build)
8136 (cons 'check check)
8137 (cons 'install install)))
8138 @end lisp
8139
8140 This shows how @code{%standard-phases} is defined as a list of
8141 symbol/procedure pairs (@pxref{Pairs,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
8142 Manual}). The first pair associates the @code{unpack} procedure with
8143 the @code{unpack} symbol---a name; the second pair defines the
8144 @code{configure} phase similarly, and so on. When building a package
8145 that uses @code{gnu-build-system} with its default list of phases, those
8146 phases are executed sequentially. You can see the name of each phase
8147 started and completed in the build log of packages that you build.
8148
8149 Let's now look at the procedures themselves. Each one is defined with
8150 @code{define*}: @code{#:key} lists keyword parameters the procedure
8151 accepts, possibly with a default value, and @code{#:allow-other-keys}
8152 specifies that other keyword parameters are ignored (@pxref{Optional
8153 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8154
8155 The @code{unpack} procedure honors the @code{source} parameter, which
8156 the build system uses to pass the file name of the source tarball (or
8157 version control checkout), and it ignores other parameters. The
8158 @code{configure} phase only cares about the @code{outputs} parameter, an
8159 alist mapping package output names to their store file name
8160 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). It extracts the file name of
8161 for @code{out}, the default output, and passes it to
8162 @command{./configure} as the installation prefix, meaning that
8163 @command{make install} will eventually copy all the files in that
8164 directory (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile
8165 conventions,, standards, GNU Coding Standards}). @code{build} and
8166 @code{install} ignore all their arguments. @code{check} honors the
8167 @code{test-target} argument, which specifies the name of the Makefile
8168 target to run tests; it prints a message and skips tests when
8169 @code{tests?} is false.
8170
8171 @cindex build phases, customizing
8172 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
8173 @code{#:phases} parameter of the build system. Changing the set of
8174 build phases boils down to building a new alist of phases based on the
8175 @code{%standard-phases} alist described above. This can be done with
8176 standard alist procedures such as @code{alist-delete} (@pxref{SRFI-1
8177 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); however, it is
8178 more convenient to do so with @code{modify-phases} (@pxref{Build
8179 Utilities, @code{modify-phases}}).
8180
8181 Here is an example of a package definition that removes the
8182 @code{configure} phase of @code{%standard-phases} and inserts a new
8183 phase before the @code{build} phase, called
8184 @code{set-prefix-in-makefile}:
8185
8186 @lisp
8187 (define-public example
8188 (package
8189 (name "example")
8190 ;; other fields omitted
8191 (build-system gnu-build-system)
8192 (arguments
8193 '(#:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases
8194 (delete 'configure)
8195 (add-before 'build 'set-prefix-in-makefile
8196 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8197 ;; Modify the makefile so that its
8198 ;; 'PREFIX' variable points to "out".
8199 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8200 (substitute* "Makefile"
8201 (("PREFIX =.*")
8202 (string-append "PREFIX = "
8203 out "\n")))
8204 #true))))))))
8205 @end lisp
8206
8207 The new phase that is inserted is written as an anonymous procedure,
8208 introduced with @code{lambda*}; it honors the @code{outputs} parameter
8209 we have seen before. @xref{Build Utilities}, for more about the helpers
8210 used by this phase, and for more examples of @code{modify-phases}.
8211
8212 @cindex code staging
8213 @cindex staging, of code
8214 Keep in mind that build phases are code evaluated at the time the
8215 package is actually built. This explains why the whole
8216 @code{modify-phases} expression above is quoted (it comes after the
8217 @code{'} or apostrophe): it is @dfn{staged} for later execution.
8218 @xref{G-Expressions}, for an explanation of code staging and the
8219 @dfn{code strata} involved.
8220
8221 @node Build Utilities
8222 @section Build Utilities
8223
8224 As soon as you start writing non-trivial package definitions
8225 (@pxref{Defining Packages}) or other build actions
8226 (@pxref{G-Expressions}), you will likely start looking for helpers for
8227 ``shell-like'' actions---creating directories, copying and deleting
8228 files recursively, manipulating build phases, and so on. The
8229 @code{(guix build utils)} module provides such utility procedures.
8230
8231 Most build systems load @code{(guix build utils)} (@pxref{Build
8232 Systems}). Thus, when writing custom build phases for your package
8233 definitions, you can usually assume those procedures are in scope.
8234
8235 When writing G-expressions, you can import @code{(guix build utils)} on
8236 the ``build side'' using @code{with-imported-modules} and then put it in
8237 scope with the @code{use-modules} form (@pxref{Using Guile Modules,,,
8238 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}):
8239
8240 @lisp
8241 (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils)) ;import it
8242 (computed-file "empty-tree"
8243 #~(begin
8244 ;; Put it in scope.
8245 (use-modules (guix build utils))
8246
8247 ;; Happily use its 'mkdir-p' procedure.
8248 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/a/b/c")))))
8249 @end lisp
8250
8251 The remainder of this section is the reference for most of the utility
8252 procedures provided by @code{(guix build utils)}.
8253
8254 @c TODO Document what's missing.
8255
8256 @subsection Dealing with Store File Names
8257
8258 This section documents procedures that deal with store file names.
8259
8260 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} %store-directory
8261 Return the directory name of the store.
8262 @end deffn
8263
8264 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} store-file-name? @var{file}
8265 Return true if @var{file} is in the store.
8266 @end deffn
8267
8268 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} strip-store-file-name @var{file}
8269 Strip the @file{/gnu/store} and hash from @var{file}, a store file name.
8270 The result is typically a @code{"@var{package}-@var{version}"} string.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-name->name+version @var{name}
8274 Given @var{name}, a package name like @code{"foo-0.9.1b"}, return two
8275 values: @code{"foo"} and @code{"0.9.1b"}. When the version part is
8276 unavailable, @var{name} and @code{#f} are returned. The first hyphen
8277 followed by a digit is considered to introduce the version part.
8278 @end deffn
8279
8280 @subsection File Types
8281
8282 The procedures below deal with files and file types.
8283
8284 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-exists? @var{dir}
8285 Return @code{#t} if @var{dir} exists and is a directory.
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} executable-file? @var{file}
8289 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} exists and is executable.
8290 @end deffn
8291
8292 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} symbolic-link? @var{file}
8293 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is a symbolic link (aka. a ``symlink'').
8294 @end deffn
8295
8296 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elf-file? @var{file}
8297 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} ar-file? @var{file}
8298 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} gzip-file? @var{file}
8299 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is, respectively, an ELF file, an
8300 @code{ar} archive (such as a @file{.a} static library), or a gzip file.
8301 @end deffn
8302
8303 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} reset-gzip-timestamp @var{file} [#:keep-mtime? #t]
8304 If @var{file} is a gzip file, reset its embedded timestamp (as with
8305 @command{gzip --no-name}) and return true. Otherwise return @code{#f}.
8306 When @var{keep-mtime?} is true, preserve @var{file}'s modification time.
8307 @end deffn
8308
8309 @subsection File Manipulation
8310
8311 The following procedures and macros help create, modify, and delete
8312 files. They provide functionality comparable to common shell utilities
8313 such as @command{mkdir -p}, @command{cp -r}, @command{rm -r}, and
8314 @command{sed}. They complement Guile's extensive, but low-level, file
8315 system interface (@pxref{POSIX,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8316
8317 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-directory-excursion @var{directory} @var{body}@dots{}
8318 Run @var{body} with @var{directory} as the process's current directory.
8319
8320 Essentially, this macro changes the current directory to @var{directory}
8321 before evaluating @var{body}, using @code{chdir} (@pxref{Processes,,,
8322 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). It changes back to the initial
8323 directory when the dynamic extent of @var{body} is left, be it @i{via}
8324 normal procedure return or @i{via} a non-local exit such as an
8325 exception.
8326 @end deffn
8327
8328 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mkdir-p @var{dir}
8329 Create directory @var{dir} and all its ancestors.
8330 @end deffn
8331
8332 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} install-file @var{file} @var{directory}
8333 Create @var{directory} if it does not exist and copy @var{file} in there
8334 under the same name.
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} make-file-writable @var{file}
8338 Make @var{file} writable for its owner.
8339 @end deffn
8340
8341 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} copy-recursively @var{source} @var{destination} @
8342 [#:log (current-output-port)] [#:follow-symlinks? #f] [#:keep-mtime? #f]
8343 Copy @var{source} directory to @var{destination}. Follow symlinks if
8344 @var{follow-symlinks?} is true; otherwise, just preserve them. When
8345 @var{keep-mtime?} is true, keep the modification time of the files in
8346 @var{source} on those of @var{destination}. Write verbose output to the
8347 @var{log} port.
8348 @end deffn
8349
8350 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} delete-file-recursively @var{dir} @
8351 [#:follow-mounts? #f]
8352 Delete @var{dir} recursively, like @command{rm -rf}, without following
8353 symlinks. Don't follow mount points either, unless @var{follow-mounts?}
8354 is true. Report but ignore errors.
8355 @end deffn
8356
8357 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} substitute* @var{file} @
8358 ((@var{regexp} @var{match-var}@dots{}) @var{body}@dots{}) @dots{}
8359 Substitute @var{regexp} in @var{file} by the string returned by
8360 @var{body}. @var{body} is evaluated with each @var{match-var} bound to
8361 the corresponding positional regexp sub-expression. For example:
8362
8363 @lisp
8364 (substitute* file
8365 (("hello")
8366 "good morning\n")
8367 (("foo([a-z]+)bar(.*)$" all letters end)
8368 (string-append "baz" letter end)))
8369 @end lisp
8370
8371 Here, anytime a line of @var{file} contains @code{hello}, it is replaced
8372 by @code{good morning}. Anytime a line of @var{file} matches the second
8373 regexp, @code{all} is bound to the complete match, @code{letters} is bound
8374 to the first sub-expression, and @code{end} is bound to the last one.
8375
8376 When one of the @var{match-var} is @code{_}, no variable is bound to the
8377 corresponding match substring.
8378
8379 Alternatively, @var{file} may be a list of file names, in which case
8380 they are all subject to the substitutions.
8381
8382 Be careful about using @code{$} to match the end of a line; by itself it
8383 won't match the terminating newline of a line.
8384 @end deffn
8385
8386 @subsection File Search
8387
8388 @cindex file, searching
8389 This section documents procedures to search and filter files.
8390
8391 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-name-predicate @var{regexp}
8392 Return a predicate that returns true when passed a file name whose base
8393 name matches @var{regexp}.
8394 @end deffn
8395
8396 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} find-files @var{dir} [@var{pred}] @
8397 [#:stat lstat] [#:directories? #f] [#:fail-on-error? #f]
8398 Return the lexicographically sorted list of files under @var{dir} for
8399 which @var{pred} returns true. @var{pred} is passed two arguments: the
8400 absolute file name, and its stat buffer; the default predicate always
8401 returns true. @var{pred} can also be a regular expression, in which
8402 case it is equivalent to @code{(file-name-predicate @var{pred})}.
8403 @var{stat} is used to obtain file information; using @code{lstat} means
8404 that symlinks are not followed. If @var{directories?} is true, then
8405 directories will also be included. If @var{fail-on-error?} is true,
8406 raise an exception upon error.
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409 Here are a few examples where we assume that the current directory is
8410 the root of the Guix source tree:
8411
8412 @lisp
8413 ;; List all the regular files in the current directory.
8414 (find-files ".")
8415 @result{} ("./.dir-locals.el" "./.gitignore" @dots{})
8416
8417 ;; List all the .scm files under gnu/services.
8418 (find-files "gnu/services" "\\.scm$")
8419 @result{} ("gnu/services/admin.scm" "gnu/services/audio.scm" @dots{})
8420
8421 ;; List ar files in the current directory.
8422 (find-files "." (lambda (file stat) (ar-file? file)))
8423 @result{} ("./libformat.a" "./libstore.a" @dots{})
8424 @end lisp
8425
8426 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} which @var{program}
8427 Return the complete file name for @var{program} as found in
8428 @code{$PATH}, or @code{#f} if @var{program} could not be found.
8429 @end deffn
8430
8431 @subsection Build Phases
8432
8433 @cindex build phases
8434 The @code{(guix build utils)} also contains tools to manipulate build
8435 phases as used by build systems (@pxref{Build Systems}). Build phases
8436 are represented as association lists or ``alists'' (@pxref{Association
8437 Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where each key is a symbol
8438 naming the phase and the associated value is a procedure (@pxref{Build
8439 Phases}).
8440
8441 Guile core and the @code{(srfi srfi-1)} module both provide tools to
8442 manipulate alists. The @code{(guix build utils)} module complements
8443 those with tools written with build phases in mind.
8444
8445 @cindex build phases, modifying
8446 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-phases @var{phases} @var{clause}@dots{}
8447 Modify @var{phases} sequentially as per each @var{clause}, which may
8448 have one of the following forms:
8449
8450 @lisp
8451 (delete @var{old-phase-name})
8452 (replace @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8453 (add-before @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8454 (add-after @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8455 @end lisp
8456
8457 Where every @var{phase-name} above is an expression evaluating to a
8458 symbol, and @var{new-phase} an expression evaluating to a procedure.
8459 @end deffn
8460
8461 The example below is taken from the definition of the @code{grep}
8462 package. It adds a phase to run after the @code{install} phase, called
8463 @code{fix-egrep-and-fgrep}. That phase is a procedure (@code{lambda*}
8464 is for anonymous procedures) that takes a @code{#:outputs} keyword
8465 argument and ignores extra keyword arguments (@pxref{Optional
8466 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for more on
8467 @code{lambda*} and optional and keyword arguments.) The phase uses
8468 @code{substitute*} to modify the installed @file{egrep} and @file{fgrep}
8469 scripts so that they refer to @code{grep} by its absolute file name:
8470
8471 @lisp
8472 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8473 (add-after 'install 'fix-egrep-and-fgrep
8474 ;; Patch 'egrep' and 'fgrep' to execute 'grep' via its
8475 ;; absolute file name instead of searching for it in $PATH.
8476 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8477 (let* ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out"))
8478 (bin (string-append out "/bin")))
8479 (substitute* (list (string-append bin "/egrep")
8480 (string-append bin "/fgrep"))
8481 (("^exec grep")
8482 (string-append "exec " bin "/grep")))
8483 #t))))
8484 @end lisp
8485
8486 In the example below, phases are modified in two ways: the standard
8487 @code{configure} phase is deleted, presumably because the package does
8488 not have a @file{configure} script or anything similar, and the default
8489 @code{install} phase is replaced by one that manually copies the
8490 executable files to be installed:
8491
8492 @lisp
8493 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8494 (delete 'configure) ;no 'configure' script
8495 (replace 'install
8496 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8497 ;; The package's Makefile doesn't provide an "install"
8498 ;; rule so do it by ourselves.
8499 (let ((bin (string-append (assoc-ref outputs "out")
8500 "/bin")))
8501 (install-file "footswitch" bin)
8502 (install-file "scythe" bin)
8503 #t))))
8504 @end lisp
8505
8506 @c TODO: Add more examples.
8507
8508 @node The Store
8509 @section The Store
8510
8511 @cindex store
8512 @cindex store items
8513 @cindex store paths
8514
8515 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
8516 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
8517 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
8518 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
8519 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
8520 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
8521 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
8522 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
8523 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
8524
8525 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
8526 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
8527 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
8528 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
8529
8530 @quotation Note
8531 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
8532 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
8533 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
8534
8535 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
8536 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
8537 accidental modifications.
8538 @end quotation
8539
8540 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
8541 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
8542 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
8543 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
8544 @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
8545
8546 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
8547 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
8548 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
8549 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
8550 supported URI schemes are:
8551
8552 @table @code
8553 @item file
8554 @itemx unix
8555 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
8556 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
8557 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
8558
8559 @item guix
8560 @cindex daemon, remote access
8561 @cindex remote access to the daemon
8562 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
8563 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
8564 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
8565 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
8566 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
8567
8568 @example
8569 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
8570 @end example
8571
8572 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
8573 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
8574 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
8575
8576 The @option{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
8577 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
8578 @option{--listen}}).
8579
8580 @item ssh
8581 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
8582 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH@. This
8583 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
8584 @command{guile} binary in @env{PATH} on the destination machine. It
8585 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
8586 like this:
8587
8588 @example
8589 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
8590 @end example
8591
8592 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
8593 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
8594 @end table
8595
8596 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
8597
8598 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
8599 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
8600 @quotation Note
8601 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
8602 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
8603 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
8604 @end quotation
8605 @end defvr
8606
8607 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
8608 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
8609 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
8610 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
8611 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
8612
8613 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
8614 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
8618 Close the connection to @var{server}.
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
8622 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
8623 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
8624 @end defvr
8625
8626 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
8627 argument.
8628
8629 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
8630 @cindex invalid store items
8631 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
8632 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
8633 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
8634 build).
8635
8636 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
8637 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
8638 @end deffn
8639
8640 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
8641 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
8642 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
8643 resulting store path.
8644 @end deffn
8645
8646 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
8647 [@var{mode}]
8648 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
8649 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
8650 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
8651 @end deffn
8652
8653 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
8654 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
8655 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
8656 Store Monad}).
8657
8658 @c FIXME
8659 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
8660
8661 @node Derivations
8662 @section Derivations
8663
8664 @cindex derivations
8665 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
8666 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
8667 following pieces of information:
8668
8669 @itemize
8670 @item
8671 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
8672 directory in the store, but may produce more.
8673
8674 @item
8675 @cindex build-time dependencies
8676 @cindex dependencies, build-time
8677 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
8678 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
8679 etc.).
8680
8681 @item
8682 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
8683
8684 @item
8685 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
8686 to be passed.
8687
8688 @item
8689 A list of environment variables to be defined.
8690
8691 @end itemize
8692
8693 @cindex derivation path
8694 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
8695 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
8696 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
8697 name end in @file{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
8698 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
8699 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
8700 Store}).
8701
8702 @cindex fixed-output derivations
8703 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
8704 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
8705 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
8706 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
8707 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
8708 method and tools being used.
8709
8710 @cindex references
8711 @cindex run-time dependencies
8712 @cindex dependencies, run-time
8713 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
8714 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
8715 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
8716 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
8717 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
8718 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
8719
8720 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
8721 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
8722 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
8723 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
8724
8725 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
8726 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8727 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
8728 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
8729 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8730 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
8731 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
8732 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
8733 @code{<derivation>} object.
8734
8735 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
8736 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
8737 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
8738 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
8739 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
8740 containing this output.
8741
8742 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
8743 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
8744 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
8745 a simple text format.
8746
8747 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
8748 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
8749 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
8750 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
8751
8752 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
8753 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
8754 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
8755 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
8756 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
8757 derivations that download files.
8758
8759 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
8760 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
8761 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
8762 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
8763
8764 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
8765 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
8766 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
8767 host CPU instruction set.
8768
8769 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
8770 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
8771 @end deffn
8772
8773 @noindent
8774 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
8775 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
8776 to a Bash executable in the store:
8777
8778 @lisp
8779 (use-modules (guix utils)
8780 (guix store)
8781 (guix derivations))
8782
8783 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
8784 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
8785 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
8786 (derivation store "foo"
8787 bash `("-e" ,builder)
8788 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
8789 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
8790 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
8791 @end lisp
8792
8793 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
8794 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
8795 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
8796 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
8797 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
8798
8799 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
8800 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
8801 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
8802 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
8803
8804 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
8805 @var{name} @var{exp} @
8806 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
8807 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8808 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
8809 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
8810 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8811 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
8812 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
8813 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
8814 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
8815 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
8816 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
8817 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
8818 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
8819 gnu-build-system))}.
8820
8821 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
8822 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
8823 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
8824 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
8825 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
8826 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
8827 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
8828
8829 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
8830 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
8831 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
8832
8833 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
8834 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
8835 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
8836 @var{substitutable?}.
8837 @end deffn
8838
8839 @noindent
8840 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
8841 containing one file:
8842
8843 @lisp
8844 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
8845 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
8846 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
8847 (lambda (p)
8848 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
8849 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
8850
8851 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
8852 @end lisp
8853
8854
8855 @node The Store Monad
8856 @section The Store Monad
8857
8858 @cindex monad
8859
8860 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
8861 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
8862 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
8863 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
8864
8865 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
8866 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
8867 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
8868 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
8869 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
8870
8871 @cindex monadic values
8872 @cindex monadic functions
8873 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
8874 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
8875 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
8876 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
8877 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
8878 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
8879 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
8880 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
8881 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
8882
8883 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
8884
8885 @lisp
8886 (define (sh-symlink store)
8887 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
8888 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
8889 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
8890 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
8891 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
8892 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
8893 @end lisp
8894
8895 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
8896 as a monadic function:
8897
8898 @lisp
8899 (define (sh-symlink)
8900 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
8901 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
8902 (gexp->derivation "sh"
8903 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
8904 #$output))))
8905 @end lisp
8906
8907 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
8908 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
8909 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
8910 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
8911 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
8912
8913 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
8914 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
8915 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
8916
8917 @lisp
8918 (define (sh-symlink)
8919 (gexp->derivation "sh"
8920 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
8921 #$output)))
8922 @end lisp
8923
8924 @c See
8925 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
8926 @c for the funny quote.
8927 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
8928 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
8929 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
8930 @code{run-with-store}:
8931
8932 @lisp
8933 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
8934 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
8935 @end lisp
8936
8937 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
8938 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
8939 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
8940 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
8941
8942 @example
8943 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
8944 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
8945 @end example
8946
8947 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
8948 automatically run through the store:
8949
8950 @example
8951 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
8952 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
8953 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
8954 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
8955 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
8956 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
8957 scheme@@(guile-user)>
8958 @end example
8959
8960 @noindent
8961 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
8962 @code{store-monad} REPL.
8963
8964 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
8965 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
8966
8967 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
8968 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
8969 in @var{monad}.
8970 @end deffn
8971
8972 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
8973 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
8974 @end deffn
8975
8976 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
8977 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
8978 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
8979 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
8980 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
8981 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
8982 in this example:
8983
8984 @lisp
8985 (run-with-state
8986 (with-monad %state-monad
8987 (>>= (return 1)
8988 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
8989 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
8990 'some-state)
8991
8992 @result{} 4
8993 @result{} some-state
8994 @end lisp
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
8998 @var{body} ...
8999 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9000 @var{body} ...
9001 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
9002 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
9003 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
9004 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
9005 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
9006 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
9007 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
9008 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
9009 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
9010 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
9011
9012 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
9013 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
9017 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
9018 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
9019 sequence must be a monadic expression.
9020
9021 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
9022 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
9023 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
9024 @end deffn
9025
9026 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9027 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9028 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9029 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9030 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9031 @end deffn
9032
9033 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9034 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9035 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9036 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9037 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9038 @end deffn
9039
9040 @cindex state monad
9041 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
9042 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
9043 monadic procedure calls.
9044
9045 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
9046 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
9047 the state that is threaded.
9048
9049 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
9050 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
9051 increments the current state value:
9052
9053 @lisp
9054 (define (square x)
9055 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
9056 (mbegin %state-monad
9057 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
9058 (return (* x x)))))
9059
9060 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
9061 @result{} (0 1 4)
9062 @result{} 3
9063 @end lisp
9064
9065 When ``run'' through @code{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
9066 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
9067 @end defvr
9068
9069 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
9070 Return the current state as a monadic value.
9071 @end deffn
9072
9073 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
9074 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
9075 monadic value.
9076 @end deffn
9077
9078 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
9079 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
9080 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
9081 @end deffn
9082
9083 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
9084 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
9085 The state is assumed to be a list.
9086 @end deffn
9087
9088 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
9089 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
9090 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
9091 @end deffn
9092
9093 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
9094 store)} module, is as follows.
9095
9096 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
9097 The store monad---an alias for @code{%state-monad}.
9098
9099 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
9100 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
9101 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below).
9102 @end defvr
9103
9104 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
9105 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
9106 open store connection.
9107 @end deffn
9108
9109 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
9110 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9111 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
9112 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9113 @end deffn
9114
9115 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
9116 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9117 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
9118 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9119 @end deffn
9120
9121 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9122 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
9123 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
9124 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
9125 @var{name} is omitted.
9126
9127 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
9128 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
9129 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
9130
9131 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9132 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9133 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9134 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9135
9136 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
9137
9138 @lisp
9139 (run-with-store (open-connection)
9140 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
9141 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
9142 (return (list a b))))
9143
9144 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
9145 @end lisp
9146
9147 @end deffn
9148
9149 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
9150 monadic procedures:
9151
9152 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
9153 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
9154 [#:output "out"]
9155 Return as a monadic
9156 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
9157 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
9158 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
9159 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
9160
9161 Note that this procedure does @emph{not} build @var{package}. Thus, the
9162 result might or might not designate an existing file. We recommend not
9163 using this procedure unless you know what you are doing.
9164 @end deffn
9165
9166 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
9167 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
9168 @var{target} [@var{system}]
9169 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
9170 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9171 @end deffn
9172
9173
9174 @node G-Expressions
9175 @section G-Expressions
9176
9177 @cindex G-expression
9178 @cindex build code quoting
9179 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
9180 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
9181 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
9182 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
9183 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
9184
9185 @cindex code staging
9186 @cindex staging, of code
9187 @cindex strata of code
9188 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
9189 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
9190 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
9191 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
9192 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
9193 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
9194 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
9195 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
9196 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
9197 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
9198 @command{make}, and so on (@pxref{Build Phases}).
9199
9200 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
9201 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
9202 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
9203 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
9204 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
9205 expressions.
9206
9207 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
9208 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
9209 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
9210 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
9211 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
9212 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
9213 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
9214 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
9215
9216 @itemize
9217 @item
9218 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
9219 processes.
9220
9221 @item
9222 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
9223 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
9224 introduced.
9225
9226 @item
9227 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
9228 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
9229 processes that use them.
9230 @end itemize
9231
9232 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9233 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
9234 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
9235 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
9236 such that these objects can also be inserted
9237 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
9238 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
9239 add files to the store and to refer to them in
9240 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
9241 below).
9242
9243 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
9244
9245 @lisp
9246 (define build-exp
9247 #~(begin
9248 (mkdir #$output)
9249 (chdir #$output)
9250 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
9251 "list-files")))
9252 @end lisp
9253
9254 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
9255 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
9256 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
9257
9258 @lisp
9259 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
9260 @end lisp
9261
9262 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
9263 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
9264 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
9265 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
9266 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
9267 output of the derivation.
9268
9269 @cindex cross compilation
9270 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
9271 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
9272 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
9273 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
9274 native package build:
9275
9276 @lisp
9277 (gexp->derivation "vi"
9278 #~(begin
9279 (mkdir #$output)
9280 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
9281 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
9282 "-s"
9283 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
9284 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
9285 #:target "aarch64-linux-gnu")
9286 @end lisp
9287
9288 @noindent
9289 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
9290 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
9291 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
9292
9293 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
9294 @findex with-imported-modules
9295 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
9296 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
9297 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
9298 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
9299
9300 @lisp
9301 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
9302 #~(begin
9303 (use-modules (guix build utils))
9304 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
9305 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
9306 #~(begin
9307 #$build
9308 (display "success!\n")
9309 #t)))
9310 @end lisp
9311
9312 @noindent
9313 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
9314 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
9315 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
9316
9317 @cindex module closure
9318 @findex source-module-closure
9319 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
9320 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
9321 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
9322 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
9323 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
9324 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
9325
9326 @lisp
9327 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
9328
9329 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
9330 '((guix build utils)
9331 (gnu build vm)))
9332 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
9333 #~(begin
9334 (use-modules (guix build utils)
9335 (gnu build vm))
9336 @dots{})))
9337 @end lisp
9338
9339 @cindex extensions, for gexps
9340 @findex with-extensions
9341 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
9342 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
9343 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
9344 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
9345
9346 @lisp
9347 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
9348
9349 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
9350 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
9351 #~(begin
9352 (use-modules (json))
9353 @dots{})))
9354 @end lisp
9355
9356 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
9357
9358 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
9359 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
9360 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
9361 or more of the following forms:
9362
9363 @table @code
9364 @item #$@var{obj}
9365 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
9366 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
9367 supported types, for example a package or a
9368 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
9369 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
9370
9371 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
9372 objects are substituted similarly.
9373
9374 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
9375 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
9376
9377 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
9378
9379 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
9380 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
9381 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
9382 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
9383 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
9384
9385 @item #+@var{obj}
9386 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
9387 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
9388 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
9389 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
9390 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
9391
9392 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
9393 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
9394 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
9395 output when @var{output} is omitted.
9396
9397 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9398
9399 @item #$@@@var{lst}
9400 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
9401 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
9402 containing list.
9403
9404 @item #+@@@var{lst}
9405 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
9406 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
9407 @var{lst}.
9408
9409 @end table
9410
9411 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
9412 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below).
9413 @end deffn
9414
9415 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
9416 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
9417 in their execution environment.
9418
9419 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
9420 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
9421 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
9422
9423 @lisp
9424 `((guix build utils)
9425 (guix gcrypt)
9426 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
9427 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
9428 @end lisp
9429
9430 @noindent
9431 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
9432 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
9433
9434 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
9435 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
9436 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
9437 @end deffn
9438
9439 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
9440 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
9441 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
9442 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
9443 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
9444
9445 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
9446 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
9447 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
9448 @var{body}@dots{}.
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
9452 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
9453 @end deffn
9454
9455 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
9456 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
9457 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
9458 information about monads).
9459
9460 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
9461 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
9462 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9463 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
9464 [#:module-path @code{%load-path}] @
9465 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
9466 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
9467 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9468 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
9469 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
9470 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
9471 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
9472 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
9473 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
9474 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
9475 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
9476 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
9477 to by @var{exp}.
9478
9479 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
9480 Its meaning is to
9481 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
9482 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
9483 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
9484 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
9485 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
9486
9487 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
9488 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
9489
9490 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
9491 applicable.
9492
9493 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
9494 following forms:
9495
9496 @example
9497 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
9498 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
9499 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
9500 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
9501 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
9502 @end example
9503
9504 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
9505 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
9506 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
9507 text format.
9508
9509 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
9510 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
9511 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
9512 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
9513 referenced by the outputs.
9514
9515 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
9516 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
9517
9518 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
9519 @end deffn
9520
9521 @cindex file-like objects
9522 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
9523 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
9524 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
9525 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
9526
9527 @lisp
9528 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
9529 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
9530 @end lisp
9531
9532 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
9533 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
9534 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
9535 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
9536 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
9537 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
9538 content is directly passed as a string.
9539
9540 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9541 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
9542 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
9543 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
9544 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
9545 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
9546 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
9547 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
9548 base name of @var{file}.
9549
9550 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
9551 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
9552 permission bits are kept.
9553
9554 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9555 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9556 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9557 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9558
9559 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
9560 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
9561 @end deffn
9562
9563 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
9564 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
9565 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
9566
9567 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
9568 @end deffn
9569
9570 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
9571 [#:local-build? #t]
9572 [#:options '()]
9573 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
9574 directory computed by @var{gexp}. When @var{local-build?} is true (the
9575 default), the derivation is built locally. @var{options} is a list of
9576 additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9577
9578 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
9579 @end deffn
9580
9581 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
9582 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9583 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
9584 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
9585 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
9586 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
9587
9588 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
9589 command:
9590
9591 @lisp
9592 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
9593
9594 (gexp->script "list-files"
9595 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
9596 "ls"))
9597 @end lisp
9598
9599 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
9600 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
9601 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
9602
9603 @example
9604 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
9605 !#
9606 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
9607 @end example
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9611 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
9612 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
9613 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
9614 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
9615
9616 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
9617 @end deffn
9618
9619 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9620 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9621 [#:splice? #f] @
9622 [#:guile (default-guile)]
9623 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
9624 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
9625 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
9626
9627 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
9628 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
9629 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
9630 @var{module-path}.
9631
9632 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
9633 or a subset thereof.
9634 @end deffn
9635
9636 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9637 [#:splice? #f] [#:set-load-path? #t]
9638 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
9639 @var{exp}.
9640
9641 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
9642 @end deffn
9643
9644 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9645 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
9646 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
9647 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
9648 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
9649 references to all these.
9650
9651 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
9652 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
9653 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
9654 like this:
9655
9656 @lisp
9657 (define (profile.sh)
9658 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
9659 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
9660 (text-file* "profile.sh"
9661 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
9662 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
9663 @end lisp
9664
9665 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
9666 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
9667 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
9668 @end deffn
9669
9670 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9671 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
9672 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
9673 as in:
9674
9675 @lisp
9676 (mixed-text-file "profile"
9677 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
9678 @end lisp
9679
9680 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
9681 @end deffn
9682
9683 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
9684 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
9685 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
9686 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
9687 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
9688
9689 @lisp
9690 (file-union "etc"
9691 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
9692 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
9693 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
9694 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
9695 @end lisp
9696
9697 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
9698 @end deffn
9699
9700 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
9701 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
9702 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
9703
9704 @lisp
9705 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
9706 @end lisp
9707
9708 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
9709 @end deffn
9710
9711 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
9712 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
9713 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
9714 @var{suffix} is a string.
9715
9716 As an example, consider this gexp:
9717
9718 @lisp
9719 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9720 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
9721 "/bin/uname")))
9722 @end lisp
9723
9724 The same effect could be achieved with:
9725
9726 @lisp
9727 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9728 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
9729 "/bin/uname")))
9730 @end lisp
9731
9732 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
9733 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
9734 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
9735 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
9736 @end deffn
9737
9738 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} let-system @var{system} @var{body}@dots{}
9739 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} let-system (@var{system} @var{target}) @var{body}@dots{}
9740 Bind @var{system} to the currently targeted system---e.g.,
9741 @code{"x86_64-linux"}---within @var{body}.
9742
9743 In the second case, additionally bind @var{target} to the current
9744 cross-compilation target---a GNU triplet such as
9745 @code{"arm-linux-gnueabihf"}---or @code{#f} if we are not
9746 cross-compiling.
9747
9748 @code{let-system} is useful in the occasional case where the object
9749 spliced into the gexp depends on the target system, as in this example:
9750
9751 @lisp
9752 #~(system*
9753 #+(let-system system
9754 (cond ((string-prefix? "armhf-" system)
9755 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-arm"))
9756 ((string-prefix? "x86_64-" system)
9757 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-x86_64"))
9758 (else
9759 (error "dunno!"))))
9760 "-net" "user" #$image)
9761 @end lisp
9762 @end deffn
9763
9764 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
9765 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
9766 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
9767 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
9768 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
9769 derivation or store item.
9770
9771 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
9772 for a given object:
9773
9774 @lisp
9775 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
9776 coreutils)
9777 @end lisp
9778
9779 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
9780 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
9781 @end deffn
9782
9783
9784 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
9785 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
9786 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
9787 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
9788
9789 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9790 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
9791 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
9792 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
9793 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
9794
9795 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
9796 [#:target #f]
9797 Return as a value in @code{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
9798 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
9799 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
9800 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
9801 @end deffn
9802
9803 @node Invoking guix repl
9804 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
9805
9806 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop, script
9807 The @command{guix repl} command makes it easier to program Guix in Guile
9808 by launching a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop} (REPL) for interactive
9809 programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
9810 GNU Guile Reference Manual}), or by running Guile scripts
9811 (@pxref{Running Guile Scripts,,, guile,
9812 GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9813 Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
9814 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
9815 dependencies are available in the search path.
9816
9817 The general syntax is:
9818
9819 @example
9820 guix repl @var{options} [@var{file} @var{args}]
9821 @end example
9822
9823 When a @var{file} argument is provided, @var{file} is
9824 executed as a Guile scripts:
9825
9826 @example
9827 guix repl my-script.scm
9828 @end example
9829
9830 To pass arguments to the script, use @code{--} to prevent them from
9831 being interpreted as arguments to @command{guix repl} itself:
9832
9833 @example
9834 guix repl -- my-script.scm --input=foo.txt
9835 @end example
9836
9837 To make a script executable directly from the shell, using the guix
9838 executable that is on the user's search path, add the following two
9839 lines at the top of the script:
9840
9841 @example
9842 @code{#!/usr/bin/env -S guix repl --}
9843 @code{!#}
9844 @end example
9845
9846 Without a file name argument, a Guile REPL is started:
9847
9848 @example
9849 $ guix repl
9850 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
9851 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
9852 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
9853 @end example
9854
9855 @cindex inferiors
9856 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
9857 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
9858 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
9859 of Guix.
9860
9861 The available options are as follows:
9862
9863 @table @code
9864 @item --type=@var{type}
9865 @itemx -t @var{type}
9866 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
9867
9868 @table @code
9869 @item guile
9870 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
9871 @item machine
9872 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
9873 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
9874 @end table
9875
9876 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
9877 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
9878 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
9879 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
9880
9881 @table @code
9882 @item --listen=tcp:37146
9883 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
9884
9885 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
9886 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
9887 @end table
9888
9889 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9890 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9891 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9892 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9893
9894 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9895 the script or REPL.
9896
9897 @item -q
9898 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
9899 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
9900 @end table
9901
9902 @c *********************************************************************
9903 @node Utilities
9904 @chapter Utilities
9905
9906 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
9907 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
9908 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
9909 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
9910
9911 @menu
9912 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
9913 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
9914 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
9915 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
9916 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
9917 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
9918 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
9919 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
9920 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
9921 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
9922 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
9923 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
9924 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
9925 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
9926 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
9927 @end menu
9928
9929 @node Invoking guix build
9930 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
9931
9932 @cindex package building
9933 @cindex @command{guix build}
9934 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
9935 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
9936 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
9937 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
9938 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
9939
9940 The general syntax is:
9941
9942 @example
9943 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
9944 @end example
9945
9946 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
9947 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
9948 resulting directories:
9949
9950 @example
9951 guix build emacs guile
9952 @end example
9953
9954 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
9955
9956 @example
9957 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
9958 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
9959 @end example
9960
9961 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
9962 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
9963 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
9964 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
9965 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
9966 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9967
9968 Alternatively, the @option{--expression} option may be used to specify a
9969 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
9970 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
9971 needed.
9972
9973 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
9974 described in the subsections below.
9975
9976 @menu
9977 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
9978 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
9979 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
9980 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
9981 @end menu
9982
9983 @node Common Build Options
9984 @subsection Common Build Options
9985
9986 A number of options that control the build process are common to
9987 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
9988 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
9989 following:
9990
9991 @table @code
9992
9993 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9994 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9995 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9996 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9997
9998 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9999 the command-line tools.
10000
10001 @item --keep-failed
10002 @itemx -K
10003 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
10004 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
10005 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
10006 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
10007 build issues.
10008
10009 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
10010 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
10011 Store, the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
10012
10013 @item --keep-going
10014 @itemx -k
10015 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
10016 all the builds have either completed or failed.
10017
10018 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
10019 derivations has failed.
10020
10021 @item --dry-run
10022 @itemx -n
10023 Do not build the derivations.
10024
10025 @anchor{fallback-option}
10026 @item --fallback
10027 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
10028 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
10029
10030 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10031 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
10032 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10033 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
10034 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
10035
10036 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
10037 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
10038 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10039
10040 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
10041 disabled.
10042
10043 @item --no-substitutes
10044 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
10045 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
10046 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10047
10048 @item --no-grafts
10049 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
10050 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10051 information on grafts.
10052
10053 @item --rounds=@var{n}
10054 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
10055 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
10056
10057 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
10058 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
10059 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
10060 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
10061
10062 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10063 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10064 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10065
10066 @item --no-offload
10067 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10068 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
10069 builds to remote machines.
10070
10071 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
10072 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
10073 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10074
10075 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10076 guix-daemon, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
10077
10078 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
10079 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
10080 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10081
10082 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10083 guix-daemon, @option{--timeout}}).
10084
10085 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
10086 @c most programs honor it.
10087 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
10088 @cindex build logs, verbosity
10089 @item -v @var{level}
10090 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
10091 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
10092 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
10093 output on standard error.
10094
10095 @item --cores=@var{n}
10096 @itemx -c @var{n}
10097 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
10098 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
10099
10100 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
10101 @itemx -M @var{n}
10102 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
10103 guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
10104 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
10105
10106 @item --debug=@var{level}
10107 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
10108 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
10109 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
10110
10111 @end table
10112
10113 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
10114 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
10115 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
10116 derivations)} module.
10117
10118 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
10119 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
10120 building honor the @env{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
10121
10122 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
10123 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
10124 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
10125 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
10126 below:
10127
10128 @example
10129 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
10130 @end example
10131
10132 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
10133 the parsed command-line options.
10134 @end defvr
10135
10136
10137 @node Package Transformation Options
10138 @subsection Package Transformation Options
10139
10140 @cindex package variants
10141 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
10142 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
10143 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
10144 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
10145 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
10146 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
10147 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10148
10149 Package transformation options are preserved across upgrades:
10150 @command{guix upgrade} attempts to apply transformation options
10151 initially used when creating the profile to the upgraded packages.
10152
10153 The available options are listed below. Most commands support them and
10154 also support a @option{--help-transform} option that lists all the
10155 available options and a synopsis (these options are not shown in the
10156 @option{--help} output for brevity).
10157
10158 @table @code
10159
10160 @item --with-source=@var{source}
10161 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
10162 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
10163 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
10164 its version number.
10165 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
10166 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
10167
10168 When @var{package} is omitted,
10169 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
10170 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
10171 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
10172 package is @code{guile}.
10173
10174 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
10175 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
10176
10177 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
10178 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
10179 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
10180 the @code{ed} package:
10181
10182 @example
10183 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
10184 @end example
10185
10186 As a developer, @option{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
10187 candidates:
10188
10189 @example
10190 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
10191 @end example
10192
10193 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
10194
10195 @example
10196 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
10197 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
10198 @end example
10199
10200 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10201 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
10202 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
10203 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
10204 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
10205
10206 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
10207 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
10208 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
10209
10210 @example
10211 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
10212 @end example
10213
10214 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
10215 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
10216 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
10217
10218 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
10219 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
10220
10221 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10222 This is similar to @option{--with-input} but with an important difference:
10223 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
10224 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
10225 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10226 information on grafts.
10227
10228 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
10229 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
10230 they currently refer to:
10231
10232 @example
10233 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
10234 @end example
10235
10236 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
10237 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
10238 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
10239 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
10240 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
10241 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
10242 care!
10243
10244 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
10245 @item --with-debug-info=@var{package}
10246 Build @var{package} in a way that preserves its debugging info and graft
10247 it onto packages that depend on it. This is useful if @var{package}
10248 does not already provide debugging info as a @code{debug} output
10249 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
10250
10251 For example, suppose you're experiencing a crash in Inkscape and would
10252 like to see what's up in GLib, a library deep down in Inkscape's
10253 dependency graph. GLib lacks a @code{debug} output, so debugging is
10254 tough. Fortunately, you rebuild GLib with debugging info and tack it on
10255 Inkscape:
10256
10257 @example
10258 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
10259 @end example
10260
10261 Only GLib needs to be recompiled so this takes a reasonable amount of
10262 time. @xref{Installing Debugging Files}, for more info.
10263
10264 @quotation Note
10265 Under the hood, this option works by passing the @samp{#:strip-binaries?
10266 #f} to the build system of the package of interest (@pxref{Build
10267 Systems}). Most build systems support that option but some do not. In
10268 that case, an error is raised.
10269
10270 Likewise, if a C/C++ package is built without @code{-g} (which is rarely
10271 the case), debugging info will remain unavailable even when
10272 @code{#:strip-binaries?} is false.
10273 @end quotation
10274
10275 @cindex tool chain, changing the build tool chain of a package
10276 @item --with-c-toolchain=@var{package}=@var{toolchain}
10277 This option changes the compilation of @var{package} and everything that
10278 depends on it so that they get built with @var{toolchain} instead of the
10279 default GNU tool chain for C/C++.
10280
10281 Consider this example:
10282
10283 @example
10284 guix build octave-cli \
10285 --with-c-toolchain=fftw=gcc-toolchain@@10 \
10286 --with-c-toolchain=fftwf=gcc-toolchain@@10
10287 @end example
10288
10289 The command above builds a variant of the @code{fftw} and @code{fftwf}
10290 packages using version 10 of @code{gcc-toolchain} instead of the default
10291 tool chain, and then builds a variant of the GNU@tie{}Octave
10292 command-line interface using them. GNU@tie{}Octave itself is also built
10293 with @code{gcc-toolchain@@10}.
10294
10295 This other example builds the Hardware Locality (@code{hwloc}) library
10296 and its dependents up to @code{intel-mpi-benchmarks} with the Clang C
10297 compiler:
10298
10299 @example
10300 guix build --with-c-toolchain=hwloc=clang-toolchain \
10301 intel-mpi-benchmarks
10302 @end example
10303
10304 @quotation Note
10305 There can be application binary interface (ABI) incompatibilities among
10306 tool chains. This is particularly true of the C++ standard library and
10307 run-time support libraries such as that of OpenMP@. By rebuilding all
10308 dependents with the same tool chain, @option{--with-c-toolchain} minimizes
10309 the risks of incompatibility but cannot entirely eliminate them. Choose
10310 @var{package} wisely.
10311 @end quotation
10312
10313 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
10314 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
10315 @cindex latest commit, building
10316 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
10317 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
10318 recursively.
10319
10320 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
10321 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
10322
10323 @example
10324 guix build python-numpy \
10325 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
10326 @end example
10327
10328 This option can also be combined with @option{--with-branch} or
10329 @option{--with-commit} (see below).
10330
10331 @cindex continuous integration
10332 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
10333 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
10334 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
10335 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
10336 integration (CI).
10337
10338 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
10339 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
10340 in a while to save disk space.
10341
10342 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
10343 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
10344 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
10345 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
10346 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
10347 @option{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
10348
10349 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
10350 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
10351 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
10352 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
10353
10354 @example
10355 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
10356 @end example
10357
10358 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
10359 This is similar to @option{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
10360 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
10361 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
10362
10363 @item --with-patch=@var{package}=@var{file}
10364 Add @var{file} to the list of patches applied to @var{package}, where
10365 @var{package} is a spec such as @code{python@@3.8} or @code{glibc}.
10366 @var{file} must contain a patch; it is applied with the flags specified
10367 in the @code{origin} of @var{package} (@pxref{origin Reference}), which
10368 by default includes @code{-p1} (@pxref{patch Directories,,, diffutils,
10369 Comparing and Merging Files}).
10370
10371 As an example, the command below rebuilds Coreutils with the GNU C
10372 Library (glibc) patched with the given patch:
10373
10374 @example
10375 guix build coreutils --with-patch=glibc=./glibc-frob.patch
10376 @end example
10377
10378 In this example, glibc itself as well as everything that leads to
10379 Coreutils in the dependency graph is rebuilt.
10380
10381 @cindex upstream, latest version
10382 @item --with-latest=@var{package}
10383 So you like living on the bleeding edge? This option is for you! It
10384 replaces occurrences of @var{package} in the dependency graph with its
10385 latest upstream version, as reported by @command{guix refresh}
10386 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
10387
10388 It does so by determining the latest upstream release of @var{package}
10389 (if possible), downloading it, and authenticating it @emph{if} it comes
10390 with an OpenPGP signature.
10391
10392 As an example, the command below builds Guix against the latest version
10393 of Guile-JSON:
10394
10395 @example
10396 guix build guix --with-latest=guile-json
10397 @end example
10398
10399 There are limitations. First, in cases where the tool cannot or does
10400 not know how to authenticate source code, you are at risk of running
10401 malicious code; a warning is emitted in this case. Second, this option
10402 simply changes the source used in the existing package definitions,
10403 which is not always sufficient: there might be additional dependencies
10404 that need to be added, patches to apply, and more generally the quality
10405 assurance work that Guix developers normally do will be missing.
10406
10407 You've been warned! In all the other cases, it's a snappy way to stay
10408 on top. We encourage you to submit patches updating the actual package
10409 definitions once you have successfully tested an upgrade
10410 (@pxref{Contributing}).
10411
10412 @cindex test suite, skipping
10413 @item --without-tests=@var{package}
10414 Build @var{package} without running its tests. This can be useful in
10415 situations where you want to skip the lengthy test suite of a
10416 intermediate package, or if a package's test suite fails in a
10417 non-deterministic fashion. It should be used with care because running
10418 the test suite is a good way to ensure a package is working as intended.
10419
10420 Turning off tests leads to a different store item. Consequently, when
10421 using this option, anything that depends on @var{package} must be
10422 rebuilt, as in this example:
10423
10424 @example
10425 guix install --without-tests=python python-notebook
10426 @end example
10427
10428 The command above installs @code{python-notebook} on top of
10429 @code{python} built without running its test suite. To do so, it also
10430 rebuilds everything that depends on @code{python}, including
10431 @code{python-notebook} itself.
10432
10433 Internally, @option{--without-tests} relies on changing the
10434 @code{#:tests?} option of a package's @code{check} phase (@pxref{Build
10435 Systems}). Note that some packages use a customized @code{check} phase
10436 that does not respect a @code{#:tests? #f} setting. Therefore,
10437 @option{--without-tests} has no effect on these packages.
10438
10439 @end table
10440
10441 Wondering how to achieve the same effect using Scheme code, for example
10442 in your manifest, or how to write your own package transformation?
10443 @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for an overview of the programming
10444 interfaces available.
10445
10446 @node Additional Build Options
10447 @subsection Additional Build Options
10448
10449 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
10450 build}.
10451
10452 @table @code
10453
10454 @item --quiet
10455 @itemx -q
10456 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
10457 @option{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
10458 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
10459
10460 @item --file=@var{file}
10461 @itemx -f @var{file}
10462 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
10463 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
10464
10465 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
10466 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
10467
10468 @lisp
10469 @include package-hello.scm
10470 @end lisp
10471
10472 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
10473 package definitions. Running @code{guix build -f} on @file{hello.json}
10474 with the following contents would result in building the packages
10475 @code{myhello} and @code{greeter}:
10476
10477 @example
10478 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
10479 @end example
10480
10481 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
10482 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
10483 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
10484 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
10485
10486 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10487 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10488 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
10489
10490 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
10491 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
10492 version 1.8 of Guile.
10493
10494 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
10495 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
10496 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10497
10498 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
10499 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
10500 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
10501
10502 @item --source
10503 @itemx -S
10504 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
10505 themselves.
10506
10507 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
10508 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
10509 source tarball.
10510
10511 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
10512 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
10513 Packages}).
10514
10515 @cindex source, verification
10516 As with other derivations, the result of building a source derivation
10517 can be verified using the @option{--check} option (@pxref{build-check}).
10518 This is useful to validate that a (potentially already built or
10519 substituted, thus cached) package source matches against its declared
10520 hash.
10521
10522 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
10523 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
10524 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
10525 the packages.
10526
10527 @item --sources
10528 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
10529 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
10530 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
10531 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
10532 of the @option{--source} option and can accept one of the following
10533 optional argument values:
10534
10535 @table @code
10536 @item package
10537 This value causes the @option{--sources} option to behave in the same way
10538 as the @option{--source} option.
10539
10540 @item all
10541 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
10542 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
10543
10544 @example
10545 $ guix build --sources tzdata
10546 The following derivations will be built:
10547 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
10548 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10549 @end example
10550
10551 @item transitive
10552 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
10553 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
10554 prefetch package source for later offline building.
10555
10556 @example
10557 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
10558 The following derivations will be built:
10559 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10560 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
10561 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
10562 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
10563 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
10564 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
10565 @dots{}
10566 @end example
10567
10568 @end table
10569
10570 @item --system=@var{system}
10571 @itemx -s @var{system}
10572 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
10573 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
10574 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
10575 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
10576
10577 @quotation Note
10578 The @option{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
10579 be confused with cross-compilation. See @option{--target} below for
10580 information on cross-compilation.
10581 @end quotation
10582
10583 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
10584 different personalities. For instance, passing
10585 @option{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
10586 @option{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows
10587 you to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
10588
10589 @quotation Note
10590 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
10591 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
10592 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
10593 @end quotation
10594
10595 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
10596 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
10597 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
10598 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
10599
10600 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
10601 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
10602 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
10603
10604 @item --target=@var{triplet}
10605 @cindex cross-compilation
10606 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
10607 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
10608 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
10609
10610 @anchor{build-check}
10611 @item --check
10612 @cindex determinism, checking
10613 @cindex reproducibility, checking
10614 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
10615 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
10616 identical.
10617
10618 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
10619 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
10620 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
10621 background information and tools.
10622
10623 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10624 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10625 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10626
10627 @item --repair
10628 @cindex repairing store items
10629 @cindex corruption, recovering from
10630 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
10631 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
10632
10633 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
10634
10635 @item --derivations
10636 @itemx -d
10637 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
10638 packages.
10639
10640 @item --root=@var{file}
10641 @itemx -r @var{file}
10642 @cindex GC roots, adding
10643 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
10644 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
10645 collector root.
10646
10647 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
10648 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
10649 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
10650 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
10651 more on GC roots.
10652
10653 @item --log-file
10654 @cindex build logs, access
10655 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
10656 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
10657 missing.
10658
10659 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
10660 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
10661
10662 @example
10663 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
10664 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
10665 guix build --log-file guile
10666 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
10667 @end example
10668
10669 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @option{--no-substitutes} is
10670 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
10671 substitute servers (as specified with @option{--substitute-urls}).
10672
10673 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
10674 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
10675
10676 @example
10677 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s aarch64-linux
10678 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
10679 @end example
10680
10681 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
10682 @end table
10683
10684 @node Debugging Build Failures
10685 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
10686
10687 @cindex build failures, debugging
10688 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
10689 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
10690 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
10691 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
10692 build daemon uses.
10693
10694 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
10695 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
10696 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
10697 @env{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
10698
10699 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
10700 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
10701 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
10702 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
10703 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
10704
10705 @example
10706 $ guix build foo -K
10707 @dots{} @i{build fails}
10708 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10709 $ source ./environment-variables
10710 $ cd foo-1.2
10711 @end example
10712
10713 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
10714 troubleshoot your build process.
10715
10716 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
10717 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
10718 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
10719 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
10720 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
10721
10722 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
10723 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
10724
10725 @example
10726 $ guix build -K foo
10727 @dots{}
10728 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10729 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
10730 [env]# source ./environment-variables
10731 [env]# cd foo-1.2
10732 @end example
10733
10734 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
10735 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
10736 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
10737 the container, which you may find handy while debugging. The
10738 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
10739 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
10740 info on grafts).
10741
10742 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
10743 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
10744
10745 @example
10746 [env]# rm /bin/sh
10747 @end example
10748
10749 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
10750 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
10751
10752 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
10753 can run:
10754
10755 @example
10756 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
10757 @end example
10758
10759 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
10760 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
10761 similar to the one the daemon uses.
10762
10763
10764 @node Invoking guix edit
10765 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
10766
10767 @cindex @command{guix edit}
10768 @cindex package definition, editing
10769 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
10770 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
10771 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
10772 For instance:
10773
10774 @example
10775 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
10776 @end example
10777
10778 @noindent
10779 launches the program specified in the @env{VISUAL} or in the
10780 @env{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
10781 and that of Vim.
10782
10783 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
10784 have created your own packages on @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
10785 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
10786 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
10787 for packages currently in the store.
10788
10789 Instead of @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
10790 @option{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @option{-L
10791 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
10792 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
10793
10794 @node Invoking guix download
10795 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
10796
10797 @cindex @command{guix download}
10798 @cindex downloading package sources
10799 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
10800 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
10801 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
10802 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
10803 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
10804 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
10805
10806 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
10807 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
10808 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
10809 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
10810 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
10811 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10812
10813 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
10814 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
10815 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
10816 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
10817 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
10818 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
10819 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
10820
10821 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
10822 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
10823 the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
10824 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
10825
10826 The following options are available:
10827
10828 @table @code
10829 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10830 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10831 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}. @xref{Invoking guix
10832 hash}, for more information.
10833
10834 @item --format=@var{fmt}
10835 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
10836 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
10837 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
10838
10839 @item --no-check-certificate
10840 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
10841
10842 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
10843 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
10844 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
10845
10846 @item --output=@var{file}
10847 @itemx -o @var{file}
10848 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
10849 store.
10850 @end table
10851
10852 @node Invoking guix hash
10853 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
10854
10855 @cindex @command{guix hash}
10856 The @command{guix hash} command computes the hash of a file.
10857 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
10858 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
10859 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10860
10861 The general syntax is:
10862
10863 @example
10864 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
10865 @end example
10866
10867 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
10868 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
10869 following options:
10870
10871 @table @code
10872
10873 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10874 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10875 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}, @code{sha256} by
10876 default.
10877
10878 @var{algorithm} must the name of a cryptographic hash algorithm
10879 supported by Libgcrypt @i{via} Guile-Gcrypt---e.g., @code{sha512} or
10880 @code{sha3-256} (@pxref{Hash Functions,,, guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt
10881 Reference Manual}).
10882
10883 @item --format=@var{fmt}
10884 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
10885 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
10886
10887 Supported formats: @code{base64}, @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
10888 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
10889
10890 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
10891 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
10892 in the definitions of packages.
10893
10894 @item --recursive
10895 @itemx -r
10896 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
10897
10898 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
10899 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
10900 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
10901 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
10902 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
10903 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
10904 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
10905 @c it exists.
10906
10907 @item --exclude-vcs
10908 @itemx -x
10909 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
10910 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.).
10911
10912 @vindex git-fetch
10913 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
10914 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
10915 Reference}):
10916
10917 @example
10918 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
10919 $ cd foo
10920 $ guix hash -rx .
10921 @end example
10922 @end table
10923
10924 @node Invoking guix import
10925 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
10926
10927 @cindex importing packages
10928 @cindex package import
10929 @cindex package conversion
10930 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
10931 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
10932 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
10933 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
10934 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
10935 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
10936 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10937
10938 The general syntax is:
10939
10940 @example
10941 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
10942 @end example
10943
10944 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
10945 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
10946 options specific to @var{importer}.
10947
10948 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
10949 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
10950 gnupg} if needed.
10951
10952 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
10953
10954 @table @code
10955 @item gnu
10956 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
10957 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
10958 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
10959
10960 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
10961 license needs to be figured out manually.
10962
10963 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
10964 GNU@tie{}Hello:
10965
10966 @example
10967 guix import gnu hello
10968 @end example
10969
10970 Specific command-line options are:
10971
10972 @table @code
10973 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
10974 As for @command{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing
10975 OpenPGP keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
10976 refresh, @option{--key-download}}.
10977 @end table
10978
10979 @item pypi
10980 @cindex pypi
10981 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
10982 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
10983 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
10984 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
10985 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
10986 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
10987
10988 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
10989 package:
10990
10991 @example
10992 guix import pypi itsdangerous
10993 @end example
10994
10995 @table @code
10996 @item --recursive
10997 @itemx -r
10998 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
10999 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11000 in Guix.
11001 @end table
11002
11003 @item gem
11004 @cindex gem
11005 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
11006 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
11007 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
11008 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
11009 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
11010 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
11011 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
11012 as an exercise to the packager.
11013
11014 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
11015
11016 @example
11017 guix import gem rails
11018 @end example
11019
11020 @table @code
11021 @item --recursive
11022 @itemx -r
11023 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11024 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11025 in Guix.
11026 @end table
11027
11028 @item cpan
11029 @cindex CPAN
11030 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
11031 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
11032 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
11033 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
11034 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
11035 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
11036 list of dependencies.
11037
11038 The command command below imports metadata for the Acme::Boolean Perl
11039 module:
11040
11041 @example
11042 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
11043 @end example
11044
11045 @item cran
11046 @cindex CRAN
11047 @cindex Bioconductor
11048 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
11049 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
11050 statistical and graphical environment}.
11051
11052 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
11053
11054 The command command below imports metadata for the Cairo R package:
11055
11056 @example
11057 guix import cran Cairo
11058 @end example
11059
11060 When @option{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
11061 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
11062 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
11063
11064 When @option{--style=specification} is added, the importer will generate
11065 package definitions whose inputs are package specifications instead of
11066 references to package variables. This is useful when generated package
11067 definitions are to be appended to existing user modules, as the list of
11068 used package modules need not be changed. The default is
11069 @option{--style=variable}.
11070
11071 When @option{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
11072 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
11073 packages for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
11074 genomic data in bioinformatics.
11075
11076 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
11077 package archive.
11078
11079 The command below imports metadata for the GenomicRanges R package:
11080
11081 @example
11082 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
11083 @end example
11084
11085 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
11086 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
11087 @option{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
11088
11089 @example
11090 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
11091 @end example
11092
11093 @item texlive
11094 @cindex TeX Live
11095 @cindex CTAN
11096 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
11097 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
11098 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
11099
11100 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
11101 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
11102 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
11103 versioned archives.
11104
11105 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
11106 TeX package:
11107
11108 @example
11109 guix import texlive fontspec
11110 @end example
11111
11112 When @option{--archive=@var{directory}} is added, the source code is
11113 downloaded not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the
11114 @file{texmf-dist/source} tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from
11115 the specified sibling @var{directory} under the same root.
11116
11117 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
11118 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
11119 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
11120
11121 @example
11122 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
11123 @end example
11124
11125 @item json
11126 @cindex JSON, import
11127 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
11128 example package definition in JSON format:
11129
11130 @example
11131 @{
11132 "name": "hello",
11133 "version": "2.10",
11134 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11135 "build-system": "gnu",
11136 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
11137 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
11138 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
11139 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
11140 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
11141 @}
11142 @end example
11143
11144 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
11145 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
11146 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
11147 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
11148
11149 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
11150 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
11151
11152 @example
11153 @{
11154 @dots{}
11155 "source": @{
11156 "method": "url-fetch",
11157 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11158 "sha256": @{
11159 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
11160 @}
11161 @}
11162 @dots{}
11163 @}
11164 @end example
11165
11166 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
11167 and outputs a package expression:
11168
11169 @example
11170 guix import json hello.json
11171 @end example
11172
11173 @item nix
11174 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
11175 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
11176 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
11177 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
11178 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
11179 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
11180 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
11181 package definition.
11182
11183 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
11184 by their canonical upstream variant.
11185
11186 Usually, you will first need to do:
11187
11188 @example
11189 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
11190 @end example
11191
11192 @noindent
11193 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
11194
11195 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
11196 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
11197 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
11198
11199 @example
11200 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
11201 @end example
11202
11203 @item hackage
11204 @cindex hackage
11205 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
11206 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
11207 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
11208 dependencies.
11209
11210 Specific command-line options are:
11211
11212 @table @code
11213 @item --stdin
11214 @itemx -s
11215 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
11216 @item --no-test-dependencies
11217 @itemx -t
11218 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11219 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
11220 @itemx -e @var{alist}
11221 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
11222 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
11223 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
11224 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
11225 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
11226 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
11227 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
11228 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
11229 @item --recursive
11230 @itemx -r
11231 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11232 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11233 in Guix.
11234 @end table
11235
11236 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
11237 HTTP Haskell package without including test dependencies and
11238 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
11239
11240 @example
11241 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
11242 @end example
11243
11244 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
11245 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
11246
11247 @example
11248 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
11249 @end example
11250
11251 @item stackage
11252 @cindex stackage
11253 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
11254 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
11255 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
11256 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
11257 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
11258 GHC compiler used by Guix.
11259
11260 Specific command-line options are:
11261
11262 @table @code
11263 @item --no-test-dependencies
11264 @itemx -t
11265 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11266 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
11267 @itemx -l @var{version}
11268 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
11269 release is used.
11270 @item --recursive
11271 @itemx -r
11272 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11273 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11274 in Guix.
11275 @end table
11276
11277 The command below imports metadata for the HTTP Haskell package
11278 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
11279
11280 @example
11281 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
11282 @end example
11283
11284 @item elpa
11285 @cindex elpa
11286 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
11287 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11288
11289 Specific command-line options are:
11290
11291 @table @code
11292 @item --archive=@var{repo}
11293 @itemx -a @var{repo}
11294 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
11295 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
11296 are:
11297 @itemize -
11298 @item
11299 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
11300 identifier. This is the default.
11301
11302 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
11303 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
11304 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
11305 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
11306 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11307
11308 @item
11309 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
11310 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
11311
11312 @item
11313 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
11314 identifier.
11315 @end itemize
11316
11317 @item --recursive
11318 @itemx -r
11319 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11320 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11321 in Guix.
11322 @end table
11323
11324 @item crate
11325 @cindex crate
11326 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
11327 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
11328
11329 @example
11330 guix import crate blake2-rfc
11331 @end example
11332
11333 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
11334
11335 @example
11336 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
11337 @end example
11338
11339 Additional options include:
11340
11341 @table @code
11342 @item --recursive
11343 @itemx -r
11344 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11345 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11346 in Guix.
11347 @end table
11348
11349 @item opam
11350 @cindex OPAM
11351 @cindex OCaml
11352 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
11353 repository used by the OCaml community.
11354
11355 Additional options include:
11356
11357 @table @code
11358 @item --recursive
11359 @itemx -r
11360 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11361 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11362 in Guix.
11363 @item --repo
11364 Select the given repository (a repository name). Possible values include:
11365 @itemize
11366 @item @code{opam}, the default opam repository,
11367 @item @code{coq} or @code{coq-released}, the stable repository for coq packages,
11368 @item @code{coq-core-dev}, the repository that contains development versions of coq,
11369 @item @code{coq-extra-dev}, the repository that contains development versions
11370 of coq packages.
11371 @end itemize
11372 @end table
11373 @end table
11374
11375 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
11376 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
11377 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
11378
11379 @node Invoking guix refresh
11380 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
11381
11382 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
11383 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
11384 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
11385 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
11386 upstream version, like this:
11387
11388 @example
11389 $ guix refresh
11390 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
11391 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
11392 @end example
11393
11394 Alternatively, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
11395 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
11396
11397 @example
11398 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
11399 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
11400 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
11401 @end example
11402
11403 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
11404 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
11405 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
11406 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
11407 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
11408 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
11409 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
11410
11411 @table @code
11412
11413 @item --recursive
11414 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
11415
11416 @example
11417 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
11418 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
11419 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
11420 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
11421 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
11422 @dots{}
11423 @end example
11424
11425 @end table
11426
11427 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
11428 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
11429 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
11430 to that effect:
11431
11432 @lisp
11433 (define-public network-manager
11434 (package
11435 (name "network-manager")
11436 ;; @dots{}
11437 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
11438 @end lisp
11439
11440 When passed @option{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
11441 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
11442 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
11443 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
11444 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
11445 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
11446 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
11447
11448 When the public
11449 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
11450 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
11451 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
11452 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
11453
11454 The following options are supported:
11455
11456 @table @code
11457
11458 @item --expression=@var{expr}
11459 @itemx -e @var{expr}
11460 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
11461
11462 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
11463
11464 @example
11465 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
11466 @end example
11467
11468 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
11469 the packages).
11470
11471 @item --update
11472 @itemx -u
11473 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
11474 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
11475 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11476
11477 @example
11478 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
11479 @end example
11480
11481 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
11482
11483 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
11484 @itemx -s @var{subset}
11485 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
11486 @code{non-core}.
11487
11488 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
11489 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
11490 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
11491 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
11492 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
11493 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
11494
11495 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
11496 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
11497 inconvenient.
11498
11499 @item --manifest=@var{file}
11500 @itemx -m @var{file}
11501 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
11502 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
11503
11504 @item --type=@var{updater}
11505 @itemx -t @var{updater}
11506 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
11507 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
11508
11509 @table @code
11510 @item gnu
11511 the updater for GNU packages;
11512 @item savannah
11513 the updater for packages hosted at @uref{https://savannah.gnu.org, Savannah};
11514 @item gnome
11515 the updater for GNOME packages;
11516 @item kde
11517 the updater for KDE packages;
11518 @item xorg
11519 the updater for X.org packages;
11520 @item kernel.org
11521 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
11522 @item elpa
11523 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
11524 @item cran
11525 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
11526 @item bioconductor
11527 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
11528 @item cpan
11529 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
11530 @item pypi
11531 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
11532 @item gem
11533 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
11534 @item github
11535 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
11536 @item hackage
11537 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
11538 @item stackage
11539 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
11540 @item crate
11541 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
11542 @item launchpad
11543 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
11544 @end table
11545
11546 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
11547 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
11548
11549 @example
11550 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
11551 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
11552 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
11553 @end example
11554
11555 @end table
11556
11557 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
11558 names, as in this example:
11559
11560 @example
11561 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
11562 @end example
11563
11564 @noindent
11565 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
11566 @code{idutils} packages. The @option{--select} option would have no
11567 effect in this case.
11568
11569 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
11570 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
11571 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
11572 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
11573
11574 @table @code
11575
11576 @item --list-updaters
11577 @itemx -L
11578 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above).
11579
11580 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
11581 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
11582
11583 @item --list-dependent
11584 @itemx -l
11585 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
11586 result of upgrading one or more packages.
11587
11588 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
11589 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
11590 dependents of a package.
11591
11592 @end table
11593
11594 Be aware that the @option{--list-dependent} option only
11595 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
11596 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
11597
11598 @example
11599 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
11600 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
11601 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
11602 @end example
11603
11604 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
11605 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
11606
11607 @table @code
11608
11609 @item --list-transitive
11610 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
11611
11612 @example
11613 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
11614 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
11615 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
11616 @end example
11617
11618 @end table
11619
11620 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
11621 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
11622
11623 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
11624
11625 @table @code
11626
11627 @item --gpg=@var{command}
11628 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
11629 for in @code{$PATH}.
11630
11631 @item --keyring=@var{file}
11632 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
11633 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
11634 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
11635 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
11636 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
11637
11638 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
11639 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
11640 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
11641 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
11642 @option{--key-download} below).
11643
11644 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
11645 commands like this one:
11646
11647 @example
11648 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
11649 @end example
11650
11651 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
11652
11653 @example
11654 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
11655 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
11656 @end example
11657
11658 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
11659 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
11660
11661 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11662 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
11663 of:
11664
11665 @table @code
11666 @item always
11667 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
11668 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
11669
11670 @item never
11671 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
11672
11673 @item interactive
11674 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
11675 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
11676 @end table
11677
11678 @item --key-server=@var{host}
11679 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
11680
11681 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11682 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11683 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11684
11685 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11686 the command-line tools.
11687
11688 @end table
11689
11690 The @code{github} updater uses the
11691 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
11692 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
11693 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
11694 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
11695 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
11696 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
11697 an API token, set the environment variable @env{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
11698 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
11699 otherwise.
11700
11701
11702 @node Invoking guix lint
11703 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
11704
11705 @cindex @command{guix lint}
11706 @cindex package, checking for errors
11707 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
11708 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
11709 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
11710 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
11711 @option{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
11712
11713 @table @code
11714 @item synopsis
11715 @itemx description
11716 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
11717 descriptions and synopses.
11718
11719 @item inputs-should-be-native
11720 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
11721
11722 @item source
11723 @itemx home-page
11724 @itemx mirror-url
11725 @itemx github-url
11726 @itemx source-file-name
11727 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
11728 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
11729 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
11730 URL@. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
11731 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
11732 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
11733
11734 @item source-unstable-tarball
11735 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
11736 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
11737 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
11738
11739 @item derivation
11740 Check that the derivation of the given packages can be successfully
11741 computed for all the supported systems (@pxref{Derivations}).
11742
11743 @item profile-collisions
11744 Check whether installing the given packages in a profile would lead to
11745 collisions. Collisions occur when several packages with the same name
11746 but a different version or a different store file name are propagated.
11747 @xref{package Reference, @code{propagated-inputs}}, for more information
11748 on propagated inputs.
11749
11750 @item archival
11751 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
11752 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
11753 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
11754 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
11755
11756 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
11757 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
11758 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
11759 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
11760 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
11761 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
11762 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
11763
11764 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
11765 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
11766 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
11767 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
11768
11769 Software Heritage
11770 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
11771 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
11772 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
11773 that limit has been reset.
11774
11775 @item cve
11776 @cindex security vulnerabilities
11777 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
11778 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
11779 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
11780 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
11781 NIST}.
11782
11783 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
11784
11785 @itemize
11786 @item
11787 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11788 @item
11789 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11790 @end itemize
11791
11792 @noindent
11793 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
11794 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
11795
11796 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
11797 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
11798 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
11799 that Guix uses, as in this example:
11800
11801 @lisp
11802 (package
11803 (name "grub")
11804 ;; @dots{}
11805 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
11806 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
11807 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
11808 @end lisp
11809
11810 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
11811 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
11812 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
11813 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
11814 declare them as in this example:
11815
11816 @lisp
11817 (package
11818 (name "t1lib")
11819 ;; @dots{}
11820 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
11821 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
11822 "CVE-2011-1553"
11823 "CVE-2011-1554"
11824 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
11825 @end lisp
11826
11827 @item formatting
11828 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
11829 use of tabulations, etc.
11830 @end table
11831
11832 The general syntax is:
11833
11834 @example
11835 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
11836 @end example
11837
11838 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
11839 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
11840
11841 @table @code
11842 @item --list-checkers
11843 @itemx -l
11844 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
11845 and exit.
11846
11847 @item --checkers
11848 @itemx -c
11849 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
11850 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
11851
11852 @item --exclude
11853 @itemx -x
11854 Only disable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
11855 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
11856
11857 @item --no-network
11858 @itemx -n
11859 Only enable the checkers that do not depend on Internet access.
11860
11861 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11862 @itemx -L @var{directory}
11863 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11864 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11865
11866 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11867 the command-line tools.
11868
11869 @end table
11870
11871 @node Invoking guix size
11872 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
11873
11874 @cindex size
11875 @cindex package size
11876 @cindex closure
11877 @cindex @command{guix size}
11878 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
11879 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
11880 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
11881 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
11882 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
11883 @command{guix size} can highlight.
11884
11885 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
11886 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
11887 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
11888 example:
11889
11890 @example
11891 $ guix size coreutils
11892 store item total self
11893 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
11894 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
11895 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
11896 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
11897 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
11898 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
11899 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
11900 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
11901 total: 78.9 MiB
11902 @end example
11903
11904 @cindex closure
11905 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
11906 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
11907 would be returned by:
11908
11909 @example
11910 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
11911 @end example
11912
11913 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
11914 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
11915 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
11916 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
11917 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
11918 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
11919
11920 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
11921 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
11922 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
11923 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
11924 on the system anyway.)
11925
11926 Since the command also accepts store file names, assessing the size of
11927 a build result is straightforward:
11928
11929 @example
11930 guix size $(guix system build config.scm)
11931 @end example
11932
11933 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
11934 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
11935 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
11936 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
11937 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
11938 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
11939 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
11940 Coreutils}).
11941
11942 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
11943 reports information based on the available substitutes
11944 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
11945 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
11946
11947 You can also specify several package names:
11948
11949 @example
11950 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
11951 store item total self
11952 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
11953 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
11954 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
11955 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
11956 @dots{}
11957 total: 102.3 MiB
11958 @end example
11959
11960 @noindent
11961 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
11962 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
11963 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
11964
11965 When looking at the profile returned by @command{guix size}, you may
11966 find yourself wondering why a given package shows up in the profile at
11967 all. To understand it, you can use @command{guix graph --path -t
11968 references} to display the shortest path between the two packages
11969 (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
11970
11971 The available options are:
11972
11973 @table @option
11974
11975 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
11976 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
11977 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
11978
11979 @item --sort=@var{key}
11980 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
11981
11982 @table @code
11983 @item self
11984 the size of each item (the default);
11985 @item closure
11986 the total size of the item's closure.
11987 @end table
11988
11989 @item --map-file=@var{file}
11990 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
11991
11992 For the example above, the map looks like this:
11993
11994 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
11995 produced by @command{guix size}}
11996
11997 This option requires that
11998 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
11999 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
12000 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
12001
12002 @item --system=@var{system}
12003 @itemx -s @var{system}
12004 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
12005
12006 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12007 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12008 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12009 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12010
12011 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12012 the command-line tools.
12013 @end table
12014
12015 @node Invoking guix graph
12016 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
12017
12018 @cindex DAG
12019 @cindex @command{guix graph}
12020 @cindex package dependencies
12021 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
12022 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
12023 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
12024 provides a visual representation of the DAG@. By default,
12025 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
12026 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
12027 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
12028 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
12029 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
12030 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
12031 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language. With
12032 @option{--path}, it simply displays the shortest path between two
12033 packages. The general syntax is:
12034
12035 @example
12036 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
12037 @end example
12038
12039 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
12040 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
12041 dependencies:
12042
12043 @example
12044 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
12045 @end example
12046
12047 The output looks like this:
12048
12049 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12050
12051 Nice little graph, no?
12052
12053 You may find it more pleasant to navigate the graph interactively with
12054 @command{xdot} (from the @code{xdot} package):
12055
12056 @example
12057 guix graph coreutils | xdot -
12058 @end example
12059
12060 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
12061 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
12062 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
12063 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
12064 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
12065
12066 @table @code
12067 @item package
12068 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
12069 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
12070 filters out many details.
12071
12072 @item reverse-package
12073 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
12074
12075 @example
12076 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
12077 @end example
12078
12079 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
12080 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
12081 @code{reverse-bag} below).
12082
12083 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
12084 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
12085 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
12086 @option{--list-dependent}}).
12087
12088 @item bag-emerged
12089 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
12090
12091 For instance, the following command:
12092
12093 @example
12094 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils
12095 @end example
12096
12097 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
12098
12099 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12100
12101 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
12102 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
12103
12104 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
12105 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
12106 here, for conciseness.
12107
12108 @item bag
12109 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
12110 dependencies.
12111
12112 @item bag-with-origins
12113 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
12114
12115 @item reverse-bag
12116 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
12117 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
12118
12119 @example
12120 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
12121 @end example
12122
12123 @noindent
12124 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
12125 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
12126 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
12127 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
12128
12129 @item derivation
12130 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
12131 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
12132 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
12133 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
12134
12135 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
12136 name instead of a package name, as in:
12137
12138 @example
12139 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
12140 @end example
12141
12142 @item module
12143 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12144 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
12145 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
12146
12147 @example
12148 guix graph -t module guile | xdot -
12149 @end example
12150 @end table
12151
12152 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
12153 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
12154
12155 @table @code
12156 @item references
12157 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
12158 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12159
12160 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
12161 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
12162
12163 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
12164 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
12165 (which can be big!):
12166
12167 @example
12168 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12169 @end example
12170
12171 @item referrers
12172 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
12173 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12174
12175 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
12176 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
12177 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
12178 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
12179 to it.
12180
12181 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
12182 collected.
12183
12184 @end table
12185
12186 @cindex shortest path, between packages
12187 Often, the graph of the package you are interested in does not fit on
12188 your screen, and anyway all you want to know is @emph{why} that package
12189 actually depends on some seemingly unrelated package. The
12190 @option{--path} option instructs @command{guix graph} to display the
12191 shortest path between two packages (or derivations, or store items,
12192 etc.):
12193
12194 @example
12195 $ guix graph --path emacs libunistring
12196 emacs@@26.3
12197 mailutils@@3.9
12198 libunistring@@0.9.10
12199 $ guix graph --path -t derivation emacs libunistring
12200 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3.drv
12201 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mailutils-3.9.drv
12202 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10.drv
12203 $ guix graph --path -t references emacs libunistring
12204 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3
12205 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libidn2-2.2.0
12206 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10
12207 @end example
12208
12209 The available options are the following:
12210
12211 @table @option
12212 @item --type=@var{type}
12213 @itemx -t @var{type}
12214 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
12215 the values listed above.
12216
12217 @item --list-types
12218 List the supported graph types.
12219
12220 @item --backend=@var{backend}
12221 @itemx -b @var{backend}
12222 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
12223
12224 @item --list-backends
12225 List the supported graph backends.
12226
12227 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
12228
12229 @item --path
12230 Display the shortest path between two nodes of the type specified by
12231 @option{--type}. The example below shows the shortest path between
12232 @code{libreoffice} and @code{llvm} according to the references of
12233 @code{libreoffice}:
12234
12235 @example
12236 $ guix graph --path -t references libreoffice llvm
12237 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libreoffice-6.4.2.2
12238 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libepoxy-1.5.4
12239 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mesa-19.3.4
12240 /gnu/store/@dots{}-llvm-9.0.1
12241 @end example
12242
12243 @item --expression=@var{expr}
12244 @itemx -e @var{expr}
12245 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
12246
12247 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
12248
12249 @example
12250 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
12251 @end example
12252
12253 @item --system=@var{system}
12254 @itemx -s @var{system}
12255 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
12256
12257 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
12258 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
12259
12260 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12261 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12262 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12263 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12264
12265 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12266 the command-line tools.
12267 @end table
12268
12269 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
12270 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
12271 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
12272 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
12273 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
12274 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
12275
12276 @example
12277 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
12278 @end example
12279
12280 So many possibilities, so much fun!
12281
12282 @node Invoking guix publish
12283 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
12284
12285 @cindex @command{guix publish}
12286 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
12287 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
12288 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12289
12290 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
12291 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
12292 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
12293 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
12294 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
12295
12296 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
12297 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
12298 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
12299 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
12300 @option{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
12301
12302 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
12303 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12304 guix archive}).
12305
12306 When the @option{--advertise} option is passed, the server advertises
12307 its availability on the local network using multicast DNS (mDNS) and DNS
12308 service discovery (DNS-SD), currently @i{via} Guile-Avahi (@pxref{Top,,,
12309 guile-avahi, Using Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}).
12310
12311 The general syntax is:
12312
12313 @example
12314 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
12315 @end example
12316
12317 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
12318 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
12319
12320 @example
12321 guix publish
12322 @end example
12323
12324 Once a publishing server has been authorized, the daemon may download
12325 substitutes from it. @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}.
12326
12327 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
12328 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
12329 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
12330 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
12331 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
12332 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
12333 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
12334
12335 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
12336 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
12337 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
12338 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
12339 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
12340 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
12341
12342 @example
12343 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
12344 @end example
12345
12346 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
12347 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
12348
12349 @cindex build logs, publication
12350 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
12351
12352 @example
12353 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
12354 @end example
12355
12356 @noindent
12357 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
12358 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
12359 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
12360 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
12361 running @command{guix-daemon} with @option{--log-compression=gzip} since
12362 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
12363 Bzip2 compression.
12364
12365 The following options are available:
12366
12367 @table @code
12368 @item --port=@var{port}
12369 @itemx -p @var{port}
12370 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
12371
12372 @item --listen=@var{host}
12373 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
12374 accept connections from any interface.
12375
12376 @item --user=@var{user}
12377 @itemx -u @var{user}
12378 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
12379 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
12380
12381 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12382 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12383 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
12384 one of @code{lzip}, @code{zstd}, and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is
12385 omitted, @code{gzip} is used.
12386
12387 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
12388 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
12389 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
12390
12391 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a
12392 small increase in CPU usage; see
12393 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip
12394 Web page}. However, @code{lzip} achieves low decompression throughput
12395 (on the order of 50@tie{}MiB/s on modern hardware), which can be a
12396 bottleneck for someone who downloads over a fast network connection.
12397
12398 The compression ratio of @code{zstd} is between that of @code{lzip} and
12399 that of @code{gzip}; its main advantage is a
12400 @uref{https://facebook.github.io/zstd/,high decompression speed}.
12401
12402 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
12403 the compressed streams are not
12404 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
12405 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
12406 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
12407 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
12408 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
12409 to its responses.
12410
12411 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
12412 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
12413 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
12414 the one they support.
12415
12416 @item --cache=@var{directory}
12417 @itemx -c @var{directory}
12418 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
12419 and only serve archives that are in cache.
12420
12421 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
12422 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
12423 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
12424 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
12425 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
12426 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
12427 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
12428
12429 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
12430 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) triggers a
12431 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
12432 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
12433 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
12434 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
12435 the best possible bandwidth.
12436
12437 That first @code{.narinfo} request nonetheless returns 200, provided the
12438 requested store item is ``small enough'', below the cache bypass
12439 threshold---see @option{--cache-bypass-threshold} below. That way,
12440 clients do not have to wait until the archive is baked. For larger
12441 store items, the first @code{.narinfo} request returns 404, meaning that
12442 clients have to wait until the archive is baked.
12443
12444 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
12445 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
12446 @option{--workers} below.
12447
12448 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
12449 when they have expired.
12450
12451 @item --workers=@var{N}
12452 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
12453 threads to ``bake'' archives.
12454
12455 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
12456 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
12457 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
12458 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
12459
12460 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
12461 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
12462 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
12463 for as long as @var{ttl}.
12464
12465 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
12466 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
12467 item in the store, may be deleted.
12468
12469 @item --cache-bypass-threshold=@var{size}
12470 When used in conjunction with @option{--cache}, store items smaller than
12471 @var{size} are immediately available, even when they are not yet in
12472 cache. @var{size} is a size in bytes, or it can be suffixed by @code{M}
12473 for megabytes and so on. The default is @code{10M}.
12474
12475 ``Cache bypass'' allows you to reduce the publication delay for clients
12476 at the expense of possibly additional I/O and CPU use on the server
12477 side: depending on the client access patterns, those store items can end
12478 up being baked several times until a copy is available in cache.
12479
12480 Increasing the threshold may be useful for sites that have few users, or
12481 to guarantee that users get substitutes even for store items that are
12482 not popular.
12483
12484 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
12485 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
12486 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
12487
12488 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
12489 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
12490 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
12491
12492 @item --public-key=@var{file}
12493 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
12494 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
12495 the store items being published.
12496
12497 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
12498 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
12499 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
12500 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12501 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
12502 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
12503
12504 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
12505 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
12506 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
12507 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
12508 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
12509 @end table
12510
12511 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
12512 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
12513 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
12514 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
12515
12516 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
12517 instructions:
12518
12519 @itemize
12520 @item
12521 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
12522
12523 @example
12524 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
12525 /etc/systemd/system/
12526 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
12527 @end example
12528
12529 @item
12530 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
12531
12532 @example
12533 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
12534 # start guix-publish
12535 @end example
12536
12537 @item
12538 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
12539 @end itemize
12540
12541 @node Invoking guix challenge
12542 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
12543
12544 @cindex reproducible builds
12545 @cindex verifiable builds
12546 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
12547 @cindex challenge
12548 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
12549 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
12550 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
12551 answer.
12552
12553 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
12554 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
12555 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
12556 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
12557 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
12558 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
12559 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
12560
12561 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
12562 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
12563 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
12564 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
12565 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
12566 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
12567 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
12568 any given store item.
12569
12570 The command output looks like this:
12571
12572 @smallexample
12573 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12574 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
12575 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12576 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
12577 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12578 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12579 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
12580 differing files:
12581 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
12582 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
12583
12584 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
12585 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
12586 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
12587 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
12588 differing file:
12589 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
12590
12591 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
12592 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12593 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12594 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
12595 differing file:
12596 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
12597
12598 @dots{}
12599
12600 6,406 store items were analyzed:
12601 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
12602 - 525 (8.2%) differed
12603 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
12604 @end smallexample
12605
12606 @noindent
12607 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
12608 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
12609 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
12610 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
12611 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
12612
12613 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
12614 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
12615 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
12616 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
12617 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
12618 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
12619 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
12620 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
12621 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
12622 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
12623 more information.
12624
12625 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
12626 to run:
12627
12628 @example
12629 guix challenge git \
12630 --diff=diffoscope \
12631 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12632 @end example
12633
12634 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
12635 information about files that differ.
12636
12637 Alternatively, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
12638 archive}):
12639
12640 @example
12641 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
12642 | lzip -d | guix archive -x /tmp/git
12643 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
12644 @end example
12645
12646 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
12647 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
12648 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
12649 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
12650 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
12651 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
12652 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
12653
12654 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
12655 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
12656 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
12657 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
12658 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
12659 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
12660 the problem.
12661
12662 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
12663 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
12664 same build result as you did with:
12665
12666 @example
12667 $ guix challenge @var{package}
12668 @end example
12669
12670 @noindent
12671 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
12672 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
12673
12674 The general syntax is:
12675
12676 @example
12677 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
12678 @end example
12679
12680 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
12681 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
12682 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
12683 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
12684 errors).
12685
12686 The one option that matters is:
12687
12688 @table @code
12689
12690 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12691 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
12692 URLs to compare to.
12693
12694 @item --diff=@var{mode}
12695 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
12696
12697 @table @asis
12698 @item @code{simple} (the default)
12699 Show the list of files that differ.
12700
12701 @item @code{diffoscope}
12702 @itemx @var{command}
12703 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
12704 two directories whose contents do not match.
12705
12706 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
12707 of Diffoscope.
12708
12709 @item @code{none}
12710 Do not show further details about the differences.
12711 @end table
12712
12713 Thus, unless @option{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
12714 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
12715 can compare them.
12716
12717 @item --verbose
12718 @itemx -v
12719 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
12720 information about mismatches.
12721
12722 @end table
12723
12724 @node Invoking guix copy
12725 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
12726
12727 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
12728 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
12729 @cindex sharing store items across machines
12730 @cindex transferring store items across machines
12731 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
12732 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
12733 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
12734 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
12735 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
12736 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
12737
12738 @example
12739 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
12740 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12741 @end example
12742
12743 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
12744 they are not actually sent.
12745
12746 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
12747 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
12748
12749 @example
12750 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
12751 @end example
12752
12753 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
12754 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
12755 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
12756
12757 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
12758 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
12759 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
12760 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
12761 store item authentication.
12762
12763 The general syntax is:
12764
12765 @example
12766 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
12767 @end example
12768
12769 You must always specify one of the following options:
12770
12771 @table @code
12772 @item --to=@var{spec}
12773 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
12774 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
12775 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
12776 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
12777 @end table
12778
12779 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
12780 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
12781
12782 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
12783 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
12784 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
12785
12786
12787 @node Invoking guix container
12788 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
12789 @cindex container
12790 @cindex @command{guix container}
12791 @quotation Note
12792 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
12793 is subject to radical change in the future.
12794 @end quotation
12795
12796 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
12797 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
12798 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
12799 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
12800 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
12801
12802 The general syntax is:
12803
12804 @example
12805 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
12806 @end example
12807
12808 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
12809 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
12810
12811 The following actions are available:
12812
12813 @table @code
12814 @item exec
12815 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
12816
12817 The syntax is:
12818
12819 @example
12820 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
12821 @end example
12822
12823 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
12824 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
12825 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
12826 will be passed to @var{program}.
12827
12828 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
12829 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
12830 process ID is 9001:
12831
12832 @example
12833 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
12834 @end example
12835
12836 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
12837 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
12838
12839 @end table
12840
12841 @node Invoking guix weather
12842 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
12843
12844 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
12845 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
12846 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
12847 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
12848 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
12849 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12850 publish}).
12851
12852 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
12853 @cindex availability of substitutes
12854 @cindex substitute availability
12855 @cindex weather, substitute availability
12856 Here's a sample run:
12857
12858 @example
12859 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
12860 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
12861 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
12862 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12863 https://guix.example.org
12864 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
12865 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
12866 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
12867 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
12868 33.5 requests per second
12869
12870 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
12871 867 queued builds
12872 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
12873 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
12874 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
12875 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
12876 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
12877 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
12878 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
12879 @end example
12880
12881 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
12882 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
12883 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
12884 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
12885 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
12886 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
12887 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
12888 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
12889 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
12890 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
12891 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
12892
12893 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
12894 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
12895 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
12896 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
12897 those substitutes.
12898
12899 The general syntax is:
12900
12901 @example
12902 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
12903 @end example
12904
12905 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
12906 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
12907 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
12908 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
12909 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
12910 available substitutes is below 100%.
12911
12912 The available options are listed below.
12913
12914 @table @code
12915 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12916 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
12917 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
12918 servers is queried.
12919
12920 @item --system=@var{system}
12921 @itemx -s @var{system}
12922 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
12923 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
12924 substitutes for several system types.
12925
12926 @item --manifest=@var{file}
12927 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
12928 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
12929 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
12930 guix package}).
12931
12932 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
12933 are concatenated.
12934
12935 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
12936 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
12937 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
12938 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
12939 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
12940 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
12941 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
12942
12943 @example
12944 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
12945 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
12946 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
12947 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
12948 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
12949 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
12950 @dots{}
12951 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
12952 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
12953 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
12954 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
12955 @dots{}
12956 @end example
12957
12958 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
12959 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at
12960 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}; likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46
12961 packages that depend on it.
12962
12963 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
12964 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
12965 fail to build.
12966
12967 @item --display-missing
12968 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
12969 @end table
12970
12971 @node Invoking guix processes
12972 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
12973
12974 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
12975 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
12976 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
12977 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
12978 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
12979 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
12980
12981 @example
12982 $ sudo guix processes
12983 SessionPID: 19002
12984 ClientPID: 19090
12985 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
12986
12987 SessionPID: 19402
12988 ClientPID: 19367
12989 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
12990
12991 SessionPID: 19444
12992 ClientPID: 19419
12993 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
12994 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
12995 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
12996 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
12997 ChildPID: 20495
12998 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
12999 ChildPID: 27733
13000 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13001 ChildPID: 27793
13002 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13003 @end example
13004
13005 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
13006 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
13007 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
13008 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
13009 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
13010
13011 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked
13012 by this session, which corresponds to store items being built or
13013 substituted (the @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when
13014 @command{guix processes} is not running as root). Last, by looking at
13015 the @code{ChildPID} and @code{ChildCommand} fields, we understand that
13016 these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
13017
13018 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
13019 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
13020 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
13021 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
13022
13023 @example
13024 $ sudo guix processes | \
13025 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
13026 ClientPID: 19419
13027 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13028 @end example
13029
13030 Additional options are listed below.
13031
13032 @table @code
13033 @item --format=@var{format}
13034 @itemx -f @var{format}
13035 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
13036
13037 @table @code
13038 @item recutils
13039 The default option. It outputs a set of Session recutils records
13040 that include each @code{ChildProcess} as a field.
13041
13042 @item normalized
13043 Normalize the output records into record sets (@pxref{Record Sets,,,
13044 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). Normalizing into record sets allows
13045 joins across record types. The example below lists the PID of each
13046 @code{ChildProcess} and the associated PID for @code{Session} that
13047 spawned the @code{ChildProcess} where the @code{Session} was started
13048 using @command{guix build}.
13049
13050 @example
13051 $ guix processes --format=normalized | \
13052 recsel \
13053 -j Session \
13054 -t ChildProcess \
13055 -p Session.PID,PID \
13056 -e 'Session.ClientCommand ~ "guix build"'
13057 PID: 4435
13058 Session_PID: 4278
13059
13060 PID: 4554
13061 Session_PID: 4278
13062
13063 PID: 4646
13064 Session_PID: 4278
13065 @end example
13066 @end table
13067 @end table
13068
13069 @node System Configuration
13070 @chapter System Configuration
13071
13072 @cindex system configuration
13073 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
13074 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
13075 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
13076 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
13077 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
13078
13079 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
13080 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
13081 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
13082 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
13083 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
13084 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
13085 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
13086 the own tools of the system.
13087 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
13088
13089 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
13090 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
13091 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
13092 instance to support new system services.
13093
13094 @menu
13095 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
13096 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
13097 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
13098 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
13099 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
13100 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
13101 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
13102 * Services:: Specifying system services.
13103 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
13104 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
13105 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
13106 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
13107 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
13108 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
13109 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
13110 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
13111 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
13112 @end menu
13113
13114 @node Using the Configuration System
13115 @section Using the Configuration System
13116
13117 The operating system is configured by providing an
13118 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
13119 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
13120 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
13121 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
13122
13123 @findex operating-system
13124 @lisp
13125 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
13126 @end lisp
13127
13128 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
13129 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
13130 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
13131 which case they get a default value.
13132
13133 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
13134 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
13135 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
13136 @command{guix system}.
13137
13138 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
13139
13140 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
13141 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
13142 @cindex UEFI boot
13143 @cindex EFI boot
13144 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
13145 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
13146 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
13147 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
13148 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
13149
13150 @lisp
13151 (bootloader-configuration
13152 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
13153 (target "/boot/efi"))
13154 @end lisp
13155
13156 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
13157 configuration options.
13158
13159 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
13160
13161 @vindex %base-packages
13162 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
13163 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @env{PATH}
13164 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
13165 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
13166 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
13167 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
13168 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
13169 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
13170 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
13171 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
13172 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
13173 of a package:
13174
13175 @lisp
13176 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13177 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
13178
13179 (operating-system
13180 ;; ...
13181 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
13182 %base-packages)))
13183 @end lisp
13184
13185 @findex specification->package
13186 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
13187 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
13188 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
13189 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
13190 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
13191 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
13192 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
13193 version:
13194
13195 @lisp
13196 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13197
13198 (operating-system
13199 ;; ...
13200 (packages (append (map specification->package
13201 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
13202 %base-packages)))
13203 @end lisp
13204
13205 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
13206
13207 @cindex services
13208 @vindex %base-services
13209 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
13210 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
13211 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
13212 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
13213 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
13214 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
13215 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
13216 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
13217 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
13218
13219 @cindex customization, of services
13220 @findex modify-services
13221 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
13222 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
13223 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
13224
13225 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
13226 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
13227 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
13228 following in your operating system declaration:
13229
13230 @lisp
13231 (define %my-services
13232 ;; My very own list of services.
13233 (modify-services %base-services
13234 (guix-service-type config =>
13235 (guix-configuration
13236 (inherit config)
13237 ;; Fetch substitutes from example.org.
13238 (substitute-urls
13239 (list "https://example.org/guix"
13240 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))))
13241 (mingetty-service-type config =>
13242 (mingetty-configuration
13243 (inherit config)
13244 ;; Automatially log in as "guest".
13245 (auto-login "guest")))))
13246
13247 (operating-system
13248 ;; @dots{}
13249 (services %my-services))
13250 @end lisp
13251
13252 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
13253 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
13254 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
13255 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
13256 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
13257 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
13258 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
13259 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
13260 configuration, but with a few modifications.
13261
13262 @cindex encrypted disk
13263 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
13264 root partition, the X11 display
13265 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
13266 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
13267 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
13268
13269 @lisp
13270 @include os-config-desktop.texi
13271 @end lisp
13272
13273 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
13274 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
13275
13276 @lisp
13277 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
13278 @end lisp
13279
13280 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
13281 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
13282 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
13283
13284 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
13285 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
13286 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
13287
13288 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
13289 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
13290 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
13291 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
13292 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
13293 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
13294
13295 @lisp
13296 (remove (lambda (service)
13297 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
13298 %desktop-services)
13299 @end lisp
13300
13301 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
13302
13303 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
13304 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
13305 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
13306 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
13307 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
13308
13309 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
13310 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
13311 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
13312 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
13313 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
13314 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
13315 system, should you ever need to.
13316
13317 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
13318 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
13319 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
13320 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
13321 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
13322 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
13323 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
13324 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
13325 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
13326 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
13327
13328 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
13329 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
13330 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
13331 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
13332 system}).
13333
13334 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
13335
13336 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
13337 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
13338 Monad}):
13339
13340 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
13341 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
13342 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
13343
13344 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
13345 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
13346 instantiate @var{os}.
13347 @end deffn
13348
13349 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
13350 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
13351 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
13352
13353
13354 @node operating-system Reference
13355 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
13356
13357 This section summarizes all the options available in
13358 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
13359 System}).
13360
13361 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
13362 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
13363 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
13364 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
13365
13366 @table @asis
13367 @item @code{kernel} (default: @code{linux-libre})
13368 The package object of the operating system kernel to
13369 use@footnote{Currently only the Linux-libre kernel is fully supported.
13370 Using GNU@tie{}mach with the GNU@tie{}Hurd is experimental and only
13371 available when building a virtual machine disk image.}.
13372
13373 @cindex hurd
13374 @item @code{hurd} (default: @code{#f})
13375 The package object of the Hurd to be started by the kernel. When this
13376 field is set, produce a GNU/Hurd operating system. In that case,
13377 @code{kernel} must also be set to the @code{gnumach} package---the
13378 microkernel the Hurd runs on.
13379
13380 @quotation Warning
13381 This feature is experimental and only supported for disk images.
13382 @end quotation
13383
13384 @item @code{kernel-loadable-modules} (default: '())
13385 A list of objects (usually packages) to collect loadable kernel modules
13386 from--e.g. @code{(list ddcci-driver-linux)}.
13387
13388 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{%default-kernel-arguments})
13389 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
13390 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
13391
13392 @item @code{bootloader}
13393 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
13394
13395 @item @code{label}
13396 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
13397 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
13398
13399 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13400 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
13401 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
13402 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record. @xref{Keyboard Layout},
13403 for more information.
13404
13405 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
13406 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
13407 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
13408 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13409
13410 @quotation Note
13411 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
13412 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
13413 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
13414 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
13415 Window System.
13416 @end quotation
13417
13418 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
13419 @cindex initrd
13420 @cindex initial RAM disk
13421 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
13422 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13423
13424 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
13425 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
13426 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
13427 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13428
13429 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
13430 @cindex firmware
13431 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
13432
13433 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
13434 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
13435 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
13436 supported hardware.
13437
13438 @item @code{host-name}
13439 The host name.
13440
13441 @item @code{hosts-file}
13442 @cindex hosts file
13443 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
13444 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
13445 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
13446 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
13447
13448 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13449 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
13450
13451 @item @code{file-systems}
13452 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
13453
13454 @cindex swap devices
13455 @cindex swap space
13456 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13457 A list of UUIDs, file system labels, or strings identifying devices or
13458 files to be used for ``swap
13459 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13460 Manual}). Here are some examples:
13461
13462 @table @code
13463 @item (list (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb"))
13464 Use the swap partition with the given UUID@. You can learn the UUID of a
13465 Linux swap partition by running @command{swaplabel @var{device}}, where
13466 @var{device} is the @file{/dev} file name of that partition.
13467
13468 @item (list (file-system-label "swap"))
13469 Use the partition with label @code{swap}. Again, the
13470 @command{swaplabel} command allows you to view and change the label of a
13471 Linux swap partition.
13472
13473 @item (list "/swapfile")
13474 Use the file @file{/swapfile} as swap space.
13475
13476 @item (list "/dev/sda3" "/dev/sdb2")
13477 Use the @file{/dev/sda3} and @file{/dev/sdb2} partitions as swap space.
13478 We recommend referring to swap devices by UUIDs or labels as shown above
13479 instead.
13480 @end table
13481
13482 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
13483 device (under @file{/dev/mapper}), provided that the necessary device
13484 mapping and file system are also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and
13485 @ref{File Systems}.
13486
13487 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
13488 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
13489 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
13490
13491 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
13492 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
13493
13494 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
13495 A list of target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13496 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
13497 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
13498
13499 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
13500
13501 @lisp
13502 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
13503 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
13504 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
13505 (activate-readline)")))
13506 @end lisp
13507
13508 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
13509 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
13510 displayed when users log in on a text console.
13511
13512 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
13513 A list of packages to be installed in the global profile, which is accessible
13514 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Each element is either a package
13515 variable or a package/output tuple. Here's a simple example of both:
13516
13517 @lisp
13518 (cons* git ; the default "out" output
13519 (list git "send-email") ; another output of git
13520 %base-packages) ; the default set
13521 @end lisp
13522
13523 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
13524 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
13525 package}).
13526
13527 @item @code{timezone}
13528 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
13529
13530 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
13531 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
13532 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
13533
13534 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
13535 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
13536 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
13537
13538 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
13539 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
13540 run time. @xref{Locales}.
13541
13542 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
13543 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
13544 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
13545 considerations that justify this option.
13546
13547 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
13548 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
13549 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
13550 details.
13551
13552 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
13553 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
13554
13555 @cindex essential services
13556 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
13557 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
13558 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
13559 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
13560 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
13561
13562 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
13563 @cindex PAM
13564 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
13565 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
13566 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
13567
13568 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @code{%setuid-programs})
13569 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
13570 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
13571
13572 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @code{%sudoers-specification})
13573 @cindex sudoers file
13574 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
13575 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
13576
13577 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
13578 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
13579 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
13580 @code{sudo}.
13581
13582 @end table
13583
13584 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
13585 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
13586 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
13587
13588 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
13589 the definition of the @code{label} field:
13590
13591 @lisp
13592 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13593
13594 (operating-system
13595 ;; ...
13596 (label (package-full-name
13597 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
13598 @end lisp
13599
13600 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
13601 system definition.
13602 @end deffn
13603
13604 @end deftp
13605
13606 @node File Systems
13607 @section File Systems
13608
13609 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
13610 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
13611 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
13612 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
13613
13614 @lisp
13615 (file-system
13616 (mount-point "/home")
13617 (device "/dev/sda3")
13618 (type "ext4"))
13619 @end lisp
13620
13621 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
13622 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
13623
13624 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
13625 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
13626 contain the following members:
13627
13628 @table @asis
13629 @item @code{type}
13630 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
13631 @code{"ext4"}.
13632
13633 @item @code{mount-point}
13634 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
13635
13636 @item @code{device}
13637 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
13638 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
13639 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
13640 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
13641 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
13642 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
13643 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
13644 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
13645 mounted.}.
13646
13647 @findex file-system-label
13648 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
13649 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
13650 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
13651 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
13652
13653 @lisp
13654 (file-system
13655 (mount-point "/home")
13656 (type "ext4")
13657 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13658 @end lisp
13659
13660 @findex uuid
13661 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
13662 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
13663 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
13664 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
13665 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
13666 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
13667 like this:
13668
13669 @lisp
13670 (file-system
13671 (mount-point "/home")
13672 (type "ext4")
13673 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
13674 @end lisp
13675
13676 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
13677 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
13678 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
13679 This is required so that
13680 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
13681 corresponding device mapping established.
13682
13683 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
13684 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
13685 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
13686 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
13687 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
13688 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
13689 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
13690 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
13691 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13692 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
13693
13694 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
13695 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to
13696 the file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
13697 Library Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for
13698 options for various file systems. Note that the
13699 @code{file-system-options->alist} and @code{alist->file-system-options}
13700 procedures from @code{(gnu system file-systems)} can be used to convert
13701 file system options given as an association list to the string
13702 representation, and vice-versa.
13703
13704 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
13705 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
13706 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
13707 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
13708 is not automatically mounted.
13709
13710 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
13711 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
13712 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
13713 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
13714 instance, for the root file system.
13715
13716 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
13717 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
13718 errors before being mounted.
13719
13720 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
13721 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
13722
13723 @item @code{mount-may-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
13724 When true, this indicates that mounting this file system can fail but
13725 that should not be considered an error. This is useful in unusual
13726 cases; an example of this is @code{efivarfs}, a file system that can
13727 only be mounted on EFI/UEFI systems.
13728
13729 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
13730 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
13731 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
13732 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
13733
13734 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
13735 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
13736 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
13737
13738 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
13739 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13740 @end table
13741 @end deftp
13742
13743 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-system-label @var{str}
13744 This procedure returns an opaque file system label from @var{str}, a
13745 string:
13746
13747 @lisp
13748 (file-system-label "home")
13749 @result{} #<file-system-label "home">
13750 @end lisp
13751
13752 File system labels are used to refer to file systems by label rather
13753 than by device name. See above for examples.
13754 @end deffn
13755
13756 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
13757 variables.
13758
13759 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
13760 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
13761 such as @code{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @code{%immutable-store} (see
13762 below). Operating system declarations should always contain at least
13763 these.
13764 @end defvr
13765
13766 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
13767 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
13768 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
13769 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13770 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
13771 @command{xterm}.
13772 @end defvr
13773
13774 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
13775 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
13776 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
13777 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
13778 @end defvr
13779
13780 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
13781 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
13782 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
13783 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
13784 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
13785
13786 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
13787 read-write in its own ``name space.''
13788 @end defvr
13789
13790 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
13791 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
13792 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
13793 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13794 @end defvr
13795
13796 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
13797 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
13798 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
13799 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13800 @end defvr
13801
13802 The @code{(gnu system uuid)} module provides tools to deal with file
13803 system ``unique identifiers'' (UUIDs).
13804
13805 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} uuid @var{str} [@var{type}]
13806 Return an opaque UUID (unique identifier) object of the given @var{type}
13807 (a symbol) by parsing @var{str} (a string):
13808
13809 @lisp
13810 (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")
13811 @result{} #<<uuid> type: dce bv: @dots{}>
13812
13813 (uuid "1234-ABCD" 'fat)
13814 @result{} #<<uuid> type: fat bv: @dots{}>
13815 @end lisp
13816
13817 @var{type} may be one of @code{dce}, @code{iso9660}, @code{fat},
13818 @code{ntfs}, or one of the commonly found synonyms for these.
13819
13820 UUIDs are another way to unambiguously refer to file systems in
13821 operating system configuration. See the examples above.
13822 @end deffn
13823
13824
13825 @node Btrfs file system
13826 @subsection Btrfs file system
13827
13828 The Btrfs has special features, such as subvolumes, that merit being
13829 explained in more details. The following section attempts to cover
13830 basic as well as complex uses of a Btrfs file system with the Guix
13831 System.
13832
13833 In its simplest usage, a Btrfs file system can be described, for
13834 example, by:
13835
13836 @lisp
13837 (file-system
13838 (mount-point "/home")
13839 (type "btrfs")
13840 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13841 @end lisp
13842
13843 The example below is more complex, as it makes use of a Btrfs
13844 subvolume, named @code{rootfs}. The parent Btrfs file system is labeled
13845 @code{my-btrfs-pool}, and is located on an encrypted device (hence the
13846 dependency on @code{mapped-devices}):
13847
13848 @lisp
13849 (file-system
13850 (device (file-system-label "my-btrfs-pool"))
13851 (mount-point "/")
13852 (type "btrfs")
13853 (options "subvol=rootfs")
13854 (dependencies mapped-devices))
13855 @end lisp
13856
13857 Some bootloaders, for example GRUB, only mount a Btrfs partition at its
13858 top level during the early boot, and rely on their configuration to
13859 refer to the correct subvolume path within that top level. The
13860 bootloaders operating in this way typically produce their configuration
13861 on a running system where the Btrfs partitions are already mounted and
13862 where the subvolume information is readily available. As an example,
13863 @command{grub-mkconfig}, the configuration generator command shipped
13864 with GRUB, reads @file{/proc/self/mountinfo} to determine the top-level
13865 path of a subvolume.
13866
13867 The Guix System produces a bootloader configuration using the operating
13868 system configuration as its sole input; it is therefore necessary to
13869 extract the subvolume name on which @file{/gnu/store} lives (if any)
13870 from that operating system configuration. To better illustrate,
13871 consider a subvolume named 'rootfs' which contains the root file system
13872 data. In such situation, the GRUB bootloader would only see the top
13873 level of the root Btrfs partition, e.g.:
13874
13875 @example
13876 / (top level)
13877 ├── rootfs (subvolume directory)
13878 ├── gnu (normal directory)
13879 ├── store (normal directory)
13880 [...]
13881 @end example
13882
13883 Thus, the subvolume name must be prepended to the @file{/gnu/store} path
13884 of the kernel, initrd binaries and any other files referred to in the
13885 GRUB configuration that must be found during the early boot.
13886
13887 The next example shows a nested hierarchy of subvolumes and
13888 directories:
13889
13890 @example
13891 / (top level)
13892 ├── rootfs (subvolume)
13893 ├── gnu (normal directory)
13894 ├── store (subvolume)
13895 [...]
13896 @end example
13897
13898 This scenario would work without mounting the 'store' subvolume.
13899 Mounting 'rootfs' is sufficient, since the subvolume name matches its
13900 intended mount point in the file system hierarchy. Alternatively, the
13901 'store' subvolume could be referred to by setting the @code{subvol}
13902 option to either @code{/rootfs/gnu/store} or @code{rootfs/gnu/store}.
13903
13904 Finally, a more contrived example of nested subvolumes:
13905
13906 @example
13907 / (top level)
13908 ├── root-snapshots (subvolume)
13909 ├── root-current (subvolume)
13910 ├── guix-store (subvolume)
13911 [...]
13912 @end example
13913
13914 Here, the 'guix-store' subvolume doesn't match its intended mount point,
13915 so it is necessary to mount it. The subvolume must be fully specified,
13916 by passing its file name to the @code{subvol} option. To illustrate,
13917 the 'guix-store' subvolume could be mounted on @file{/gnu/store} by using
13918 a file system declaration such as:
13919
13920 @lisp
13921 (file-system
13922 (device (file-system-label "btrfs-pool-1"))
13923 (mount-point "/gnu/store")
13924 (type "btrfs")
13925 (options "subvol=root-snapshots/root-current/guix-store,\
13926 compress-force=zstd,space_cache=v2"))
13927 @end lisp
13928
13929 @node Mapped Devices
13930 @section Mapped Devices
13931
13932 @cindex device mapping
13933 @cindex mapped devices
13934 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
13935 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
13936 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
13937 with additional processing over the data that flows through
13938 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
13939 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
13940 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
13941 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
13942 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
13943 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
13944 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
13945 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
13946 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
13947 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
13948 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
13949 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
13950
13951 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
13952 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
13953
13954 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
13955 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
13956 the system boots up.
13957
13958 @table @code
13959 @item source
13960 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
13961 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
13962 need to be assembled for creating a new one. In case of LVM this is a
13963 string specifying name of the volume group to be mapped.
13964
13965 @item target
13966 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
13967 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
13968 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
13969 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
13970 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
13971 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
13972 LVM logical volumes of type @code{lvm-device-mapping} need to
13973 be specified as @code{"VGNAME-LVNAME"}.
13974
13975 @item targets
13976 This list of strings specifies names of the resulting mapped devices in case
13977 there are several. The format is identical to @var{target}.
13978
13979 @item type
13980 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
13981 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
13982 @end table
13983 @end deftp
13984
13985 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
13986 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
13987 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
13988 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
13989 @end defvr
13990
13991 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
13992 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
13993 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
13994 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
13995 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
13996 @end defvr
13997
13998 @cindex LVM, logical volume manager
13999 @defvr {Scheme Variable} lvm-device-mapping
14000 This defines one or more logical volumes for the Linux
14001 @uref{https://www.sourceware.org/lvm2/, Logical Volume Manager (LVM)}.
14002 The volume group is activated by the @command{vgchange} command from the
14003 @code{lvm2} package.
14004 @end defvr
14005
14006 @cindex disk encryption
14007 @cindex LUKS
14008 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
14009 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
14010 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
14011 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
14012 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
14013 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
14014 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14015
14016 @lisp
14017 (mapped-device
14018 (source "/dev/sda3")
14019 (target "home")
14020 (type luks-device-mapping))
14021 @end lisp
14022
14023 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
14024 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
14025 command like:
14026
14027 @example
14028 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
14029 @end example
14030
14031 and use it as follows:
14032
14033 @lisp
14034 (mapped-device
14035 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
14036 (target "home")
14037 (type luks-device-mapping))
14038 @end lisp
14039
14040 @cindex swap encryption
14041 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
14042 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
14043 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
14044 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
14045 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
14046
14047 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
14048 may be declared as follows:
14049
14050 @lisp
14051 (mapped-device
14052 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
14053 (target "/dev/md0")
14054 (type raid-device-mapping))
14055 @end lisp
14056
14057 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
14058 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14059 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
14060 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
14061 automatically later.
14062
14063 LVM logical volumes ``alpha'' and ``beta'' from volume group ``vg0'' can
14064 be declared as follows:
14065
14066 @lisp
14067 (mapped-device
14068 (source "vg0")
14069 (target (list "vg0-alpha" "vg0-beta"))
14070 (type lvm-device-mapping))
14071 @end lisp
14072
14073 Devices @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-alpha} and @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-beta} can
14074 then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system} declaration
14075 (@pxref{File Systems}).
14076
14077 @node User Accounts
14078 @section User Accounts
14079
14080 @cindex users
14081 @cindex accounts
14082 @cindex user accounts
14083 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
14084 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
14085 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
14086
14087 @lisp
14088 (user-account
14089 (name "alice")
14090 (group "users")
14091 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
14092 "audio" ;sound card
14093 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
14094 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
14095 (comment "Bob's sister"))
14096 @end lisp
14097
14098 Here's a user account that uses a different shell and a custom home
14099 directory (the default would be @file{"/home/bob"}):
14100
14101 @lisp
14102 (user-account
14103 (name "bob")
14104 (group "users")
14105 (comment "Alice's bro")
14106 (shell (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh"))
14107 (home-directory "/home/robert"))
14108 @end lisp
14109
14110 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
14111 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
14112 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
14113 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
14114 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
14115 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
14116 as declared.
14117
14118 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
14119 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
14120 be specified:
14121
14122 @table @asis
14123 @item @code{name}
14124 The name of the user account.
14125
14126 @item @code{group}
14127 @cindex groups
14128 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
14129 this account belongs to.
14130
14131 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
14132 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
14133 account belongs to.
14134
14135 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
14136 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
14137 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
14138 account is created.
14139
14140 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
14141 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
14142
14143 @item @code{home-directory}
14144 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
14145
14146 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
14147 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
14148 if it does not exist yet.
14149
14150 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
14151 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
14152 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}). For example, you would refer to the
14153 Bash executable like this:
14154
14155 @lisp
14156 (file-append bash "/bin/bash")
14157 @end lisp
14158
14159 @noindent
14160 ... and to the Zsh executable like that:
14161
14162 @lisp
14163 (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh")
14164 @end lisp
14165
14166 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14167 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
14168 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
14169 graphical login managers do not list them.
14170
14171 @anchor{user-account-password}
14172 @cindex password, for user accounts
14173 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14174 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
14175 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
14176 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
14177 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
14178 reconfiguration.
14179
14180 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
14181 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
14182 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
14183
14184 @lisp
14185 (user-account
14186 (name "charlie")
14187 (group "users")
14188
14189 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
14190 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
14191 @end lisp
14192
14193 @quotation Note
14194 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
14195 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
14196 care.
14197 @end quotation
14198
14199 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
14200 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
14201 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
14202
14203 @end table
14204 @end deftp
14205
14206 @cindex groups
14207 User group declarations are even simpler:
14208
14209 @lisp
14210 (user-group (name "students"))
14211 @end lisp
14212
14213 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
14214 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
14215
14216 @table @asis
14217 @item @code{name}
14218 The name of the group.
14219
14220 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
14221 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
14222 automatically allocated when the group is created.
14223
14224 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14225 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
14226 System groups have low numerical IDs.
14227
14228 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14229 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
14230 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
14231
14232 @end table
14233 @end deftp
14234
14235 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
14236 expect:
14237
14238 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
14239 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
14240 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
14241 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
14242 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
14243 @end defvr
14244
14245 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
14246 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
14247 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
14248
14249 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
14250 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
14251 @end defvr
14252
14253 @node Keyboard Layout
14254 @section Keyboard Layout
14255
14256 @cindex keyboard layout
14257 @cindex keymap
14258 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
14259 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
14260 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
14261 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
14262 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
14263 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
14264 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
14265
14266 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
14267 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
14268
14269 @itemize
14270 @item
14271 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
14272 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
14273 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
14274 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
14275
14276 @item
14277 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
14278 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14279 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14280
14281 @item
14282 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
14283 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14284 @end itemize
14285
14286 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
14287 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
14288
14289 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
14290 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
14291 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
14292 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
14293 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
14294 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
14295 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
14296 about.
14297
14298 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} keyboard-layout @var{name} [@var{variant}] @
14299 [#:model] [#:options '()]
14300 Return a new keyboard layout with the given @var{name} and @var{variant}.
14301
14302 @var{name} must be a string such as @code{"fr"}; @var{variant} must be a
14303 string such as @code{"bepo"} or @code{"nodeadkeys"}. See the
14304 @code{xkeyboard-config} package for valid options.
14305 @end deffn
14306
14307 Here are a few examples:
14308
14309 @lisp
14310 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
14311 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
14312 (keyboard-layout "de")
14313
14314 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
14315 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
14316
14317 ;; The Catalan layout.
14318 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
14319
14320 ;; Arabic layout with "Alt-Shift" to switch to US layout.
14321 (keyboard-layout "ar,us" #:options '("grp:alt_shift_toggle"))
14322
14323 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
14324 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
14325 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
14326 ;; accented letters.
14327 (keyboard-layout "latam"
14328 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
14329
14330 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
14331 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
14332
14333 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
14334 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
14335 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
14336 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
14337 @end lisp
14338
14339 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
14340 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
14341
14342 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
14343 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
14344 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
14345 configuration would look like:
14346
14347 @findex set-xorg-configuration
14348 @lisp
14349 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
14350 ;; and for Xorg.
14351
14352 (operating-system
14353 ;; ...
14354 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
14355 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
14356 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
14357 (target "/boot/efi")
14358 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
14359 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
14360 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
14361 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
14362 %desktop-services)))
14363 @end lisp
14364
14365 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
14366 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
14367 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
14368 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
14369 GDM.
14370
14371 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
14372 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
14373
14374 @itemize
14375 @item
14376 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
14377 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
14378
14379 @item
14380 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
14381 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
14382 change the layout to US Dvorak:
14383
14384 @example
14385 setxkbmap us dvorak
14386 @end example
14387
14388 @item
14389 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
14390 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
14391 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
14392 French bépo layout:
14393
14394 @example
14395 loadkeys fr-bepo
14396 @end example
14397 @end itemize
14398
14399 @node Locales
14400 @section Locales
14401
14402 @cindex locale
14403 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
14404 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14405 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
14406 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
14407 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
14408 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
14409
14410 @cindex locale definition
14411 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
14412 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
14413 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
14414
14415 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
14416 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
14417 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
14418 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
14419 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
14420 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
14421 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
14422 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
14423
14424 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
14425 that field may be:
14426
14427 @lisp
14428 (cons (locale-definition
14429 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
14430 %default-locale-definitions)
14431 @end lisp
14432
14433 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
14434 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
14435
14436 @lisp
14437 (list (locale-definition
14438 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
14439 (charset "EUC-JP")))
14440 @end lisp
14441
14442 @vindex LOCPATH
14443 The compiled locale definitions are available at
14444 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
14445 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
14446 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
14447 @env{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14448 @env{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14449
14450 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
14451 locale)} module. Details are given below.
14452
14453 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
14454 This is the data type of a locale definition.
14455
14456 @table @asis
14457
14458 @item @code{name}
14459 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14460 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
14461
14462 @item @code{source}
14463 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
14464 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
14465
14466 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
14467 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
14468 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
14469 IANA}.
14470
14471 @end table
14472 @end deftp
14473
14474 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
14475 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
14476 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
14477 declarations.
14478
14479 @cindex locale name
14480 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
14481 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
14482 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
14483 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
14484 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
14485 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
14486 @end defvr
14487
14488 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
14489
14490 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
14491 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
14492 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
14493 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
14494 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
14495 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
14496 another.
14497
14498 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
14499 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
14500 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
14501 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
14502 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
14503 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
14504 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
14505 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
14506 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @env{LC_COLLATE}
14507 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
14508 programs will not abort.
14509
14510 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
14511 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
14512 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
14513 used to build the system-wide locale data.
14514
14515 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
14516 and define @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14517 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14518
14519 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
14520 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
14521 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
14522 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
14523 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
14524 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
14525
14526 @lisp
14527 (use-package-modules base)
14528
14529 (operating-system
14530 ;; @dots{}
14531 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
14532 @end lisp
14533
14534 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
14535 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
14536 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
14537
14538
14539 @node Services
14540 @section Services
14541
14542 @cindex system services
14543 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
14544 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
14545 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
14546 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
14547 configuring network access.
14548
14549 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
14550 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
14551 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
14552 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
14553 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
14554 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
14555
14556 @example
14557 # herd status
14558 @end example
14559
14560 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
14561 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
14562 service and its associated actions:
14563
14564 @example
14565 # herd doc nscd
14566 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
14567
14568 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
14569 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
14570 @end example
14571
14572 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
14573 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
14574 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
14575
14576 @example
14577 # herd stop nscd
14578 Service nscd has been stopped.
14579 # herd restart xorg-server
14580 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
14581 Service xorg-server has been started.
14582 @end example
14583
14584 The following sections document the available services, starting with
14585 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
14586 declaration.
14587
14588 @menu
14589 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
14590 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
14591 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
14592 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
14593 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
14594 * X Window:: Graphical display.
14595 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
14596 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
14597 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
14598 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
14599 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
14600 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
14601 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
14602 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
14603 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
14604 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
14605 * Web Services:: Web servers.
14606 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
14607 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
14608 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
14609 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
14610 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
14611 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
14612 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
14613 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
14614 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
14615 * Game Services:: Game servers.
14616 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
14617 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
14618 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
14619 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
14620 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
14621 @end menu
14622
14623 @node Base Services
14624 @subsection Base Services
14625
14626 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
14627 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
14628 this module are listed below.
14629
14630 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
14631 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
14632 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
14633 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
14634 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
14635 more.
14636
14637 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
14638 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
14639 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
14640 this:
14641
14642 @lisp
14643 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
14644 (service openssh-service-type))
14645 %base-services)
14646 @end lisp
14647 @end defvr
14648
14649 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
14650 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
14651 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
14652
14653 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
14654 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
14655 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
14656
14657 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
14658 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
14659 @lisp
14660 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
14661 @end lisp
14662
14663 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
14664 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
14665 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
14666 change it to:
14667
14668 @lisp
14669 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
14670 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
14671 @end lisp
14672
14673 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
14674 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
14675 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
14676 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
14677 (see below).
14678 @end defvr
14679
14680 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
14681 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
14682
14683 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
14684 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
14685 symlink:
14686
14687 @lisp
14688 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
14689 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
14690 @end lisp
14691 @end deffn
14692
14693 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
14694 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
14695 @end deffn
14696
14697 @defvr {Scheme Variable} console-font-service-type
14698 Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
14699 virtual console on the kernel Linux). The value of this service is a list of
14700 tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the @code{kbd}
14701 package or any valid argument to @command{setfont}, as in this example:
14702
14703 @lisp
14704 `(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
14705 ("tty2" . ,(file-append
14706 font-tamzen
14707 "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
14708 ("tty3" . ,(file-append
14709 font-terminus
14710 "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
14711 @end lisp
14712 @end defvr
14713
14714 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
14715 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
14716 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
14717 among other things.
14718 @end deffn
14719
14720 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
14721 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
14722
14723 @table @asis
14724
14725 @item @code{motd}
14726 @cindex message of the day
14727 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
14728
14729 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14730 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
14731 the 'root' account has just been created.
14732
14733 @end table
14734 @end deftp
14735
14736 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
14737 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
14738 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
14739 other things.
14740 @end deffn
14741
14742 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
14743 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
14744 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
14745
14746 @table @asis
14747
14748 @item @code{tty}
14749 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
14750
14751 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14752 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
14753 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
14754 user name and password must be entered to log in.
14755
14756 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
14757 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
14758 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
14759 the name of the log-in program.
14760
14761 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
14762 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
14763 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
14764
14765 @item @code{clear-on-logout?} (default: @code{#t})
14766 When set to @code{#t}, the screen will be cleared after logout.
14767
14768 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
14769 The Mingetty package to use.
14770
14771 @end table
14772 @end deftp
14773
14774 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
14775 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
14776 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
14777 among other things.
14778 @end deffn
14779
14780 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
14781 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
14782 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
14783 man page for more information.
14784
14785 @table @asis
14786
14787 @item @code{tty}
14788 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
14789 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
14790 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
14791
14792 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
14793 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
14794 from it and use that.
14795
14796 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
14797 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
14798 serial port from it and use that.
14799
14800 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
14801 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
14802 correct values.
14803
14804 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
14805 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
14806 descending order.
14807
14808 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
14809 A string containing the value used for the @env{TERM} environment
14810 variable.
14811
14812 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
14813 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
14814 disabled.
14815
14816 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14817 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
14818 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
14819
14820 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
14821 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
14822
14823 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
14824 This accepts a string containing the ``login_host'', which will be written
14825 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
14826
14827 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
14828 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
14829 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
14830 specified in @var{login-program}.
14831
14832 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
14833 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
14834
14835 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
14836 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
14837 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
14838
14839 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
14840 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
14841 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
14842
14843 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
14844 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
14845 the login prompt.
14846
14847 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
14848 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
14849 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
14850 Shadow tool suite.
14851
14852 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
14853 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
14854 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
14855 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
14856
14857 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
14858 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
14859 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
14860
14861 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14862 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
14863 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
14864 systems.
14865
14866 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
14867 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
14868 @file{/etc/issue} file.
14869
14870 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
14871 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
14872 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
14873 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
14874 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
14875 options that could be parsed by the login program.
14876
14877 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
14878 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
14879 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
14880 lazily spawning shells.
14881
14882 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
14883 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
14884 path as a string.
14885
14886 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
14887 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
14888 specified terminal.
14889
14890 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
14891 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
14892 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
14893 character.
14894
14895 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
14896 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
14897 within @var{timeout} seconds.
14898
14899 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
14900 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
14901 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
14902 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
14903 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
14904 Unicode characters.
14905
14906 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
14907 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
14908 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
14909 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
14910 @var{init-string} option.
14911
14912 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
14913 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
14914 locks.
14915
14916 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
14917 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
14918 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
14919
14920 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
14921 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
14922 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
14923 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
14924
14925 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
14926 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
14927 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
14928
14929 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
14930 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean ``ignore
14931 all previous characters'' (also called a ``kill'' character) when the user
14932 types their login name.
14933
14934 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
14935 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
14936 to before login.
14937
14938 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
14939 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
14940 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
14941
14942 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
14943 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
14944 @command{login} program.
14945
14946 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
14947 This option provides an ``escape hatch'' for the user to provide arbitrary
14948 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
14949
14950 @end table
14951 @end deftp
14952
14953 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
14954 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
14955 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
14956 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
14957 @end deffn
14958
14959 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
14960 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
14961 implements virtual console log-in.
14962
14963 @table @asis
14964
14965 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
14966 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
14967
14968 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
14969 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
14970 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
14971
14972 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
14973 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
14974
14975 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14976 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
14977 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
14978
14979 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
14980 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
14981
14982 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
14983 The Kmscon package to use.
14984
14985 @end table
14986 @end deftp
14987
14988 @cindex name service cache daemon
14989 @cindex nscd
14990 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
14991 [#:name-services '()]
14992 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
14993 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
14994 Service Switch}, for an example.
14995
14996 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
14997
14998 @table @code
14999 @item invalidate
15000 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
15001 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
15002 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
15003
15004 @example
15005 herd invalidate nscd hosts
15006 @end example
15007
15008 @noindent
15009 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
15010
15011 @item statistics
15012 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
15013 and caches.
15014 @end table
15015
15016 @end deffn
15017
15018 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
15019 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
15020 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
15021 @code{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
15022 @end defvr
15023
15024 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
15025 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
15026 configuration.
15027
15028 @table @asis
15029
15030 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
15031 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
15032 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
15033
15034 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
15035 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
15036 command.
15037
15038 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
15039 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
15040 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
15041
15042 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
15043 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
15044 debugging output is logged.
15045
15046 @item @code{caches} (default: @code{%nscd-default-caches})
15047 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
15048 below.
15049
15050 @end table
15051 @end deftp
15052
15053 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
15054 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
15055
15056 @table @asis
15057
15058 @item @code{database}
15059 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
15060 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
15061 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
15062 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
15063
15064 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
15065 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
15066 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
15067 negative lookup result remains in cache.
15068
15069 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
15070 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
15071 @var{database}.
15072
15073 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
15074 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
15075 them into account.
15076
15077 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
15078 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
15079
15080 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
15081 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
15082
15083 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
15084 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
15085
15086 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
15087 @c settings, so leave them out.
15088
15089 @end table
15090 @end deftp
15091
15092 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
15093 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
15094 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
15095
15096 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
15097 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
15098 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
15099 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
15100 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
15101 @end defvr
15102
15103 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
15104 @cindex syslog
15105 @cindex logging
15106 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
15107 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
15108
15109 @table @asis
15110 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
15111 The syslog daemon to use.
15112
15113 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
15114 The syslog configuration file to use.
15115
15116 @end table
15117 @end deftp
15118
15119 @anchor{syslog-service}
15120 @cindex syslog
15121 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
15122 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
15123
15124 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
15125 information on the configuration file syntax.
15126 @end deffn
15127
15128 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
15129 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
15130 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
15131 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
15132 @end defvr
15133
15134 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
15135 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
15136 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
15137 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
15138
15139 @table @asis
15140 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
15141 The Guix package to use.
15142
15143 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
15144 Name of the group for build user accounts.
15145
15146 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
15147 Number of build user accounts to create.
15148
15149 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
15150 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
15151 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
15152 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
15153 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15154
15155 When @code{authorize-key?} is true, @file{/etc/guix/acl} cannot be
15156 changed by invoking @command{guix archive --authorize}. You must
15157 instead adjust @code{guix-configuration} as you wish and reconfigure the
15158 system. This ensures that your operating system configuration file is
15159 self-contained.
15160
15161 @quotation Note
15162 When booting or reconfiguring to a system where @code{authorize-key?}
15163 is true, the existing @file{/etc/guix/acl} file is backed up as
15164 @file{/etc/guix/acl.bak} if it was determined to be a manually modified
15165 file. This is to facilitate migration from earlier versions, which
15166 allowed for in-place modifications to @file{/etc/guix/acl}.
15167 @end quotation
15168
15169 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
15170 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
15171 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
15172 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
15173 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15174 See @code{substitute-urls} below for an example on how to change it.
15175
15176 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
15177 Whether to use substitutes.
15178
15179 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
15180 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
15181
15182 Suppose you would like to fetch substitutes from @code{guix.example.org}
15183 in addition to @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. You will need to do
15184 two things: (1) add @code{guix.example.org} to @code{substitute-urls},
15185 and (2) authorize its signing key, having done appropriate checks
15186 (@pxref{Substitute Server Authorization}). The configuration below does
15187 exactly that:
15188
15189 @lisp
15190 (guix-configuration
15191 (substitute-urls
15192 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
15193 %default-substitute-urls))
15194 (authorized-keys
15195 (append (list (local-file "./guix.example.org-key.pub"))
15196 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))
15197 @end lisp
15198
15199 This example assumes that the file @file{./guix.example.org-key.pub}
15200 contains the public key that @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign
15201 substitutes.
15202
15203 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
15204 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
15205 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
15206 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
15207 disables the timeout.
15208
15209 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
15210 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
15211 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
15212
15213 @item @code{discover?} (default: @code{#f})
15214 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
15215 and DNS-SD.
15216
15217 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15218 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
15219
15220 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
15221 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
15222 are written.
15223
15224 @cindex HTTP proxy, for @code{guix-daemon}
15225 @cindex proxy, for @code{guix-daemon} HTTP access
15226 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
15227 The URL of the HTTP and HTTPS proxy used for downloading fixed-output
15228 derivations and substitutes.
15229
15230 It is also possible to change the daemon's proxy at run time through the
15231 @code{set-http-proxy} action, which restarts it:
15232
15233 @example
15234 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon http://localhost:8118
15235 @end example
15236
15237 To clear the proxy settings, run:
15238
15239 @example
15240 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon
15241 @end example
15242
15243 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
15244 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
15245
15246 @end table
15247 @end deftp
15248
15249 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
15250 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
15251 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
15252 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule}, @code{udev-rules-service}
15253 and @code{file->udev-rule} from @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the
15254 creation of such rule files.
15255
15256 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
15257 directory containing all the active udev rules.
15258 @end deffn
15259
15260 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
15261 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
15262 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
15263
15264 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
15265 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
15266 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
15267
15268 @lisp
15269 (define %example-udev-rule
15270 (udev-rule
15271 "90-usb-thing.rules"
15272 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
15273 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
15274 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
15275 @end lisp
15276 @end deffn
15277
15278 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rules-service [@var{name} @var{rules}] @
15279 [#:groups @var{groups}]
15280 Return a service that extends @code{udev-service-type } with @var{rules}
15281 and @code{account-service-type} with @var{groups} as system groups.
15282 This works by creating a singleton service type
15283 @code{@var{name}-udev-rules}, of which the returned service is an
15284 instance.
15285
15286 Here we show how it can be used to extend @code{udev-service-type} with the
15287 previously defined rule @code{%example-udev-rule}.
15288
15289 @lisp
15290 (operating-system
15291 ;; @dots{}
15292 (services
15293 (cons (udev-rules-service 'usb-thing %example-udev-rule)
15294 %desktop-services)))
15295 @end lisp
15296 @end deffn
15297
15298 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
15299 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
15300 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
15301
15302 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
15303
15304 @lisp
15305 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
15306 (guix packages) ;for origin
15307 @dots{})
15308
15309 (define %android-udev-rules
15310 (file->udev-rule
15311 "51-android-udev.rules"
15312 (let ((version "20170910"))
15313 (origin
15314 (method url-fetch)
15315 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
15316 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
15317 (sha256
15318 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
15319 @end lisp
15320 @end deffn
15321
15322 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
15323 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
15324 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
15325 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
15326 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
15327 packages android)} module.
15328
15329 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
15330 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
15331 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
15332 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
15333 the rules defined within the @code{android-udev-rules} package. To
15334 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
15335 @code{supplementary-groups} of our @code{user-account} declaration, as
15336 well as in the @var{groups} of the @code{udev-rules-service} procedure.
15337
15338 @lisp
15339 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
15340 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
15341 @dots{})
15342
15343 (operating-system
15344 ;; @dots{}
15345 (users (cons (user-account
15346 ;; @dots{}
15347 (supplementary-groups
15348 '("adbusers" ;for adb
15349 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
15350 ;; @dots{}
15351 (services
15352 (cons (udev-rules-service 'android android-udev-rules
15353 #:groups '("adbusers"))
15354 %desktop-services)))
15355 @end lisp
15356
15357 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
15358 Save some entropy in @code{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
15359 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
15360 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
15361 readable.
15362 @end defvr
15363
15364 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
15365 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
15366 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
15367 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
15368 @end defvr
15369
15370 @cindex mouse
15371 @cindex gpm
15372 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
15373 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
15374 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
15375 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
15376 and paste text.
15377
15378 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
15379 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
15380 @end defvr
15381
15382 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
15383 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
15384
15385 @table @asis
15386 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
15387 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
15388 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
15389 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
15390 more information.
15391
15392 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
15393 The GPM package to use.
15394
15395 @end table
15396 @end deftp
15397
15398 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
15399 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
15400 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
15401 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
15402 object, as described below.
15403
15404 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
15405 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
15406 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
15407 @end deffn
15408
15409 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
15410 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
15411 service.
15412
15413 @table @asis
15414 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
15415 The Guix package to use.
15416
15417 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
15418 The TCP port to listen for connections.
15419
15420 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
15421 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
15422 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
15423
15424 @item @code{advertise?} (default: @code{#f})
15425 When true, advertise the service on the local network @i{via} the DNS-SD
15426 protocol, using Avahi.
15427
15428 This allows neighboring Guix devices with discovery on (see
15429 @code{guix-configuration} above) to discover this @command{guix publish}
15430 instance and to automatically download substitutes from it.
15431
15432 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
15433 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
15434 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
15435 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
15436
15437 @lisp
15438 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
15439 @end lisp
15440
15441 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
15442 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression. @xref{Invoking guix
15443 publish}, for more information on the available compression methods and
15444 the tradeoffs involved.
15445
15446 An empty list disables compression altogether.
15447
15448 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
15449 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
15450 publish, @option{--nar-path}}, for details.
15451
15452 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
15453 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
15454 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
15455 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
15456 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15457 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
15458
15459 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
15460 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
15461 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
15462 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
15463
15464 @item @code{cache-bypass-threshold} (default: 10 MiB)
15465 When @code{cache} is true, this is the maximum size in bytes of a store
15466 item for which @command{guix publish} may bypass its cache in case of a
15467 cache miss. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15468 @option{--cache-bypass-threshold}}, for more information.
15469
15470 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
15471 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
15472 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
15473 for more information.
15474 @end table
15475 @end deftp
15476
15477 @anchor{rngd-service}
15478 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
15479 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
15480 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
15481 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
15482 @var{device} does not exist.
15483 @end deffn
15484
15485 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
15486 @cindex session limits
15487 @cindex ulimit
15488 @cindex priority
15489 @cindex realtime
15490 @cindex jackd
15491 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
15492
15493 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
15494 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
15495 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
15496 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
15497 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
15498
15499 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
15500 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
15501
15502 @lisp
15503 (pam-limits-service
15504 (list
15505 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
15506 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
15507 @end lisp
15508
15509 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
15510 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
15511 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
15512 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
15513 @end deffn
15514
15515 @node Scheduled Job Execution
15516 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
15517
15518 @cindex cron
15519 @cindex mcron
15520 @cindex scheduling jobs
15521 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
15522 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
15523 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
15524 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
15525 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
15526 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
15527
15528 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
15529 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
15530 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
15531 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
15532 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
15533 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
15534 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
15535
15536 @lisp
15537 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
15538 (use-package-modules base idutils)
15539
15540 (define updatedb-job
15541 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
15542 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
15543 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
15544 (lambda ()
15545 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
15546 "updatedb"
15547 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
15548
15549 (define garbage-collector-job
15550 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
15551 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
15552 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
15553 "guix gc -F 1G"))
15554
15555 (define idutils-job
15556 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
15557 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
15558 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
15559 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
15560 #:user "charlie"))
15561
15562 (operating-system
15563 ;; @dots{}
15564
15565 ;; %BASE-SERVICES already includes an instance of
15566 ;; 'mcron-service-type', which we extend with additional
15567 ;; jobs using 'simple-service'.
15568 (services (cons (simple-service 'my-cron-jobs
15569 mcron-service-type
15570 (list garbage-collector-job
15571 updatedb-job
15572 idutils-job))
15573 %base-services)))
15574 @end lisp
15575
15576 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
15577 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
15578 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
15579 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
15580 illustrates that.
15581
15582 @lisp
15583 (define %battery-alert-job
15584 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
15585 #~(job
15586 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
15587 #$(program-file
15588 "battery-alert.scm"
15589 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
15590 '((guix build utils)))
15591 #~(begin
15592 (use-modules (guix build utils)
15593 (ice-9 popen)
15594 (ice-9 regex)
15595 (ice-9 textual-ports)
15596 (srfi srfi-2))
15597
15598 (define %min-level 20)
15599
15600 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
15601 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
15602 OPEN_READ
15603 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
15604 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
15605 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
15606 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
15607 ((< level %min-level)))
15608 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
15609 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
15610 @end lisp
15611
15612 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
15613 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
15614 reference of the mcron service.
15615
15616 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
15617 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
15618
15619 @example
15620 # herd schedule mcron
15621 @end example
15622
15623 @noindent
15624 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
15625 also specify the number of tasks to display:
15626
15627 @example
15628 # herd schedule mcron 10
15629 @end example
15630
15631 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
15632 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
15633 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
15634
15635 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
15636 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
15637 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
15638 mcron jobs to run.
15639 @end defvr
15640
15641 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
15642 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
15643
15644 @table @asis
15645 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
15646 The mcron package to use.
15647
15648 @item @code{jobs}
15649 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
15650 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
15651 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
15652 @end table
15653 @end deftp
15654
15655
15656 @node Log Rotation
15657 @subsection Log Rotation
15658
15659 @cindex rottlog
15660 @cindex log rotation
15661 @cindex logging
15662 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
15663 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
15664 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
15665 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
15666 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15667
15668 This service is part of @code{%base-services}, and thus enabled by
15669 default, with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
15670 The example below shows how to extend it with an additional
15671 @dfn{rotation}, should you need to do that (usually, services that
15672 produce log files already take care of that):
15673
15674 @lisp
15675 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
15676 (use-service-modules admin)
15677
15678 (define my-log-files
15679 ;; Log files that I want to rotate.
15680 '("/var/log/something.log" "/var/log/another.log"))
15681
15682 (operating-system
15683 ;; @dots{}
15684 (services (cons (simple-service 'rotate-my-stuff
15685 rottlog-service-type
15686 (list (log-rotation
15687 (frequency 'daily)
15688 (files my-log-files))))
15689 %base-services)))
15690 @end lisp
15691
15692 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
15693 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
15694 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
15695
15696 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
15697 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
15698
15699 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
15700 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
15701 @end defvr
15702
15703 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
15704 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
15705
15706 @table @asis
15707 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
15708 The Rottlog package to use.
15709
15710 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
15711 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
15712 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15713
15714 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
15715 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
15716
15717 @item @code{jobs}
15718 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
15719 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
15720 @end table
15721 @end deftp
15722
15723 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
15724 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
15725
15726 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
15727 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
15728 defined like this:
15729
15730 @lisp
15731 (log-rotation
15732 (frequency 'daily)
15733 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
15734 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
15735 "rotate 6"
15736 "notifempty"
15737 "nocompress")))
15738 @end lisp
15739
15740 The list of fields is as follows:
15741
15742 @table @asis
15743 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
15744 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
15745
15746 @item @code{files}
15747 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
15748
15749 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
15750 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
15751 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
15752
15753 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
15754 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
15755 @end table
15756 @end deftp
15757
15758 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
15759 Specifies weekly rotation of @code{%rotated-files} and of
15760 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
15761 @end defvr
15762
15763 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
15764 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
15765 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
15766 "/var/log/maillog")}.
15767 @end defvr
15768
15769 @node Networking Services
15770 @subsection Networking Services
15771
15772 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
15773 the network interface.
15774
15775 @cindex DHCP, networking service
15776 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
15777 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
15778 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
15779 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
15780 @end defvr
15781
15782 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
15783 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
15784 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
15785 For example:
15786
15787 @lisp
15788 (service dhcpd-service-type
15789 (dhcpd-configuration
15790 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
15791 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
15792 @end lisp
15793 @end deffn
15794
15795 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
15796 @table @asis
15797 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
15798 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
15799 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
15800 directory. The default package is the
15801 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
15802 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
15803 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
15804 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
15805 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
15806 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
15807 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
15808 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
15809 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
15810 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
15811 details.
15812 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
15813 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
15814 will be created if it does not exist.
15815 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
15816 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
15817 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15818 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
15819 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
15820 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
15821 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
15822 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
15823 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15824 @end table
15825 @end deftp
15826
15827 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
15828 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
15829 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
15830 @end defvr
15831
15832 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
15833 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
15834 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
15835 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
15836 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
15837 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
15838 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
15839 interface.
15840
15841 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
15842 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
15843 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
15844 to handle.
15845
15846 For example:
15847
15848 @lisp
15849 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
15850 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
15851 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
15852 @end lisp
15853 @end deffn
15854
15855 @cindex wicd
15856 @cindex wireless
15857 @cindex WiFi
15858 @cindex network management
15859 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
15860 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
15861 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
15862
15863 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
15864 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
15865 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
15866 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
15867 @end deffn
15868
15869 @cindex ModemManager
15870
15871 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
15872 This is the service type for the
15873 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
15874 service. The value for this service type is a
15875 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
15876
15877 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
15878 Services}).
15879 @end defvr
15880
15881 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
15882 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
15883
15884 @table @asis
15885 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
15886 The ModemManager package to use.
15887
15888 @end table
15889 @end deftp
15890
15891 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
15892 @cindex Modeswitching
15893
15894 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
15895 This is the service type for the
15896 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch}
15897 service. The value for this service type is
15898 a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
15899
15900 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
15901 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
15902 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
15903 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
15904 plugged in.
15905
15906 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
15907 Services}).
15908 @end defvr
15909
15910 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
15911 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
15912
15913 @table @asis
15914 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
15915 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
15916
15917 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
15918 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
15919 USB_ModeSwitch.
15920
15921 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
15922 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
15923 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
15924 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
15925 file is used.
15926
15927 @end table
15928 @end deftp
15929
15930 @cindex NetworkManager
15931
15932 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
15933 This is the service type for the
15934 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
15935 service. The value for this service type is a
15936 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
15937
15938 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
15939 Services}).
15940 @end defvr
15941
15942 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
15943 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
15944
15945 @table @asis
15946 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
15947 The NetworkManager package to use.
15948
15949 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
15950 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
15951 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
15952
15953 @table @samp
15954 @item default
15955 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
15956 provided by currently active connections.
15957
15958 @item dnsmasq
15959 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
15960 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
15961 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
15962
15963 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
15964 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
15965 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
15966 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
15967 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
15968
15969 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
15970 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
15971 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
15972 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
15973 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
15974 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
15975
15976 @example
15977 nmcli connection add type tun \
15978 connection.interface-name tap0 \
15979 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
15980 ipv4.method shared \
15981 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
15982 @end example
15983
15984 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
15985 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
15986 @command{qemu-system-...}.
15987
15988 @item none
15989 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
15990 @end table
15991
15992 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
15993 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
15994 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
15995 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
15996
15997 @end table
15998 @end deftp
15999
16000 @cindex Connman
16001 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
16002 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
16003 a network connection manager.
16004
16005 Its value must be an
16006 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
16007
16008 @lisp
16009 (service connman-service-type
16010 (connman-configuration
16011 (disable-vpn? #t)))
16012 @end lisp
16013
16014 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
16015 @end deffn
16016
16017 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
16018 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
16019
16020 @table @asis
16021 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
16022 The connman package to use.
16023
16024 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
16025 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
16026 @end table
16027 @end deftp
16028
16029 @cindex WPA Supplicant
16030 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
16031 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
16032 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
16033 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
16034 @end defvr
16035
16036 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
16037 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
16038
16039 It takes the following parameters:
16040
16041 @table @asis
16042 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
16043 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
16044
16045 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'(user-processes loopback syslogd)}
16046 List of services that should be started before WPA Supplicant starts.
16047
16048 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
16049 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
16050
16051 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
16052 Where to store the PID file.
16053
16054 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
16055 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
16056 WPA supplicant will control.
16057
16058 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16059 Optional configuration file to use.
16060
16061 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
16062 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
16063 @end table
16064 @end deftp
16065
16066 @cindex hostapd service, for Wi-Fi access points
16067 @cindex Wi-Fi access points, hostapd service
16068 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hostapd-service-type
16069 This is the service type to run the @uref{https://w1.fi/hostapd/,
16070 hostapd} daemon to set up WiFi (IEEE 802.11) access points and
16071 authentication servers. Its associated value must be a
16072 @code{hostapd-configuration} as shown below:
16073
16074 @lisp
16075 ;; Use wlan1 to run the access point for "My Network".
16076 (service hostapd-service-type
16077 (hostapd-configuration
16078 (interface "wlan1")
16079 (ssid "My Network")
16080 (channel 12)))
16081 @end lisp
16082 @end defvr
16083
16084 @deftp {Data Type} hostapd-configuration
16085 This data type represents the configuration of the hostapd service, with
16086 the following fields:
16087
16088 @table @asis
16089 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hostapd})
16090 The hostapd package to use.
16091
16092 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wlan0"})
16093 The network interface to run the WiFi access point.
16094
16095 @item @code{ssid}
16096 The SSID (@dfn{service set identifier}), a string that identifies this
16097 network.
16098
16099 @item @code{broadcast-ssid?} (default: @code{#t})
16100 Whether to broadcast this SSID.
16101
16102 @item @code{channel} (default: @code{1})
16103 The WiFi channel to use.
16104
16105 @item @code{driver} (default: @code{"nl80211"})
16106 The driver interface type. @code{"nl80211"} is used with all Linux
16107 mac80211 drivers. Use @code{"none"} if building hostapd as a standalone
16108 RADIUS server that does # not control any wireless/wired driver.
16109
16110 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
16111 Extra settings to append as-is to the hostapd configuration file. See
16112 @uref{https://w1.fi/cgit/hostap/plain/hostapd/hostapd.conf} for the
16113 configuration file reference.
16114 @end table
16115 @end deftp
16116
16117 @defvr {Scheme Variable} simulated-wifi-service-type
16118 This is the type of a service to simulate WiFi networking, which can be
16119 useful in virtual machines for testing purposes. The service loads the
16120 Linux kernel
16121 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/mac80211_hwsim/mac80211_hwsim.html,
16122 @code{mac80211_hwsim} module} and starts hostapd to create a pseudo WiFi
16123 network that can be seen on @code{wlan0}, by default.
16124
16125 The service's value is a @code{hostapd-configuration} record.
16126 @end defvr
16127
16128 @cindex iptables
16129 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
16130 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
16131 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
16132 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
16133 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
16134 22 is shown below.
16135
16136 @lisp
16137 (service iptables-service-type
16138 (iptables-configuration
16139 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
16140 :INPUT ACCEPT
16141 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16142 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16143 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16144 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
16145 COMMIT
16146 "))
16147 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
16148 :INPUT ACCEPT
16149 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16150 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16151 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16152 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
16153 COMMIT
16154 "))))
16155 @end lisp
16156 @end defvr
16157
16158 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
16159 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
16160
16161 @table @asis
16162 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
16163 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
16164 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16165 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16166 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
16167 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16168 objects}).
16169 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16170 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16171 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16172 objects}).
16173 @end table
16174 @end deftp
16175
16176 @cindex nftables
16177 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
16178 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
16179 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
16180 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
16181 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
16182 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
16183 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
16184 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
16185
16186 @lisp
16187 (service nftables-service-type)
16188 @end lisp
16189 @end defvr
16190
16191 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
16192 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
16193
16194 @table @asis
16195 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
16196 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
16197 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
16198 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
16199 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
16200 @end table
16201 @end deftp
16202
16203 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
16204 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
16205 @cindex real time clock
16206 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
16207 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
16208 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
16209 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
16210
16211 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
16212 below.
16213 @end defvr
16214
16215 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
16216 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
16217
16218 @table @asis
16219 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
16220 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
16221 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
16222 definition below.
16223
16224 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
16225 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
16226 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
16227
16228 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
16229 The NTP package to use.
16230 @end table
16231 @end deftp
16232
16233 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
16234 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
16235 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
16236 @end defvr
16237
16238 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
16239 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
16240
16241 @table @asis
16242 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
16243 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
16244 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
16245
16246 @item @code{address}
16247 The address of the server, as a string.
16248
16249 @item @code{options}
16250 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
16251 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
16252 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
16253 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
16254
16255 @example
16256 (ntp-server
16257 (type 'server)
16258 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
16259 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
16260 @end example
16261 @end table
16262 @end deftp
16263
16264 @cindex OpenNTPD
16265 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
16266 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
16267 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
16268 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
16269
16270 @lisp
16271 (service
16272 openntpd-service-type
16273 (openntpd-configuration
16274 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
16275 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
16276 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
16277 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))))
16278
16279 @end lisp
16280 @end deffn
16281
16282 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
16283 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
16284 @code{%ntp-servers}.
16285 @end defvr
16286
16287 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
16288 @table @asis
16289 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
16290 The openntpd executable to use.
16291 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
16292 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
16293 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
16294 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
16295 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
16296 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
16297 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
16298 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
16299 information.
16300 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
16301 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
16302 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%openntp-servers})
16303 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
16304 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
16305 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
16306 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
16307 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
16308 man-in-the-middle attacks.
16309 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
16310 a constraint.
16311 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
16312 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
16313 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
16314 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
16315 @end table
16316 @end deftp
16317
16318 @cindex inetd
16319 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
16320 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
16321 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
16322 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
16323 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
16324
16325 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
16326 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
16327 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
16328 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
16329 gateway @code{hostname}:
16330
16331 @lisp
16332 (service
16333 inetd-service-type
16334 (inetd-configuration
16335 (entries (list
16336 (inetd-entry
16337 (name "echo")
16338 (socket-type 'stream)
16339 (protocol "tcp")
16340 (wait? #f)
16341 (user "root"))
16342 (inetd-entry
16343 (node "127.0.0.1")
16344 (name "smtp")
16345 (socket-type 'stream)
16346 (protocol "tcp")
16347 (wait? #f)
16348 (user "root")
16349 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
16350 (arguments
16351 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
16352 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
16353 @end lisp
16354
16355 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
16356 @end deffn
16357
16358 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
16359 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
16360
16361 @table @asis
16362 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
16363 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
16364
16365 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
16366 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
16367 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
16368 @end table
16369 @end deftp
16370
16371 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
16372 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
16373 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
16374 requests.
16375
16376 @table @asis
16377 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
16378 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
16379 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
16380 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
16381 description of all options.
16382 @item @code{name}
16383 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
16384 @item @code{socket-type}
16385 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
16386 @code{'seqpacket}.
16387 @item @code{protocol}
16388 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
16389 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
16390 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
16391 listening to new service requests.
16392 @item @code{user}
16393 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
16394 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
16395 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
16396 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
16397 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
16398 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
16399 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
16400 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
16401 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
16402 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
16403 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
16404 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
16405 @end table
16406
16407 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
16408 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
16409 @end deftp
16410
16411 @cindex Tor
16412 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
16413 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
16414 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
16415 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
16416 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
16417
16418 @end defvr
16419
16420 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
16421 @table @asis
16422 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
16423 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
16424 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
16425 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
16426 implementation.
16427
16428 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
16429 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
16430 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
16431 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
16432 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
16433 syntax.
16434
16435 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
16436 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
16437 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
16438 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
16439 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
16440 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
16441
16442 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
16443 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
16444 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
16445 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
16446 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
16447 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16448 @code{tor} group.
16449
16450 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
16451 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
16452 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
16453 @code{SocksPort} option.
16454 @end table
16455 @end deftp
16456
16457 @cindex hidden service
16458 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
16459 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
16460 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
16461
16462 @example
16463 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
16464 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
16465 @end example
16466
16467 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
16468 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
16469
16470 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
16471 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
16472 service.
16473
16474 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
16475 project's documentation} for more information.
16476 @end deffn
16477
16478 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
16479
16480 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
16481 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
16482 files.
16483
16484 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
16485 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
16486 The value for this service type is a
16487 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
16488
16489 @lisp
16490 (service rsync-service-type)
16491 @end lisp
16492
16493 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
16494 @end deffn
16495
16496 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
16497 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
16498
16499 @table @asis
16500 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
16501 @code{rsync} package to use.
16502
16503 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
16504 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
16505 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
16506 @code{root} user and group.
16507
16508 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
16509 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
16510
16511 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
16512 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
16513
16514 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
16515 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
16516
16517 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
16518 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
16519
16520 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
16521 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16522
16523 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
16524 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16525
16526 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
16527 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
16528
16529 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
16530 I/O timeout in seconds.
16531
16532 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
16533 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
16534
16535 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
16536 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
16537
16538 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16539 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
16540 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
16541
16542 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16543 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
16544
16545 @end table
16546 @end deftp
16547
16548 The @code{(gnu services syncthing)} module provides the following services:
16549 @cindex syncthing
16550
16551 You might want a syncthing daemon if you have files between two or more
16552 computers and want to sync them in real time, safely protected from
16553 prying eyes.
16554
16555 @deffn {Scheme Variable} syncthing-service-type
16556 This is the service type for the @uref{https://syncthing.net/,
16557 syncthing} daemon, The value for this service type is a
16558 @command{syncthing-configuration} record as in this example:
16559
16560 @lisp
16561 (service syncthing-service-type
16562 (syncthing-configuration (user "alice")))
16563 @end lisp
16564
16565 See below for details about @code{syncthing-configuration}.
16566
16567 @deftp {Data Type} syncthing-configuration
16568 Data type representing the configuration for @code{syncthing-service-type}.
16569
16570 @table @asis
16571 @item @code{syncthing} (default: @var{syncthing})
16572 @code{syncthing} package to use.
16573
16574 @item @code{arguments} (default: @var{'()})
16575 List of command-line arguments passing to @code{syncthing} binary.
16576
16577 @item @code{logflags} (default: @var{0})
16578 Sum of loging flags, see
16579 @uref{https://docs.syncthing.net/users/syncthing.html#cmdoption-logflags, Syncthing documentation logflags}.
16580
16581 @item @code{user} (default: @var{#f})
16582 The user as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16583 This assumes that the specified user exists.
16584
16585 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"users"})
16586 The group as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16587 This assumes that the specified group exists.
16588
16589 @item @code{home} (default: @var{#f})
16590 Common configuration and data directory. The default configuration
16591 directory is @file{$HOME} of the specified Syncthing @code{user}.
16592
16593 @end table
16594 @end deftp
16595 @end deffn
16596
16597 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
16598 @cindex SSH
16599 @cindex SSH server
16600
16601 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
16602 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
16603 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
16604 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
16605 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
16606 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
16607 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
16608 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
16609 only by root.
16610
16611 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
16612 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
16613 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
16614 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
16615 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
16616
16617 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
16618 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
16619 require interaction.
16620
16621 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
16622 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
16623 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
16624 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
16625
16626 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
16627 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
16628 or addresses.
16629
16630 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
16631 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
16632 root.
16633
16634 The other options should be self-descriptive.
16635 @end deffn
16636
16637 @cindex SSH
16638 @cindex SSH server
16639 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
16640 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
16641 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
16642 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
16643
16644 @lisp
16645 (service openssh-service-type
16646 (openssh-configuration
16647 (x11-forwarding? #t)
16648 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
16649 (authorized-keys
16650 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
16651 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
16652 @end lisp
16653
16654 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
16655
16656 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
16657 example:
16658
16659 @lisp
16660 (service-extension openssh-service-type
16661 (const `(("charlie"
16662 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
16663 @end lisp
16664 @end deffn
16665
16666 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
16667 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
16668
16669 @table @asis
16670 @item @code{openssh} (default @var{openssh})
16671 The Openssh package to use.
16672
16673 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
16674 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
16675
16676 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
16677 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
16678
16679 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
16680 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
16681 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
16682 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
16683 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
16684
16685 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16686 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
16687 not.
16688
16689 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16690 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
16691 other authentication methods.
16692
16693 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16694 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
16695 false, users have to use other authentication method.
16696
16697 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16698 This is used only by protocol version 2.
16699
16700 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
16701 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
16702 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
16703 @option{-Y} will work.
16704
16705 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16706 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
16707
16708 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16709 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
16710
16711 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
16712 Whether to allow gateway ports.
16713
16714 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
16715 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
16716 PAM).
16717
16718 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
16719 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
16720 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
16721 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
16722 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
16723 module processing for all authentication types.
16724
16725 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
16726 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
16727 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
16728 @code{password-authentication?}.
16729
16730 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
16731 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
16732 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
16733
16734 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
16735 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
16736
16737 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
16738 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
16739 subsystem request.
16740
16741 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
16742 server. Alternatively, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
16743 @lisp
16744 (service openssh-service-type
16745 (openssh-configuration
16746 (subsystems
16747 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
16748 @end lisp
16749
16750 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
16751 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
16752
16753 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
16754 @code{man sshd_config}.
16755
16756 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @env{COLORTERM} variable.
16757 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
16758 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
16759 if this variable is set.
16760
16761 @lisp
16762 (service openssh-service-type
16763 (openssh-configuration
16764 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
16765 @end lisp
16766
16767 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
16768 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
16769 @cindex SSH authorized keys
16770 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
16771 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
16772 keys. For example:
16773
16774 @lisp
16775 (openssh-configuration
16776 (authorized-keys
16777 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
16778 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
16779 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
16780 @end lisp
16781
16782 @noindent
16783 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
16784 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
16785
16786 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
16787 @code{service-extension}.
16788
16789 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
16790 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16791
16792 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
16793 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
16794 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
16795 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
16796
16797 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
16798 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
16799 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
16800 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
16801 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
16802
16803 @lisp
16804 (openssh-configuration
16805 (extra-content "\
16806 Match Address 192.168.0.1
16807 PermitRootLogin yes"))
16808 @end lisp
16809
16810 @end table
16811 @end deftp
16812
16813 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
16814 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
16815 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
16816 object.
16817
16818 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
16819 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
16820
16821 @lisp
16822 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
16823 (port-number 1234)))
16824 @end lisp
16825 @end deffn
16826
16827 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
16828 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
16829
16830 @table @asis
16831 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
16832 The Dropbear package to use.
16833
16834 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
16835 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
16836
16837 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
16838 Whether to enable syslog output.
16839
16840 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
16841 File name of the daemon's PID file.
16842
16843 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
16844 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
16845
16846 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16847 Whether to allow empty passwords.
16848
16849 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16850 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
16851 @end table
16852 @end deftp
16853
16854 @cindex AutoSSH
16855 @deffn {Scheme Variable} autossh-service-type
16856 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.harding.motd.ca/autossh,
16857 AutoSSH} program that runs a copy of @command{ssh} and monitors it,
16858 restarting it as necessary should it die or stop passing traffic.
16859 AutoSSH can be run manually from the command-line by passing arguments
16860 to the binary @command{autossh} from the package @code{autossh}, but it
16861 can also be run as a Guix service. This latter use case is documented
16862 here.
16863
16864 AutoSSH can be used to forward local traffic to a remote machine using
16865 an SSH tunnel, and it respects the @file{~/.ssh/config} of the user it
16866 is run as.
16867
16868 For example, to specify a service running autossh as the user
16869 @code{pino} and forwarding all local connections to port @code{8081} to
16870 @code{remote:8081} using an SSH tunnel, add this call to the operating
16871 system's @code{services} field:
16872
16873 @lisp
16874 (service autossh-service-type
16875 (autossh-configuration
16876 (user "pino")
16877 (ssh-options (list "-T" "-N" "-L" "8081:localhost:8081" "remote.net"))))
16878 @end lisp
16879 @end deffn
16880
16881 @deftp {Data Type} autossh-configuration
16882 This data type represents the configuration of an AutoSSH service.
16883
16884 @table @asis
16885
16886 @item @code{user} (default @code{"autossh"})
16887 The user as which the AutoSSH service is to be run.
16888 This assumes that the specified user exists.
16889
16890 @item @code{poll} (default @code{600})
16891 Specifies the connection poll time in seconds.
16892
16893 @item @code{first-poll} (default @code{#f})
16894 Specifies how many seconds AutoSSH waits before the first connection
16895 test. After this first test, polling is resumed at the pace defined in
16896 @code{poll}. When set to @code{#f}, the first poll is not treated
16897 specially and will also use the connection poll specified in
16898 @code{poll}.
16899
16900 @item @code{gate-time} (default @code{30})
16901 Specifies how many seconds an SSH connection must be active before it is
16902 considered successful.
16903
16904 @item @code{log-level} (default @code{1})
16905 The log level, corresponding to the levels used by syslog---so @code{0}
16906 is the most silent while @code{7} is the chattiest.
16907
16908 @item @code{max-start} (default @code{#f})
16909 The maximum number of times SSH may be (re)started before AutoSSH exits.
16910 When set to @code{#f}, no maximum is configured and AutoSSH may restart indefinitely.
16911
16912 @item @code{message} (default @code{""})
16913 The message to append to the echo message sent when testing connections.
16914
16915 @item @code{port} (default @code{"0"})
16916 The ports used for monitoring the connection. When set to @code{"0"},
16917 monitoring is disabled. When set to @code{"@var{n}"} where @var{n} is
16918 a positive integer, ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for
16919 monitoring the connection, such that port @var{n} is the base
16920 monitoring port and @code{n+1} is the echo port. When set to
16921 @code{"@var{n}:@var{m}"} where @var{n} and @var{m} are positive
16922 integers, the ports @var{n} and @var{m} are used for monitoring the
16923 connection, such that port @var{n} is the base monitoring port and
16924 @var{m} is the echo port.
16925
16926 @item @code{ssh-options} (default @code{'()})
16927 The list of command-line arguments to pass to @command{ssh} when it is
16928 run. Options @option{-f} and @option{-M} are reserved for AutoSSH and
16929 may cause undefined behaviour.
16930
16931 @end table
16932 @end deftp
16933
16934 @cindex WebSSH
16935 @deffn {Scheme Variable} webssh-service-type
16936 This is the type for the @uref{https://webssh.huashengdun.org/, WebSSH}
16937 program that runs a web SSH client. WebSSH can be run manually from the
16938 command-line by passing arguments to the binary @command{wssh} from the
16939 package @code{webssh}, but it can also be run as a Guix service. This
16940 latter use case is documented here.
16941
16942 For example, to specify a service running WebSSH on loopback interface
16943 on port @code{8888} with reject policy with a list of allowed to
16944 connection hosts, and NGINX as a reverse-proxy to this service listening
16945 for HTTPS connection, add this call to the operating system's
16946 @code{services} field:
16947
16948 @lisp
16949 (service webssh-service-type
16950 (webssh-configuration (address "127.0.0.1")
16951 (port 8888)
16952 (policy 'reject)
16953 (known-hosts '("localhost ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"
16954 "127.0.0.1 ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"))))
16955
16956 (service nginx-service-type
16957 (nginx-configuration
16958 (server-blocks
16959 (list
16960 (nginx-server-configuration
16961 (inherit %webssh-configuration-nginx)
16962 (server-name '("webssh.example.com"))
16963 (listen '("443 ssl"))
16964 (ssl-certificate (letsencrypt-certificate "webssh.example.com"))
16965 (ssl-certificate-key (letsencrypt-key "webssh.example.com"))
16966 (locations
16967 (cons (nginx-location-configuration
16968 (uri "/.well-known")
16969 (body '("root /var/www;")))
16970 (nginx-server-configuration-locations %webssh-configuration-nginx))))))))
16971 @end lisp
16972 @end deffn
16973
16974 @deftp {Data Type} webssh-configuration
16975 Data type representing the configuration for @code{webssh-service}.
16976
16977 @table @asis
16978 @item @code{package} (default: @var{webssh})
16979 @code{webssh} package to use.
16980
16981 @item @code{user-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
16982 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
16983 place.
16984
16985 @item @code{group-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
16986 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
16987
16988 @item @code{address} (default: @var{#f})
16989 IP address on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
16990
16991 @item @code{port} (default: @var{8888})
16992 TCP port on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
16993
16994 @item @code{policy} (default: @var{#f})
16995 Connection policy. @var{reject} policy requires to specify @var{known-hosts}.
16996
16997 @item @code{known-hosts} (default: @var{'()})
16998 List of hosts which allowed for SSH connection from @command{webssh}.
16999
17000 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/webssh.log"})
17001 Name of the file where @command{webssh} writes its log file.
17002
17003 @item @code{log-level} (default: @var{#f})
17004 Logging level.
17005
17006 @end table
17007 @end deftp
17008
17009 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
17010 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
17011 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
17012 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
17013 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
17014 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
17015
17016 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
17017 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
17018 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
17019
17020 @lisp
17021 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
17022
17023 (operating-system
17024 (host-name "mymachine")
17025 ;; ...
17026 (hosts-file
17027 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
17028 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
17029 (plain-file "hosts"
17030 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
17031 %facebook-host-aliases))))
17032 @end lisp
17033
17034 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
17035 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
17036 @end defvr
17037
17038 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
17039
17040 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
17041 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
17042 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
17043 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
17044 Its value must be an @code{avahi-configuration} record---see below.
17045
17046 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
17047 resolve @code{.local} host names using
17048 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
17049 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
17050
17051 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
17052 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
17053 @end defvr
17054
17055 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
17056 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
17057
17058 @table @asis
17059
17060 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
17061 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
17062 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
17063
17064 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
17065 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
17066 network.
17067
17068 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
17069 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
17070 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
17071 your local network, you can run:
17072
17073 @example
17074 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
17075 @end example
17076
17077 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
17078 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
17079
17080 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
17081 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
17082 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
17083
17084 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
17085 This is a list of domains to browse.
17086 @end table
17087 @end deftp
17088
17089 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
17090 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
17091 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
17092 object.
17093 @end deffn
17094
17095 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
17096 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
17097 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
17098 through programmatic extension.
17099
17100 @table @asis
17101 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
17102 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
17103
17104 @end table
17105 @end deftp
17106
17107 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
17108 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
17109 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
17110 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
17111 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
17112
17113 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
17114
17115 @lisp
17116 (service pagekite-service-type
17117 (pagekite-configuration
17118 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
17119 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
17120 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
17121 @end lisp
17122 @end defvr
17123
17124 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
17125 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
17126
17127 @table @asis
17128 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
17129 Package object of PageKite.
17130
17131 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
17132 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
17133
17134 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
17135 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
17136 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
17137
17138 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
17139 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
17140 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
17141
17142 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
17143 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
17144 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
17145
17146 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
17147 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
17148 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
17149
17150 @end table
17151 @end deftp
17152
17153 @defvr {Scheme Variable} yggdrasil-service-type
17154 The service type for connecting to the @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/,
17155 Yggdrasil network}, an early-stage implementation of a fully end-to-end
17156 encrypted IPv6 network.
17157
17158 @quotation
17159 Yggdrasil provides name-independent routing with cryptographically generated
17160 addresses. Static addressing means you can keep the same address as long as
17161 you want, even if you move to a new location, or generate a new address (by
17162 generating new keys) whenever you want.
17163 @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/2018/07/28/addressing.html}
17164 @end quotation
17165
17166 Pass it a value of @code{yggdrasil-configuration} to connect it to public
17167 peers and/or local peers.
17168
17169 Here is an example using public peers and a static address. The static
17170 signing and encryption keys are defined in @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}
17171 (the default value for @code{config-file}).
17172
17173 @lisp
17174 ;; part of the operating-system declaration
17175 (service yggdrasil-service-type
17176 (yggdrasil-configuration
17177 (autoconf? #f) ;; use only the public peers
17178 (json-config
17179 ;; choose one from
17180 ;; https://github.com/yggdrasil-network/public-peers
17181 '((peers . #("tcp://1.2.3.4:1337"))))
17182 ;; /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf is the default value for config-file
17183 ))
17184 @end lisp
17185 @example
17186 # sample content for /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf
17187 @{
17188 # Your public encryption key. Your peers may ask you for this to put
17189 # into their AllowedEncryptionPublicKeys configuration.
17190 EncryptionPublicKey: 378dc5...
17191
17192 # Your private encryption key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17193 EncryptionPrivateKey: 0777...
17194
17195 # Your public signing key. You should not ordinarily need to share
17196 # this with anyone.
17197 SigningPublicKey: e1664...
17198
17199 # Your private signing key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17200 SigningPrivateKey: 0589d...
17201 @}
17202 @end example
17203 @end defvr
17204
17205 @deftp {Data Type} yggdrasil-configuration
17206 Data type representing the configuration of Yggdrasil.
17207
17208 @table @asis
17209 @item @code{package} (default: @code{yggdrasil})
17210 Package object of Yggdrasil.
17211
17212 @item @code{json-config} (default: @code{'()})
17213 Contents of @file{/etc/yggdrasil.conf}. Will be merged with
17214 @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}. Note that these settings are stored in
17215 the Guix store, which is readable to all users. @strong{Do not store your
17216 private keys in it}. See the output of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} for a
17217 quick overview of valid keys and their default values.
17218
17219 @item @code{autoconf?} (default: @code{#f})
17220 Whether to use automatic mode. Enabling it makes Yggdrasil use adynamic IP
17221 and peer with IPv6 neighbors.
17222
17223 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
17224 How much detail to include in logs. Use @code{'debug} for more detail.
17225
17226 @item @code{log-to} (default: @code{'stdout})
17227 Where to send logs. By default, the service logs standard output to
17228 @file{/var/log/yggdrasil.log}. The alternative is @code{'syslog}, which
17229 sends output to the running syslog service.
17230
17231 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{"/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf"})
17232 What HJSON file to load sensitive data from. This is where private keys
17233 should be stored, which are necessary to specify if you don't want a
17234 randomized address after each restart. Use @code{#f} to disable. Options
17235 defined in this file take precedence over @code{json-config}. Use the output
17236 of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} as a starting point. To configure a static
17237 address, delete everything except these options:
17238
17239 @itemize
17240 @item @code{EncryptionPublicKey}
17241 @item @code{EncryptionPrivateKey}
17242 @item @code{SigningPublicKey}
17243 @item @code{SigningPrivateKey}
17244 @end itemize
17245 @end table
17246 @end deftp
17247
17248 @cindex keepalived
17249 @deffn {Scheme Variable} keepalived-service-type
17250 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.keepalived.org/, Keepalived}
17251 routing software, @command{keepalived}. Its value must be an
17252 @code{keepalived-configuration} record as in this example for master
17253 machine:
17254
17255 @lisp
17256 (service keepalived-service-type
17257 (keepalived-configuration
17258 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-master.conf"))))
17259 @end lisp
17260
17261 where @file{keepalived-master.conf}:
17262
17263 @example
17264 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17265 state MASTER
17266 interface enp9s0
17267 virtual_router_id 100
17268 priority 100
17269 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.2 @}
17270 virtual_ipaddress @{
17271 10.0.0.4/24
17272 @}
17273 @}
17274 @end example
17275
17276 and for backup machine:
17277
17278 @lisp
17279 (service keepalived-service-type
17280 (keepalived-configuration
17281 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-backup.conf"))))
17282 @end lisp
17283
17284 where @file{keepalived-backup.conf}:
17285
17286 @example
17287 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17288 state BACKUP
17289 interface enp9s0
17290 virtual_router_id 100
17291 priority 99
17292 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.3 @}
17293 virtual_ipaddress @{
17294 10.0.0.4/24
17295 @}
17296 @}
17297 @end example
17298 @end deffn
17299
17300 @node Unattended Upgrades
17301 @subsection Unattended Upgrades
17302
17303 @cindex unattended upgrades
17304 @cindex upgrades, unattended
17305 Guix provides a service to perform @emph{unattended upgrades}:
17306 periodically, the system automatically reconfigures itself from the
17307 latest Guix. Guix System has several properties that make unattended
17308 upgrades safe:
17309
17310 @itemize
17311 @item
17312 upgrades are transactional (either the upgrade succeeds or it fails, but
17313 you cannot end up with an ``in-between'' system state);
17314 @item
17315 the upgrade log is kept---you can view it with @command{guix system
17316 list-generations}---and you can roll back to any previous generation,
17317 should the upgraded system fail to behave as intended;
17318 @item
17319 channel code is authenticated so you know you can only run genuine code
17320 (@pxref{Channels});
17321 @item
17322 @command{guix system reconfigure} prevents downgrades, which makes it
17323 immune to @dfn{downgrade attacks}.
17324 @end itemize
17325
17326 To set up unattended upgrades, add an instance of
17327 @code{unattended-upgrade-service-type} like the one below to the list of
17328 your operating system services:
17329
17330 @lisp
17331 (service unattended-upgrade-service-type)
17332 @end lisp
17333
17334 The defaults above set up weekly upgrades: every Sunday at midnight.
17335 You do not need to provide the operating system configuration file: it
17336 uses @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm}, which ensures it
17337 always uses your latest configuration---@pxref{provenance-service-type},
17338 for more information about this file.
17339
17340 There are several things that can be configured, in particular the
17341 periodicity and services (daemons) to be restarted upon completion.
17342 When the upgrade is successful, the service takes care of deleting
17343 system generations older that some threshold, as per @command{guix
17344 system delete-generations}. See the reference below for details.
17345
17346 To ensure that upgrades are actually happening, you can run
17347 @command{guix system describe}. To investigate upgrade failures, visit
17348 the unattended upgrade log file (see below).
17349
17350 @defvr {Scheme Variable} unattended-upgrade-service-type
17351 This is the service type for unattended upgrades. It sets up an mcron
17352 job (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) that runs @command{guix system
17353 reconfigure} from the latest version of the specified channels.
17354
17355 Its value must be a @code{unattended-upgrade-configuration} record (see
17356 below).
17357 @end defvr
17358
17359 @deftp {Data Type} unattended-upgrade-configuration
17360 This data type represents the configuration of the unattended upgrade
17361 service. The following fields are available:
17362
17363 @table @asis
17364 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{"30 01 * * 0"})
17365 This is the schedule of upgrades, expressed as a gexp containing an
17366 mcron job schedule (@pxref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,,
17367 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
17368
17369 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{#~%default-channels})
17370 This gexp specifies the channels to use for the upgrade
17371 (@pxref{Channels}). By default, the tip of the official @code{guix}
17372 channel is used.
17373
17374 @item @code{operating-system-file} (default: @code{"/run/current-system/configuration.scm"})
17375 This field specifies the operating system configuration file to use.
17376 The default is to reuse the config file of the current configuration.
17377
17378 There are cases, though, where referring to
17379 @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} is not enough, for instance
17380 because that file refers to extra files (SSH public keys, extra
17381 configuration files, etc.) @i{via} @code{local-file} and similar
17382 constructs. For those cases, we recommend something along these lines:
17383
17384 @lisp
17385 (unattended-upgrade-configuration
17386 (operating-system-file
17387 (file-append (local-file "." "config-dir" #:recursive? #t)
17388 "/config.scm")))
17389 @end lisp
17390
17391 The effect here is to import all of the current directory into the
17392 store, and to refer to @file{config.scm} within that directory.
17393 Therefore, uses of @code{local-file} within @file{config.scm} will work
17394 as expected. @xref{G-Expressions}, for information about
17395 @code{local-file} and @code{file-append}.
17396
17397 @item @code{services-to-restart} (default: @code{'(mcron)})
17398 This field specifies the Shepherd services to restart when the upgrade
17399 completes.
17400
17401 Those services are restarted right away upon completion, as with
17402 @command{herd restart}, which ensures that the latest version is
17403 running---remember that by default @command{guix system reconfigure}
17404 only restarts services that are not currently running, which is
17405 conservative: it minimizes disruption but leaves outdated services
17406 running.
17407
17408 Use @command{herd status} to find out candidates for restarting.
17409 @xref{Services}, for general information about services. Common
17410 services to restart would include @code{ntpd} and @code{ssh-daemon}.
17411
17412 By default, the @code{mcron} service is restarted. This ensures that
17413 the latest version of the unattended upgrade job will be used next time.
17414
17415 @item @code{system-expiration} (default: @code{(* 3 30 24 3600)})
17416 This is the expiration time in seconds for system generations. System
17417 generations older that this amount of time are deleted with
17418 @command{guix system delete-generations} when an upgrade completes.
17419
17420 @quotation Note
17421 The unattended upgrade service does not run the garbage collector. You
17422 will probably want to set up your own mcron job to run @command{guix gc}
17423 periodically.
17424 @end quotation
17425
17426 @item @code{maximum-duration} (default: @code{3600})
17427 Maximum duration in seconds for the upgrade; past that time, the upgrade
17428 aborts.
17429
17430 This is primarily useful to ensure the upgrade does not end up
17431 rebuilding or re-downloading ``the world''.
17432
17433 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/unattended-upgrade.log"})
17434 File where unattended upgrades are logged.
17435 @end table
17436 @end deftp
17437
17438 @node X Window
17439 @subsection X Window
17440
17441 @cindex X11
17442 @cindex X Window System
17443 @cindex login manager
17444 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
17445 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
17446 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
17447 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
17448
17449 @cindex GDM
17450 @cindex GNOME, login manager
17451 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
17452 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
17453 features such as automatic screen locking.
17454
17455 @cindex window manager
17456 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
17457 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
17458 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
17459 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
17460
17461 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
17462 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
17463 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
17464 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
17465 (see below).
17466
17467 @cindex session types (X11)
17468 @cindex X11 session types
17469 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
17470 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
17471 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
17472 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
17473 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
17474
17475 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
17476 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
17477 and/or other X clients.
17478 @end defvr
17479
17480 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
17481 @table @asis
17482 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17483 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
17484 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
17485
17486 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
17487 @code{default-user}.
17488
17489 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17490 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
17491
17492 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
17493 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
17494
17495 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17496 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17497
17498 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
17499 Script to run before starting a X session.
17500
17501 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
17502 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
17503
17504 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
17505 The GDM package to use.
17506 @end table
17507 @end deftp
17508
17509 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
17510 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
17511
17512 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
17513 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
17514 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
17515
17516 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
17517 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
17518 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
17519 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
17520 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
17521 and tty8.
17522
17523 @lisp
17524 (use-modules (gnu services)
17525 (gnu services desktop)
17526 (gnu services xorg)
17527 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
17528
17529 (operating-system
17530 ;; ...
17531 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17532 (display ":0")
17533 (vt "vt7")))
17534 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17535 (display ":1")
17536 (vt "vt8")))
17537 (remove (lambda (service)
17538 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
17539 %desktop-services))))
17540 @end lisp
17541
17542 @end defvr
17543
17544 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
17545 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
17546
17547 @table @asis
17548 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
17549 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
17550
17551 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17552 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
17553 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
17554
17555 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
17556 @code{default-user}.
17557
17558 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
17559 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
17560 The graphical theme to use and its name.
17561
17562 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
17563 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
17564 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
17565
17566 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
17567 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
17568 will be used.
17569
17570 @quotation Note
17571 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
17572 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
17573 false, you will be unable to log in.
17574 @end quotation
17575
17576 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17577 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17578
17579 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
17580 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17581
17582 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
17583 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17584
17585 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
17586 The XAuth package to use.
17587
17588 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
17589 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
17590 @command{reboot}.
17591
17592 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
17593 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
17594
17595 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
17596 The SLiM package to use.
17597 @end table
17598 @end deftp
17599
17600 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
17601 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
17602 The default SLiM theme and its name.
17603 @end defvr
17604
17605
17606 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17607 This is the data type representing the SDDM service configuration.
17608
17609 @table @asis
17610 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
17611 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are
17612 @samp{"x11"} or @samp{"wayland"}.
17613
17614 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
17615 Valid values are @samp{"on"}, @samp{"off"} or @samp{"none"}.
17616
17617 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
17618 Command to run when halting.
17619
17620 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
17621 Command to run when rebooting.
17622
17623 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
17624 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are @samp{"elarun"},
17625 @samp{"maldives"} or @samp{"maya"}.
17626
17627 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
17628 Directory to look for themes.
17629
17630 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
17631 Directory to look for faces.
17632
17633 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
17634 Default PATH to use.
17635
17636 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
17637 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
17638
17639 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
17640 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
17641
17642 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
17643 Remember last user.
17644
17645 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
17646 Remember last session.
17647
17648 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
17649 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
17650
17651 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
17652 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
17653
17654 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
17655 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
17656
17657 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
17658 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
17659
17660 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17661 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17662
17663 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
17664 Path to xauth.
17665
17666 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
17667 Path to Xephyr.
17668
17669 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
17670 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
17671
17672 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
17673 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
17674
17675 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
17676 Script to run before starting a X session.
17677
17678 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
17679 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
17680
17681 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
17682 Minimum VT to use.
17683
17684 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
17685 User to use for auto-login.
17686
17687 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
17688 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
17689
17690 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
17691 Relogin after logout.
17692
17693 @end table
17694 @end deftp
17695
17696 @cindex login manager
17697 @cindex X11 login
17698 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
17699 This is the type of the service to run the
17700 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
17701 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
17702
17703 Here's an example use:
17704
17705 @lisp
17706 (service sddm-service-type
17707 (sddm-configuration
17708 (auto-login-user "alice")
17709 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
17710 @end lisp
17711 @end defvr
17712
17713 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17714 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
17715 The available fields are:
17716
17717 @table @asis
17718 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
17719 The SDDM package to use.
17720
17721 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
17722 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
17723
17724 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
17725
17726 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
17727 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
17728 automatically.
17729
17730 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
17731 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
17732 auto-login session.
17733 @end table
17734 @end deftp
17735
17736 @cindex Xorg, configuration
17737 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
17738 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
17739 server. Note that there is no Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
17740 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM@. Thus, the configuration
17741 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
17742
17743 @table @asis
17744 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
17745 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
17746 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
17747
17748 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
17749 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
17750
17751 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
17752 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
17753 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
17754 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
17755
17756 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
17757 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
17758 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
17759 768) (640 480))}.
17760
17761 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
17762 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
17763 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
17764 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
17765 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
17766
17767 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
17768 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
17769 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
17770
17771 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
17772 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
17773 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
17774
17775 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
17776 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
17777
17778 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
17779 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
17780 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
17781 @end table
17782 @end deftp
17783
17784 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
17785 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
17786 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
17787 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
17788
17789 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
17790 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
17791 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
17792 @end deffn
17793
17794 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
17795 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
17796 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
17797 @code{startx}.
17798
17799 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
17800 @end deffn
17801
17802
17803 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
17804 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
17805 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
17806 for it. For example:
17807
17808 @lisp
17809 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
17810 @end lisp
17811
17812 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
17813 @end deffn
17814
17815
17816 @node Printing Services
17817 @subsection Printing Services
17818
17819 @cindex printer support with CUPS
17820 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
17821 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
17822 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
17823
17824 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
17825 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
17826 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
17827 write:
17828 @lisp
17829 (service cups-service-type)
17830 @end lisp
17831 @end deffn
17832
17833 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
17834 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
17835 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
17836 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
17837 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
17838 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
17839 secure connections to the print server.
17840
17841 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
17842 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{epson-inkjet-printer-escpr}
17843 package and for HP printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package.
17844 You can do that directly, like this (you need to use the
17845 @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
17846
17847 @lisp
17848 (service cups-service-type
17849 (cups-configuration
17850 (web-interface? #t)
17851 (extensions
17852 (list cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr hplip-minimal))))
17853 @end lisp
17854
17855 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
17856 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
17857 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
17858
17859 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
17860 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
17861 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
17862 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
17863 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
17864 from some other system; see the end for more details.
17865
17866 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17867 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
17868 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17869 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17870 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17871 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17872 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
17873
17874
17875 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
17876
17877 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
17878 The CUPS package.
17879 @end deftypevr
17880
17881 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions (default: @code{(list brlaser cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr foomatic-filters hplip-minimal splix)})
17882 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
17883 @end deftypevr
17884
17885 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
17886 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
17887 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
17888
17889 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
17890
17891 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
17892 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
17893 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
17894 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
17895 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
17896 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
17897 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
17898 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
17899
17900 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
17901 @end deftypevr
17902
17903 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
17904 Where CUPS should cache data.
17905
17906 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
17907 @end deftypevr
17908
17909 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
17910 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
17911 writes.
17912
17913 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
17914 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
17915 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
17916 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
17917 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
17918
17919 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
17920 @end deftypevr
17921
17922 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
17923 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
17924 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
17925 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
17926 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
17927 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
17928 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
17929 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
17930
17931 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
17932 @end deftypevr
17933
17934 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
17935 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
17936 kind strings are:
17937
17938 @table @code
17939 @item none
17940 No errors are fatal.
17941
17942 @item all
17943 All of the errors below are fatal.
17944
17945 @item browse
17946 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
17947 to the DNS-SD daemon.
17948
17949 @item config
17950 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
17951
17952 @item listen
17953 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
17954 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
17955
17956 @item log
17957 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
17958
17959 @item permissions
17960 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
17961 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
17962 @end table
17963
17964 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
17965 @end deftypevr
17966
17967 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
17968 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
17969 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
17970
17971 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17972 @end deftypevr
17973
17974 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
17975 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
17976 programs.
17977
17978 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
17979 @end deftypevr
17980
17981 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
17982 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
17983
17984 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
17985 @end deftypevr
17986
17987 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
17988 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
17989 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
17990 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
17991 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
17992 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
17993 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
17994 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
17995
17996 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
17997 @end deftypevr
17998
17999 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
18000 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
18001 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
18002
18003 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
18004 @end deftypevr
18005
18006 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
18007 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
18008 data.
18009
18010 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
18011 @end deftypevr
18012
18013 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
18014 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
18015 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
18016 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
18017 used/supported on macOS.
18018
18019 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
18020 @end deftypevr
18021
18022 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
18023 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
18024 look for public and private keys in this directory: @file{.crt} files
18025 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @file{.key} files for
18026 PEM-encoded private keys.
18027
18028 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
18029 @end deftypevr
18030
18031 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
18032 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
18033
18034 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
18035 @end deftypevr
18036
18037 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
18038 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
18039 configuration or state files.
18040
18041 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18042 @end deftypevr
18043
18044 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
18045 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
18046 @end deftypevr
18047
18048 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
18049 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
18050
18051 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
18052 @end deftypevr
18053
18054 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
18055 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
18056 programs.
18057
18058 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18059 @end deftypevr
18060
18061 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
18062 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
18063
18064 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
18065 @end deftypevr
18066 @end deftypevr
18067
18068 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
18069 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
18070 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
18071 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
18072 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
18073 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
18074 level logs all requests.
18075
18076 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
18077 @end deftypevr
18078
18079 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
18080 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
18081 longer required for quotas.
18082
18083 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18084 @end deftypevr
18085
18086 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
18087 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
18088 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
18089 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
18090
18091 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
18092 @end deftypevr
18093
18094 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
18095 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
18096
18097 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
18098 @end deftypevr
18099
18100 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
18101 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
18102
18103 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18104 @end deftypevr
18105
18106 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
18107 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
18108
18109 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18110 @end deftypevr
18111
18112 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
18113 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
18114 name can be used, including @samp{"classified"}, @samp{"confidential"},
18115 @samp{"secret"}, @samp{"topsecret"}, and @samp{"unclassified"}, or the
18116 banner can be omitted to disable secure printing functions.
18117
18118 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18119 @end deftypevr
18120
18121 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
18122 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
18123 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
18124
18125 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18126 @end deftypevr
18127
18128 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
18129 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
18130
18131 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
18132 @end deftypevr
18133
18134 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
18135 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
18136
18137 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
18138 @end deftypevr
18139
18140 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
18141 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
18142
18143 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
18144 @end deftypevr
18145
18146 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
18147 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
18148 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
18149 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
18150 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
18151
18152 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
18153 @end deftypevr
18154
18155 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
18156 Specifies the default access policy to use.
18157
18158 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
18159 @end deftypevr
18160
18161 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
18162 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
18163
18164 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18165 @end deftypevr
18166
18167 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
18168 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
18169 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
18170 typically within a few milliseconds.
18171
18172 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18173 @end deftypevr
18174
18175 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
18176 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
18177 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
18178 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
18179 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
18180 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
18181
18182 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
18183 @end deftypevr
18184
18185 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
18186 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
18187 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
18188 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
18189 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
18190 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
18191 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
18192 at any time.
18193
18194 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18195 @end deftypevr
18196
18197 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
18198 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
18199 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
18200 lowest priority.
18201
18202 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18203 @end deftypevr
18204
18205 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
18206 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
18207 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
18208 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
18209 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
18210 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
18211 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
18212
18213 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18214 @end deftypevr
18215
18216 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
18217 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
18218 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
18219
18220 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18221 @end deftypevr
18222
18223 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
18224 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
18225 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18226 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18227 @code{retry-current-job}.
18228
18229 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18230 @end deftypevr
18231
18232 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
18233 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
18234 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18235 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18236 @code{retry-current-job}.
18237
18238 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18239 @end deftypevr
18240
18241 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
18242 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
18243
18244 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18245 @end deftypevr
18246
18247 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
18248 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
18249
18250 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18251 @end deftypevr
18252
18253 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
18254 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
18255 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
18256
18257 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18258 @end deftypevr
18259
18260 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
18261 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
18262 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
18263 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
18264 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
18265 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
18266 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
18267 @end deftypevr
18268
18269 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
18270 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
18271 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
18272 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
18273 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
18274 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
18275 ones.
18276
18277 Defaults to @samp{128}.
18278 @end deftypevr
18279
18280 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
18281 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
18282
18283 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
18284
18285 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
18286 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
18287 @end deftypevr
18288
18289 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18290 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
18291 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
18292
18293 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18294 @end deftypevr
18295
18296 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
18297 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
18298
18299 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18300
18301 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
18302
18303 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
18304 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
18305 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
18306
18307 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18308 @end deftypevr
18309
18310 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
18311 Methods to which this access control applies.
18312
18313 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18314 @end deftypevr
18315
18316 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18317 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
18318 one directive, such as @samp{"Order allow,deny"}.
18319
18320 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18321 @end deftypevr
18322 @end deftypevr
18323 @end deftypevr
18324
18325 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
18326 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
18327 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
18328 of the LogLevel setting.
18329
18330 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18331 @end deftypevr
18332
18333 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
18334 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
18335 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
18336
18337 Defaults to @samp{info}.
18338 @end deftypevr
18339
18340 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
18341 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
18342 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
18343
18344 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
18345 @end deftypevr
18346
18347 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
18348 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
18349 the scheduler.
18350
18351 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18352 @end deftypevr
18353
18354 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
18355 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
18356 from a single address.
18357
18358 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18359 @end deftypevr
18360
18361 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
18362 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
18363 job.
18364
18365 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
18366 @end deftypevr
18367
18368 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
18369 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
18370 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
18371 held jobs.
18372
18373 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18374 @end deftypevr
18375
18376 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
18377 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
18378 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
18379
18380 Defaults to @samp{500}.
18381 @end deftypevr
18382
18383 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
18384 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18385 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
18386
18387 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18388 @end deftypevr
18389
18390 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
18391 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18392 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
18393
18394 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18395 @end deftypevr
18396
18397 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
18398 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
18399 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of ``stuck'' jobs.
18400
18401 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
18402 @end deftypevr
18403
18404 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
18405 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
18406 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
18407
18408 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
18409 @end deftypevr
18410
18411 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
18412 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
18413 multiple file print job, in seconds.
18414
18415 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18416 @end deftypevr
18417
18418 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
18419 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
18420 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
18421 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
18422 sequences are recognized:
18423
18424 @table @samp
18425 @item %%
18426 insert a single percent character
18427
18428 @item %@{name@}
18429 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
18430
18431 @item %C
18432 insert the number of copies for the current page
18433
18434 @item %P
18435 insert the current page number
18436
18437 @item %T
18438 insert the current date and time in common log format
18439
18440 @item %j
18441 insert the job ID
18442
18443 @item %p
18444 insert the printer name
18445
18446 @item %u
18447 insert the username
18448 @end table
18449
18450 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
18451 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
18452 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
18453 standard items.
18454
18455 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18456 @end deftypevr
18457
18458 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
18459 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
18460 of strings.
18461
18462 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18463 @end deftypevr
18464
18465 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
18466 Specifies named access control policies.
18467
18468 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
18469
18470 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
18471 Name of the policy.
18472 @end deftypevr
18473
18474 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
18475 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
18476 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18477 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18478 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18479 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18480 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18481 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18482 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18483 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18484
18485 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18486 @end deftypevr
18487
18488 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
18489 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18490 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18491
18492 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
18493 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
18494 @end deftypevr
18495
18496 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
18497 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
18498 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18499 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18500 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18501 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18502 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18503 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18504 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18505 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18506
18507 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18508 @end deftypevr
18509
18510 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
18511 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18512 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18513
18514 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
18515 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
18516 @end deftypevr
18517
18518 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
18519 Access control by IPP operation.
18520
18521 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18522 @end deftypevr
18523 @end deftypevr
18524
18525 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
18526 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
18527 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
18528 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
18529 value applies indefinitely.
18530
18531 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
18532 @end deftypevr
18533
18534 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
18535 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
18536 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
18537 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
18538 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
18539
18540 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18541 @end deftypevr
18542
18543 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
18544 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
18545 restarting the scheduler.
18546
18547 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18548 @end deftypevr
18549
18550 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
18551 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
18552 into bitmaps for a printer.
18553
18554 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
18555 @end deftypevr
18556
18557 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
18558 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
18559
18560 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
18561 @end deftypevr
18562
18563 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
18564 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
18565 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
18566 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
18567 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
18568 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
18569 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
18570 @code{*}.
18571
18572 Defaults to @samp{*}.
18573 @end deftypevr
18574
18575 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
18576 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
18577
18578 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18579 @end deftypevr
18580
18581 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
18582 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
18583 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
18584 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
18585 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
18586 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
18587 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
18588 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
18589
18590 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
18591 @end deftypevr
18592
18593 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
18594 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
18595 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
18596 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
18597 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
18598
18599 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18600 @end deftypevr
18601
18602 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
18603 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
18604 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
18605 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
18606 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
18607 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
18608 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
18609 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
18610 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
18611 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
18612
18613 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18614 @end deftypevr
18615
18616 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
18617 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
18618 the IPP specifications.
18619
18620 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18621 @end deftypevr
18622
18623 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
18624 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
18625
18626 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18627
18628 @end deftypevr
18629
18630 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
18631 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
18632
18633 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18634 @end deftypevr
18635
18636 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
18637 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
18638 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
18639 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
18640 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
18641 @code{cups-service-type}.
18642
18643 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
18644
18645 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18646 The CUPS package.
18647 @end deftypevr
18648
18649 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
18650 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
18651 @end deftypevr
18652
18653 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
18654 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
18655 @end deftypevr
18656
18657 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
18658 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
18659 this:
18660
18661 @lisp
18662 (service cups-service-type
18663 (opaque-cups-configuration
18664 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
18665 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
18666 @end lisp
18667
18668
18669 @node Desktop Services
18670 @subsection Desktop Services
18671
18672 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
18673 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
18674 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
18675 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
18676 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
18677
18678 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
18679 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
18680 environment and networking:
18681
18682 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
18683 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
18684 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
18685
18686 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
18687 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
18688 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
18689 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
18690 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
18691 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
18692 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
18693 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
18694 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
18695 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
18696 @end defvr
18697
18698 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
18699 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
18700 Reference, @code{services}}).
18701
18702 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
18703 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type},
18704 @code{lxqt-desktop-service-type} and @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type}
18705 procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE and/or Enlightenment to a system. To
18706 ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the backlight adjustment
18707 helpers and the power management utilities are added to the system, extending
18708 @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with
18709 elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose system interfaces.
18710 Additionally, adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds
18711 the GNOME metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce
18712 service not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but
18713 it also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode'' file
18714 management window, if the user authenticates using the administrator's
18715 password via the standard polkit graphical interface. To ``add MATE'' means
18716 that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended appropriately, allowing MATE
18717 to operate with elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose
18718 system interfaces. Additionally, adding a service of type
18719 @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE metapackage to the system
18720 profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that @code{dbus} is extended
18721 appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries are set as setuid,
18722 allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other functionality to work as
18723 expected.
18724
18725 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
18726 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
18727 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
18728 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
18729 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM@. Alternatively you can
18730 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
18731 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
18732 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
18733
18734 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
18735 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
18736 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
18737 object (see below).
18738
18739 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
18740 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
18741 @end defvr
18742
18743 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
18744 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
18745
18746 @table @asis
18747 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
18748 The GNOME package to use.
18749 @end table
18750 @end deftp
18751
18752 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
18753 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
18754 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
18755 (see below).
18756
18757 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
18758 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
18759 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
18760 with the administrator's password.
18761
18762 Note that @code{xfce4-panel} and its plugin packages should be installed in
18763 the same profile to ensure compatibility. When using this service, you should
18764 add extra plugins (@code{xfce4-whiskermenu-plugin},
18765 @code{xfce4-weather-plugin}, etc.) to the @code{packages} field of your
18766 @code{operating-system}.
18767 @end defvr
18768
18769 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
18770 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
18771
18772 @table @asis
18773 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
18774 The Xfce package to use.
18775 @end table
18776 @end deftp
18777
18778 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
18779 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
18780 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
18781 object (see below).
18782
18783 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
18784 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
18785 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
18786 @end deffn
18787
18788 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
18789 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
18790
18791 @table @asis
18792 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
18793 The MATE package to use.
18794 @end table
18795 @end deftp
18796
18797 @deffn {Scheme Variable} lxqt-desktop-service-type
18798 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://lxqt.github.io,
18799 LXQt desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{lxqt-desktop-configuration}
18800 object (see below).
18801
18802 This service adds the @code{lxqt} package to the system
18803 profile.
18804 @end deffn
18805
18806 @deftp {Data Type} lxqt-desktop-configuration
18807 Configuration record for the LXQt desktop environment.
18808
18809 @table @asis
18810 @item @code{lxqt} (default: @code{lxqt})
18811 The LXQT package to use.
18812 @end table
18813 @end deftp
18814
18815 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
18816 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
18817 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
18818 @end deffn
18819
18820 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
18821 @table @asis
18822 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
18823 The enlightenment package to use.
18824 @end table
18825 @end deftp
18826
18827 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
18828 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
18829 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
18830 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
18831 @code{operating-system}:
18832
18833 @lisp
18834 (use-modules (gnu))
18835 (use-service-modules desktop)
18836 (operating-system
18837 ...
18838 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
18839 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
18840 (service xfce-desktop-service)
18841 %desktop-services))
18842 ...)
18843 @end lisp
18844
18845 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
18846 graphical login window.
18847
18848 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
18849 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
18850 are described below.
18851
18852 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
18853 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
18854 support for @var{services}.
18855
18856 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
18857 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
18858 and to be notified of system-wide events.
18859
18860 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
18861 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
18862 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
18863 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
18864 @end deffn
18865
18866 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
18867 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
18868 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
18869 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
18870 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
18871 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
18872
18873 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
18874 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
18875 when the power button is pressed.
18876
18877 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
18878 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
18879 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
18880 their default values are:
18881
18882 @table @code
18883 @item kill-user-processes?
18884 @code{#f}
18885 @item kill-only-users
18886 @code{()}
18887 @item kill-exclude-users
18888 @code{("root")}
18889 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
18890 @code{5}
18891 @item handle-power-key
18892 @code{poweroff}
18893 @item handle-suspend-key
18894 @code{suspend}
18895 @item handle-hibernate-key
18896 @code{hibernate}
18897 @item handle-lid-switch
18898 @code{suspend}
18899 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
18900 @code{ignore}
18901 @item handle-lid-switch-external-power
18902 @code{ignore}
18903 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
18904 @code{#f}
18905 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
18906 @code{#f}
18907 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
18908 @code{#f}
18909 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
18910 @code{#t}
18911 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
18912 @code{30}
18913 @item idle-action
18914 @code{ignore}
18915 @item idle-action-seconds
18916 @code{(* 30 60)}
18917 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
18918 @code{10}
18919 @item runtime-directory-size
18920 @code{#f}
18921 @item remove-ipc?
18922 @code{#t}
18923 @item suspend-state
18924 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
18925 @item suspend-mode
18926 @code{()}
18927 @item hibernate-state
18928 @code{("disk")}
18929 @item hibernate-mode
18930 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
18931 @item hybrid-sleep-state
18932 @code{("disk")}
18933 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
18934 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
18935 @end table
18936 @end deffn
18937
18938 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
18939 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
18940 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
18941 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
18942 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
18943 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
18944 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
18945 accountsservice web site} for more information.
18946
18947 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
18948 package to expose as a service.
18949 @end deffn
18950
18951 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
18952 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
18953 Return a service that runs the
18954 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
18955 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
18956 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
18957 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
18958 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
18959 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
18960 @end deffn
18961
18962 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
18963 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
18964 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
18965 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
18966 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
18967 @end defvr
18968
18969 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
18970 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
18971 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
18972 configuration settings.
18973
18974 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
18975 notably used by GNOME.
18976 @end defvr
18977
18978 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
18979 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
18980
18981 @table @asis
18982
18983 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
18984 Package to use for @code{upower}.
18985
18986 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
18987 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
18988
18989 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
18990 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
18991
18992 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
18993 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
18994
18995 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
18996 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
18997 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
18998
18999 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
19000 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19001 at which the battery is considered low.
19002
19003 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
19004 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19005 at which the battery is considered critical.
19006
19007 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
19008 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19009 at which action will be taken.
19010
19011 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
19012 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19013 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
19014
19015 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
19016 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19017 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
19018
19019 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
19020 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19021 seconds at which action will be taken.
19022
19023 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
19024 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
19025 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
19026
19027 Possible values are:
19028
19029 @itemize @bullet
19030 @item
19031 @code{'power-off}
19032
19033 @item
19034 @code{'hibernate}
19035
19036 @item
19037 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
19038 @end itemize
19039
19040 @end table
19041 @end deftp
19042
19043 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
19044 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
19045 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces
19046 with notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk
19047 to UDisks include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and
19048 GNOME Disks. Note that Udisks relies on the @command{mount} command, so
19049 it will only be able to use the file-system utilities installed in the
19050 system profile. For example if you want to be able to mount NTFS
19051 file-systems in read and write fashion, you'll need to have
19052 @code{ntfs-3g} installed system-wide.
19053 @end deffn
19054
19055 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
19056 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
19057 service with a D-Bus
19058 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
19059 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
19060 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
19061 site} for more information.
19062 @end deffn
19063
19064 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
19065 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
19066 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
19067 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
19068 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
19069 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
19070 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
19071 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
19072 means that all users are allowed.
19073 @end deffn
19074
19075 @cindex scanner access
19076 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sane-service-type
19077 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
19078 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary udev
19079 rules.
19080 @end deffn
19081
19082 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
19083 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
19084 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
19085 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
19086 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
19087 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
19088 know the user's location.
19089 @end defvr
19090
19091 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
19092 [#:whitelist '()] @
19093 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
19094 [#:submit-data? #f]
19095 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
19096 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
19097 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
19098 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
19099 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
19100 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
19101 location databases. See
19102 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
19103 web site} for more information.
19104 @end deffn
19105
19106 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
19107 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
19108 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
19109 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
19110 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
19111 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
19112 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
19113
19114 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
19115 @end deffn
19116
19117 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
19118 This is the type of the service that adds the
19119 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
19120 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below).
19121
19122 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
19123 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
19124 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
19125 @end defvr
19126
19127 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
19128 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
19129
19130 @table @asis
19131 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
19132 The GNOME keyring package to use.
19133
19134 @item @code{pam-services}
19135 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
19136 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
19137 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
19138 @code{passwd}.
19139
19140 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
19141 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
19142 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
19143 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
19144 without arguments.
19145
19146 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
19147 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
19148 @end table
19149 @end deftp
19150
19151
19152 @node Sound Services
19153 @subsection Sound Services
19154
19155 @cindex sound support
19156 @cindex ALSA
19157 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
19158
19159 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
19160 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
19161 preferred ALSA output driver.
19162
19163 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
19164 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
19165 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
19166 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
19167 record as in this example:
19168
19169 @lisp
19170 (service alsa-service-type)
19171 @end lisp
19172
19173 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
19174 @end deffn
19175
19176 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
19177 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
19178
19179 @table @asis
19180 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
19181 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
19182
19183 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
19184 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
19185 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
19186
19187 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
19188 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
19189 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
19190
19191 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
19192 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
19193
19194 @end table
19195 @end deftp
19196
19197 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
19198 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
19199
19200 @example
19201 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
19202 pcm_type.jack @{
19203 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
19204 @}
19205
19206 # Routing ALSA to jack:
19207 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
19208 pcm.rawjack @{
19209 type jack
19210 playback_ports @{
19211 0 system:playback_1
19212 1 system:playback_2
19213 @}
19214
19215 capture_ports @{
19216 0 system:capture_1
19217 1 system:capture_2
19218 @}
19219 @}
19220
19221 pcm.!default @{
19222 type plug
19223 slave @{
19224 pcm "rawjack"
19225 @}
19226 @}
19227 @end example
19228
19229 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
19230 details.
19231
19232 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
19233 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
19234 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
19235 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
19236
19237 @quotation Warning
19238 This service overrides per-user configuration files. If you want
19239 PulseAudio to honor configuration files in @file{~/.config/pulse} you
19240 have to unset the environment variables @env{PULSE_CONFIG} and
19241 @env{PULSE_CLIENTCONFIG} in your @file{~/.bash_profile}.
19242 @end quotation
19243
19244 @quotation Warning
19245 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
19246 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
19247 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
19248 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
19249 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
19250 @end quotation
19251 @end deffn
19252
19253 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
19254 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
19255
19256 @table @asis
19257 @item @code{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
19258 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
19259 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
19260 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
19261 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
19262
19263 @item @code{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
19264 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
19265 @var{client-conf}.
19266
19267 @item @code{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
19268 Script file to use as @file{default.pa}.
19269
19270 @item @code{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
19271 Script file to use as @file{system.pa}.
19272 @end table
19273 @end deftp
19274
19275 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
19276 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
19277 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
19278
19279 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
19280 @code{swh-plugins} package:
19281
19282 @lisp
19283 (service ladspa-service-type
19284 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
19285 @end lisp
19286
19287 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
19288 details.
19289
19290 @end deffn
19291
19292 @node Database Services
19293 @subsection Database Services
19294
19295 @cindex database
19296 @cindex SQL
19297 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
19298
19299 @subsubheading PostgreSQL
19300
19301 The following example describes a PostgreSQL service with the default
19302 configuration.
19303
19304 @lisp
19305 (service postgresql-service-type
19306 (postgresql-configuration
19307 (postgresql postgresql-10)))
19308 @end lisp
19309
19310 If the services fails to start, it may be due to an incompatible
19311 cluster already present in @var{data-directory}. Adjust it (or, if you
19312 don't need the cluster anymore, delete @var{data-directory}), then
19313 restart the service.
19314
19315 Peer authentication is used by default and the @code{postgres} user
19316 account has no shell, which prevents the direct execution of @code{psql}
19317 commands as this user. To use @code{psql}, you can temporarily log in
19318 as @code{postgres} using a shell, create a PostgreSQL superuser with the
19319 same name as one of the system users and then create the associated
19320 database.
19321
19322 @example
19323 sudo -u postgres -s /bin/sh
19324 createuser --interactive
19325 createdb $MY_USER_LOGIN # Replace appropriately.
19326 @end example
19327
19328 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-configuration
19329 Data type representing the configuration for the
19330 @code{postgresql-service-type}.
19331
19332 @table @asis
19333 @item @code{postgresql}
19334 PostgreSQL package to use for the service.
19335
19336 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5432})
19337 Port on which PostgreSQL should listen.
19338
19339 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
19340 Locale to use as the default when creating the database cluster.
19341
19342 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(postgresql-config-file)})
19343 The configuration file to use when running PostgreSQL@. The default
19344 behaviour uses the postgresql-config-file record with the default values
19345 for the fields.
19346
19347 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql"})
19348 The directory where @command{pg_ctl} output will be written in a file
19349 named @code{"pg_ctl.log"}. This file can be useful to debug PostgreSQL
19350 configuration errors for instance.
19351
19352 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/postgresql/data"})
19353 Directory in which to store the data.
19354
19355 @item @code{extension-packages} (default: @code{'()})
19356 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
19357 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
19358 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
19359 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
19360 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
19361
19362 @cindex postgis
19363 @lisp
19364 (use-package-modules databases geo)
19365
19366 (operating-system
19367 ...
19368 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
19369 ;; proper operation.
19370 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
19371 (services
19372 (cons*
19373 (service postgresql-service-type
19374 (postgresql-configuration
19375 (postgresql postgresql-10)
19376 (extension-packages (list postgis))))
19377 %base-services)))
19378 @end lisp
19379
19380 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
19381 database in this way:
19382
19383 @example
19384 psql -U postgres
19385 > create database postgistest;
19386 > \connect postgistest;
19387 > create extension postgis;
19388 > create extension postgis_topology;
19389 @end example
19390
19391 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
19392 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
19393 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
19394
19395 @end table
19396 @end deftp
19397
19398 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-config-file
19399 Data type representing the PostgreSQL configuration file. As shown in
19400 the following example, this can be used to customize the configuration
19401 of PostgreSQL@. Note that you can use any G-expression or filename in
19402 place of this record, if you already have a configuration file you'd
19403 like to use for example.
19404
19405 @lisp
19406 (service postgresql-service-type
19407 (postgresql-configuration
19408 (config-file
19409 (postgresql-config-file
19410 (log-destination "stderr")
19411 (hba-file
19412 (plain-file "pg_hba.conf"
19413 "
19414 local all all trust
19415 host all all 127.0.0.1/32 md5
19416 host all all ::1/128 md5"))
19417 (extra-config
19418 '(("session_preload_libraries" "auto_explain")
19419 ("random_page_cost" 2)
19420 ("auto_explain.log_min_duration" "100 ms")
19421 ("work_mem" "500 MB")
19422 ("logging_collector" #t)
19423 ("log_directory" "/var/log/postgresql")))))))
19424 @end lisp
19425
19426 @table @asis
19427 @item @code{log-destination} (default: @code{"syslog"})
19428 The logging method to use for PostgreSQL@. Multiple values are accepted,
19429 separated by commas.
19430
19431 @item @code{hba-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-hba})
19432 Filename or G-expression for the host-based authentication
19433 configuration.
19434
19435 @item @code{ident-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-ident})
19436 Filename or G-expression for the user name mapping configuration.
19437
19438 @item @code{socket-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/postgresql"})
19439 Specifies the directory of the Unix-domain socket(s) on which PostgreSQL
19440 is to listen for connections from client applications. If set to
19441 @code{#false} PostgreSQL does not listen on any Unix-domain sockets, in
19442 which case only TCP/IP sockets can be used to connect to the server.
19443
19444 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
19445 List of additional keys and values to include in the PostgreSQL config
19446 file. Each entry in the list should be a list where the first element
19447 is the key, and the remaining elements are the values.
19448
19449 The values can be numbers, booleans or strings and will be mapped to
19450 PostgreSQL parameters types @code{Boolean}, @code{String},
19451 @code{Numeric}, @code{Numeric with Unit} and @code{Enumerated} described
19452 @uref{https://www.postgresql.org/docs/current/config-setting.html,
19453 here}.
19454
19455 @end table
19456 @end deftp
19457
19458 @deffn {Scheme Variable} postgresql-role-service-type
19459 This service allows to create PostgreSQL roles and databases after
19460 PostgreSQL service start. Here is an example of its use.
19461
19462 @lisp
19463 (service postgresql-role-service-type
19464 (postgresql-role-configuration
19465 (roles
19466 (list (postgresql-role
19467 (name "test")
19468 (create-database? #t))))))
19469 @end lisp
19470
19471 This service can be extended with extra roles, as in this
19472 example:
19473
19474 @lisp
19475 (service-extension postgresql-role-service-type
19476 (const (postgresql-role
19477 (name "alice")
19478 (create-database? #t))))
19479 @end lisp
19480 @end deffn
19481
19482 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role
19483 PostgreSQL manages database access permissions using the concept of
19484 roles. A role can be thought of as either a database user, or a group
19485 of database users, depending on how the role is set up. Roles can own
19486 database objects (for example, tables) and can assign privileges on
19487 those objects to other roles to control who has access to which objects.
19488
19489 @table @asis
19490 @item @code{name}
19491 The role name.
19492
19493 @item @code{permissions} (default: @code{'(createdb login)})
19494 The role permissions list. Supported permissions are @code{bypassrls},
19495 @code{createdb}, @code{createrole}, @code{login}, @code{replication} and
19496 @code{superuser}.
19497
19498 @item @code{create-database?} (default: @code{#f})
19499 Whether to create a database with the same name as the role.
19500
19501 @end table
19502 @end deftp
19503
19504 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role-configuration
19505 Data type representing the configuration of
19506 @var{postgresql-role-service-type}.
19507
19508 @table @asis
19509 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
19510 The PostgreSQL host to connect to.
19511
19512 @item @code{log} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql_roles.log"})
19513 File name of the log file.
19514
19515 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'()})
19516 The initial PostgreSQL roles to create.
19517 @end table
19518 @end deftp
19519
19520 @subsubheading MariaDB/MySQL
19521
19522 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mysql-service-type
19523 This is the service type for a MySQL or MariaDB database server. Its value
19524 is a @code{mysql-configuration} object that specifies which package to use,
19525 as well as various settings for the @command{mysqld} daemon.
19526 @end defvr
19527
19528 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
19529 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service-type}.
19530
19531 @table @asis
19532 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
19533 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
19534 or @var{mysql}.
19535
19536 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
19537 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
19538
19539 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19540 The IP on which to listen for network connections. Use @code{"0.0.0.0"}
19541 to bind to all available network interfaces.
19542
19543 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
19544 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
19545
19546 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{"/run/mysqld/mysqld.sock"})
19547 Socket file to use for local (non-network) connections.
19548
19549 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19550 Additional settings for the @file{my.cnf} configuration file.
19551
19552 @item @code{auto-upgrade?} (default: @code{#t})
19553 Whether to automatically run @command{mysql_upgrade} after starting the
19554 service. This is necessary to upgrade the @dfn{system schema} after
19555 ``major'' updates (such as switching from MariaDB 10.4 to 10.5), but can
19556 be disabled if you would rather do that manually.
19557
19558 @end table
19559 @end deftp
19560
19561 @subsubheading Memcached
19562
19563 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
19564 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
19565 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
19566 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
19567 @end defvr
19568
19569 @lisp
19570 (service memcached-service-type)
19571 @end lisp
19572
19573 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
19574 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
19575
19576 @table @asis
19577 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
19578 The Memcached package to use.
19579
19580 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
19581 Network interfaces on which to listen.
19582
19583 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19584 Port on which to accept connections.
19585
19586 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19587 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19588 listening on a UDP socket.
19589
19590 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
19591 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
19592 @end table
19593 @end deftp
19594
19595 @subsubheading MongoDB
19596
19597 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
19598 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
19599 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
19600 @end defvr
19601
19602 @lisp
19603 (service mongodb-service-type)
19604 @end lisp
19605
19606 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
19607 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
19608
19609 @table @asis
19610 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
19611 The MongoDB package to use.
19612
19613 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
19614 The configuration file for MongoDB.
19615
19616 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
19617 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
19618 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
19619 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
19620 @end table
19621 @end deftp
19622
19623 @subsubheading Redis
19624
19625 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
19626 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
19627 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
19628 @end defvr
19629
19630 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
19631 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
19632
19633 @table @asis
19634 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
19635 The Redis package to use.
19636
19637 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19638 Network interface on which to listen.
19639
19640 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
19641 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19642 listening on a TCP socket.
19643
19644 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
19645 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
19646 @end table
19647 @end deftp
19648
19649 @node Mail Services
19650 @subsection Mail Services
19651
19652 @cindex mail
19653 @cindex email
19654 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
19655 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
19656 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
19657 in the subsections below.
19658
19659 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
19660
19661 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
19662 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
19663 @end deffn
19664
19665 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
19666 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
19667 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
19668 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
19669 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
19670 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
19671 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
19672 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
19673
19674 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
19675 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
19676
19677 @lisp
19678 (dovecot-service #:config
19679 (dovecot-configuration
19680 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
19681 @end lisp
19682
19683 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
19684 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
19685 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
19686 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
19687 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
19688 from some other system; see the end for more details.
19689
19690 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
19691 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
19692 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
19693 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
19694 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
19695 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
19696 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
19697
19698 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
19699
19700 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
19701 The dovecot package.
19702 @end deftypevr
19703
19704 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
19705 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
19706 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
19707 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
19708 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
19709 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
19710 @end deftypevr
19711
19712 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
19713 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
19714 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
19715
19716 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
19717
19718 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
19719 The name of the protocol.
19720 @end deftypevr
19721
19722 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
19723 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
19724 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
19725 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
19726 @end deftypevr
19727
19728 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
19729 Space separated list of plugins to load.
19730 @end deftypevr
19731
19732 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
19733 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
19734 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
19735 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19736 @end deftypevr
19737
19738 @end deftypevr
19739
19740 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
19741 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
19742 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
19743 @samp{lmtp}.
19744
19745 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
19746
19747 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
19748 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
19749 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
19750 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
19751 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
19752 @end deftypevr
19753
19754 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
19755 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
19756 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
19757 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
19758 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19759
19760 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
19761
19762 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19763 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19764 the section name.
19765 @end deftypevr
19766
19767 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19768 The access mode for the socket.
19769 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19770 @end deftypevr
19771
19772 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19773 The user to own the socket.
19774 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19775 @end deftypevr
19776
19777 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19778 The group to own the socket.
19779 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19780 @end deftypevr
19781
19782
19783 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
19784
19785 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19786 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19787 the section name.
19788 @end deftypevr
19789
19790 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19791 The access mode for the socket.
19792 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19793 @end deftypevr
19794
19795 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19796 The user to own the socket.
19797 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19798 @end deftypevr
19799
19800 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19801 The group to own the socket.
19802 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19803 @end deftypevr
19804
19805
19806 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
19807
19808 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
19809 The protocol to listen for.
19810 @end deftypevr
19811
19812 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
19813 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
19814 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19815 @end deftypevr
19816
19817 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
19818 The port on which to listen.
19819 @end deftypevr
19820
19821 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
19822 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
19823 @samp{required}.
19824 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19825 @end deftypevr
19826
19827 @end deftypevr
19828
19829 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
19830 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
19831 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
19832 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
19833 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
19834
19835 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19836
19837 @end deftypevr
19838
19839 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
19840 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
19841 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
19842 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
19843 Defaults to @samp{1}.
19844
19845 @end deftypevr
19846
19847 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
19848 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
19849 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
19850
19851 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19852
19853 @end deftypevr
19854
19855 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
19856 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
19857 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19858 @end deftypevr
19859
19860 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
19861 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
19862 this.
19863 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
19864 @end deftypevr
19865
19866 @end deftypevr
19867
19868 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
19869 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
19870 constructor.
19871
19872 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
19873
19874 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
19875 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
19876 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19877 @end deftypevr
19878
19879 @end deftypevr
19880
19881 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
19882 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
19883 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
19884
19885 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
19886
19887 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
19888 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
19889 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
19890 @samp{static}.
19891 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
19892 @end deftypevr
19893
19894 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
19895 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
19896 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19897 @end deftypevr
19898
19899 @end deftypevr
19900
19901 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
19902 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
19903 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
19904
19905 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
19906
19907 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
19908 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
19909 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
19910 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
19911 @end deftypevr
19912
19913 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
19914 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
19915 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19916 @end deftypevr
19917
19918 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
19919 Override fields from passwd.
19920 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19921 @end deftypevr
19922
19923 @end deftypevr
19924
19925 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
19926 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
19927 constructor.
19928 @end deftypevr
19929
19930 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
19931 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
19932 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
19933
19934 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
19935
19936 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
19937 Name for this namespace.
19938 @end deftypevr
19939
19940 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
19941 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
19942 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
19943 @end deftypevr
19944
19945 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
19946 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
19947 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
19948 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
19949 format.
19950 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19951 @end deftypevr
19952
19953 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
19954 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
19955 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
19956 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19957 @end deftypevr
19958
19959 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
19960 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
19961 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
19962 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19963 @end deftypevr
19964
19965 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
19966 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
19967 namespace has it.
19968 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19969 @end deftypevr
19970
19971 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
19972 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
19973 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
19974 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
19975 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
19976 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
19977 and @samp{mail/}.
19978 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19979 @end deftypevr
19980
19981 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
19982 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
19983 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
19984 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
19985 hides the namespace prefix.
19986 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19987 @end deftypevr
19988
19989 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
19990 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
19991 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
19992 as @code{#t}).
19993 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19994 @end deftypevr
19995
19996 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
19997 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
19998 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19999
20000 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
20001
20002 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
20003 Name for this mailbox.
20004 @end deftypevr
20005
20006 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
20007 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
20008 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
20009 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20010 @end deftypevr
20011
20012 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
20013 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
20014 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
20015 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
20016 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20017 @end deftypevr
20018
20019 @end deftypevr
20020
20021 @end deftypevr
20022
20023 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
20024 Base directory where to store runtime data.
20025 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
20026 @end deftypevr
20027
20028 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
20029 Greeting message for clients.
20030 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
20031 @end deftypevr
20032
20033 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
20034 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
20035 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
20036 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
20037 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
20038 here.
20039 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20040 @end deftypevr
20041
20042 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
20043 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
20044 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20045 @end deftypevr
20046
20047 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
20048 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
20049 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
20050 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
20051 accounts).
20052 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20053 @end deftypevr
20054
20055 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
20056 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
20057 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
20058 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
20059 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
20060 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20061 @end deftypevr
20062
20063 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
20064 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
20065 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
20066 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20067 @end deftypevr
20068
20069 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
20070 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
20071 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
20072 @end deftypevr
20073
20074 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
20075 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
20076 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
20077 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
20078 @end deftypevr
20079
20080 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
20081 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
20082 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
20083 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
20084 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
20085 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
20086 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20087 @end deftypevr
20088
20089 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
20090 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
20091 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
20092 for caching to be used.
20093 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20094 @end deftypevr
20095
20096 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
20097 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
20098 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
20099 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
20100 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
20101 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
20102 authentication.
20103 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20104 @end deftypevr
20105
20106 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
20107 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
20108 0 disables caching them completely.
20109 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20110 @end deftypevr
20111
20112 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
20113 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
20114 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
20115 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
20116 realm first.
20117 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20118 @end deftypevr
20119
20120 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
20121 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
20122 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
20123 logins.
20124 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20125 @end deftypevr
20126
20127 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
20128 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
20129 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
20130 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
20131 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
20132 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
20133 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
20134 @end deftypevr
20135
20136 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
20137 Username character translations before it's looked up from
20138 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
20139 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
20140 translated to @samp{@@}.
20141 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20142 @end deftypevr
20143
20144 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
20145 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
20146 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
20147 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
20148 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
20149 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
20150 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20151 @end deftypevr
20152
20153 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
20154 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
20155 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
20156 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
20157 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
20158 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
20159 choice.
20160 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20161 @end deftypevr
20162
20163 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
20164 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
20165 mechanism.
20166 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
20167 @end deftypevr
20168
20169 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
20170 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
20171 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
20172 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
20173 Defaults to @samp{30}.
20174 @end deftypevr
20175
20176 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
20177 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
20178 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
20179 allow all keytab entries.
20180 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20181 @end deftypevr
20182
20183 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
20184 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
20185 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
20186 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
20187 file.
20188 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20189 @end deftypevr
20190
20191 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
20192 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
20193 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
20194 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
20195 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20196 @end deftypevr
20197
20198 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
20199 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
20200 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
20201 @end deftypevr
20202
20203 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
20204 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
20205 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
20206 @end deftypevr
20207
20208 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
20209 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
20210 fails.
20211 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20212 @end deftypevr
20213
20214 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
20215 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
20216 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
20217 CommonName.
20218 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20219 @end deftypevr
20220
20221 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
20222 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
20223 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
20224 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
20225 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
20226 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
20227 @end deftypevr
20228
20229 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
20230 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
20231 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
20232 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
20233 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20234 @end deftypevr
20235
20236 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
20237 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
20238 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
20239 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20240 @end deftypevr
20241
20242 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
20243 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
20244 has any connections.
20245 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
20246 @end deftypevr
20247
20248 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
20249 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
20250 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
20251 are shared within domain.
20252 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20253 @end deftypevr
20254
20255 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
20256 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
20257 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
20258 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
20259 @end deftypevr
20260
20261 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
20262 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
20263 @samp{log-path}.
20264 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20265 @end deftypevr
20266
20267 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
20268 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
20269 @samp{info-log-path}.
20270 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20271 @end deftypevr
20272
20273 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
20274 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
20275 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
20276 standard facilities are supported.
20277 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
20278 @end deftypevr
20279
20280 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
20281 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
20282 failed.
20283 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20284 @end deftypevr
20285
20286 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
20287 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
20288 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
20289 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
20290 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
20291 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
20292 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20293 @end deftypevr
20294
20295 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
20296 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
20297 SQL queries.
20298 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20299 @end deftypevr
20300
20301 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
20302 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
20303 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
20304 @samp{auth-debug}.
20305 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20306 @end deftypevr
20307
20308 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
20309 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
20310 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
20311 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20312 @end deftypevr
20313
20314 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
20315 Show protocol level SSL errors.
20316 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20317 @end deftypevr
20318
20319 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
20320 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
20321 strftime(3) format.
20322 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
20323 @end deftypevr
20324
20325 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
20326 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
20327 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
20328 string.
20329 @end deftypevr
20330
20331 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
20332 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
20333 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
20334 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
20335 @end deftypevr
20336
20337 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
20338 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
20339 of possible variables you can use.
20340 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
20341 @end deftypevr
20342
20343 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
20344 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
20345 @table @code
20346 @item %$
20347 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
20348 @item %m
20349 Message-ID
20350 @item %s
20351 Subject
20352 @item %f
20353 From address
20354 @item %p
20355 Physical size
20356 @item %w
20357 Virtual size.
20358 @end table
20359 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
20360 @end deftypevr
20361
20362 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
20363 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
20364 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
20365 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
20366 Dovecot the full location.
20367
20368 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
20369 file (e.g.@: @file{/var/mail/%u}) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
20370 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the @emph{root mail
20371 directory}, and it must be the first path given in the
20372 @samp{mail-location} setting.
20373
20374 There are a few special variables you can use, e.g.:
20375
20376 @table @samp
20377 @item %u
20378 username
20379 @item %n
20380 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
20381 @item %d
20382 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
20383 @item %h
20384 home director
20385 @end table
20386
20387 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
20388 @table @samp
20389 @item maildir:~/Maildir
20390 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
20391 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
20392 @end table
20393 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20394 @end deftypevr
20395
20396 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
20397 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
20398 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
20399 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
20400 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20401 @end deftypevr
20402
20403 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
20404
20405 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20406 @end deftypevr
20407
20408 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
20409 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
20410 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
20411 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to @samp{"mail"} to give access to
20412 @file{/var/mail}.
20413 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20414 @end deftypevr
20415
20416 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
20417 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
20418 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
20419 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create symlinks
20420 (e.g.@: if @samp{mail} group is set here, @code{ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var}
20421 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or @code{ln -s
20422 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox} would allow reading it). Defaults to
20423 @samp{""}.
20424 @end deftypevr
20425
20426 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
20427 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
20428 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID@. It
20429 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
20430 names with e.g.@: @file{/path/} or @file{~user/}.
20431 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20432 @end deftypevr
20433
20434 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
20435 Don't use @code{mmap()} at all. This is required if you store indexes to
20436 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
20437 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20438 @end deftypevr
20439
20440 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
20441 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
20442 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
20443 nowadays by default.
20444 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20445 @end deftypevr
20446
20447 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
20448 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
20449 @table @code
20450 @item optimized
20451 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
20452 @item always
20453 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when @code{write()}s are delayed
20454 @item never
20455 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
20456 @end table
20457 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
20458 @end deftypevr
20459
20460 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
20461 Mail storage exists in NFS@. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
20462 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
20463 this isn't needed.
20464 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20465 @end deftypevr
20466
20467 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
20468 Mail index files also exist in NFS@. Setting this to yes requires
20469 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
20470 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20471 @end deftypevr
20472
20473 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
20474 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
20475 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
20476 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
20477 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
20478 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
20479 @end deftypevr
20480
20481 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
20482 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
20483 kB.
20484 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
20485 @end deftypevr
20486
20487 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
20488 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
20489 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
20490 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
20491 is set to 0.
20492 Defaults to @samp{500}.
20493 @end deftypevr
20494
20495 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
20496
20497 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20498 @end deftypevr
20499
20500 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
20501 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
20502 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
20503 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
20504 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20505 @end deftypevr
20506
20507 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
20508
20509 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20510 @end deftypevr
20511
20512 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
20513 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
20514 trying to create new keywords.
20515 Defaults to @samp{50}.
20516 @end deftypevr
20517
20518 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
20519 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
20520 processes (i.e.@: @file{/var/mail} will allow chrooting to @file{/var/mail/foo/bar}
20521 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
20522 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
20523 @samp{/./} in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
20524 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
20525 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
20526 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20527 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20528 @end deftypevr
20529
20530 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
20531 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
20532 for specific users in user database by giving @samp{/./} in user's home
20533 directory (e.g.@: @samp{/home/./user} chroots into @file{/home}). Note that usually
20534 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
20535 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
20536 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append @samp{/.} to
20537 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20538 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20539 @end deftypevr
20540
20541 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
20542 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
20543 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
20544 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
20545 @end deftypevr
20546
20547 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
20548 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
20549 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
20550 @end deftypevr
20551
20552 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
20553 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
20554 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
20555 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20556 @end deftypevr
20557
20558 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
20559 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
20560 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
20561 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
20562 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20563 @end deftypevr
20564
20565 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
20566 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
20567 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
20568 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
20569 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
20570 occur.
20571 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
20572 @end deftypevr
20573
20574 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
20575 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF@. This makes sending those
20576 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
20577 FreeBSD@. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
20578 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
20579 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
20580 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20581 @end deftypevr
20582
20583 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
20584 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
20585 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
20586 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
20587 causes more disk I/O.
20588 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
20589 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
20590 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20591 @end deftypevr
20592
20593 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
20594 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
20595 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
20596 side effects.
20597 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20598 @end deftypevr
20599
20600 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
20601 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
20602 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
20603 the mail otherwise.
20604 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20605 @end deftypevr
20606
20607 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
20608 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
20609 available:
20610
20611 @table @code
20612 @item dotlock
20613 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
20614 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
20615 need write access to that directory.
20616 @item dotlock-try
20617 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
20618 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
20619 @item fcntl
20620 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
20621 @item flock
20622 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20623 @item lockf
20624 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20625 @end table
20626
20627 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
20628 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
20629 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
20630 them simultaneously.
20631 @end deftypevr
20632
20633 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
20634
20635 @end deftypevr
20636
20637 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
20638 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
20639 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
20640 @end deftypevr
20641
20642 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
20643 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
20644 override the lock file after this much time.
20645 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
20646 @end deftypevr
20647
20648 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
20649 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
20650 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
20651 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
20652 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
20653 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
20654 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
20655 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
20656 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
20657 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
20658 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20659 @end deftypevr
20660
20661 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
20662 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
20663 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
20664 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
20665 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20666 @end deftypevr
20667
20668 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
20669 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
20670 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
20671 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
20672 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
20673 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20674 @end deftypevr
20675
20676 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
20677 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
20678 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
20679 updated.
20680 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20681 @end deftypevr
20682
20683 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
20684 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
20685 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
20686 @end deftypevr
20687
20688 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
20689 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
20690 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
20691 disabled.
20692 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
20693 @end deftypevr
20694
20695 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
20696 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
20697 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
20698 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
20699 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20700 @end deftypevr
20701
20702 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
20703 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
20704 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
20705 don't support this for now.
20706
20707 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
20708
20709 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
20710 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20711 @end deftypevr
20712
20713 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
20714 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
20715 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
20716 externally.
20717 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
20718 @end deftypevr
20719
20720 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
20721 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
20722 @table @code
20723 @item posix
20724 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
20725 @item sis posix
20726 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
20727 @item sis-queue posix
20728 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
20729 @end table
20730 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
20731 @end deftypevr
20732
20733 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
20734 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
20735 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
20736 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
20737 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
20738 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
20739 @end deftypevr
20740
20741 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
20742
20743 Defaults to @samp{100}.
20744 @end deftypevr
20745
20746 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
20747
20748 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
20749 @end deftypevr
20750
20751 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
20752 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
20753 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
20754 before they eat up everything.
20755 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20756 @end deftypevr
20757
20758 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
20759 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
20760 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
20761 at all.
20762 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
20763 @end deftypevr
20764
20765 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
20766 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
20767 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
20768 processes.
20769 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
20770 @end deftypevr
20771
20772 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
20773 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
20774 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
20775 @end deftypevr
20776
20777 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
20778 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
20779 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
20780 @end deftypevr
20781
20782 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
20783 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
20784 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
20785 root.
20786 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
20787 @end deftypevr
20788
20789 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
20790 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
20791 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
20792 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
20793 instead to a different.
20794 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20795 @end deftypevr
20796
20797 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
20798 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
20799 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
20800 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
20801 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
20802 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20803 @end deftypevr
20804
20805 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
20806 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
20807 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20808 @end deftypevr
20809
20810 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
20811 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
20812 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
20813 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20814 @end deftypevr
20815
20816 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
20817 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
20818 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
20819 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
20820 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
20821 @end deftypevr
20822
20823 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
20824 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
20825 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
20826 @end deftypevr
20827
20828 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
20829 SSL ciphers to use.
20830 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
20831 @end deftypevr
20832
20833 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
20834 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
20835 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20836 @end deftypevr
20837
20838 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
20839 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
20840 %d expands to recipient domain.
20841 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
20842 @end deftypevr
20843
20844 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
20845 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
20846 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
20847 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20848 @end deftypevr
20849
20850 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
20851 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
20852 bouncing the mail.
20853 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20854 @end deftypevr
20855
20856 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
20857 Binary to use for sending mails.
20858 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
20859 @end deftypevr
20860
20861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
20862 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
20863 sendmail.
20864 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20865 @end deftypevr
20866
20867 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
20868 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
20869 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
20870 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
20871 @end deftypevr
20872
20873 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
20874 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
20875 variables:
20876
20877 @table @code
20878 @item %n
20879 CRLF
20880 @item %r
20881 reason
20882 @item %s
20883 original subject
20884 @item %t
20885 recipient
20886 @end table
20887 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
20888 @end deftypevr
20889
20890 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
20891 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
20892 address.
20893 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
20894 @end deftypevr
20895
20896 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
20897 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
20898 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
20899 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
20900 X-Original-To.
20901 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20902 @end deftypevr
20903
20904 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
20905 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
20906 it?.
20907 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20908 @end deftypevr
20909
20910 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
20911 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
20912 subscribed?.
20913 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20914 @end deftypevr
20915
20916 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
20917 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
20918 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
20919 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
20920 often.
20921 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
20922 @end deftypevr
20923
20924 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
20925 IMAP logout format string:
20926 @table @code
20927 @item %i
20928 total number of bytes read from client
20929 @item %o
20930 total number of bytes sent to client.
20931 @end table
20932 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
20933 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
20934 @end deftypevr
20935
20936 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
20937 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
20938 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
20939 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20940 @end deftypevr
20941
20942 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
20943 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
20944 is IDLEing.
20945 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
20946 @end deftypevr
20947
20948 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
20949 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
20950 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
20951 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
20952 support-email.
20953 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20954 @end deftypevr
20955
20956 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
20957 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
20958 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20959 @end deftypevr
20960
20961 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
20962 Workarounds for various client bugs:
20963
20964 @table @code
20965 @item delay-newmail
20966 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
20967 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
20968 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
20969 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
20970 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
20971 "Headers Only".
20972
20973 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
20974 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
20975 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
20976 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
20977
20978 @item tb-lsub-flags
20979 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
20980 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
20981 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
20982 @end table
20983 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20984 @end deftypevr
20985
20986 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
20987 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
20988 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20989 @end deftypevr
20990
20991
20992 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
20993 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
20994 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
20995 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
20996 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
20997
20998 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
20999 and running. In that case, you can pass an
21000 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
21001 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
21002 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
21003
21004 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
21005
21006 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
21007 The dovecot package.
21008 @end deftypevr
21009
21010 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
21011 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
21012 @end deftypevr
21013
21014 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
21015 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
21016
21017 @lisp
21018 (dovecot-service #:config
21019 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
21020 (string "")))
21021 @end lisp
21022
21023 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
21024
21025 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
21026 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
21027 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
21028 as in this example:
21029
21030 @lisp
21031 (service opensmtpd-service-type
21032 (opensmtpd-configuration
21033 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
21034 @end lisp
21035 @end deffn
21036
21037 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
21038 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
21039
21040 @table @asis
21041 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
21042 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
21043
21044 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
21045 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
21046 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
21047 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
21048 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
21049
21050 @end table
21051 @end deftp
21052
21053 @subsubheading Exim Service
21054
21055 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
21056 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
21057 @cindex SMTP
21058
21059 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
21060 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
21061 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
21062 as in this example:
21063
21064 @lisp
21065 (service exim-service-type
21066 (exim-configuration
21067 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
21068 @end lisp
21069 @end deffn
21070
21071 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
21072 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
21073 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
21074
21075 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
21076 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
21077
21078 @table @asis
21079 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
21080 Package object of the Exim server.
21081
21082 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
21083 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
21084 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
21085 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
21086 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
21087 variables.
21088
21089 @end table
21090 @end deftp
21091
21092 @subsubheading Getmail service
21093
21094 @cindex IMAP
21095 @cindex POP
21096
21097 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
21098 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
21099 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
21100 @end deffn
21101
21102 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
21103
21104 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
21105 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
21106
21107 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
21108
21109 @end deftypevr
21110
21111 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
21112 The getmail package to use.
21113
21114 @end deftypevr
21115
21116 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
21117 The user to run getmail as.
21118
21119 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21120
21121 @end deftypevr
21122
21123 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
21124 The group to run getmail as.
21125
21126 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21127
21128 @end deftypevr
21129
21130 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
21131 The getmail directory to use.
21132
21133 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
21134
21135 @end deftypevr
21136
21137 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
21138 The getmail configuration file to use.
21139
21140 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
21141
21142 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
21143 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
21144
21145 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
21146
21147 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
21148 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
21149 and @samp{static}.
21150
21151 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
21152
21153 @end deftypevr
21154
21155 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
21156 Username to login to the mail server with.
21157
21158 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21159
21160 @end deftypevr
21161
21162 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
21163 Username to login to the mail server with.
21164
21165 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21166
21167 @end deftypevr
21168
21169 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
21170 Port number to connect to.
21171
21172 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21173
21174 @end deftypevr
21175
21176 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
21177 Override fields from passwd.
21178
21179 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21180
21181 @end deftypevr
21182
21183 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
21184 Override fields from passwd.
21185
21186 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21187
21188 @end deftypevr
21189
21190 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
21191 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21192
21193 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21194
21195 @end deftypevr
21196
21197 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
21198 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21199
21200 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21201
21202 @end deftypevr
21203
21204 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
21205 CA certificates to use.
21206
21207 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21208
21209 @end deftypevr
21210
21211 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21212 Extra retriever parameters.
21213
21214 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21215
21216 @end deftypevr
21217
21218 @end deftypevr
21219
21220 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
21221 What to do with retrieved messages.
21222
21223 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
21224
21225 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
21226 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
21227 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
21228
21229 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21230
21231 @end deftypevr
21232
21233 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
21234 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
21235 chosen type.
21236
21237 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21238
21239 @end deftypevr
21240
21241 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21242 Extra destination parameters
21243
21244 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21245
21246 @end deftypevr
21247
21248 @end deftypevr
21249
21250 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
21251 Configure getmail.
21252
21253 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
21254
21255 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
21256 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
21257 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
21258 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
21259 about each of it's actions.
21260
21261 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21262
21263 @end deftypevr
21264
21265 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
21266 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
21267 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
21268
21269 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21270
21271 @end deftypevr
21272
21273 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
21274 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
21275 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
21276 be left on the server.
21277
21278 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21279
21280 @end deftypevr
21281
21282 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
21283 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
21284 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
21285 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
21286 disabled this feature.
21287
21288 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21289
21290 @end deftypevr
21291
21292 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
21293 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
21294 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
21295 disables this feature.
21296
21297 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21298
21299 @end deftypevr
21300
21301 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
21302 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
21303 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
21304
21305 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21306
21307 @end deftypevr
21308
21309 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
21310 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
21311 @samp{0} disables this feature.
21312
21313 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21314
21315 @end deftypevr
21316
21317 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
21318 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
21319
21320 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21321
21322 @end deftypevr
21323
21324 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
21325 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
21326
21327 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21328
21329 @end deftypevr
21330
21331 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
21332 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
21333 @samp{""} disables this feature.
21334
21335 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21336
21337 @end deftypevr
21338
21339 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
21340 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
21341 logger.
21342
21343 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21344
21345 @end deftypevr
21346
21347 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
21348 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
21349 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
21350 information lines.
21351
21352 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21353
21354 @end deftypevr
21355
21356 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21357 Extra options to include.
21358
21359 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21360
21361 @end deftypevr
21362
21363 @end deftypevr
21364
21365 @end deftypevr
21366
21367 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
21368 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
21369 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
21370 extension.
21371
21372 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21373
21374 @end deftypevr
21375
21376 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
21377 Environment variables to set for getmail.
21378
21379 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21380
21381 @end deftypevr
21382
21383 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
21384
21385 @cindex email aliases
21386 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
21387
21388 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
21389 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
21390 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
21391
21392 @lisp
21393 (service mail-aliases-service-type
21394 '(("postmaster" "bob")
21395 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
21396 @end lisp
21397 @end deffn
21398
21399 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
21400 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
21401 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
21402 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
21403 where to deliver this user's mail.
21404
21405 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
21406 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
21407 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
21408 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
21409 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
21410
21411 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21412 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21413
21414 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
21415 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
21416 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
21417 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
21418
21419 @lisp
21420 (service imap4d-service-type
21421 (imap4d-configuration
21422 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
21423 @end lisp
21424 @end deffn
21425
21426 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
21427 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
21428
21429 @table @asis
21430 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
21431 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
21432
21433 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
21434 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21435 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
21436 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
21437
21438 @end table
21439 @end deftp
21440
21441 @subsubheading Radicale Service
21442 @cindex CalDAV
21443 @cindex CardDAV
21444
21445 @deffn {Scheme Variable} radicale-service-type
21446 This is the type of the @uref{https://radicale.org, Radicale} CalDAV/CardDAV
21447 server whose value should be a @code{radicale-configuration}.
21448 @end deffn
21449
21450 @deftp {Data Type} radicale-configuration
21451 Data type representing the configuration of @command{radicale}.
21452
21453 @table @asis
21454 @item @code{package} (default: @code{radicale})
21455 The package that provides @command{radicale}.
21456
21457 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-radicale-config-file})
21458 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21459 on TCP port 5232 of @code{localhost} and use the @code{htpasswd} file at
21460 @file{/var/lib/radicale/users} with no (@code{plain}) encryption.
21461
21462 @end table
21463 @end deftp
21464
21465 @node Messaging Services
21466 @subsection Messaging Services
21467
21468 @cindex messaging
21469 @cindex jabber
21470 @cindex XMPP
21471 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
21472 definitions for messaging services. Currently it provides the following
21473 services:
21474
21475 @subsubheading Prosody Service
21476
21477 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
21478 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
21479 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
21480 record as in this example:
21481
21482 @lisp
21483 (service prosody-service-type
21484 (prosody-configuration
21485 (modules-enabled (cons* "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
21486 (int-components
21487 (list
21488 (int-component-configuration
21489 (hostname "conference.example.net")
21490 (plugin "muc")
21491 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
21492 (virtualhosts
21493 (list
21494 (virtualhost-configuration
21495 (domain "example.net"))))))
21496 @end lisp
21497
21498 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
21499
21500 @end deffn
21501
21502 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
21503 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
21504 Prosody to serve.
21505
21506 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
21507 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
21508
21509 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
21510 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
21511 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
21512
21513 @example
21514 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
21515 @end example
21516
21517 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
21518 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
21519 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
21520 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
21521 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21522
21523 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
21524 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
21525 some other system; see the end for more details.
21526
21527 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
21528 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
21529
21530 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21531 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
21532 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21533 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21534 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21535 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21536 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
21537
21538 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
21539
21540 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
21541 The Prosody package.
21542 @end deftypevr
21543
21544 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
21545 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
21546 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
21547 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
21548 @end deftypevr
21549
21550 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
21551 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
21552 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
21553 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21554 @end deftypevr
21555
21556 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
21557 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
21558 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
21559 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
21560 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
21561 @end deftypevr
21562
21563 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
21564 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
21565 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
21566 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21567 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
21568 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21569 @end deftypevr
21570
21571 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
21572 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
21573 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
21574 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21575 @end deftypevr
21576
21577 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
21578 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
21579 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
21580 Documentation on modules can be found at:
21581 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
21582 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
21583 @end deftypevr
21584
21585 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
21586 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
21587 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
21588 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21589 @end deftypevr
21590
21591 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
21592 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
21593 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
21594 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
21595 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
21596 @end deftypevr
21597
21598 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
21599 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
21600 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21601 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21602 @end deftypevr
21603
21604 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
21605 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
21606 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
21607 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
21608 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
21609
21610 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
21611
21612 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
21613 This determines what handshake to use.
21614 @end deftypevr
21615
21616 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
21617 Path to your private key file.
21618 @end deftypevr
21619
21620 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
21621 Path to your certificate file.
21622 @end deftypevr
21623
21624 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
21625 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
21626 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
21627 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
21628 @end deftypevr
21629
21630 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
21631 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
21632 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
21633 @end deftypevr
21634
21635 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
21636 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
21637 @code{set_verify()} flags).
21638 @end deftypevr
21639
21640 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
21641 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS@. These map to OpenSSL's
21642 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
21643 LuaSec source.
21644 @end deftypevr
21645
21646 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
21647 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
21648 trusted root certificate.
21649 @end deftypevr
21650
21651 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
21652 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
21653 clients, and in what order.
21654 @end deftypevr
21655
21656 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
21657 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
21658 can create such a file with:
21659 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
21660 @end deftypevr
21661
21662 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
21663 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
21664 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
21665 @end deftypevr
21666
21667 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
21668 A list of ``extra'' verification options.
21669 @end deftypevr
21670
21671 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
21672 Password for encrypted private keys.
21673 @end deftypevr
21674
21675 @end deftypevr
21676
21677 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
21678 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21679 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21680 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21681 @end deftypevr
21682
21683 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
21684 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
21685 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
21686 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
21687 @end deftypevr
21688
21689 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
21690 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21691 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21692 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21693 @end deftypevr
21694
21695 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
21696 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
21697 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
21698 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
21699 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21700 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21701 @end deftypevr
21702
21703 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
21704 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
21705 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
21706 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS@. See
21707 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21708 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21709 @end deftypevr
21710
21711 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
21712 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
21713 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
21714 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21715 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21716 @end deftypevr
21717
21718 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
21719 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
21720 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
21721 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
21722 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
21723 about using the hashed backend. See also
21724 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
21725 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
21726 @end deftypevr
21727
21728 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
21729 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
21730 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
21731 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
21732 @end deftypevr
21733
21734 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
21735 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
21736 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
21737 @end deftypevr
21738
21739 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
21740 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
21741 @end deftypevr
21742
21743 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
21744 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
21745 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
21746 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
21747 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
21748 @end deftypevr
21749
21750 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
21751 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
21752 example if you want your users to have addresses like
21753 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
21754 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
21755
21756 Note: the name @emph{virtual} host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
21757 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
21758 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
21759 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
21760 have just one VirtualHost entry.
21761
21762 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
21763
21764 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
21765
21766 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21767 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
21768 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
21769 @end deftypevr
21770
21771 @end deftypevr
21772
21773 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
21774 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
21775 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
21776 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
21777 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
21778
21779 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
21780 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
21781 to use for the component.
21782
21783 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
21784 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21785
21786 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
21787
21788 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21789 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21790 Hostname of the component.
21791 @end deftypevr
21792
21793 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
21794 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
21795 @end deftypevr
21796
21797 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
21798 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
21799 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
21800
21801 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
21802 in the ``Chatrooms'' documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
21803 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
21804
21805 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
21806
21807 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
21808
21809 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
21810 The name to return in service discovery responses.
21811 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
21812 @end deftypevr
21813
21814 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
21815 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
21816 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
21817 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
21818 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
21819 restricts to service administrators only.
21820 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21821 @end deftypevr
21822
21823 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
21824 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
21825 just joined the room.
21826 Defaults to @samp{20}.
21827 @end deftypevr
21828
21829 @end deftypevr
21830
21831 @end deftypevr
21832
21833 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
21834 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
21835 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
21836 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
21837 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21838
21839 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
21840
21841 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21842 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
21843 Password which the component will use to log in.
21844 @end deftypevr
21845
21846 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21847 Hostname of the component.
21848 @end deftypevr
21849
21850 @end deftypevr
21851
21852 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
21853 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
21854 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
21855 @end deftypevr
21856
21857 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
21858 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
21859 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
21860 @end deftypevr
21861
21862 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
21863 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
21864 @end deftypevr
21865
21866 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
21867 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
21868 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
21869 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
21870 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
21871 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
21872
21873 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
21874 The prosody package.
21875 @end deftypevr
21876
21877 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
21878 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
21879 @end deftypevr
21880
21881 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
21882 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
21883
21884 @lisp
21885 (service prosody-service-type
21886 (opaque-prosody-configuration
21887 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
21888 @end lisp
21889
21890 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
21891
21892 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
21893
21894 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
21895 @cindex IRC gateway
21896 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
21897 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
21898
21899 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
21900 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
21901 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
21902 below).
21903
21904 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
21905 services:
21906
21907 @lisp
21908 (service bitlbee-service-type)
21909 @end lisp
21910 @end defvr
21911
21912 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
21913 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
21914
21915 @table @asis
21916 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
21917 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
21918 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
21919 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
21920
21921 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
21922 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
21923 networking interface.
21924
21925 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
21926 The BitlBee package to use.
21927
21928 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
21929 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
21930
21931 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
21932 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
21933 @end table
21934 @end deftp
21935
21936 @subsubheading Quassel Service
21937
21938 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
21939 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
21940 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
21941 central core.
21942
21943 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
21944 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
21945 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
21946 (see below).
21947 @end defvr
21948
21949 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
21950 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
21951
21952 @table @asis
21953 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
21954 The Quassel package to use.
21955
21956 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
21957 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
21958 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
21959 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
21960 @var{port}.
21961
21962 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
21963 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
21964 and Error.
21965 @end table
21966 @end deftp
21967
21968 @node Telephony Services
21969 @subsection Telephony Services
21970
21971 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
21972 @cindex VoIP server
21973 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
21974 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
21975 (VoIP) suite.
21976
21977 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
21978 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
21979 look like this:
21980
21981 @lisp
21982 (service murmur-service-type
21983 (murmur-configuration
21984 (welcome-text
21985 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
21986 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
21987 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
21988 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
21989 @end lisp
21990
21991 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
21992 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
21993
21994 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
21995 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
21996 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
21997 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
21998 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
21999 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
22000 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
22001 rights and create some channels.
22002
22003 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
22004
22005 @table @asis
22006 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
22007 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
22008
22009 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22010 User who will run the Murmur server.
22011
22012 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22013 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
22014
22015 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
22016 Port on which the server will listen.
22017
22018 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
22019 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
22020
22021 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
22022 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
22023
22024 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
22025 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
22026
22027 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
22028 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
22029
22030 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
22031 File name of the sqlite database.
22032 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22033
22034 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
22035 File name of the log file.
22036 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22037
22038 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
22039 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
22040 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
22041
22042 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
22043 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
22044
22045 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
22046 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
22047 when violating the autoban limits.
22048
22049 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
22050 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
22051 before switching over to opus audio codec.
22052
22053 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
22054 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
22055
22056 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22057 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
22058
22059 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22060 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
22061
22062 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
22063 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
22064
22065 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
22066 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
22067
22068 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
22069 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
22070 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
22071
22072 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
22073 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
22074 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
22075
22076 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
22077 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
22078
22079 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
22080 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
22081 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
22082 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
22083
22084 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
22085
22086 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
22087 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
22088
22089 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
22090 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
22091
22092 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
22093 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
22094 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
22095 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
22096
22097 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
22098 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
22099
22100 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
22101 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
22102
22103 @lisp
22104 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
22105 @end lisp
22106 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
22107 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
22108 @lisp
22109 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
22110 @end lisp
22111
22112 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
22113 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
22114 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
22115 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
22116 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
22117
22118 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
22119 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
22120 in SSL/TLS.
22121
22122 This option is specified using
22123 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
22124 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
22125
22126 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
22127 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
22128 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
22129 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
22130
22131 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
22132 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
22133 to connect to it.
22134
22135 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
22136 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
22137
22138 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
22139 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
22140 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
22141 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
22142
22143 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
22144
22145 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
22146 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
22147 @end table
22148 @end deftp
22149
22150 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
22151 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
22152
22153 @table @asis
22154 @item @code{name}
22155 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
22156
22157 @item @code{password}
22158 A password to identify your registration.
22159 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
22160
22161 @item @code{url}
22162 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
22163 site.
22164
22165 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
22166 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
22167 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
22168 @end table
22169 @end deftp
22170
22171
22172
22173 @node Monitoring Services
22174 @subsection Monitoring Services
22175
22176 @subsubheading Tailon Service
22177
22178 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
22179 viewing and searching log files.
22180
22181 The following example will configure the service with default values.
22182 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
22183
22184 @lisp
22185 (service tailon-service-type)
22186 @end lisp
22187
22188 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
22189 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
22190
22191 @lisp
22192 (service tailon-service-type
22193 (tailon-configuration
22194 (config-file
22195 (tailon-configuration-file
22196 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
22197 @end lisp
22198
22199
22200 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
22201 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
22202 This type has the following parameters:
22203
22204 @table @asis
22205 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
22206 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
22207 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
22208 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
22209
22210 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
22211 can be used:
22212
22213 @lisp
22214 (service tailon-service-type
22215 (tailon-configuration
22216 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
22217 @end lisp
22218
22219 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
22220 The tailon package to use.
22221
22222 @end table
22223 @end deftp
22224
22225 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
22226 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
22227 This type has the following parameters:
22228
22229 @table @asis
22230 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
22231 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
22232 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
22233 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
22234 subsection.
22235
22236 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
22237 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
22238
22239 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
22240 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
22241
22242 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
22243 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
22244
22245 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
22246 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
22247
22248 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
22249 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
22250
22251 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
22252 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
22253
22254 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
22255 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
22256
22257 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
22258 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
22259 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
22260 wrap lines.
22261
22262 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
22263 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
22264 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
22265 @code{"basic"}.
22266
22267 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
22268 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
22269 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
22270 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
22271 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
22272
22273 @lisp
22274 (tailon-configuration-file
22275 (http-auth "basic")
22276 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
22277 ("user2" . "password2"))))
22278 @end lisp
22279
22280 @end table
22281 @end deftp
22282
22283
22284 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
22285 @cindex darkstat
22286 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
22287 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
22288
22289 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
22290 This is the service type for the
22291 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
22292 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
22293 this example:
22294
22295 @lisp
22296 (service darkstat-service-type
22297 (darkstat-configuration
22298 (interface "eno1")))
22299 @end lisp
22300 @end defvar
22301
22302 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
22303 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
22304
22305 @table @asis
22306 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
22307 The darkstat package to use.
22308
22309 @item @code{interface}
22310 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
22311
22312 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
22313 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
22314
22315 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
22316 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
22317
22318 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
22319 Specify the path of the base URL@. This can be useful if
22320 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
22321
22322 @end table
22323 @end deftp
22324
22325 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
22326
22327 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
22328 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
22329 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
22330 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
22331 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
22332
22333 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
22334 This is the service type for the
22335 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
22336 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}.
22337
22338 @lisp
22339 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type)
22340 @end lisp
22341 @end defvar
22342
22343 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
22344 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
22345
22346 @table @asis
22347 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
22348 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
22349
22350 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
22351 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
22352
22353 @item @code{textfile-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/prometheus/node-exporter"})
22354 This directory can be used to export metrics specific to this machine.
22355 Files containing metrics in the text format, with the filename ending in
22356 @code{.prom} should be placed in this directory.
22357
22358 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
22359 Extra options to pass to the Prometheus node exporter.
22360
22361 @end table
22362 @end deftp
22363
22364 @subsubheading Zabbix server
22365 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
22366 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
22367 and disk space consumption:
22368
22369 @itemize
22370 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
22371 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
22372 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
22373 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
22374 @item Native high performance agents.
22375 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
22376 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
22377 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
22378 @end itemize
22379
22380 @c %start of fragment
22381
22382 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
22383
22384 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
22385 The zabbix-server package.
22386
22387 @end deftypevr
22388
22389 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
22390 User who will run the Zabbix server.
22391
22392 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22393
22394 @end deftypevr
22395
22396 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
22397 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
22398
22399 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22400
22401 @end deftypevr
22402
22403 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
22404 Database host name.
22405
22406 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
22407
22408 @end deftypevr
22409
22410 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
22411 Database name.
22412
22413 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22414
22415 @end deftypevr
22416
22417 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
22418 Database user.
22419
22420 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22421
22422 @end deftypevr
22423
22424 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
22425 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
22426 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
22427
22428 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22429
22430 @end deftypevr
22431
22432 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
22433 Database port.
22434
22435 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
22436
22437 @end deftypevr
22438
22439 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
22440 Specifies where log messages are written to:
22441
22442 @itemize @bullet
22443 @item
22444 @code{system} - syslog.
22445
22446 @item
22447 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
22448
22449 @item
22450 @code{console} - standard output.
22451
22452 @end itemize
22453
22454 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22455
22456 @end deftypevr
22457
22458 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
22459 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
22460
22461 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
22462
22463 @end deftypevr
22464
22465 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
22466 Name of PID file.
22467
22468 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
22469
22470 @end deftypevr
22471
22472 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
22473 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
22474 certificate verification.
22475
22476 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
22477
22478 @end deftypevr
22479
22480 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
22481 Location of SSL client certificates.
22482
22483 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
22484
22485 @end deftypevr
22486
22487 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
22488 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
22489
22490 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22491
22492 @end deftypevr
22493
22494 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
22495 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
22496 configuration file.
22497
22498 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22499
22500 @end deftypevr
22501
22502 @c %end of fragment
22503
22504 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
22505 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
22506
22507 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
22508
22509 @c %start of fragment
22510
22511 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
22512
22513 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
22514 The zabbix-agent package.
22515
22516 @end deftypevr
22517
22518 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
22519 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
22520
22521 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22522
22523 @end deftypevr
22524
22525 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
22526 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
22527
22528 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22529
22530 @end deftypevr
22531
22532 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22533 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
22534 must match hostname as configured on the server.
22535
22536 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22537
22538 @end deftypevr
22539
22540 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
22541 Specifies where log messages are written to:
22542
22543 @itemize @bullet
22544 @item
22545 @code{system} - syslog.
22546
22547 @item
22548 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
22549
22550 @item
22551 @code{console} - standard output.
22552
22553 @end itemize
22554
22555 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22556
22557 @end deftypevr
22558
22559 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
22560 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
22561
22562 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
22563
22564 @end deftypevr
22565
22566 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
22567 Name of PID file.
22568
22569 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
22570
22571 @end deftypevr
22572
22573 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
22574 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
22575 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
22576 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
22577
22578 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
22579
22580 @end deftypevr
22581
22582 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
22583 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
22584 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
22585 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
22586
22587 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
22588
22589 @end deftypevr
22590
22591 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
22592 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
22593
22594 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22595
22596 @end deftypevr
22597
22598 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
22599 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
22600 configuration file.
22601
22602 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22603
22604 @end deftypevr
22605
22606 @c %end of fragment
22607
22608 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
22609 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
22610
22611 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
22612
22613 @c %start of fragment
22614
22615 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
22616
22617 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
22618 NGINX configuration.
22619
22620 @end deftypevr
22621
22622 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
22623 Database host name.
22624
22625 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
22626
22627 @end deftypevr
22628
22629 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
22630 Database port.
22631
22632 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
22633
22634 @end deftypevr
22635
22636 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
22637 Database name.
22638
22639 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22640
22641 @end deftypevr
22642
22643 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
22644 Database user.
22645
22646 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22647
22648 @end deftypevr
22649
22650 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
22651 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
22652
22653 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22654
22655 @end deftypevr
22656
22657 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
22658 Secret file containing the credentials for the Zabbix front-end. The value
22659 must be a local file name, not a G-expression. You are expected to create
22660 this file manually. Its contents will be copied into @file{zabbix.conf.php}
22661 as the value of @code{$DB['PASSWORD']}.
22662
22663 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22664
22665 @end deftypevr
22666
22667 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
22668 Zabbix server hostname.
22669
22670 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
22671
22672 @end deftypevr
22673
22674 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
22675 Zabbix server port.
22676
22677 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
22678
22679 @end deftypevr
22680
22681
22682 @c %end of fragment
22683
22684 @node Kerberos Services
22685 @subsection Kerberos Services
22686 @cindex Kerberos
22687
22688 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
22689 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
22690
22691 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
22692
22693 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
22694 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
22695 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
22696 operating system declaration.
22697 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
22698
22699 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
22700 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
22701 Other implementations have not been tested.
22702
22703 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
22704 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
22705 @end defvr
22706
22707 @noindent
22708 Here is an example of its use:
22709 @lisp
22710 (service krb5-service-type
22711 (krb5-configuration
22712 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
22713 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
22714 (realms (list
22715 (krb5-realm
22716 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
22717 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
22718 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
22719 (krb5-realm
22720 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
22721 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
22722 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
22723 @end lisp
22724
22725 @noindent
22726 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
22727 @itemize
22728 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
22729 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
22730 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
22731 specified by clients;
22732 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
22733 @end itemize
22734
22735 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
22736 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
22737 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
22738 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
22739 documentation.
22740
22741
22742 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
22743 @cindex realm, kerberos
22744 @table @asis
22745 @item @code{name}
22746 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
22747 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
22748 converted to upper case.
22749
22750 @item @code{admin-server}
22751 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
22752 running.
22753
22754 @item @code{kdc}
22755 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
22756 for the realm.
22757 @end table
22758 @end deftp
22759
22760 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
22761
22762 @table @asis
22763 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
22764 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
22765 known to be weak will be accepted.
22766
22767 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
22768 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
22769 realm for the client.
22770 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
22771 If this value is @code{#f}
22772 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
22773 such as @command{kinit}.
22774
22775 @item @code{realms}
22776 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
22777 access.
22778 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
22779 field.
22780 @end table
22781 @end deftp
22782
22783
22784 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
22785 @cindex pam-krb5
22786
22787 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
22788 management via Kerberos.
22789 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
22790 users using Kerberos.
22791
22792 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
22793 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
22794 @end defvr
22795
22796 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
22797 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
22798 This type has the following parameters:
22799 @table @asis
22800 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
22801 The pam-krb5 package to use.
22802
22803 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
22804 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
22805 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
22806 @end table
22807 @end deftp
22808
22809
22810 @node LDAP Services
22811 @subsection LDAP Services
22812 @cindex LDAP
22813 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
22814
22815 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
22816 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
22817 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
22818 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
22819 Switch} for detailed information.
22820
22821 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
22822 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
22823 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
22824
22825 @lisp
22826 (use-service-modules authentication)
22827 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
22828 ...
22829 (operating-system
22830 ...
22831 (services
22832 (cons*
22833 (service nslcd-service-type)
22834 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
22835 %base-services))
22836 (name-service-switch
22837 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
22838 (name-service (name "files"))
22839 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
22840 (name-service-switch
22841 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
22842 (password services)
22843 (shadow services)
22844 (group services)
22845 (netgroup services)
22846 (gshadow services)))))
22847 @end lisp
22848
22849 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
22850
22851 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
22852
22853 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
22854 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
22855
22856 @end deftypevr
22857
22858 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
22859 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
22860 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
22861 The default is to start 5 threads.
22862
22863 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22864
22865 @end deftypevr
22866
22867 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
22868 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
22869
22870 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
22871
22872 @end deftypevr
22873
22874 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
22875 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
22876
22877 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
22878
22879 @end deftypevr
22880
22881 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
22882 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
22883 SCHEME and LEVEL@. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols
22884 @samp{none} or @samp{syslog}, or an absolute file name. The LEVEL
22885 argument is optional and specifies the log level. The log level may be
22886 one of the following symbols: @samp{crit}, @samp{error}, @samp{warning},
22887 @samp{notice}, @samp{info} or @samp{debug}. All messages with the
22888 specified log level or higher are logged.
22889
22890 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
22891
22892 @end deftypevr
22893
22894 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
22895 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
22896 used with the following servers as fall-back.
22897
22898 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
22899
22900 @end deftypevr
22901
22902 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
22903 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
22904 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
22905
22906 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22907
22908 @end deftypevr
22909
22910 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
22911 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
22912 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
22913
22914 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22915
22916 @end deftypevr
22917
22918 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
22919 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
22920 applicable when used with binddn.
22921
22922 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22923
22924 @end deftypevr
22925
22926 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
22927 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
22928 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
22929
22930 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22931
22932 @end deftypevr
22933
22934 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
22935 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
22936 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
22937 rootpwmoddn
22938
22939 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22940
22941 @end deftypevr
22942
22943 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
22944 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
22945 authentication.
22946
22947 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22948
22949 @end deftypevr
22950
22951 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
22952 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
22953
22954 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22955
22956 @end deftypevr
22957
22958 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
22959 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
22960 authentication.
22961
22962 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22963
22964 @end deftypevr
22965
22966 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
22967 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
22968 authentication.
22969
22970 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22971
22972 @end deftypevr
22973
22974 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
22975 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
22976 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
22977 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
22978 performed or not.
22979
22980 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22981
22982 @end deftypevr
22983
22984 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
22985 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
22986
22987 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22988
22989 @end deftypevr
22990
22991 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
22992 The directory search base.
22993
22994 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
22995
22996 @end deftypevr
22997
22998 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
22999 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
23000 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
23001 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
23002
23003 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
23004
23005 @end deftypevr
23006
23007 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
23008 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
23009 to never dereference aliases.
23010
23011 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23012
23013 @end deftypevr
23014
23015 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
23016 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
23017 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
23018
23019 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23020
23021 @end deftypevr
23022
23023 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
23024 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
23025 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
23026 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
23027 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
23028
23029 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23030
23031 @end deftypevr
23032
23033 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
23034 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
23035 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
23036
23037 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23038
23039 @end deftypevr
23040
23041 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
23042 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
23043 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
23044
23045 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23046
23047 @end deftypevr
23048
23049 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
23050 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
23051 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
23052 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
23053
23054 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23055
23056 @end deftypevr
23057
23058 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
23059 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
23060 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
23061 out connections.
23062
23063 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23064
23065 @end deftypevr
23066
23067 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
23068 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
23069 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
23070 failure and the first retry.
23071
23072 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23073
23074 @end deftypevr
23075
23076 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
23077 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
23078 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
23079 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
23080
23081 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23082
23083 @end deftypevr
23084
23085 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
23086 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
23087 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
23088 SSL.
23089
23090 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23091
23092 @end deftypevr
23093
23094 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
23095 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
23096 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
23097
23098 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23099
23100 @end deftypevr
23101
23102 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
23103 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
23104 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
23105
23106 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23107
23108 @end deftypevr
23109
23110 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
23111 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
23112
23113 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23114
23115 @end deftypevr
23116
23117 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
23118 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
23119 using GnuTLS.
23120
23121 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23122
23123 @end deftypevr
23124
23125 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
23126 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
23127
23128 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23129
23130 @end deftypevr
23131
23132 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
23133 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
23134 client TLS authentication.
23135
23136 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23137
23138 @end deftypevr
23139
23140 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
23141 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
23142 authentication.
23143
23144 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23145
23146 @end deftypevr
23147
23148 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
23149 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
23150 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
23151 request paged results.
23152
23153 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23154
23155 @end deftypevr
23156
23157 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
23158 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
23159 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
23160 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
23161
23162 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23163
23164 @end deftypevr
23165
23166 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
23167 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
23168 the specified value are ignored.
23169
23170 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23171
23172 @end deftypevr
23173
23174 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
23175 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
23176 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
23177
23178 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23179
23180 @end deftypevr
23181
23182 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
23183 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
23184 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
23185
23186 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23187
23188 @end deftypevr
23189
23190 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
23191 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
23192 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
23193 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
23194 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
23195 groups.
23196
23197 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23198
23199 @end deftypevr
23200
23201 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
23202 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
23203 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
23204 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
23205 groups assigned on login.
23206
23207 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23208
23209 @end deftypevr
23210
23211 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
23212 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
23213 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
23214 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
23215 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
23216 most configurations.
23217
23218 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23219
23220 @end deftypevr
23221
23222 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
23223 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
23224 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
23225 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
23226
23227 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23228
23229 @end deftypevr
23230
23231 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
23232 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
23233 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
23234 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
23235 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
23236
23237 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23238
23239 @end deftypevr
23240
23241 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
23242 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
23243 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
23244
23245 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23246
23247 @end deftypevr
23248
23249 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
23250 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
23251 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
23252 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
23253 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
23254 It should return at least one entry.
23255
23256 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23257
23258 @end deftypevr
23259
23260 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
23261 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
23262 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
23263 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
23264
23265 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23266
23267 @end deftypevr
23268
23269 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
23270 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
23271 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
23272 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
23273 changing their password.
23274
23275 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23276
23277 @end deftypevr
23278
23279 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
23280 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
23281
23282 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23283
23284 @end deftypevr
23285
23286 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
23287
23288
23289 @node Web Services
23290 @subsection Web Services
23291
23292 @cindex web
23293 @cindex www
23294 @cindex HTTP
23295 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
23296 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
23297
23298 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
23299
23300 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
23301 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
23302 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
23303 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
23304
23305 A simple example configuration is given below.
23306
23307 @lisp
23308 (service httpd-service-type
23309 (httpd-configuration
23310 (config
23311 (httpd-config-file
23312 (server-name "www.example.com")
23313 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
23314 @end lisp
23315
23316 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
23317 the configuration.
23318
23319 @lisp
23320 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
23321 (list
23322 (httpd-virtualhost
23323 "*:80"
23324 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
23325 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
23326 "\n")))))
23327 @end lisp
23328 @end deffn
23329
23330 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
23331 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
23332 given below.
23333
23334 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
23335 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
23336
23337 @table @asis
23338 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
23339 The httpd package to use.
23340
23341 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
23342 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
23343
23344 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
23345 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
23346 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
23347 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
23348 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
23349
23350 @end table
23351 @end deffn
23352
23353 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
23354 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
23355
23356 @table @asis
23357 @item @code{name}
23358 The name of the module.
23359
23360 @item @code{file}
23361 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
23362 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
23363 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
23364 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
23365
23366 @end table
23367 @end deffn
23368
23369 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
23370 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
23371 @end defvr
23372
23373 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
23374 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
23375
23376 @table @asis
23377 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
23378 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
23379 additional configuration.
23380
23381 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
23382 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
23383
23384 @lisp
23385 (service httpd-service-type
23386 (httpd-configuration
23387 (config
23388 (httpd-config-file
23389 (modules (cons*
23390 (httpd-module
23391 (name "proxy_module")
23392 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
23393 (httpd-module
23394 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
23395 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
23396 %default-httpd-modules))
23397 (extra-config (list "\
23398 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
23399 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
23400 </FilesMatch>"))))))
23401 (service php-fpm-service-type
23402 (php-fpm-configuration
23403 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
23404 (socket-group "httpd")))
23405 @end lisp
23406
23407 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
23408 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
23409 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
23410 taken as relative to the server root.
23411
23412 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
23413 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
23414 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
23415 itself.
23416
23417 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
23418 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
23419 @code{ServerName}.
23420
23421 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
23422 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
23423
23424 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
23425 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
23426 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
23427 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
23428 protocol to use.
23429
23430 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
23431 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
23432 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
23433 configured correctly.
23434
23435 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
23436 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
23437
23438 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
23439 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
23440
23441 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
23442 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
23443
23444 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
23445 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
23446 of the configuration file.
23447
23448 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
23449 list.
23450
23451 @end table
23452 @end deffn
23453
23454 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
23455 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
23456
23457 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
23458
23459 @lisp
23460 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
23461 (list
23462 (httpd-virtualhost
23463 "*:80"
23464 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
23465 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
23466 "\n")))))
23467 @end lisp
23468
23469 @table @asis
23470 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
23471 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
23472
23473 @item @code{contents}
23474 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
23475 of strings and G-expressions.
23476
23477 @end table
23478 @end deffn
23479
23480 @subsubheading NGINX
23481
23482 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
23483 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
23484 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
23485
23486 A simple example configuration is given below.
23487
23488 @lisp
23489 (service nginx-service-type
23490 (nginx-configuration
23491 (server-blocks
23492 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23493 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
23494 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
23495 @end lisp
23496
23497 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
23498 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
23499 blocks, as in this example:
23500
23501 @lisp
23502 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
23503 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23504 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
23505 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
23506 @end lisp
23507 @end deffn
23508
23509 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
23510 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
23511 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
23512 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
23513 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
23514 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
23515 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
23516 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
23517
23518 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
23519 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
23520 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
23521 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
23522
23523 @table @asis
23524 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
23525 The nginx package to use.
23526
23527 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
23528 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
23529
23530 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
23531 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
23532 files.
23533
23534 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
23535 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
23536 file, the elements should be of type
23537 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
23538
23539 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
23540 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
23541 HTTPS.
23542 @lisp
23543 (service nginx-service-type
23544 (nginx-configuration
23545 (server-blocks
23546 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23547 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
23548 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
23549 @end lisp
23550
23551 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
23552 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
23553 file, the elements should be of type
23554 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
23555
23556 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
23557 when combined with @code{locations} in the
23558 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
23559 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
23560 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
23561 requests with two servers.
23562
23563 @lisp
23564 (service
23565 nginx-service-type
23566 (nginx-configuration
23567 (server-blocks
23568 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23569 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
23570 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
23571 (locations
23572 (list
23573 (nginx-location-configuration
23574 (uri "/path1")
23575 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
23576 (upstream-blocks
23577 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
23578 (name "server-proxy")
23579 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
23580 "server2.example.com")))))))
23581 @end lisp
23582
23583 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
23584 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
23585 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
23586 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
23587 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
23588 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
23589
23590 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
23591 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
23592 nginx-configuration record.
23593
23594 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
23595 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
23596 use the size of the processors cache line.
23597
23598 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
23599 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
23600
23601 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
23602 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
23603 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
23604
23605 @lisp
23606 (modules
23607 (list
23608 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
23609 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")
23610 (file-append nginx-lua-module "\
23611 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_lua_module.so")))
23612 @end lisp
23613
23614 @item @code{lua-package-path} (default: @code{'()})
23615 List of nginx lua packages to load. This should be a list of package
23616 names of loadable lua modules, as in this example:
23617
23618 @lisp
23619 (lua-package-path (list lua-resty-core
23620 lua-resty-lrucache
23621 lua-resty-signal
23622 lua-tablepool
23623 lua-resty-shell))
23624 @end lisp
23625
23626 @item @code{lua-package-cpath} (default: @code{'()})
23627 List of nginx lua C packages to load. This should be a list of package
23628 names of loadable lua C modules, as in this example:
23629
23630 @lisp
23631 (lua-package-cpath (list lua-resty-signal))
23632 @end lisp
23633
23634 @item @code{global-directives} (default: @code{'((events . ()))})
23635 Association list of global directives for the top level of the nginx
23636 configuration. Values may themselves be association lists.
23637
23638 @lisp
23639 (global-directives
23640 `((worker_processes . 16)
23641 (pcre_jit . on)
23642 (events . ((worker_connections . 1024)))))
23643 @end lisp
23644
23645 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
23646 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
23647 valued G-expression.
23648
23649 @end table
23650 @end deffn
23651
23652 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
23653 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
23654 This type has the following parameters:
23655
23656 @table @asis
23657 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
23658 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
23659 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
23660 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
23661 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
23662
23663 @lisp
23664 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
23665 @end lisp
23666
23667 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
23668 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
23669 default server for connections matching no other server.
23670
23671 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
23672 Root of the website nginx will serve.
23673
23674 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
23675 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
23676 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
23677 server block.
23678
23679 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
23680 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
23681 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
23682
23683 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
23684 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
23685 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
23686
23687 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
23688 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
23689 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
23690
23691 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
23692 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
23693 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
23694
23695 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
23696 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
23697
23698 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
23699 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
23700
23701 @end table
23702 @end deftp
23703
23704 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
23705 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
23706 block. This type has the following parameters:
23707
23708 @table @asis
23709 @item @code{name}
23710 Name for this group of servers.
23711
23712 @item @code{servers}
23713 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
23714 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
23715 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
23716 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
23717 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
23718 explicitly.
23719
23720 @end table
23721 @end deftp
23722
23723 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
23724 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
23725 block. This type has the following parameters:
23726
23727 @table @asis
23728 @item @code{uri}
23729 URI which this location block matches.
23730
23731 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
23732 @item @code{body}
23733 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
23734 many
23735 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
23736 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
23737 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
23738 http://upstream-name;")}.
23739
23740 @end table
23741 @end deftp
23742
23743 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
23744 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
23745 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
23746 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
23747 parameters:
23748
23749 @table @asis
23750 @item @code{name}
23751 Name to identify this location block.
23752
23753 @item @code{body}
23754 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
23755 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
23756 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
23757 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
23758
23759 @end table
23760 @end deftp
23761
23762 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
23763 @cindex Varnish
23764 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
23765 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
23766 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
23767 creates one request to the back-end.
23768
23769 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
23770 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
23771 @end defvr
23772
23773 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
23774 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
23775 This type has the following parameters:
23776
23777 @table @asis
23778 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
23779 The Varnish package to use.
23780
23781 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
23782 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
23783 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
23784 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
23785 directory name.
23786
23787 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
23788 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
23789
23790 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
23791 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
23792
23793 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
23794 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
23795 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
23796 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
23797 VCL syntax.
23798
23799 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
23800 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
23801 can do something along these lines:
23802
23803 @lisp
23804 (define %gnu-mirror
23805 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
23806 "vcl 4.1;
23807 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
23808
23809 (operating-system
23810 ;; @dots{}
23811 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
23812 (varnish-configuration
23813 (listen '(":80"))
23814 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
23815 %base-services)))
23816 @end lisp
23817
23818 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
23819 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
23820
23821 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
23822 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
23823 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
23824
23825 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
23826 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
23827
23828 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
23829 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
23830
23831 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
23832 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
23833
23834 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
23835 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
23836
23837 @end table
23838 @end deftp
23839
23840 @subsubheading Patchwork
23841 @cindex Patchwork
23842 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
23843 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
23844
23845 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
23846 Service type for Patchwork.
23847 @end defvr
23848
23849 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
23850 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
23851
23852 @lisp
23853 (service patchwork-service-type
23854 (patchwork-configuration
23855 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
23856 (settings-module
23857 (patchwork-settings-module
23858 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
23859 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
23860 (getmail-retriever-config
23861 (getmail-retriever-configuration
23862 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
23863 (server "imap.example.com")
23864 (port 993)
23865 (username "patchwork")
23866 (password-command
23867 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
23868 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
23869 (extra-parameters
23870 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
23871
23872 @end lisp
23873
23874 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
23875 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
23876 within the HTTPD service.
23877
23878 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
23879 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
23880 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
23881
23882 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
23883 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
23884 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
23885
23886 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
23887 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
23888 following parameters:
23889
23890 @table @asis
23891 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
23892 The Patchwork package to use.
23893
23894 @item @code{domain}
23895 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
23896 host.
23897
23898 @item @code{settings-module}
23899 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
23900 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
23901 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
23902 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
23903 store.
23904
23905 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
23906 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
23907
23908 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
23909 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
23910 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
23911 delivered to Patchwork.
23912
23913 @end table
23914 @end deftp
23915
23916 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
23917 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
23918 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
23919 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
23920 has the following parameters:
23921
23922 @table @asis
23923 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
23924 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
23925 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
23926
23927 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
23928 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
23929 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
23930
23931 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
23932 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
23933
23934 This setting relates to Django.
23935
23936 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
23937 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
23938 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
23939
23940 This is a Django setting.
23941
23942 @item @code{default-from-email}
23943 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
23944
23945 This is a Patchwork setting.
23946
23947 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
23948 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
23949 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
23950
23951 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
23952 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
23953
23954 This is a Django setting.
23955
23956 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
23957 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
23958 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
23959
23960 This is a Django setting.
23961
23962 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
23963 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
23964 messages will be shown.
23965
23966 This is a Django setting.
23967
23968 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
23969 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
23970
23971 This is a Patchwork setting.
23972
23973 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
23974 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
23975
23976 This is a Patchwork setting.
23977
23978 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
23979 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
23980
23981 This is a Patchwork setting.
23982
23983 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
23984 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
23985
23986 @end table
23987 @end deftp
23988
23989 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
23990 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
23991
23992 @table @asis
23993 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
23994 The database engine to use.
23995
23996 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
23997 The name of the database to use.
23998
23999 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24000 The user to connect to the database as.
24001
24002 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
24003 The password to use when connecting to the database.
24004
24005 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
24006 The host to make the database connection to.
24007
24008 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
24009 The port on which to connect to the database.
24010
24011 @end table
24012 @end deftp
24013
24014 @subsubheading Mumi
24015
24016 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
24017 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
24018 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
24019 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
24020 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
24021 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
24022
24023 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
24024 This is the service type for Mumi.
24025 @end defvr
24026
24027 @deftp {Data Type} mumi-configuration
24028 Data type representing the Mumi service configuration. This type has the
24029 following fields:
24030
24031 @table @asis
24032 @item @code{mumi} (default: @code{mumi})
24033 The Mumi package to use.
24034
24035 @item @code{mailer?} (default: @code{#true})
24036 Whether to enable or disable the mailer component.
24037
24038 @item @code{mumi-configuration-sender}
24039 The email address used as the sender for comments.
24040
24041 @item @code{mumi-configuration-smtp}
24042 A URI to configure the SMTP settings for Mailutils. This could be
24043 something like @code{sendmail:///path/to/bin/msmtp} or any other URI
24044 supported by Mailutils. @xref{SMTP Mailboxes, SMTP Mailboxes,,
24045 mailutils, GNU@tie{}Mailutils}.
24046
24047 @end table
24048 @end deftp
24049
24050
24051 @subsubheading FastCGI
24052 @cindex fastcgi
24053 @cindex fcgiwrap
24054 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
24055 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
24056 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
24057 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
24058 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
24059 support for it in Guix.
24060
24061 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
24062 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
24063 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
24064 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
24065 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
24066 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
24067
24068 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
24069 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
24070 @end defvr
24071
24072 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
24073 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
24074 This type has the following parameters:
24075 @table @asis
24076 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
24077 The fcgiwrap package to use.
24078
24079 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
24080 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
24081 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
24082 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
24083 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
24084 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
24085
24086 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
24087 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
24088 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
24089 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
24090 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
24091 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
24092
24093 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
24094 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
24095 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
24096 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
24097 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
24098 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
24099 @end table
24100 @end deftp
24101
24102 @cindex php-fpm
24103 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
24104 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
24105
24106 These features include:
24107 @itemize @bullet
24108 @item Adaptive process spawning
24109 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
24110 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
24111 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
24112 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
24113 @item Stdout & stderr logging
24114 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
24115 @item Accelerated upload support
24116 @item Support for a "slowlog"
24117 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
24118 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
24119 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
24120 @end itemize
24121 ...@: and much more.
24122
24123 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
24124 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
24125 @end defvr
24126
24127 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
24128 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
24129 @table @asis
24130 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
24131 The php package to use.
24132 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
24133 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
24134 @table @asis
24135 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
24136 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
24137 @item @code{"port"}
24138 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
24139 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
24140 Listen on a unix socket.
24141 @end table
24142
24143 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
24144 User who will own the php worker processes.
24145 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
24146 Group of the worker processes.
24147 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
24148 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
24149 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
24150 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
24151 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
24152 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
24153 once the service has started.
24154 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
24155 Log for the php-fpm master process.
24156 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
24157 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
24158 Must be one of:
24159 @table @asis
24160 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
24161 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
24162 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
24163 @end table
24164 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
24165 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
24166 and displayed in their browsers.
24167 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
24168 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
24169 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
24170 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
24171 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
24172 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
24173 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
24174 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
24175 An optional override of the whole configuration.
24176 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
24177 @item @code{php-ini-file} (default @code{#f})
24178 An optional override of the default php settings.
24179 It may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
24180 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
24181
24182 For local development it is useful to set a higher timeout and memory
24183 limit for spawned php processes. This be accomplished with the
24184 following operating system configuration snippet:
24185 @lisp
24186 (define %local-php-ini
24187 (plain-file "php.ini"
24188 "memory_limit = 2G
24189 max_execution_time = 1800"))
24190
24191 (operating-system
24192 ;; @dots{}
24193 (services (cons (service php-fpm-service-type
24194 (php-fpm-configuration
24195 (php-ini-file %local-php-ini)))
24196 %base-services)))
24197 @end lisp
24198
24199 Consult the @url{https://www.php.net/manual/en/ini.core.php,core php.ini
24200 directives} for comprehensive documentation on the acceptable
24201 @file{php.ini} directives.
24202 @end table
24203 @end deftp
24204
24205 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
24206 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
24207 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
24208 based on it's configured limits.
24209 @table @asis
24210 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
24211 Maximum of worker processes.
24212 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
24213 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
24214 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
24215 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
24216 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
24217 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
24218 @end table
24219 @end deftp
24220
24221 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
24222 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
24223 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
24224 are created.
24225 @table @asis
24226 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
24227 Maximum of worker processes.
24228 @end table
24229 @end deftp
24230
24231 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
24232 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
24233 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
24234 requests arrive.
24235 @table @asis
24236 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
24237 Maximum of worker processes.
24238 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
24239 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
24240 @end table
24241 @end deftp
24242
24243
24244 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-location @
24245 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
24246 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
24247 (version-major (package-version php)) @
24248 "-fpm.sock")]
24249 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
24250 @end deffn
24251
24252 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
24253 @lisp
24254 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
24255 (service php-fpm-service-type)
24256 (service nginx-service-type
24257 (nginx-server-configuration
24258 (server-name '("example.com"))
24259 (root "/srv/http/")
24260 (locations
24261 (list (nginx-php-location)))
24262 (listen '("80"))
24263 (ssl-certificate #f)
24264 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
24265 %base-services))
24266 @end lisp
24267
24268 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
24269 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
24270 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
24271 the hash of a user's email address.
24272
24273 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
24274 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
24275 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
24276 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
24277 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
24278 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
24279 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
24280 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
24281 @end deffn
24282
24283 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
24284 @lisp
24285 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
24286 #:configuration
24287 (nginx-server-configuration
24288 (server-name '("example.com"))))
24289 ...
24290 %base-services))
24291 @end lisp
24292
24293 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
24294
24295 @cindex hpcguix-web
24296 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
24297 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
24298 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
24299 clusters.
24300
24301 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
24302 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
24303 @end defvr
24304
24305 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
24306 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
24307
24308 @table @asis
24309 @item @code{specs}
24310 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
24311 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
24312
24313 @table @asis
24314 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
24315 The page title prefix.
24316
24317 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
24318 The @command{guix} command.
24319
24320 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
24321 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
24322
24323 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
24324 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
24325
24326 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
24327 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
24328
24329 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
24330 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
24331
24332 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
24333 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
24334 the latest instances of the given channels.
24335 @end table
24336
24337 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
24338 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
24339 complete example}.
24340
24341 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
24342 The hpcguix-web package to use.
24343 @end table
24344 @end deftp
24345
24346 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
24347
24348 @lisp
24349 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
24350 (hpcguix-web-configuration
24351 (specs
24352 #~(define site-config
24353 (hpcweb-configuration
24354 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
24355 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
24356 @end lisp
24357
24358 @quotation Note
24359 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
24360 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
24361 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
24362 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
24363
24364 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
24365 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
24366 more information on X.509 certificates.
24367 @end quotation
24368
24369 @subsubheading gmnisrv
24370
24371 @cindex gmnisrv
24372 The @uref{https://git.sr.ht/~sircmpwn/gmnisrv, gmnisrv} program is a
24373 simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini} protocol server.
24374
24375 @deffn {Scheme Variable} gmnisrv-service-type
24376 This is the type of the gmnisrv service, whose value should be a
24377 @code{gmnisrv-configuration} object, as in this example:
24378
24379 @lisp
24380 (service gmnisrv-service-type
24381 (gmnisrv-configuration
24382 (config-file (local-file "./my-gmnisrv.ini"))))
24383 @end lisp
24384 @end deffn
24385
24386 @deftp {Data Type} gmnisrv-configuration
24387 Data type representing the configuration of gmnisrv.
24388
24389 @table @asis
24390 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gmnisrv})
24391 Package object of the gmnisrv server.
24392
24393 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-gmnisrv-config-file})
24394 File-like object of the gmnisrv configuration file to use. The default
24395 configuration listens on port 1965 and serves files from
24396 @file{/srv/gemini}. Certificates are stored in
24397 @file{/var/lib/gemini/certs}. For more information, run @command{man
24398 gmnisrv} and @command{man gmnisrv.ini}.
24399
24400 @end table
24401 @end deftp
24402
24403 @node Certificate Services
24404 @subsection Certificate Services
24405
24406 @cindex Web
24407 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
24408 @cindex Let's Encrypt
24409 @cindex TLS certificates
24410 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
24411 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
24412 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
24413 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
24414 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
24415 authenticity.
24416
24417 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
24418 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
24419 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
24420 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
24421 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
24422 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
24423 response over HTTP@. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
24424 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
24425 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
24426 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
24427 signature.
24428
24429 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
24430 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
24431 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
24432 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
24433 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
24434 with different permissions).
24435
24436 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
24437 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
24438 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
24439 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
24440 some reason.
24441
24442 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
24443 can be found there:
24444 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
24445
24446 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
24447 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
24448 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
24449
24450 @lisp
24451 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
24452 (program-file
24453 "nginx-deploy-hook"
24454 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
24455 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
24456
24457 (service certbot-service-type
24458 (certbot-configuration
24459 (email "foo@@example.net")
24460 (certificates
24461 (list
24462 (certificate-configuration
24463 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
24464 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
24465 (certificate-configuration
24466 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
24467 @end lisp
24468
24469 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
24470 @end defvr
24471
24472 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
24473 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
24474 This type has the following parameters:
24475
24476 @table @asis
24477 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
24478 The certbot package to use.
24479
24480 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
24481 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
24482 files.
24483
24484 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
24485 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
24486 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
24487 and several @code{domains}.
24488
24489 @item @code{email} (default: @code{#f})
24490 Optional email address used for registration and recovery contact.
24491 Setting this is encouraged as it allows you to receive important
24492 notifications about the account and issued certificates.
24493
24494 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
24495 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
24496 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
24497
24498 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
24499 Size of the RSA key.
24500
24501 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
24502 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
24503 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
24504 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
24505 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
24506 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
24507 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
24508 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
24509 these nginx configuration data types.
24510
24511 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
24512 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
24513 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
24514
24515 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
24516 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
24517 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
24518
24519 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
24520 @end table
24521 @end deftp
24522
24523 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
24524 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
24525 This type has the following parameters:
24526
24527 @table @asis
24528 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
24529 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
24530 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
24531 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
24532
24533 Its default is the first provided domain.
24534
24535 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
24536 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
24537 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
24538
24539 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
24540 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
24541 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
24542 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
24543 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
24544 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
24545 requesting machine.
24546
24547 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
24548 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
24549 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
24550 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
24551 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
24552 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
24553
24554 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
24555 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
24556 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
24557 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
24558 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
24559 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
24560
24561 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
24562 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
24563 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
24564 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
24565 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
24566 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
24567 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
24568 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
24569
24570 @end table
24571 @end deftp
24572
24573 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
24574 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
24575 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
24576 @node DNS Services
24577 @subsection DNS Services
24578 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
24579 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
24580
24581 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
24582 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
24583 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
24584 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
24585 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
24586 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
24587
24588 @subsubheading Knot Service
24589
24590 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
24591 and one slave, is:
24592
24593 @lisp
24594 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
24595 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
24596 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
24597 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
24598 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
24599
24600 (define master-zone
24601 (knot-zone-configuration
24602 (domain "example.org")
24603 (zone (zone-file
24604 (origin "example.org")
24605 (entries example.org.zone)))))
24606
24607 (define slave-zone
24608 (knot-zone-configuration
24609 (domain "plop.org")
24610 (dnssec-policy "default")
24611 (master (list "plop-master"))))
24612
24613 (define plop-master
24614 (knot-remote-configuration
24615 (id "plop-master")
24616 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
24617
24618 (operating-system
24619 ;; ...
24620 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
24621 (knot-configuration
24622 (remotes (list plop-master))
24623 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
24624 ;; ...
24625 %base-services)))
24626 @end lisp
24627
24628 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
24629 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
24630
24631 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
24632 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
24633 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
24634 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
24635 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
24636 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
24637 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
24638
24639 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
24640 @end deffn
24641
24642 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
24643 Data type representing a key.
24644 This type has the following parameters:
24645
24646 @table @asis
24647 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24648 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
24649 be unique and must not be empty.
24650
24651 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
24652 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
24653 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
24654 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
24655
24656 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
24657 The secret key itself.
24658
24659 @end table
24660 @end deftp
24661
24662 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
24663 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
24664 This type has the following parameters:
24665
24666 @table @asis
24667 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24668 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
24669 unique and must not be empty.
24670
24671 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
24672 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
24673 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
24674 address match is not required.
24675
24676 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
24677 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
24678 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
24679 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
24680
24681 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
24682 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL@. Possible
24683 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
24684 and @code{'update}.
24685
24686 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
24687 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
24688 false, listed actions are allowed.
24689
24690 @end table
24691 @end deftp
24692
24693 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
24694 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
24695 This type has the following parameters:
24696
24697 @table @asis
24698 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
24699 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
24700 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
24701 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
24702 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
24703 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
24704
24705 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
24706 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
24707
24708 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
24709 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
24710 partially @code{"CH"}.
24711
24712 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
24713 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
24714 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
24715 defined.
24716
24717 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
24718 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
24719 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
24720 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
24721
24722 @end table
24723 @end deftp
24724
24725 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
24726 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
24727 This type has the following parameters:
24728
24729 @table @asis
24730 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
24731 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
24732 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
24733 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
24734 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
24735 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
24736 field of the @code{zone-file}.
24737
24738 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
24739 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
24740
24741 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
24742 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
24743 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
24744 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
24745 to an IP address in the list of entries.
24746
24747 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
24748 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
24749 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
24750
24751 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
24752 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
24753 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
24754 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
24755
24756 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
24757 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
24758 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
24759 @code{(string->duration)}.
24760
24761 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
24762 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
24763 to do so a first time.
24764
24765 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
24766 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
24767 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
24768 and check again that it still exists.
24769
24770 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
24771 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
24772 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
24773
24774 @end table
24775 @end deftp
24776
24777 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
24778 Data type representing a remote configuration.
24779 This type has the following parameters:
24780
24781 @table @asis
24782 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24783 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
24784 be unique and must not be empty.
24785
24786 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
24787 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
24788 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
24789 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
24790
24791 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
24792 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
24793 an appropriate source IP@. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
24794 The default is to choose at random.
24795
24796 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
24797 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
24798 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
24799
24800 @end table
24801 @end deftp
24802
24803 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
24804 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
24805 This type has the following parameters:
24806
24807 @table @asis
24808 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24809 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
24810
24811 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
24812 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
24813
24814 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
24815 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
24816 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
24817 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
24818
24819 @end table
24820 @end deftp
24821
24822 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
24823 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
24824 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
24825 use keys that you generate.
24826
24827 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
24828 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
24829 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
24830 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
24831 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
24832 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
24833
24834 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
24835 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
24836 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
24837 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
24838 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
24839
24840 This type has the following parameters:
24841
24842 @table @asis
24843 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24844 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
24845
24846 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
24847 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
24848 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
24849 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
24850 was setup by this service).
24851
24852 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
24853 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
24854
24855 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
24856 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
24857
24858 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
24859 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
24860
24861 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
24862 The length of the KSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
24863 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
24864
24865 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
24866 The length of the ZSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
24867 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
24868
24869 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
24870 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
24871 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
24872
24873 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
24874 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
24875
24876 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
24877 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
24878 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
24879
24880 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
24881 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
24882
24883 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
24884 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
24885
24886 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
24887 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
24888
24889 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
24890 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
24891
24892 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
24893 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
24894 name before hashing.
24895
24896 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
24897 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
24898
24899 @end table
24900 @end deftp
24901
24902 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
24903 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
24904 This type has the following parameters:
24905
24906 @table @asis
24907 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
24908 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
24909
24910 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
24911 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
24912 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
24913
24914 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
24915 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
24916 must contain a zone-file record.
24917
24918 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
24919 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
24920 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
24921
24922 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
24923 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
24924 masters.
24925
24926 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
24927 A list of slave remote identifiers.
24928
24929 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
24930 A list of acl identifiers.
24931
24932 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
24933 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
24934
24935 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
24936 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
24937
24938 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
24939 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
24940 synchronization.
24941
24942 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
24943 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
24944 are:
24945
24946 @itemize
24947 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
24948 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
24949 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
24950 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
24951 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
24952 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
24953 automatically.
24954 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
24955 @end itemize
24956
24957 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
24958 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
24959 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
24960 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
24961 default value from Knot is used.
24962
24963 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
24964 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
24965 so the default value from Knot is used.
24966
24967 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
24968 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
24969 default value from Knot is used.
24970
24971 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
24972 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
24973 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
24974 value from Knot is used.
24975
24976 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
24977 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
24978 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
24979 on this zone.
24980
24981 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
24982 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
24983
24984 @end table
24985 @end deftp
24986
24987 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
24988 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
24989 This type has the following parameters:
24990
24991 @table @asis
24992 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
24993 The Knot package.
24994
24995 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
24996 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
24997
24998 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
24999 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
25000 included at the top of the configuration file.
25001
25002 @cindex secrets, Knot service
25003 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
25004 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
25005 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
25006 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
25007 to the @code{includes} list.
25008
25009 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
25010 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
25011 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
25012 tsig key:
25013
25014 @example
25015 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
25016 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
25017 @end example
25018
25019 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
25020 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
25021 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
25022 to that key.
25023
25024 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
25025
25026 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
25027 An ip address on which to listen.
25028
25029 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
25030 An ip address on which to listen.
25031
25032 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
25033 A port on which to listen.
25034
25035 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
25036 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
25037
25038 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
25039 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
25040
25041 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
25042 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
25043
25044 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
25045 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
25046
25047 @end table
25048 @end deftp
25049
25050 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
25051
25052 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
25053 This is the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
25054 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
25055
25056 @lisp
25057 (service knot-resolver-service-type
25058 (knot-resolver-configuration
25059 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
25060 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
25061 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
25062 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
25063 cache.size = 100 * MB
25064 "))))
25065 @end lisp
25066
25067 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
25068 @end deffn
25069
25070 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
25071 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
25072
25073 @table @asis
25074 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
25075 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
25076
25077 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
25078 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
25079 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
25080
25081 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
25082 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
25083
25084 @end table
25085 @end deftp
25086
25087
25088 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
25089
25090 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
25091 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
25092 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
25093
25094 @lisp
25095 (service dnsmasq-service-type
25096 (dnsmasq-configuration
25097 (no-resolv? #t)
25098 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
25099 @end lisp
25100 @end deffn
25101
25102 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
25103 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
25104
25105 @table @asis
25106 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
25107 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
25108
25109 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
25110 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
25111
25112 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
25113 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
25114 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
25115
25116 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
25117 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
25118 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
25119
25120 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
25121 Listen on the given IP addresses.
25122
25123 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
25124 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
25125
25126 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
25127 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
25128
25129 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
25130 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
25131
25132 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'()})
25133 For each entry, specify an IP address to return for any host in the
25134 given domains. Queries in the domains are never forwarded and always
25135 replied to with the specified IP address.
25136
25137 This is useful for redirecting hosts locally, for example:
25138
25139 @lisp
25140 (service dnsmasq-service-type
25141 (dnsmasq-configuration
25142 (addresses
25143 '(; Redirect to a local web-server.
25144 "/example.org/127.0.0.1"
25145 ; Redirect subdomain to a specific IP.
25146 "/subdomain.example.org/192.168.1.42"))))
25147 @end lisp
25148
25149 Note that rules in @file{/etc/hosts} take precedence over this.
25150
25151 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
25152 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
25153 disables caching.
25154
25155 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
25156 When false, disable negative caching.
25157
25158 @item @code{tftp-enable?} (default: @code{#f})
25159 Whether to enable the built-in TFTP server.
25160
25161 @item @code{tftp-no-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
25162 If true, does not fail dnsmasq if the TFTP server could not start up.
25163
25164 @item @code{tftp-single-port?} (default: @code{#f})
25165 Whether to use only one single port for TFTP.
25166
25167 @item @code{tftp-secure?} (default: @code{#f})
25168 If true, only files owned by the user running the dnsmasq process are accessible.
25169
25170 If dnsmasq is being run as root, different rules apply:
25171 @code{tftp-secure?} has no effect, but only files which have the
25172 world-readable bit set are accessible.
25173
25174 @item @code{tftp-max} (default: @code{#f})
25175 If set, sets the maximal number of concurrent connections allowed.
25176
25177 @item @code{tftp-mtu} (default: @code{#f})
25178 If set, sets the MTU for TFTP packets to that value.
25179
25180 @item @code{tftp-no-blocksize?} (default: @code{#f})
25181 If true, stops the TFTP server from negotiating the blocksize with a client.
25182
25183 @item @code{tftp-lowercase?} (default: @code{#f})
25184 Whether to convert all filenames in TFTP requests to lowercase.
25185
25186 @item @code{tftp-port-range} (default: @code{#f})
25187 If set, fixes the dynamical ports (one per client) to the given range
25188 (@code{"<start>,<end>"}).
25189
25190 @item @code{tftp-root} (default: @code{/var/empty,lo})
25191 Look for files to transfer using TFTP relative to the given directory.
25192 When this is set, TFTP paths which include @samp{..} are rejected, to stop clients
25193 getting outside the specified root. Absolute paths (starting with @samp{/}) are
25194 allowed, but they must be within the TFTP-root. If the optional interface
25195 argument is given, the directory is only used for TFTP requests via that
25196 interface.
25197
25198 @item @code{tftp-unique-root} (default: @code{#f})
25199 If set, add the IP or hardware address of the TFTP client as a path component
25200 on the end of the TFTP-root. Only valid if a TFTP root is set and the
25201 directory exists. Defaults to adding IP address (in standard dotted-quad
25202 format).
25203
25204 For instance, if @option{--tftp-root} is @samp{/tftp} and client
25205 @samp{1.2.3.4} requests file @file{myfile} then the effective path will
25206 be @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4/myfile} if @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4} exists or
25207 @file{/tftp/myfile} otherwise. When @samp{=mac} is specified it will
25208 append the MAC address instead, using lowercase zero padded digits
25209 separated by dashes, e.g.: @samp{01-02-03-04-aa-bb}. Note that
25210 resolving MAC addresses is only possible if the client is in the local
25211 network or obtained a DHCP lease from dnsmasq.
25212
25213 @end table
25214 @end deftp
25215
25216 @subsubheading ddclient Service
25217
25218 @cindex ddclient
25219 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
25220 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
25221 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
25222
25223 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
25224 configuration:
25225
25226 @lisp
25227 (service ddclient-service-type)
25228 @end lisp
25229
25230 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
25231 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
25232 @code{secret-file} below). You are expected to create this file manually, in
25233 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
25234 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
25235 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}). See the examples in the
25236 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
25237
25238 @c %start of fragment
25239
25240 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
25241
25242 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
25243 The ddclient package.
25244
25245 @end deftypevr
25246
25247 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
25248 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
25249
25250 Defaults to @samp{300}.
25251
25252 @end deftypevr
25253
25254 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
25255 Use syslog for the output.
25256
25257 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25258
25259 @end deftypevr
25260
25261 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
25262 Mail to user.
25263
25264 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
25265
25266 @end deftypevr
25267
25268 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
25269 Mail failed update to user.
25270
25271 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
25272
25273 @end deftypevr
25274
25275 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
25276 The ddclient PID file.
25277
25278 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
25279
25280 @end deftypevr
25281
25282 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
25283 Enable SSL support.
25284
25285 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25286
25287 @end deftypevr
25288
25289 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
25290 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
25291 program.
25292
25293 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
25294
25295 @end deftypevr
25296
25297 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
25298 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
25299
25300 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
25301
25302 @end deftypevr
25303
25304 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
25305 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
25306 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
25307 create it manually.
25308
25309 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
25310
25311 @end deftypevr
25312
25313 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
25314 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
25315
25316 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25317
25318 @end deftypevr
25319
25320
25321 @c %end of fragment
25322
25323
25324 @node VPN Services
25325 @subsection VPN Services
25326 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
25327 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
25328
25329 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
25330 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
25331 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
25332 to host a VPN@. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
25333
25334 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
25335 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
25336
25337 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
25338 @end deffn
25339
25340 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
25341 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
25342
25343 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
25344
25345 Both can be run simultaneously.
25346 @end deffn
25347
25348 @c %automatically generated documentation
25349
25350 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
25351
25352 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
25353 The OpenVPN package.
25354
25355 @end deftypevr
25356
25357 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
25358 The OpenVPN pid file.
25359
25360 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
25361
25362 @end deftypevr
25363
25364 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
25365 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
25366 servers.
25367
25368 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
25369
25370 @end deftypevr
25371
25372 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
25373 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
25374
25375 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
25376
25377 @end deftypevr
25378
25379 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
25380 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
25381 it to @code{'disabled}.
25382
25383 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
25384 The certificate authority to check connections against.
25385
25386 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
25387
25388 @end deftypevr
25389
25390 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
25391 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
25392 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
25393
25394 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
25395
25396 @end deftypevr
25397
25398 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
25399 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
25400 certificate is @code{cert}.
25401
25402 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
25403
25404 @end deftypevr
25405
25406 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
25407 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
25408
25409 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25410
25411 @end deftypevr
25412
25413 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
25414 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
25415
25416 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25417
25418 @end deftypevr
25419
25420 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
25421 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
25422 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
25423
25424 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25425
25426 @end deftypevr
25427
25428 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
25429 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
25430 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
25431
25432 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25433 @end deftypevr
25434
25435 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
25436 Verbosity level.
25437
25438 Defaults to @samp{3}.
25439
25440 @end deftypevr
25441
25442 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
25443 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
25444 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
25445
25446 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25447
25448 @end deftypevr
25449
25450 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
25451 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
25452 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
25453 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
25454
25455 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
25456 @end deftypevr
25457
25458 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
25459 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
25460
25461 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25462
25463 @end deftypevr
25464
25465 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
25466 Bind to a specific local port number.
25467
25468 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25469
25470 @end deftypevr
25471
25472 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
25473 Retry resolving server address.
25474
25475 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25476
25477 @end deftypevr
25478
25479 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
25480 A list of remote servers to connect to.
25481
25482 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25483
25484 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
25485
25486 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
25487 Server name.
25488
25489 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
25490
25491 @end deftypevr
25492
25493 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
25494 Port number the server listens to.
25495
25496 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
25497
25498 @end deftypevr
25499
25500 @end deftypevr
25501 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
25502
25503 @c %automatically generated documentation
25504
25505 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
25506
25507 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
25508 The OpenVPN package.
25509
25510 @end deftypevr
25511
25512 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
25513 The OpenVPN pid file.
25514
25515 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
25516
25517 @end deftypevr
25518
25519 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
25520 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
25521 servers.
25522
25523 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
25524
25525 @end deftypevr
25526
25527 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
25528 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
25529
25530 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
25531
25532 @end deftypevr
25533
25534 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
25535 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
25536 it to @code{'disabled}.
25537
25538 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
25539 The certificate authority to check connections against.
25540
25541 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
25542
25543 @end deftypevr
25544
25545 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
25546 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
25547 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
25548
25549 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
25550
25551 @end deftypevr
25552
25553 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
25554 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
25555 certificate is @code{cert}.
25556
25557 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
25558
25559 @end deftypevr
25560
25561 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
25562 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
25563
25564 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25565
25566 @end deftypevr
25567
25568 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
25569 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
25570
25571 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25572
25573 @end deftypevr
25574
25575 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
25576 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
25577 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
25578
25579 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25580
25581 @end deftypevr
25582
25583 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
25584 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
25585 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
25586
25587 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25588 @end deftypevr
25589
25590 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
25591 Verbosity level.
25592
25593 Defaults to @samp{3}.
25594
25595 @end deftypevr
25596
25597 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
25598 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
25599 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
25600
25601 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25602
25603 @end deftypevr
25604
25605 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
25606 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
25607
25608 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
25609
25610 @end deftypevr
25611
25612 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
25613 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
25614
25615 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
25616
25617 @end deftypevr
25618
25619 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
25620 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
25621
25622 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25623
25624 @end deftypevr
25625
25626 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
25627 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
25628
25629 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
25630
25631 @end deftypevr
25632
25633 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
25634 The file that records client IPs.
25635
25636 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
25637
25638 @end deftypevr
25639
25640 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
25641 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
25642
25643 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25644
25645 @end deftypevr
25646
25647 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
25648 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
25649
25650 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25651
25652 @end deftypevr
25653
25654 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
25655 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
25656 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
25657 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
25658 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
25659 down.
25660
25661 @end deftypevr
25662
25663 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
25664 The maximum number of clients.
25665
25666 Defaults to @samp{100}.
25667
25668 @end deftypevr
25669
25670 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
25671 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
25672 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
25673
25674 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
25675
25676 @end deftypevr
25677
25678 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
25679 The list of configuration for some clients.
25680
25681 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25682
25683 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
25684
25685 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
25686 Client name.
25687
25688 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
25689
25690 @end deftypevr
25691
25692 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
25693 Client own network
25694
25695 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25696
25697 @end deftypevr
25698
25699 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
25700 Client VPN IP.
25701
25702 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25703
25704 @end deftypevr
25705
25706 @end deftypevr
25707
25708
25709 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
25710
25711
25712 @node Network File System
25713 @subsection Network File System
25714 @cindex NFS
25715
25716 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
25717 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
25718 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
25719
25720 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
25721 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
25722 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
25723
25724 @subsubheading NFS Service
25725 @cindex NFS, server
25726
25727 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
25728 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
25729 the locations that NFS expects.
25730
25731 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
25732 A service type for a complete NFS server.
25733 @end defvr
25734
25735 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
25736 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
25737 of its subsystems.
25738
25739 It has the following parameters:
25740 @table @asis
25741 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
25742 The nfs-utils package to use.
25743
25744 @item @code{nfs-versions} (default: @code{'("4.2" "4.1" "4.0")})
25745 If a list of string values is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon
25746 will be limited to supporting the given versions of the NFS protocol.
25747
25748 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
25749 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
25750 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
25751 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
25752 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
25753
25754 @lisp
25755 (nfs-configuration
25756 (exports
25757 '(("/export"
25758 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
25759 @end lisp
25760
25761 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
25762 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
25763
25764 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
25765 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
25766
25767 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
25768 The rpcbind package to use.
25769
25770 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
25771 The local NFSv4 domain name.
25772
25773 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
25774 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
25775
25776 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
25777 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
25778
25779 @item @code{nfsd-tcp?} (default: @code{#t})
25780 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a TCP socket.
25781
25782 @item @code{nfsd-udp?} (default: @code{#f})
25783 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a UDP socket.
25784
25785 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25786 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
25787
25788 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
25789 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
25790 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
25791 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
25792 @end table
25793 @end deftp
25794
25795 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
25796 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
25797
25798 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
25799 @cindex rpcbind
25800
25801 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
25802 universal addresses.
25803 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
25804 started when a dependent service starts.
25805
25806 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
25807 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
25808 @end defvr
25809
25810
25811 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
25812 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
25813 This type has the following parameters:
25814 @table @asis
25815 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
25816 The rpcbind package to use.
25817
25818 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
25819 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
25820 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
25821 instance.
25822 @end table
25823 @end deftp
25824
25825
25826 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
25827 @cindex pipefs
25828 @cindex rpc_pipefs
25829
25830 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
25831 between the kernel and user space programs.
25832
25833 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
25834 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
25835 @end defvr
25836
25837 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
25838 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
25839 This type has the following parameters:
25840 @table @asis
25841 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25842 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
25843 @end table
25844 @end deftp
25845
25846
25847 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
25848 @cindex GSSD
25849 @cindex GSS
25850 @cindex global security system
25851
25852 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
25853 based protocols.
25854 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
25855 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
25856 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
25857
25858 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
25859 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
25860 @end defvr
25861
25862 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
25863 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
25864 This type has the following parameters:
25865 @table @asis
25866 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
25867 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
25868
25869 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25870 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
25871
25872 @end table
25873 @end deftp
25874
25875
25876 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
25877 @cindex idmapd
25878 @cindex name mapper
25879
25880 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
25881 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
25882
25883 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
25884 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
25885 @end defvr
25886
25887 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
25888 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
25889 This type has the following parameters:
25890 @table @asis
25891 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
25892 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
25893
25894 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25895 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
25896
25897 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
25898 The local NFSv4 domain name.
25899 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
25900 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
25901
25902 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
25903 The verbosity level of the daemon.
25904
25905 @end table
25906 @end deftp
25907
25908 @node Continuous Integration
25909 @subsection Continuous Integration
25910
25911 @cindex continuous integration
25912 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
25913 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
25914 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
25915
25916 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
25917
25918 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
25919 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
25920 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
25921 @end defvr
25922
25923 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
25924 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
25925 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
25926 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
25927 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
25928
25929 @lisp
25930 (define %cuirass-specs
25931 #~(list
25932 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
25933 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
25934 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
25935 (#:proc-input . "guix")
25936 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
25937 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
25938 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
25939 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
25940 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
25941 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
25942 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
25943 (#:load-path . ".")
25944 (#:branch . "master")
25945 (#:no-compile? . #t))
25946 ((#:name . "config")
25947 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
25948 (#:load-path . ".")
25949 (#:branch . "master")
25950 (#:no-compile? . #t))
25951 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
25952 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
25953 (#:load-path . ".")
25954 (#:branch . "master")
25955 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
25956
25957 (service cuirass-service-type
25958 (cuirass-configuration
25959 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
25960 @end lisp
25961
25962 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
25963 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
25964 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
25965
25966 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
25967 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
25968
25969 @table @asis
25970 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
25971 Location of the log file.
25972
25973 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
25974 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
25975
25976 @item @code{queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
25977 Location of the SQL queries log file. By default, SQL queries logging is
25978 disabled.
25979
25980 @item @code{web-queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
25981 Location of the web SQL queries log file. By default, web SQL queries
25982 logging is disabled.
25983
25984 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
25985 Location of the repository cache.
25986
25987 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
25988 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
25989
25990 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
25991 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
25992
25993 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
25994 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
25995 Cuirass jobs.
25996
25997 @item @code{queue-size} (default: @code{1})
25998 Size of the database writer queue.
25999
26000 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
26001 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
26002 added specifications.
26003
26004 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
26005 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
26006 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
26007 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
26008
26009 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
26010 Port number used by the HTTP server.
26011
26012 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
26013 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
26014 accept connections from localhost.
26015
26016 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
26017 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
26018 where a specification is an association list
26019 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
26020 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
26021 above.
26022
26023 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
26024 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
26025 from source.
26026
26027 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
26028 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
26029
26030 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
26031 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
26032 packages locally.
26033
26034 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
26035 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
26036
26037 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
26038 The Cuirass package to use.
26039 @end table
26040 @end deftp
26041
26042 @node Power Management Services
26043 @subsection Power Management Services
26044
26045 @cindex tlp
26046 @cindex power management with TLP
26047 @subsubheading TLP daemon
26048
26049 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
26050 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
26051
26052 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
26053 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
26054 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
26055 source is detected. More information can be found at
26056 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
26057
26058 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
26059 The service type for the TLP tool. The default settings are optimised
26060 for battery life on most systems, but you can tweak them to your heart's
26061 content by adding a valid @code{tlp-configuration}:
26062 @lisp
26063 (service tlp-service-type
26064 (tlp-configuration
26065 (cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac (list "performance"))
26066 (sched-powersave-on-bat? #t)))
26067 @end lisp
26068 @end deffn
26069
26070 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
26071 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
26072 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
26073 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
26074 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
26075
26076 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
26077 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
26078 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
26079 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
26080 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
26081 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
26082 @c the churn as TLP updates.
26083
26084 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
26085
26086 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
26087 The TLP package.
26088
26089 @end deftypevr
26090
26091 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
26092 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
26093
26094 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26095
26096 @end deftypevr
26097
26098 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
26099 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
26100 and BAT.
26101
26102 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
26103
26104 @end deftypevr
26105
26106 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
26107 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
26108 before syncing on AC.
26109
26110 Defaults to @samp{0}.
26111
26112 @end deftypevr
26113
26114 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
26115 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
26116
26117 Defaults to @samp{2}.
26118
26119 @end deftypevr
26120
26121 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
26122 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
26123
26124 Defaults to @samp{15}.
26125
26126 @end deftypevr
26127
26128 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
26129 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
26130
26131 Defaults to @samp{60}.
26132
26133 @end deftypevr
26134
26135 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
26136 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
26137 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
26138 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
26139
26140 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26141
26142 @end deftypevr
26143
26144 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
26145 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
26146
26147 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26148
26149 @end deftypevr
26150
26151 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
26152 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
26153
26154 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26155
26156 @end deftypevr
26157
26158 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
26159 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
26160
26161 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26162
26163 @end deftypevr
26164
26165 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
26166 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
26167
26168 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26169
26170 @end deftypevr
26171
26172 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
26173 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
26174
26175 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26176
26177 @end deftypevr
26178
26179 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
26180 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
26181 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
26182
26183 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26184
26185 @end deftypevr
26186
26187 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
26188 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
26189 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
26190
26191 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26192
26193 @end deftypevr
26194
26195 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
26196 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
26197
26198 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26199
26200 @end deftypevr
26201
26202 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
26203 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
26204
26205 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26206
26207 @end deftypevr
26208
26209 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
26210 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
26211
26212 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26213
26214 @end deftypevr
26215
26216 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
26217 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
26218
26219 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26220
26221 @end deftypevr
26222
26223 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
26224 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
26225 used under light load conditions.
26226
26227 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26228
26229 @end deftypevr
26230
26231 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
26232 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
26233
26234 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26235
26236 @end deftypevr
26237
26238 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
26239 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
26240
26241 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26242
26243 @end deftypevr
26244
26245 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
26246 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
26247 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
26248
26249 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26250
26251 @end deftypevr
26252
26253 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
26254 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC@. Alternatives are
26255 performance, normal, powersave.
26256
26257 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
26258
26259 @end deftypevr
26260
26261 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
26262 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
26263
26264 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
26265
26266 @end deftypevr
26267
26268 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
26269 Hard disk devices.
26270
26271 @end deftypevr
26272
26273 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
26274 Hard disk advanced power management level.
26275
26276 @end deftypevr
26277
26278 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
26279 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
26280
26281 @end deftypevr
26282
26283 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
26284 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
26285 declared hard disk.
26286
26287 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26288
26289 @end deftypevr
26290
26291 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
26292 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
26293
26294 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26295
26296 @end deftypevr
26297
26298 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
26299 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
26300 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
26301 noop.
26302
26303 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26304
26305 @end deftypevr
26306
26307 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
26308 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
26309 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
26310
26311 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
26312
26313 @end deftypevr
26314
26315 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
26316 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
26317
26318 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
26319
26320 @end deftypevr
26321
26322 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
26323 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
26324
26325 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26326
26327 @end deftypevr
26328
26329 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
26330 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
26331 mode.
26332
26333 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26334
26335 @end deftypevr
26336
26337 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
26338 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
26339
26340 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26341
26342 @end deftypevr
26343
26344 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
26345 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
26346
26347 Defaults to @samp{15}.
26348
26349 @end deftypevr
26350
26351 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
26352 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
26353 default, performance, powersave.
26354
26355 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
26356
26357 @end deftypevr
26358
26359 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
26360 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
26361
26362 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
26363
26364 @end deftypevr
26365
26366 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
26367 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
26368 auto, default.
26369
26370 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
26371
26372 @end deftypevr
26373
26374 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
26375 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
26376
26377 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
26378
26379 @end deftypevr
26380
26381 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
26382 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
26383 performance.
26384
26385 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
26386
26387 @end deftypevr
26388
26389 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
26390 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
26391
26392 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
26393
26394 @end deftypevr
26395
26396 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
26397 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
26398
26399 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
26400
26401 @end deftypevr
26402
26403 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
26404 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
26405
26406 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
26407
26408 @end deftypevr
26409
26410 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
26411 Wifi power saving mode.
26412
26413 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26414
26415 @end deftypevr
26416
26417 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
26418 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
26419
26420 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26421
26422 @end deftypevr
26423
26424 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
26425 Disable wake on LAN.
26426
26427 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26428
26429 @end deftypevr
26430
26431 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
26432 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
26433 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
26434
26435 Defaults to @samp{0}.
26436
26437 @end deftypevr
26438
26439 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
26440 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
26441
26442 Defaults to @samp{1}.
26443
26444 @end deftypevr
26445
26446 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
26447 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
26448
26449 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26450
26451 @end deftypevr
26452
26453 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
26454 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
26455 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
26456 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
26457
26458 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26459
26460 @end deftypevr
26461
26462 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
26463 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
26464
26465 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
26466
26467 @end deftypevr
26468
26469 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
26470 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
26471 and auto.
26472
26473 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
26474
26475 @end deftypevr
26476
26477 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
26478 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
26479
26480 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
26481
26482 @end deftypevr
26483
26484 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
26485 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
26486 ones.
26487
26488 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26489
26490 @end deftypevr
26491
26492 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
26493 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
26494
26495 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26496
26497 @end deftypevr
26498
26499 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
26500 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
26501 Power Management.
26502
26503 @end deftypevr
26504
26505 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
26506 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
26507
26508 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26509
26510 @end deftypevr
26511
26512 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
26513 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
26514
26515 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26516
26517 @end deftypevr
26518
26519 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
26520 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
26521
26522 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26523
26524 @end deftypevr
26525
26526 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
26527 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
26528 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
26529
26530 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26531
26532 @end deftypevr
26533
26534 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
26535 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
26536
26537 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26538
26539 @end deftypevr
26540
26541 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
26542 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
26543 shutdown on system startup.
26544
26545 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26546
26547 @end deftypevr
26548
26549 @cindex thermald
26550 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
26551 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
26552
26553 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
26554 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
26555
26556 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
26557 This is the service type for
26558 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
26559 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
26560 of processors and preventing overheating.
26561 @end defvr
26562
26563 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
26564 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
26565
26566 @table @asis
26567 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
26568 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
26569
26570 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
26571 Package object of thermald.
26572
26573 @end table
26574 @end deftp
26575
26576 @node Audio Services
26577 @subsection Audio Services
26578
26579 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
26580 (the Music Player Daemon).
26581
26582 @cindex mpd
26583 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
26584
26585 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
26586 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
26587 of clients.
26588
26589 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
26590 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
26591
26592 @lisp
26593 (service mpd-service-type
26594 (mpd-configuration
26595 (user "bob")
26596 (port "6666")))
26597 @end lisp
26598
26599 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
26600 The service type for @command{mpd}
26601 @end defvr
26602
26603 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
26604 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
26605
26606 @table @asis
26607 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
26608 The user to run mpd as.
26609
26610 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
26611 The directory to scan for music files.
26612
26613 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
26614 The directory to store playlists.
26615
26616 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
26617 The location of the music database.
26618
26619 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
26620 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
26621
26622 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
26623 The location of the sticker database.
26624
26625 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
26626 The port to run mpd on.
26627
26628 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
26629 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
26630 an absolute path can be specified here.
26631
26632 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
26633 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
26634
26635 @end table
26636 @end deftp
26637
26638 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
26639 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
26640
26641 @table @asis
26642 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
26643 The name of the audio output.
26644
26645 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
26646 The type of audio output.
26647
26648 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
26649 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
26650 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
26651 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
26652 state is restored.
26653
26654 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
26655 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
26656 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
26657 @code{httpd} output plugin.
26658
26659 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
26660 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
26661 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
26662 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
26663
26664 @item @code{mixer-type}
26665 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
26666 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
26667 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
26668 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
26669 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
26670
26671 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
26672 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
26673 the audio output configuration.
26674
26675 @end table
26676 @end deftp
26677
26678 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
26679 an HTTP audio streaming output.
26680
26681 @lisp
26682 (service mpd-service-type
26683 (mpd-configuration
26684 (outputs
26685 (list (mpd-output
26686 (name "streaming")
26687 (type "httpd")
26688 (mixer-type 'null)
26689 (extra-options
26690 `((encoder . "vorbis")
26691 (port . "8080"))))))))
26692 @end lisp
26693
26694
26695 @node Virtualization Services
26696 @subsection Virtualization Services
26697
26698 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
26699 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
26700 services.
26701
26702 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
26703
26704 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
26705 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
26706 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
26707
26708 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
26709 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
26710 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
26711
26712 @lisp
26713 (service libvirt-service-type
26714 (libvirt-configuration
26715 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
26716 (tls-port "16555")))
26717 @end lisp
26718 @end deffn
26719
26720 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
26721 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
26722
26723 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
26724 Libvirt package.
26725
26726 @end deftypevr
26727
26728 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
26729 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
26730 You must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
26731
26732 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
26733 this capability.
26734
26735 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26736
26737 @end deftypevr
26738
26739 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
26740 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. You must
26741 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
26742
26743 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
26744 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
26745 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5).
26746
26747 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26748
26749 @end deftypevr
26750
26751 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
26752 Port for accepting secure TLS connections. This can be a port number,
26753 or service name.
26754
26755 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
26756
26757 @end deftypevr
26758
26759 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
26760 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections. This can be a port number,
26761 or service name.
26762
26763 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
26764
26765 @end deftypevr
26766
26767 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
26768 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
26769
26770 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
26771
26772 @end deftypevr
26773
26774 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
26775 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
26776
26777 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
26778 Avahi daemon.
26779
26780 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26781
26782 @end deftypevr
26783
26784 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
26785 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
26786 broadcast network.
26787
26788 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
26789
26790 @end deftypevr
26791
26792 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
26793 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
26794 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
26795 becoming root.
26796
26797 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26798
26799 @end deftypevr
26800
26801 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
26802 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
26803 VM status only.
26804
26805 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
26806
26807 @end deftypevr
26808
26809 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
26810 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
26811 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
26812 everyone (eg, 0777)
26813
26814 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
26815
26816 @end deftypevr
26817
26818 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
26819 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
26820 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
26821 the access to.
26822
26823 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
26824
26825 @end deftypevr
26826
26827 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
26828 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
26829
26830 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
26831
26832 @end deftypevr
26833
26834 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
26835 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
26836 permissions allow anyone to connect
26837
26838 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
26839
26840 @end deftypevr
26841
26842 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
26843 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
26844 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
26845 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
26846
26847 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
26848
26849 @end deftypevr
26850
26851 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
26852 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
26853 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
26854 scenario.
26855
26856 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
26857
26858 @end deftypevr
26859
26860 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
26861 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
26862 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
26863 by certificates.
26864
26865 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
26866 by using 'sasl' for this option
26867
26868 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
26869
26870 @end deftypevr
26871
26872 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
26873 API access control scheme.
26874
26875 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
26876 drivers can place restrictions on this.
26877
26878 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26879
26880 @end deftypevr
26881
26882 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
26883 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
26884 loaded.
26885
26886 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26887
26888 @end deftypevr
26889
26890 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
26891 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
26892 loaded.
26893
26894 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26895
26896 @end deftypevr
26897
26898 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
26899 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
26900 is loaded.
26901
26902 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26903
26904 @end deftypevr
26905
26906 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
26907 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
26908 CRL is loaded.
26909
26910 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26911
26912 @end deftypevr
26913
26914 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
26915 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
26916
26917 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
26918 certificates.
26919
26920 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26921
26922 @end deftypevr
26923
26924 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
26925 Disable verification of client certificates.
26926
26927 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
26928 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
26929 rejected.
26930
26931 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26932
26933 @end deftypevr
26934
26935 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
26936 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
26937
26938 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26939
26940 @end deftypevr
26941
26942 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
26943 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
26944 the SASL authentication mechanism.
26945
26946 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26947
26948 @end deftypevr
26949
26950 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
26951 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
26952 usually @samp{"NORMAL"} unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
26953 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
26954
26955 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
26956
26957 @end deftypevr
26958
26959 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
26960 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
26961 sockets combined.
26962
26963 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
26964
26965 @end deftypevr
26966
26967 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
26968 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
26969 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
26970 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
26971
26972 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
26973
26974 @end deftypevr
26975
26976 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
26977 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
26978 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
26979
26980 Defaults to @samp{20}.
26981
26982 @end deftypevr
26983
26984 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
26985 Number of workers to start up initially.
26986
26987 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26988
26989 @end deftypevr
26990
26991 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
26992 Maximum number of worker threads.
26993
26994 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
26995 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
26996 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
26997
26998 Defaults to @samp{20}.
26999
27000 @end deftypevr
27001
27002 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
27003 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
27004 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
27005 executed in this pool.
27006
27007 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27008
27009 @end deftypevr
27010
27011 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
27012 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
27013
27014 Defaults to @samp{20}.
27015
27016 @end deftypevr
27017
27018 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
27019 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
27020 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
27021 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
27022
27023 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27024
27025 @end deftypevr
27026
27027 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
27028 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
27029
27030 Defaults to @samp{1}.
27031
27032 @end deftypevr
27033
27034 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
27035 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
27036
27037 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27038
27039 @end deftypevr
27040
27041 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
27042 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
27043
27044 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27045
27046 @end deftypevr
27047
27048 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
27049 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
27050
27051 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27052
27053 @end deftypevr
27054
27055 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
27056 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
27057
27058 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27059
27060 @end deftypevr
27061
27062 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
27063 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
27064
27065 Defaults to @samp{3}.
27066
27067 @end deftypevr
27068
27069 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
27070 Logging filters.
27071
27072 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
27073 of logs. The format for a filter is one of:
27074
27075 @itemize @bullet
27076 @item
27077 x:name
27078
27079 @item
27080 x:+name
27081
27082 @end itemize
27083
27084 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
27085 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
27086 file, e.g., @samp{"remote"}, @samp{"qemu"}, or @samp{"util.json"} (the
27087 name in the filter can be a substring of the full category name, in
27088 order to match multiple similar categories), the optional @samp{"+"}
27089 prefix tells libvirt to log stack trace for each message matching name,
27090 and @code{x} is the minimal level where matching messages should be
27091 logged:
27092
27093 @itemize @bullet
27094 @item
27095 1: DEBUG
27096
27097 @item
27098 2: INFO
27099
27100 @item
27101 3: WARNING
27102
27103 @item
27104 4: ERROR
27105
27106 @end itemize
27107
27108 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
27109 need to be separated by spaces.
27110
27111 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
27112
27113 @end deftypevr
27114
27115 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
27116 Logging outputs.
27117
27118 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
27119 for an output can be:
27120
27121 @table @code
27122 @item x:stderr
27123 output goes to stderr
27124
27125 @item x:syslog:name
27126 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
27127
27128 @item x:file:file_path
27129 output to a file, with the given filepath
27130
27131 @item x:journald
27132 output to journald logging system
27133
27134 @end table
27135
27136 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
27137
27138 @itemize @bullet
27139 @item
27140 1: DEBUG
27141
27142 @item
27143 2: INFO
27144
27145 @item
27146 3: WARNING
27147
27148 @item
27149 4: ERROR
27150
27151 @end itemize
27152
27153 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
27154 spaces.
27155
27156 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
27157
27158 @end deftypevr
27159
27160 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
27161 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
27162
27163 @itemize @bullet
27164 @item
27165 0: disable all auditing
27166
27167 @item
27168 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
27169
27170 @item
27171 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
27172
27173 @end itemize
27174
27175 Defaults to @samp{1}.
27176
27177 @end deftypevr
27178
27179 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
27180 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
27181
27182 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27183
27184 @end deftypevr
27185
27186 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
27187 Host UUID@. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
27188
27189 Defaults to @samp{""}.
27190
27191 @end deftypevr
27192
27193 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
27194 Source to read host UUID.
27195
27196 @itemize @bullet
27197 @item
27198 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
27199
27200 @item
27201 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
27202
27203 @end itemize
27204
27205 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
27206 be generated.
27207
27208 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
27209
27210 @end deftypevr
27211
27212 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
27213 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
27214 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
27215 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
27216 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
27217
27218 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27219
27220 @end deftypevr
27221
27222 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
27223 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
27224 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
27225 broken.
27226
27227 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
27228 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
27229 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
27230 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
27231 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
27232 keepalive messages.
27233
27234 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27235
27236 @end deftypevr
27237
27238 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
27239 Same as above but for admin interface.
27240
27241 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27242
27243 @end deftypevr
27244
27245 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
27246 Same as above but for admin interface.
27247
27248 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27249
27250 @end deftypevr
27251
27252 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
27253 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
27254
27255 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
27256 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
27257 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
27258
27259 Defaults to @samp{5}.
27260
27261 @end deftypevr
27262
27263 @c %end of autogenerated docs
27264
27265 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
27266 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
27267 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
27268
27269 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
27270 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
27271 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
27272 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
27273 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
27274
27275 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
27276 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
27277 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
27278
27279 @lisp
27280 (service virtlog-service-type
27281 (virtlog-configuration
27282 (max-clients 1000)))
27283 @end lisp
27284 @end deffn
27285
27286 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
27287 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
27288
27289 Defaults to @samp{3}.
27290
27291 @end deftypevr
27292
27293 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
27294 Logging filters.
27295
27296 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
27297 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
27298
27299 @itemize @bullet
27300 @item
27301 x:name
27302
27303 @item
27304 x:+name
27305
27306 @end itemize
27307
27308 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
27309 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
27310 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
27311 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
27312 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
27313 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
27314 where matching messages should be logged:
27315
27316 @itemize @bullet
27317 @item
27318 1: DEBUG
27319
27320 @item
27321 2: INFO
27322
27323 @item
27324 3: WARNING
27325
27326 @item
27327 4: ERROR
27328
27329 @end itemize
27330
27331 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
27332 need to be separated by spaces.
27333
27334 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
27335
27336 @end deftypevr
27337
27338 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
27339 Logging outputs.
27340
27341 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
27342 for an output can be:
27343
27344 @table @code
27345 @item x:stderr
27346 output goes to stderr
27347
27348 @item x:syslog:name
27349 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
27350
27351 @item x:file:file_path
27352 output to a file, with the given filepath
27353
27354 @item x:journald
27355 output to journald logging system
27356
27357 @end table
27358
27359 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
27360
27361 @itemize @bullet
27362 @item
27363 1: DEBUG
27364
27365 @item
27366 2: INFO
27367
27368 @item
27369 3: WARNING
27370
27371 @item
27372 4: ERROR
27373
27374 @end itemize
27375
27376 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
27377 spaces.
27378
27379 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
27380
27381 @end deftypevr
27382
27383 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
27384 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
27385 sockets combined.
27386
27387 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
27388
27389 @end deftypevr
27390
27391 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
27392 Maximum file size before rolling over.
27393
27394 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
27395
27396 @end deftypevr
27397
27398 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
27399 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
27400
27401 Defaults to @samp{3}
27402
27403 @end deftypevr
27404
27405 @anchor{transparent-emulation-qemu}
27406 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
27407
27408 @cindex emulation
27409 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
27410 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
27411 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
27412 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
27413 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
27414 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
27415 This feature only allows you to emulate GNU/Linux on a different
27416 architecture, but see below for GNU/Hurd support.
27417
27418 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
27419 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
27420 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
27421 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
27422 emulated:
27423
27424 @lisp
27425 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
27426 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
27427 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64"))))
27428 @end lisp
27429
27430 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
27431 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
27432 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
27433 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27434 @end defvr
27435
27436 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
27437 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
27438
27439 @table @asis
27440 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
27441 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
27442 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
27443
27444 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#t})
27445 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
27446 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
27447 @option{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
27448 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
27449 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
27450
27451 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
27452 service:
27453
27454 @lisp
27455 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
27456 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
27457 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
27458 (guix-support? #t)))
27459 @end lisp
27460
27461 You can run:
27462
27463 @example
27464 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
27465 @end example
27466
27467 @noindent
27468 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
27469 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU@. Pretty handy
27470 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
27471 access to!
27472
27473 When @code{guix-support?} is set to @code{#f}, programs for other
27474 architectures can still be executed transparently, but invoking commands
27475 like @command{guix build -s armhf-linux @dots{}} will fail.
27476
27477 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
27478 The QEMU package to use.
27479 @end table
27480 @end deftp
27481
27482 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
27483 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
27484 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
27485 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
27486 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
27487 @end deffn
27488
27489 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
27490 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
27491 @end deffn
27492
27493 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
27494 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
27495 @end deffn
27496
27497
27498 @subsubheading The Hurd in a Virtual Machine
27499
27500 @cindex @code{hurd}
27501 @cindex the Hurd
27502 @cindex childhurd
27503
27504 Service @code{hurd-vm} provides support for running GNU/Hurd in a
27505 virtual machine (VM), a so-called @dfn{childhurd}. This service is meant
27506 to be used on GNU/Linux and the given GNU/Hurd operating system
27507 configuration is cross-compiled. The virtual machine is a Shepherd
27508 service that can be referred to by the names @code{hurd-vm} and
27509 @code{childhurd} and be controlled with commands such as:
27510
27511 @example
27512 herd start hurd-vm
27513 herd stop childhurd
27514 @end example
27515
27516 When the service is running, you can view its console by connecting to
27517 it with a VNC client, for example with:
27518
27519 @example
27520 guix environment --ad-hoc tigervnc-client -- \
27521 vncviewer localhost:5900
27522 @end example
27523
27524 The default configuration (see @code{hurd-vm-configuration} below)
27525 spawns a secure shell (SSH) server in your GNU/Hurd system, which QEMU
27526 (the virtual machine emulator) redirects to port 10222 on the host.
27527 Thus, you can connect over SSH to the childhurd with:
27528
27529 @example
27530 ssh root@@localhost -p 10022
27531 @end example
27532
27533 The childhurd is volatile and stateless: it starts with a fresh root
27534 file system every time you restart it. By default though, all the files
27535 under @file{/etc/childhurd} on the host are copied as is to the root
27536 file system of the childhurd when it boots. This allows you to
27537 initialize ``secrets'' inside the VM: SSH host keys, authorized
27538 substitute keys, and so on---see the explanation of @code{secret-root}
27539 below.
27540
27541 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-vm-service-type
27542 This is the type of the Hurd in a Virtual Machine service. Its value
27543 must be a @code{hurd-vm-configuration} object, which specifies the
27544 operating system (@pxref{operating-system Reference}) and the disk size
27545 for the Hurd Virtual Machine, the QEMU package to use as well as the
27546 options for running it.
27547
27548 For example:
27549
27550 @lisp
27551 (service hurd-vm-service-type
27552 (hurd-vm-configuration
27553 (disk-size (* 5000 (expt 2 20))) ;5G
27554 (memory-size 1024))) ;1024MiB
27555 @end lisp
27556
27557 would create a disk image big enough to build GNU@tie{}Hello, with some
27558 extra memory.
27559 @end defvr
27560
27561 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-vm-configuration
27562 The data type representing the configuration for
27563 @code{hurd-vm-service-type}.
27564
27565 @table @asis
27566 @item @code{os} (default: @var{%hurd-vm-operating-system})
27567 The operating system to instantiate. This default is bare-bones with a
27568 permissive OpenSSH secure shell daemon listening on port 2222
27569 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}).
27570
27571 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu-minimal})
27572 The QEMU package to use.
27573
27574 @item @code{image} (default: @var{hurd-vm-disk-image})
27575 The procedure used to build the disk-image built from this
27576 configuration.
27577
27578 @item @code{disk-size} (default: @code{'guess})
27579 The size of the disk image.
27580
27581 @item @code{memory-size} (default: @code{512})
27582 The memory size of the Virtual Machine in mebibytes.
27583
27584 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'("--snapshot")})
27585 The extra options for running QEMU.
27586
27587 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
27588 If set, a non-zero positive integer used to parameterize Childhurd
27589 instances. It is appended to the service's name,
27590 e.g. @code{childhurd1}.
27591
27592 @item @code{net-options} (default: @var{hurd-vm-net-options})
27593 The procedure used to produce the list of QEMU networking options.
27594
27595 By default, it produces
27596
27597 @lisp
27598 '("--device" "rtl8139,netdev=net0"
27599 "--netdev" "user,id=net0\
27600 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{secrets-port}-:1004\
27601 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{ssh-port}-:2222\
27602 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{vnc-port}-:5900")
27603 @end lisp
27604
27605 with forwarded ports:
27606
27607 @example
27608 @var{secrets-port}: @code{(+ 11004 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
27609 @var{ssh-port}: @code{(+ 10022 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
27610 @var{vnc-port}: @code{(+ 15900 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
27611 @end example
27612
27613 @item @code{secret-root} (default: @file{/etc/childhurd})
27614 The root directory with out-of-band secrets to be installed into the
27615 childhurd once it runs. Childhurds are volatile which means that on
27616 every startup, secrets such as the SSH host keys and Guix signing key
27617 are recreated.
27618
27619 If the @file{/etc/childhurd} directory does not exist, the
27620 @code{secret-service} running in the Childhurd will be sent an empty
27621 list of secrets.
27622
27623 By default, the service automatically populates @file{/etc/childhurd}
27624 with the following non-volatile secrets, unless they already exist:
27625
27626 @example
27627 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/acl
27628 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
27629 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.sec
27630 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key
27631 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key
27632 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub
27633 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key.pub
27634 @end example
27635
27636 These files are automatically sent to the guest Hurd VM when it boots,
27637 including permissions.
27638
27639 @cindex childhurd, offloading
27640 @cindex Hurd, offloading
27641 Having these files in place means that only a couple of things are
27642 missing to allow the host to offload @code{i586-gnu} builds to the
27643 childhurd:
27644
27645 @enumerate
27646 @item
27647 Authorizing the childhurd's key on the host so that the host accepts
27648 build results coming from the childhurd, which can be done like so:
27649
27650 @example
27651 guix archive --authorize < \
27652 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
27653 @end example
27654
27655 @item
27656 Adding the childhurd to @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} (@pxref{Daemon
27657 Offload Setup}).
27658 @end enumerate
27659
27660 We're working towards making that happen automatically---get in touch
27661 with us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to discuss it!
27662 @end table
27663 @end deftp
27664
27665 Note that by default the VM image is volatile, i.e., once stopped the
27666 contents are lost. If you want a stateful image instead, override the
27667 configuration's @code{image} and @code{options} without
27668 the @code{--snapshot} flag using something along these lines:
27669
27670 @lisp
27671 (service hurd-vm-service-type
27672 (hurd-vm-configuration
27673 (image (const "/out/of/store/writable/hurd.img"))
27674 (options '())))
27675 @end lisp
27676
27677 @subsubheading Ganeti
27678
27679 @cindex ganeti
27680
27681 @quotation Note
27682 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be changed
27683 in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have been thorougly
27684 tested. Users of this service are encouraged to share their experience at
27685 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
27686 @end quotation
27687
27688 Ganeti is a virtual machine management system. It is designed to keep virtual
27689 machines running on a cluster of servers even in the event of hardware failures,
27690 and to make maintenance and recovery tasks easy. It consists of multiple
27691 services which are described later in this section. In addition to the Ganeti
27692 service, you will need the OpenSSH service (@pxref{Networking Services,
27693 @code{openssh-service-type}}), and update the @file{/etc/hosts} file
27694 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{hosts-file}}) with the cluster name
27695 and address (or use a DNS server).
27696
27697 All nodes participating in a Ganeti cluster should have the same Ganeti and
27698 @file{/etc/hosts} configuration. Here is an example configuration for a Ganeti
27699 cluster node that supports multiple storage backends, and installs the
27700 @code{debootstrap} and @code{guix} @dfn{OS providers}:
27701
27702 @lisp
27703 (use-package-modules virtualization)
27704 (use-service-modules base ganeti networking ssh)
27705 (operating-system
27706 ;; @dots{}
27707 (host-name "node1")
27708 (hosts-file (plain-file "hosts" (format #f "
27709 127.0.0.1 localhost
27710 ::1 localhost
27711
27712 192.168.1.200 ganeti.example.com
27713 192.168.1.201 node1.example.com node1
27714 192.168.1.202 node2.example.com node2
27715 ")))
27716
27717 ;; Install QEMU so we can use KVM-based instances, and LVM, DRBD and Ceph
27718 ;; in order to use the "plain", "drbd" and "rbd" storage backends.
27719 (packages (append (map specification->package
27720 '("qemu" "lvm2" "drbd-utils" "ceph"
27721 ;; Add the debootstrap and guix OS providers.
27722 "ganeti-instance-guix" "ganeti-instance-debootstrap"))
27723 %base-packages))
27724 (services
27725 (append (list (static-networking-service "eth0" "192.168.1.201"
27726 #:netmask "255.255.255.0"
27727 #:gateway "192.168.1.254"
27728 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.252"
27729 "192.168.1.253"))
27730
27731 ;; Ganeti uses SSH to communicate between nodes.
27732 (service openssh-service-type
27733 (openssh-configuration
27734 (permit-root-login 'without-password)))
27735
27736 (service ganeti-service-type
27737 (ganeti-configuration
27738 ;; This list specifies allowed file system paths
27739 ;; for storing virtual machine images.
27740 (file-storage-paths '("/srv/ganeti/file-storage"))
27741 ;; This variable configures a single "variant" for
27742 ;; both Debootstrap and Guix that works with KVM.
27743 (os %default-ganeti-os))))
27744 %base-services)))
27745 @end lisp
27746
27747 Users are advised to read the
27748 @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/admin.html,Ganeti
27749 administrators guide} to learn about the various cluster options and
27750 day-to-day operations. There is also a
27751 @url{https://guix.gnu.org/blog/2020/running-a-ganeti-cluster-on-guix/,blog post}
27752 describing how to configure and initialize a small cluster.
27753
27754 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-service-type
27755 This is a service type that includes all the various services that Ganeti
27756 nodes should run.
27757
27758 Its value is a @code{ganeti-configuration} object that defines the package
27759 to use for CLI operations, as well as configuration for the various daemons.
27760 Allowed file storage paths and available guest operating systems are also
27761 configured through this data type.
27762 @end defvr
27763
27764 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-configuration
27765 The @code{ganeti} service takes the following configuration options:
27766
27767 @table @asis
27768 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27769 The @code{ganeti} package to use. It will be installed to the system profile
27770 and make @command{gnt-cluster}, @command{gnt-instance}, etc available. Note
27771 that the value specified here does not affect the other services as each refer
27772 to a specific @code{ganeti} package (see below).
27773
27774 @item @code{noded-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-noded-configuration)})
27775 @itemx @code{confd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-confd-configuration)})
27776 @itemx @code{wconfd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-wconfd-configuration)})
27777 @itemx @code{luxid-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-luxid-configuration)})
27778 @itemx @code{rapi-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-rapi-configuration)})
27779 @itemx @code{kvmd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-kvmd-configuration)})
27780 @itemx @code{mond-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-mond-configuration)})
27781 @itemx @code{metad-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-metad-configuration)})
27782 @itemx @code{watcher-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-watcher-configuration)})
27783 @itemx @code{cleaner-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-cleaner-configuration)})
27784
27785 These options control the various daemons and cron jobs that are distributed
27786 with Ganeti. The possible values for these are described in detail below.
27787 To override a setting, you must use the configuration type for that service:
27788
27789 @lisp
27790 (service ganeti-service-type
27791 (ganeti-configuration
27792 (rapi-configuration
27793 (ganeti-rapi-configuration
27794 (interface "eth1"))))
27795 (watcher-configuration
27796 (ganeti-watcher-configuration
27797 (rapi-ip "10.0.0.1"))))
27798 @end lisp
27799
27800 @item @code{file-storage-paths} (default: @code{'()})
27801 List of allowed directories for file storage backend.
27802
27803 @item @code{os} (default: @code{%default-ganeti-os})
27804 List of @code{<ganeti-os>} records.
27805 @end table
27806
27807 In essence @code{ganeti-service-type} is shorthand for declaring each service
27808 individually:
27809
27810 @lisp
27811 (service ganeti-noded-service-type)
27812 (service ganeti-confd-service-type)
27813 (service ganeti-wconfd-service-type)
27814 (service ganeti-luxid-service-type)
27815 (service ganeti-kvmd-service-type)
27816 (service ganeti-mond-service-type)
27817 (service ganeti-metad-service-type)
27818 (service ganeti-watcher-service-type)
27819 (service ganeti-cleaner-service-type)
27820 @end lisp
27821
27822 Plus a service extension for @code{etc-service-type} that configures the file
27823 storage backend and OS variants.
27824
27825 @end deftp
27826
27827 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os
27828 This data type is suitable for passing to the @code{os} parameter of
27829 @code{ganeti-configuration}. It takes the following parameters:
27830
27831 @table @asis
27832 @item @code{name}
27833 The name for this OS provider. It is only used to specify where the
27834 configuration ends up. Setting it to ``debootstrap'' will create
27835 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap}.
27836
27837 @item @code{extension}
27838 The file extension for variants of this OS type. For example
27839 @file{.conf} or @file{.scm}.
27840
27841 @item @code{variants} (default: @code{'()})
27842 List of @code{ganeti-os-variant} objects for this OS.
27843
27844 @end table
27845 @end deftp
27846
27847 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os-variant
27848 This is the data type for a Ganeti OS variant. It takes the following
27849 parameters:
27850
27851 @table @asis
27852 @item @code{name}
27853 The name of this variant.
27854
27855 @item @code{configuration}
27856 A configuration file for this variant.
27857 @end table
27858 @end deftp
27859
27860 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-hooks
27861 This variable contains hooks to configure networking and the GRUB bootloader.
27862 @end defvr
27863
27864 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs
27865 This variable contains a list of packages suitable for a fully-virtualized guest.
27866 @end defvr
27867
27868 @deftp {Data Type} debootstrap-configuration
27869
27870 This data type creates configuration files suitable for the debootstrap OS provider.
27871
27872 @table @asis
27873 @item @code{hooks} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-hooks})
27874 When not @code{#f}, this must be a G-expression that specifies a directory with
27875 scripts that will run when the OS is installed. It can also be a list of
27876 @code{(name . file-like)} pairs. For example:
27877
27878 @lisp
27879 `((99-hello-world . ,(plain-file "#!/bin/sh\necho Hello, World")))
27880 @end lisp
27881
27882 That will create a directory with one executable named @code{99-hello-world}
27883 and run it every time this variant is installed. If set to @code{#f}, hooks
27884 in @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap/hooks} will be used, if any.
27885 @item @code{proxy} (default: @code{#f})
27886 Optional HTTP proxy to use.
27887 @item @code{mirror} (default: @code{#f})
27888 The Debian mirror. Typically something like @code{http://ftp.no.debian.org/debian}.
27889 The default varies depending on the distribution.
27890 @item @code{arch} (default: @code{#f})
27891 The dpkg architecture. Set to @code{armhf} to debootstrap an ARMv7 instance
27892 on an AArch64 host. Default is to use the current system architecture.
27893 @item @code{suite} (default: @code{"stable"})
27894 When set, this must be a Debian distribution ``suite'' such as @code{buster}
27895 or @code{focal}. If set to @code{#f}, the default for the OS provider is used.
27896 @item @code{extra-pkgs} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs})
27897 List of extra packages that will get installed by dpkg in addition
27898 to the minimal system.
27899 @item @code{components} (default: @code{#f})
27900 When set, must be a list of Debian repository ``components''. For example
27901 @code{'("main" "contrib")}.
27902 @item @code{generate-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
27903 Whether to automatically cache the generated debootstrap archive.
27904 @item @code{clean-cache} (default: @code{14})
27905 Discard the cache after this amount of days. Use @code{#f} to never
27906 clear the cache.
27907 @item @code{partition-style} (default: @code{'msdos})
27908 The type of partition to create. When set, it must be one of
27909 @code{'msdos}, @code{'none} or a string.
27910 @item @code{partition-alignment} (default: @code{2048})
27911 Alignment of the partition in sectors.
27912 @end table
27913 @end deftp
27914
27915 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
27916 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record. It
27917 takes two parameters: a name and a @code{debootstrap-configuration} object.
27918 @end deffn
27919
27920 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-os @var{variants}@dots{}
27921 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It takes
27922 a list of variants created with @code{debootstrap-variant}.
27923 @end deffn
27924
27925 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
27926 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record for
27927 use with the Guix OS provider. It takes a name and a G-expression that returns
27928 a ``file-like'' (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) object containing a
27929 Guix System configuration.
27930 @end deffn
27931
27932 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-os @var{variants}@dots{}
27933 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It
27934 takes a list of variants produced by @code{guix-variant}.
27935 @end deffn
27936
27937 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-variants
27938 This is a convenience variable to make the debootstrap provider work
27939 ``out of the box'' without users having to declare variants manually. It
27940 contains a single debootstrap variant with the default configuration:
27941
27942 @lisp
27943 (list (debootstrap-variant
27944 "default"
27945 (debootstrap-configuration)))
27946 @end lisp
27947 @end defvr
27948
27949 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-guix-variants
27950 This is a convenience variable to make the Guix OS provider work without
27951 additional configuration. It creates a virtual machine that has an SSH
27952 server, a serial console, and authorizes the Ganeti hosts SSH keys.
27953
27954 @lisp
27955 (list (guix-variant
27956 "default"
27957 (file-append ganeti-instance-guix
27958 "/share/doc/ganeti-instance-guix/examples/dynamic.scm")))
27959 @end lisp
27960 @end defvr
27961
27962 Users can implement support for OS providers unbeknownst to Guix by extending
27963 the @code{ganeti-os} and @code{ganeti-os-variant} records appropriately.
27964 For example:
27965
27966 @lisp
27967 (ganeti-os
27968 (name "custom")
27969 (extension ".conf")
27970 (variants
27971 (list (ganeti-os-variant
27972 (name "foo")
27973 (configuration (plain-file "bar" "this is fine"))))))
27974 @end lisp
27975
27976 That creates @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/foo.conf} which points
27977 to a file in the store with contents @code{this is fine}. It also creates
27978 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/variants.list} with contents @code{foo}.
27979
27980 Obviously this may not work for all OS providers out there. If you find the
27981 interface limiting, please reach out to @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
27982
27983 The rest of this section documents the various services that are included by
27984 @code{ganeti-service-type}.
27985
27986 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-noded-service-type
27987 @command{ganeti-noded} is the daemon responsible for node-specific functions
27988 within the Ganeti system. The value of this service must be a
27989 @code{ganeti-noded-configuration} object.
27990 @end defvr
27991
27992 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-noded-configuration
27993 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-noded} service.
27994
27995 @table @asis
27996 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27997 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27998
27999 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1811})
28000 The TCP port on which the node daemon listens for network requests.
28001
28002 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
28003 The network address that the daemon will bind to. The default address means
28004 bind to all available addresses.
28005
28006 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
28007 When this is set, it must be a specific network interface (e.g.@: @code{eth0})
28008 that the daemon will bind to.
28009
28010 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
28011 This sets a limit on the maximum number of simultaneous client connections
28012 that the daemon will handle. Connections above this count are accepted, but
28013 no responses will be sent until enough connections have closed.
28014
28015 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
28016 Whether to use SSL/TLS to encrypt network communications. The certificate
28017 is automatically provisioned by the cluster and can be rotated with
28018 @command{gnt-cluster renew-crypto}.
28019
28020 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
28021 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
28022
28023 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
28024 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
28025
28026 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28027 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28028 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
28029
28030 @end table
28031 @end deftp
28032
28033 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-confd-service-type
28034 @command{ganeti-confd} answers queries related to the configuration of a
28035 Ganeti cluster. The purpose of this daemon is to have a highly available
28036 and fast way to query cluster configuration values. It is automatically
28037 active on all @dfn{master candidates}. The value of this service must be a
28038 @code{ganeti-confd-configuration} object.
28039
28040 @end defvr
28041
28042 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-confd-configuration
28043 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-confd} service.
28044
28045 @table @asis
28046 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28047 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28048
28049 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1814})
28050 The UDP port on which to listen for network requests.
28051
28052 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
28053 Network address that the daemon will bind to.
28054
28055 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28056 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28057
28058 @end table
28059 @end deftp
28060
28061 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-wconfd-service-type
28062 @command{ganeti-wconfd} is the daemon that has authoritative knowledge
28063 about the cluster configuration and is the only entity that can accept
28064 changes to it. All jobs that need to modify the configuration will do so
28065 by sending appropriate requests to this daemon. It only runs on the
28066 @dfn{master node} and will automatically disable itself on other nodes.
28067
28068 The value of this service must be a
28069 @code{ganeti-wconfd-configuration} object.
28070 @end defvr
28071
28072 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-wconfd-configuration
28073 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
28074
28075 @table @asis
28076 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28077 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28078
28079 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
28080 The daemon will refuse to start if the majority of cluster nodes does not
28081 agree that it is running on the master node. Set to @code{#t} to start
28082 even if a quorum can not be reached (dangerous, use with caution).
28083
28084 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28085 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28086
28087 @end table
28088 @end deftp
28089
28090 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-luxid-service-type
28091 @command{ganeti-luxid} is a daemon used to answer queries related to the
28092 configuration and the current live state of a Ganeti cluster. Additionally,
28093 it is the authoritative daemon for the Ganeti job queue. Jobs can be
28094 submitted via this daemon and it schedules and starts them.
28095
28096 It takes a @code{ganeti-luxid-configuration} object.
28097 @end defvr
28098
28099 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-luxid-configuration
28100 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
28101
28102 @table @asis
28103 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28104 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28105
28106 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
28107 The daemon will refuse to start if it cannot verify that the majority of
28108 cluster nodes believes that it is running on the master node. Set to
28109 @code{#t} to ignore such checks and start anyway (this can be dangerous).
28110
28111 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28112 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28113
28114 @end table
28115 @end deftp
28116
28117 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-rapi-service-type
28118 @command{ganeti-rapi} provides a remote API for Ganeti clusters. It runs on
28119 the master node and can be used to perform cluster actions programmatically
28120 via a JSON-based RPC protocol.
28121
28122 Most query operations are allowed without authentication (unless
28123 @var{require-authentication?} is set), whereas write operations require
28124 explicit authorization via the @file{/var/lib/ganeti/rapi/users} file. See
28125 the @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/rapi.html, Ganeti Remote
28126 API documentation} for more information.
28127
28128 The value of this service must be a @code{ganeti-rapi-configuration} object.
28129 @end defvr
28130
28131 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-rapi-configuration
28132 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-rapi} service.
28133
28134 @table @asis
28135 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28136 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28137
28138 @item @code{require-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
28139 Whether to require authentication even for read-only operations.
28140
28141 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5080})
28142 The TCP port on which to listen to API requests.
28143
28144 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
28145 The network address that the service will bind to. By default it listens
28146 on all configured addresses.
28147
28148 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
28149 When set, it must specify a specific network interface such as @code{eth0}
28150 that the daemon will bind to.
28151
28152 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
28153 The maximum number of simultaneous client requests to handle. Further
28154 connections are allowed, but no responses are sent until enough connections
28155 have closed.
28156
28157 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
28158 Whether to use SSL/TLS encryption on the RAPI port.
28159
28160 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
28161 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
28162
28163 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
28164 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
28165
28166 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28167 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28168 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
28169
28170 @end table
28171 @end deftp
28172
28173 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-kvmd-service-type
28174 @command{ganeti-kvmd} is responsible for determining whether a given KVM
28175 instance was shut down by an administrator or a user. Normally Ganeti will
28176 restart an instance that was not stopped through Ganeti itself. If the
28177 cluster option @code{user_shutdown} is true, this daemon monitors the
28178 @code{QMP} socket provided by QEMU and listens for shutdown events, and
28179 marks the instance as @dfn{USER_down} instead of @dfn{ERROR_down} when
28180 it shuts down gracefully by itself.
28181
28182 It takes a @code{ganeti-kvmd-configuration} object.
28183 @end defvr
28184
28185 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-kvmd-configuration
28186
28187 @table @asis
28188 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28189 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28190
28191 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28192 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28193
28194 @end table
28195 @end deftp
28196
28197 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-mond-service-type
28198 @command{ganeti-mond} is an optional daemon that provides Ganeti monitoring
28199 functionality. It is responsible for running data collectors and publish the
28200 collected information through a HTTP interface.
28201
28202 It takes a @code{ganeti-mond-configuration} object.
28203 @end defvr
28204
28205 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-mond-configuration
28206
28207 @table @asis
28208 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28209 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28210
28211 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1815})
28212 The port on which the daemon will listen.
28213
28214 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
28215 The network address that the daemon will bind to. By default it binds to all
28216 available interfaces.
28217
28218 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28219 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28220
28221 @end table
28222 @end deftp
28223
28224 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-metad-service-type
28225 @command{ganeti-metad} is an optional daemon that can be used to provide
28226 information about the cluster to instances or OS install scripts.
28227
28228 It takes a @code{ganeti-metad-configuration} object.
28229 @end defvr
28230
28231 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-metad-configuration
28232
28233 @table @asis
28234 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28235 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28236
28237 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
28238 The port on which the daemon will listen.
28239
28240 @item @code{address} (default: @code{#f})
28241 If set, the daemon will bind to this address only. If left unset, the behavior
28242 depends on the cluster configuration.
28243
28244 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28245 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28246
28247 @end table
28248 @end deftp
28249
28250 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-watcher-service-type
28251 @command{ganeti-watcher} is a script designed to run periodically and ensure
28252 the health of a cluster. It will automatically restart instances that have
28253 stopped without Ganeti's consent, and repairs DRBD links in case a node has
28254 rebooted. It also archives old cluster jobs and restarts Ganeti daemons
28255 that are not running. If the cluster parameter @code{ensure_node_health}
28256 is set, the watcher will also shutdown instances and DRBD devices if the
28257 node it is running on is declared offline by known master candidates.
28258
28259 It can be paused on all nodes with @command{gnt-cluster watcher pause}.
28260
28261 The service takes a @code{ganeti-watcher-configuration} object.
28262 @end defvr
28263
28264 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-watcher-configuration
28265
28266 @table @asis
28267 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28268 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
28269
28270 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{'(next-second-from (next-minute (range 0 60 5)))})
28271 How often to run the script. The default is every five minutes.
28272
28273 @item @code{rapi-ip} (default: @code{#f})
28274 This option needs to be specified only if the RAPI daemon is configured to use
28275 a particular interface or address. By default the cluster address is used.
28276
28277 @item @code{job-age} (default: @code{(* 6 3600)})
28278 Archive cluster jobs older than this age, specified in seconds. The default
28279 is 6 hours. This keeps @command{gnt-job list} manageable.
28280
28281 @item @code{verify-disks?} (default: @code{#t})
28282 If this is @code{#f}, the watcher will not try to repair broken DRBD links
28283 automatically. Administrators will need to use @command{gnt-cluster verify-disks}
28284 manually instead.
28285
28286 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
28287 When @code{#t}, the script performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
28288
28289 @end table
28290 @end deftp
28291
28292 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-cleaner-service-type
28293 @command{ganeti-cleaner} is a script designed to run periodically and remove
28294 old files from the cluster. This service type controls two @dfn{cron jobs}:
28295 one intended for the master node that permanently purges old cluster jobs,
28296 and one intended for every node that removes expired X509 certificates, keys,
28297 and outdated @command{ganeti-watcher} information. Like all Ganeti services,
28298 it is safe to include even on non-master nodes as it will disable itself as
28299 necessary.
28300
28301 It takes a @code{ganeti-cleaner-configuration} object.
28302 @end defvr
28303
28304 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-cleaner-configuration
28305
28306 @table @asis
28307 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
28308 The @code{ganeti} package to use for the @command{gnt-cleaner} command.
28309
28310 @item @code{master-schedule} (default: @code{"45 1 * * *"})
28311 How often to run the master cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
28312 01:45:00.
28313
28314 @item @code{node-schedule} (default: @code{"45 2 * * *"})
28315 How often to run the node cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
28316 02:45:00.
28317
28318 @end table
28319 @end deftp
28320
28321 @node Version Control Services
28322 @subsection Version Control Services
28323
28324 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
28325 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
28326 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
28327 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
28328 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
28329 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
28330 @code{cgit-service-type}.
28331
28332 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
28333
28334 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
28335 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
28336
28337 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
28338 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
28339 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
28340 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} in the repository directory.} repositories under
28341 @file{/srv/git}.
28342
28343 @end deffn
28344
28345 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
28346 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
28347
28348 @table @asis
28349 @item @code{package} (default: @code{git})
28350 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
28351
28352 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
28353 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
28354 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
28355
28356 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
28357 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
28358 If you run @command{git daemon} with @code{(base-path "/srv/git")} on
28359 @samp{example.com}, then if you later try to pull
28360 @indicateurl{git://example.com/hello.git}, git daemon will interpret the
28361 path as @file{/srv/git/hello.git}.
28362
28363 @item @code{user-path} (default: @code{#f})
28364 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
28365 specified with empty string, requests to
28366 @indicateurl{git://host/~alice/foo} is taken as a request to access
28367 @code{foo} repository in the home directory of user @code{alice}. If
28368 @code{(user-path "@var{path}")} is specified, the same request is taken
28369 as a request to access @file{@var{path}/foo} repository in the home
28370 directory of user @code{alice}.
28371
28372 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'()})
28373 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
28374 all.
28375
28376 @item @code{port} (default: @code{#f})
28377 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
28378
28379 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @code{'()})
28380 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
28381
28382 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
28383 Extra options will be passed to @command{git daemon}, please run
28384 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
28385
28386 @end table
28387 @end deftp
28388
28389 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
28390 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
28391 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
28392 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
28393 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
28394 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
28395 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
28396 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
28397 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
28398 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
28399
28400 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
28401 over HTTP.
28402
28403 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
28404 Data type representing the configuration for a future
28405 @code{git-http-service-type}; can currently be used to configure Nginx
28406 through @code{git-http-nginx-location-configuration}.
28407
28408 @table @asis
28409 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
28410 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
28411
28412 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
28413 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
28414
28415 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
28416 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
28417 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
28418
28419 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @samp{/git/})
28420 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @samp{/git/} prefix, this
28421 will map @indicateurl{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
28422 @file{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
28423 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
28424
28425 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
28426 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
28427 Services}.
28428 @end table
28429 @end deftp
28430
28431 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
28432 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
28433 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
28434 server.
28435
28436 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
28437 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
28438 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
28439 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
28440 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
28441
28442 @lisp
28443 (service nginx-service-type
28444 (nginx-configuration
28445 (server-blocks
28446 (list
28447 (nginx-server-configuration
28448 (listen '("443 ssl"))
28449 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
28450 (ssl-certificate
28451 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
28452 (ssl-certificate-key
28453 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
28454 (locations
28455 (list
28456 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
28457 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
28458 @end lisp
28459
28460 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
28461 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
28462 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
28463 HTTPS@. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
28464 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
28465 @end deffn
28466
28467 @subsubheading Cgit Service
28468
28469 @cindex Cgit service
28470 @cindex Git, web interface
28471 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
28472 repositories written in C.
28473
28474 The following example will configure the service with default values.
28475 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
28476
28477 @lisp
28478 (service cgit-service-type)
28479 @end lisp
28480
28481 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
28482 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
28483
28484 @c %start of fragment
28485
28486 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
28487
28488 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
28489 The CGIT package.
28490
28491 @end deftypevr
28492
28493 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
28494 NGINX configuration.
28495
28496 @end deftypevr
28497
28498 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
28499 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
28500 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
28501
28502 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28503
28504 @end deftypevr
28505
28506 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
28507 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
28508 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
28509
28510 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28511
28512 @end deftypevr
28513
28514 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
28515 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
28516 access.
28517
28518 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28519
28520 @end deftypevr
28521
28522 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
28523 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
28524 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
28525
28526 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
28527
28528 @end deftypevr
28529
28530 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
28531 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
28532
28533 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
28534
28535 @end deftypevr
28536
28537 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
28538 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28539 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
28540
28541 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
28542
28543 @end deftypevr
28544
28545 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
28546 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28547 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
28548
28549 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28550
28551 @end deftypevr
28552
28553 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
28554 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28555 version of the repository summary page.
28556
28557 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28558
28559 @end deftypevr
28560
28561 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
28562 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28563 version of the repository index page.
28564
28565 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28566
28567 @end deftypevr
28568
28569 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
28570 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
28571 scanning a path for Git repositories.
28572
28573 Defaults to @samp{15}.
28574
28575 @end deftypevr
28576
28577 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
28578 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28579 version of the repository about page.
28580
28581 Defaults to @samp{15}.
28582
28583 @end deftypevr
28584
28585 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
28586 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28587 version of snapshots.
28588
28589 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28590
28591 @end deftypevr
28592
28593 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
28594 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
28595 caching is disabled.
28596
28597 Defaults to @samp{0}.
28598
28599 @end deftypevr
28600
28601 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
28602 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
28603
28604 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28605
28606 @end deftypevr
28607
28608 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
28609 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
28610 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
28611
28612 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28613
28614 @end deftypevr
28615
28616 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
28617 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
28618
28619 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28620
28621 @end deftypevr
28622
28623 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
28624 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
28625
28626 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28627
28628 @end deftypevr
28629
28630 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
28631 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
28632 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
28633 ordering.
28634
28635 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
28636
28637 @end deftypevr
28638
28639 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
28640 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
28641
28642 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
28643
28644 @end deftypevr
28645
28646 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
28647 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
28648 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
28649 places throughout the cgit interface.
28650
28651 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28652
28653 @end deftypevr
28654
28655 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
28656 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
28657 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
28658
28659 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28660
28661 @end deftypevr
28662
28663 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
28664 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
28665 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
28666 repository log page.
28667
28668 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28669
28670 @end deftypevr
28671
28672 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
28673 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
28674 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
28675
28676 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28677
28678 @end deftypevr
28679
28680 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
28681 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
28682 log view.
28683
28684 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28685
28686 @end deftypevr
28687
28688 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
28689 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
28690 clones.
28691
28692 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28693
28694 @end deftypevr
28695
28696 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
28697 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
28698 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
28699
28700 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28701
28702 @end deftypevr
28703
28704 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
28705 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
28706 each repo in the repository index.
28707
28708 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28709
28710 @end deftypevr
28711
28712 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
28713 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
28714 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
28715
28716 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28717
28718 @end deftypevr
28719
28720 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
28721 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
28722 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
28723
28724 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28725
28726 @end deftypevr
28727
28728 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
28729 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
28730 branches in the summary and refs views.
28731
28732 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28733
28734 @end deftypevr
28735
28736 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
28737 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
28738 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
28739 commit view.
28740
28741 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28742
28743 @end deftypevr
28744
28745 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
28746 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
28747 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
28748 commit view.
28749
28750 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28751
28752 @end deftypevr
28753
28754 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
28755 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
28756 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
28757
28758 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28759
28760 @end deftypevr
28761
28762 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
28763 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
28764 set any repo specific settings.
28765
28766 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28767
28768 @end deftypevr
28769
28770 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
28771 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
28772
28773 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
28774
28775 @end deftypevr
28776
28777 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
28778 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28779 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
28780 "generated by..."@: message).
28781
28782 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28783
28784 @end deftypevr
28785
28786 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
28787 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28788 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
28789
28790 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28791
28792 @end deftypevr
28793
28794 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
28795 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28796 verbatim at the top of all pages.
28797
28798 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28799
28800 @end deftypevr
28801
28802 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
28803 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
28804 file is parsed.
28805
28806 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28807
28808 @end deftypevr
28809
28810 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
28811 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28812 verbatim above the repository index.
28813
28814 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28815
28816 @end deftypevr
28817
28818 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
28819 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28820 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
28821
28822 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28823
28824 @end deftypevr
28825
28826 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
28827 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
28828 in the servers timezone.
28829
28830 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28831
28832 @end deftypevr
28833
28834 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
28835 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
28836 on all cgit pages.
28837
28838 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
28839
28840 @end deftypevr
28841
28842 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
28843 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
28844
28845 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28846
28847 @end deftypevr
28848
28849 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
28850 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
28851 page.
28852
28853 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28854
28855 @end deftypevr
28856
28857 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
28858 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
28859
28860 Defaults to @samp{10}.
28861
28862 @end deftypevr
28863
28864 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
28865 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
28866
28867 Defaults to @samp{50}.
28868
28869 @end deftypevr
28870
28871 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
28872 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
28873
28874 Defaults to @samp{80}.
28875
28876 @end deftypevr
28877
28878 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
28879 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
28880 page.
28881
28882 Defaults to @samp{50}.
28883
28884 @end deftypevr
28885
28886 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
28887 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
28888 on the repository index page.
28889
28890 Defaults to @samp{80}.
28891
28892 @end deftypevr
28893
28894 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
28895 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
28896
28897 Defaults to @samp{0}.
28898
28899 @end deftypevr
28900
28901 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
28902 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
28903 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
28904
28905 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28906
28907 @end deftypevr
28908
28909 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
28910 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
28911
28912 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
28913 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
28914 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
28915
28916 @end deftypevr
28917
28918 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
28919 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
28920
28921 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28922
28923 @end deftypevr
28924
28925 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
28926 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
28927 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
28928
28929 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28930
28931 @end deftypevr
28932
28933 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
28934 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
28935
28936 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28937
28938 @end deftypevr
28939
28940 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
28941 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
28942 disabled.
28943
28944 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28945
28946 @end deftypevr
28947
28948 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
28949 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
28950 header on all pages.
28951
28952 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28953
28954 @end deftypevr
28955
28956 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
28957 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
28958 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
28959 all subdirectories will be loaded.
28960
28961 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28962
28963 @end deftypevr
28964
28965 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
28966 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
28967
28968 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28969
28970 @end deftypevr
28971
28972 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
28973 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
28974 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
28975 removed for the URL and name.
28976
28977 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28978
28979 @end deftypevr
28980
28981 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
28982 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
28983
28984 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
28985
28986 @end deftypevr
28987
28988 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
28989 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
28990
28991 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28992
28993 @end deftypevr
28994
28995 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
28996 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
28997
28998 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
28999
29000 @end deftypevr
29001
29002 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
29003 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
29004
29005 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
29006
29007 @end deftypevr
29008
29009 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
29010 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
29011 verbatim below the ``about'' link on the repository index page.
29012
29013 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29014
29015 @end deftypevr
29016
29017 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
29018 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
29019
29020 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29021
29022 @end deftypevr
29023
29024 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
29025 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
29026 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
29027 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
29028 directories, considered as ``hidden''. Note that this does not apply to
29029 the @file{.git} directory in non-bare repos.
29030
29031 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29032
29033 @end deftypevr
29034
29035 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
29036 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
29037 generates links for.
29038
29039 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29040
29041 @end deftypevr
29042
29043 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
29044 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
29045 @code{scan-path}).
29046
29047 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
29048
29049 @end deftypevr
29050
29051 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
29052 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
29053 after this option will inherit the current section name.
29054
29055 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29056
29057 @end deftypevr
29058
29059 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
29060 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
29061 repository listing by name.
29062
29063 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29064
29065 @end deftypevr
29066
29067 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
29068 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
29069 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
29070
29071 Defaults to @samp{0}.
29072
29073 @end deftypevr
29074
29075 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
29076 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
29077 default.
29078
29079 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29080
29081 @end deftypevr
29082
29083 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
29084 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
29085 the tree view.
29086
29087 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29088
29089 @end deftypevr
29090
29091 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
29092 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository ``summary''
29093 view.
29094
29095 Defaults to @samp{10}.
29096
29097 @end deftypevr
29098
29099 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
29100 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
29101 ``summary'' view.
29102
29103 Defaults to @samp{10}.
29104
29105 @end deftypevr
29106
29107 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
29108 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository ``summary''
29109 view.
29110
29111 Defaults to @samp{10}.
29112
29113 @end deftypevr
29114
29115 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
29116 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
29117 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
29118
29119 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29120
29121 @end deftypevr
29122
29123 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
29124 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
29125
29126 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
29127
29128 @end deftypevr
29129
29130 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
29131 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
29132
29133 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29134
29135 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
29136
29137 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
29138 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
29139 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
29140
29141 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29142
29143 @end deftypevr
29144
29145 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
29146 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
29147
29148 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29149
29150 @end deftypevr
29151
29152 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
29153 The relative URL used to access the repository.
29154
29155 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29156
29157 @end deftypevr
29158
29159 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
29160 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
29161
29162 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29163
29164 @end deftypevr
29165
29166 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
29167 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
29168 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
29169
29170 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29171
29172 @end deftypevr
29173
29174 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
29175 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
29176
29177 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29178
29179 @end deftypevr
29180
29181 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
29182 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
29183
29184 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29185
29186 @end deftypevr
29187
29188 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
29189 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
29190 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
29191 ordering.
29192
29193 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29194
29195 @end deftypevr
29196
29197 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
29198 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
29199 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
29200 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or ``master'' if
29201 there is no suitable HEAD.
29202
29203 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29204
29205 @end deftypevr
29206
29207 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
29208 The value to show as repository description.
29209
29210 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29211
29212 @end deftypevr
29213
29214 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
29215 The value to show as repository homepage.
29216
29217 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29218
29219 @end deftypevr
29220
29221 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
29222 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
29223
29224 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29225
29226 @end deftypevr
29227
29228 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
29229 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
29230 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
29231
29232 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
29233
29234 @end deftypevr
29235
29236 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
29237 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
29238 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
29239
29240 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
29241
29242 @end deftypevr
29243
29244 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
29245 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
29246 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
29247
29248 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
29249
29250 @end deftypevr
29251
29252 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
29253 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
29254 branches in the summary and refs views.
29255
29256 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
29257
29258 @end deftypevr
29259
29260 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
29261 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
29262 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
29263
29264 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
29265
29266 @end deftypevr
29267
29268 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
29269 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
29270 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
29271
29272 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
29273
29274 @end deftypevr
29275
29276 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
29277 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
29278 repository index.
29279
29280 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29281
29282 @end deftypevr
29283
29284 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
29285 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
29286
29287 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29288
29289 @end deftypevr
29290
29291 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
29292 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
29293 on this repo’s pages.
29294
29295 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29296
29297 @end deftypevr
29298
29299 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
29300 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
29301
29302 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29303
29304 @end deftypevr
29305
29306 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
29307 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
29308
29309 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29310
29311 @end deftypevr
29312
29313 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
29314 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
29315 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
29316 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
29317
29318 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29319
29320 @end deftypevr
29321
29322 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
29323 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
29324 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
29325 listing.
29326
29327 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29328
29329 @end deftypevr
29330
29331 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
29332 Override the default maximum statistics period.
29333
29334 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29335
29336 @end deftypevr
29337
29338 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
29339 The value to show as repository name.
29340
29341 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29342
29343 @end deftypevr
29344
29345 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
29346 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
29347
29348 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29349
29350 @end deftypevr
29351
29352 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
29353 An absolute path to the repository directory.
29354
29355 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29356
29357 @end deftypevr
29358
29359 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
29360 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
29361 the ``About'' page for this repo.
29362
29363 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29364
29365 @end deftypevr
29366
29367 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
29368 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
29369 after this option will inherit the current section name.
29370
29371 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29372
29373 @end deftypevr
29374
29375 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
29376 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
29377
29378 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29379
29380 @end deftypevr
29381
29382 @end deftypevr
29383
29384 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
29385 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
29386
29387 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29388
29389 @end deftypevr
29390
29391
29392 @c %end of fragment
29393
29394 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
29395 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
29396 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
29397 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
29398
29399 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
29400
29401 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
29402 The cgit package.
29403 @end deftypevr
29404
29405 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
29406 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
29407 @end deftypevr
29408
29409 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
29410 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
29411
29412 @lisp
29413 (service cgit-service-type
29414 (opaque-cgit-configuration
29415 (cgitrc "")))
29416 @end lisp
29417
29418 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
29419
29420 @cindex Gitolite service
29421 @cindex Git, hosting
29422 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
29423 repositories on a central server.
29424
29425 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
29426 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
29427
29428 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
29429 user, and the provided SSH public key.
29430
29431 @lisp
29432 (service gitolite-service-type
29433 (gitolite-configuration
29434 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
29435 "yourname.pub"
29436 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
29437 @end lisp
29438
29439 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
29440 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
29441 following command to clone the admin repository.
29442
29443 @example
29444 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
29445 @end example
29446
29447 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
29448 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
29449 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
29450 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
29451
29452 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
29453 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
29454
29455 @table @asis
29456 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
29457 Gitolite package to use.
29458
29459 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
29460 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
29461 Gitolite over SSH.
29462
29463 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
29464 Group to use for Gitolite.
29465
29466 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
29467 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
29468
29469 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
29470 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
29471 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
29472
29473 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
29474 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
29475 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
29476 within the gitolite-admin repository.
29477
29478 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
29479
29480 @lisp
29481 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
29482 @end lisp
29483
29484 @end table
29485 @end deftp
29486
29487 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
29488 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
29489
29490 @table @asis
29491 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
29492 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
29493 contents.
29494
29495 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
29496 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
29497 like cgit or gitweb.
29498
29499 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
29500 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the @samp{config}
29501 keyword. This setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
29502
29503 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
29504 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
29505
29506 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
29507 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
29508
29509 @end table
29510 @end deftp
29511
29512
29513 @node Game Services
29514 @subsection Game Services
29515
29516 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
29517 @cindex wesnothd
29518 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
29519 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
29520 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
29521
29522 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
29523 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
29524 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
29525 configuration, instantiate it as:
29526
29527 @lisp
29528 (service wesnothd-service-type)
29529 @end lisp
29530 @end defvar
29531
29532 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
29533 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
29534
29535 @table @asis
29536 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
29537 The wesnoth server package to use.
29538
29539 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
29540 The port to bind the server to.
29541 @end table
29542 @end deftp
29543
29544
29545 @node PAM Mount Service
29546 @subsection PAM Mount Service
29547 @cindex pam-mount
29548
29549 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
29550 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
29551 volume format supported by the system.
29552
29553 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
29554 Service type for PAM Mount support.
29555 @end defvar
29556
29557 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
29558 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
29559
29560 It takes the following parameters:
29561
29562 @table @asis
29563 @item @code{rules}
29564 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
29565 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
29566
29567 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
29568 Guile Reference Manual}), and the default ones don't mount anything for
29569 anyone at login:
29570
29571 @lisp
29572 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
29573 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
29574 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
29575 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
29576 "allow_root" "allow_other")
29577 ","))))
29578 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
29579 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
29580 (hup "0")
29581 (term "no")
29582 (kill "no")))
29583 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
29584 (remove "true"))))
29585 @end lisp
29586
29587 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
29588 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
29589 encrypted @env{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
29590 the partition where he stores his data:
29591
29592 @lisp
29593 (define pam-mount-rules
29594 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
29595 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
29596 (fstype "crypt")
29597 (path "/dev/sda2")
29598 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
29599 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
29600 (fstype "auto")
29601 (path "/dev/sdb3")
29602 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
29603 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
29604 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
29605 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
29606 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
29607 "allow_root" "allow_other")
29608 ","))))
29609 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
29610 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
29611 (hup "0")
29612 (term "no")
29613 (kill "no")))
29614 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
29615 (remove "true")))))
29616
29617 (service pam-mount-service-type
29618 (pam-mount-configuration
29619 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
29620 @end lisp
29621
29622 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
29623 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
29624 @end table
29625 @end deftp
29626
29627
29628 @node Guix Services
29629 @subsection Guix Services
29630
29631 @subsubheading Guix Build Coordinator
29632 The @uref{https://git.cbaines.net/guix/build-coordinator/,Guix Build
29633 Coordinator} aids in distributing derivation builds among machines
29634 running an @dfn{agent}. The build daemon is still used to build the
29635 derivations, but the Guix Build Coordinator manages allocating builds
29636 and working with the results.
29637
29638 @quotation Note
29639 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be
29640 changed in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have
29641 been thorougly tested.
29642 @end quotation
29643
29644 The Guix Build Coordinator consists of one @dfn{coordinator}, and one or
29645 more connected @dfn{agent} processes. The coordinator process handles
29646 clients submitting builds, and allocating builds to agents. The agent
29647 processes talk to a build daemon to actually perform the builds, then
29648 send the results back to the coordinator.
29649
29650 There is a script to run the coordinator component of the Guix Build
29651 Coordinator, but the Guix service uses a custom Guile script instead, to
29652 provide better integration with G-expressions used in the configuration.
29653
29654 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-service-type
29655 Service type for the Guix Build Coordinator. Its value must be a
29656 @code{guix-build-coordinator-configuration} object.
29657 @end defvar
29658
29659 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-configuration
29660 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Build Coordinator.
29661
29662 @table @asis
29663 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
29664 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
29665
29666 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
29667 The system user to run the service as.
29668
29669 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
29670 The system group to run the service as.
29671
29672 @item @code{database-uri-string} (default: @code{"sqlite:///var/lib/guix-build-coordinator/guix_build_coordinator.db"})
29673 The URI to use for the database.
29674
29675 @item @code{agent-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://0.0.0.0:8745"})
29676 The URI describing how to listen to requests from agent processes.
29677
29678 @item @code{client-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://127.0.0.1:8746"})
29679 The URI describing how to listen to requests from clients. The client
29680 API allows submitting builds and currently isn't authenticated, so take
29681 care when configuring this value.
29682
29683 @item @code{allocation-strategy} (default: @code{#~basic-build-allocation-strategy})
29684 A G-expression for the allocation strategy to be used. This is a
29685 procedure that takes the datastore as an argument and populates the
29686 allocation plan in the database.
29687
29688 @item @code{hooks} (default: @var{'()})
29689 An association list of hooks. These provide a way to execute arbitrary
29690 code upon certain events, like a build result being processed.
29691
29692 @item @code{guile} (default: @code{guile-3.0-latest})
29693 The Guile package with which to run the Guix Build Coordinator.
29694
29695 @end table
29696 @end deftp
29697
29698 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-agent-service-type
29699 Service type for a Guix Build Coordinator agent. Its value must be a
29700 @code{guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration} object.
29701 @end defvar
29702
29703 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration
29704 Data type representing the configuration a Guix Build Coordinator agent.
29705
29706 @table @asis
29707 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
29708 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
29709
29710 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-agent"})
29711 The system user to run the service as.
29712
29713 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
29714 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
29715
29716 @item @code{uuid}
29717 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
29718 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
29719 agent.
29720
29721 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
29722 The password to use when connecting to the coordinator. A file to read
29723 the password from can also be specified, and this is more secure.
29724
29725 @item @code{password-file} (default: @code{#f})
29726 A file containing the password to use when connecting to the
29727 coordinator.
29728
29729 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
29730 The systems for which this agent should fetch builds. The agent process
29731 will use the current system it's running on as the default.
29732
29733 @item @code{max-parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
29734 The number of builds to perform in parallel.
29735
29736 @item @code{derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
29737 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for derivations, if the
29738 derivations aren't already available.
29739
29740 @item @code{non-derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
29741 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for build inputs, if the
29742 input store items aren't already available.
29743
29744 @end table
29745 @end deftp
29746
29747 The Guix Build Coordinator package contains a script to query an
29748 instance of the Guix Data Service for derivations to build, and then
29749 submit builds for those derivations to the coordinator. The service
29750 type below assists in running this script. This is an additional tool
29751 that may be useful when building derivations contained within an
29752 instance of the Guix Data Service.
29753
29754 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-service-type
29755 Service type for the
29756 guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-from-guix-data-service script. Its
29757 value must be a @code{guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration}
29758 object.
29759 @end defvar
29760
29761 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration
29762 Data type representing the options to the queue builds from guix data
29763 service script.
29764
29765 @table @asis
29766 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
29767 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
29768
29769 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds"})
29770 The system user to run the service as.
29771
29772 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
29773 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
29774
29775 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
29776 The systems for which to fetch derivations to build.
29777
29778 @item @code{systems-and-targets} (default: @code{#f})
29779 An association list of system and target pairs for which to fetch
29780 derivations to build.
29781
29782 @item @code{guix-data-service} (default: @code{"https://data.guix.gnu.org"})
29783 The Guix Data Service instance from which to query to find out about
29784 derivations to build.
29785
29786 @item @code{processed-commits-file} (default: @code{"/var/cache/guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds/processed-commits"})
29787 A file to record which commits have been processed, to avoid needlessly
29788 processing them again if the service is restarted.
29789
29790 @end table
29791 @end deftp
29792
29793 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
29794 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
29795 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
29796 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
29797
29798 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
29799 interface.
29800
29801 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
29802 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
29803 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
29804 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
29805 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
29806 @end defvar
29807
29808 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
29809 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
29810
29811 @table @asis
29812 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
29813 The Guix Data Service package to use.
29814
29815 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
29816 The system user to run the service as.
29817
29818 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
29819 The system group to run the service as.
29820
29821 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
29822 The port to bind the web service to.
29823
29824 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
29825 The host to bind the web service to.
29826
29827 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
29828 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
29829 configured to listen to.
29830
29831 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
29832 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
29833 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
29834 list.
29835
29836 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
29837 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
29838
29839 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
29840 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
29841
29842 @end table
29843 @end deftp
29844
29845 @node Linux Services
29846 @subsection Linux Services
29847
29848 @cindex oom
29849 @cindex out of memory killer
29850 @cindex earlyoom
29851 @cindex early out of memory daemon
29852 @subsubheading Early OOM Service
29853
29854 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
29855 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
29856 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
29857 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
29858 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
29859
29860 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
29861 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
29862 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
29863 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
29864 with:
29865
29866 @lisp
29867 (service earlyoom-service-type)
29868 @end lisp
29869 @end deffn
29870
29871 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
29872 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
29873
29874 @table @asis
29875 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
29876 The Earlyoom package to use.
29877
29878 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
29879 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
29880
29881 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
29882 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
29883
29884 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
29885 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
29886 that should be preferably killed.
29887
29888 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
29889 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
29890 that should @emph{not} be killed.
29891
29892 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
29893 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
29894 disabled by default.
29895
29896 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
29897 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
29898 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj} should be ignored.
29899
29900 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
29901 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
29902 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
29903
29904 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
29905 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
29906 notifications.
29907 @end table
29908 @end deftp
29909
29910 @cindex modprobe
29911 @cindex kernel module loader
29912 @subsubheading Kernel Module Loader Service
29913
29914 The kernel module loader service allows one to load loadable kernel
29915 modules at boot. This is especially useful for modules that don't
29916 autoload and need to be manually loaded, as it's the case with
29917 @code{ddcci}.
29918
29919 @deffn {Scheme Variable} kernel-module-loader-service-type
29920 The service type for loading loadable kernel modules at boot with
29921 @command{modprobe}. Its value must be a list of strings representing
29922 module names. For example loading the drivers provided by
29923 @code{ddcci-driver-linux}, in debugging mode by passing some module
29924 parameters, can be done as follow:
29925
29926 @lisp
29927 (use-modules (gnu) (gnu services))
29928 (use-package-modules linux)
29929 (use-service-modules linux)
29930
29931 (define ddcci-config
29932 (plain-file "ddcci.conf"
29933 "options ddcci dyndbg delay=120"))
29934
29935 (operating-system
29936 ...
29937 (services (cons* (service kernel-module-loader-service-type
29938 '("ddcci" "ddcci_backlight"))
29939 (simple-service 'ddcci-config etc-service-type
29940 (list `("modprobe.d/ddcci.conf"
29941 ,ddcci-config)))
29942 %base-services))
29943 (kernel-loadable-modules (list ddcci-driver-linux)))
29944 @end lisp
29945 @end deffn
29946
29947 @cindex zram
29948 @cindex compressed swap
29949 @cindex Compressed RAM-based block devices
29950 @subsubheading Zram Device Service
29951
29952 The Zram device service provides a compressed swap device in system
29953 memory. The Linux Kernel documentation has more information about
29954 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/admin-guide/blockdev/zram.html,zram}
29955 devices.
29956
29957 @deffn {Scheme Variable} zram-device-service-type
29958 This service creates the zram block device, formats it as swap and
29959 enables it as a swap device. The service's value is a
29960 @code{zram-device-configuration} record.
29961
29962 @deftp {Data Type} zram-device-configuration
29963 This is the data type representing the configuration for the zram-device
29964 service.
29965
29966 @table @asis
29967 @item @code{size} (default @code{"1G"})
29968 This is the amount of space you wish to provide for the zram device. It
29969 accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a suffix, eg.:
29970 @code{"512M"} or @code{1024000}.
29971 @item @code{compression-algorithm} (default @code{'lzo})
29972 This is the compression algorithm you wish to use. It is difficult to
29973 list all the possible compression options, but common ones supported by
29974 Guix's Linux Libre Kernel include @code{'lzo}, @code{'lz4} and @code{'zstd}.
29975 @item @code{memory-limit} (default @code{0})
29976 This is the maximum amount of memory which the zram device can use.
29977 Setting it to '0' disables the limit. While it is generally expected
29978 that compression will be 2:1, it is possible that uncompressable data
29979 can be written to swap and this is a method to limit how much memory can
29980 be used. It accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a
29981 suffix, eg.: @code{"2G"}.
29982 @item @code{priority} (default @code{-1})
29983 This is the priority of the swap device created from the zram device.
29984 @code{swapon} accepts values between -1 and 32767, with higher values
29985 indicating higher priority. Higher priority swap will generally be used
29986 first.
29987 @end table
29988
29989 @end deftp
29990 @end deffn
29991
29992 @node Hurd Services
29993 @subsection Hurd Services
29994
29995 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-console-service-type
29996 This service starts the fancy @code{VGA} console client on the Hurd.
29997
29998 The service's value is a @code{hurd-console-configuration} record.
29999 @end defvr
30000
30001 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-console-configuration
30002 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
30003 hurd-console-service.
30004
30005 @table @asis
30006 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
30007 The Hurd package to use.
30008 @end table
30009 @end deftp
30010
30011 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-getty-service-type
30012 This service starts a tty using the Hurd @code{getty} program.
30013
30014 The service's value is a @code{hurd-getty-configuration} record.
30015 @end defvr
30016
30017 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-getty-configuration
30018 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
30019 hurd-getty-service.
30020
30021 @table @asis
30022 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
30023 The Hurd package to use.
30024
30025 @item @code{tty}
30026 The name of the console this Getty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
30027
30028 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{38400})
30029 An integer specifying the baud rate of the tty.
30030
30031 @end table
30032 @end deftp
30033
30034 @node Miscellaneous Services
30035 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
30036
30037 @cindex fingerprint
30038 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
30039
30040 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
30041 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
30042
30043 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
30044 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
30045 reading capability.
30046
30047 @lisp
30048 (service fprintd-service-type)
30049 @end lisp
30050 @end defvr
30051
30052 @cindex sysctl
30053 @subsubheading System Control Service
30054
30055 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
30056 parameters at boot.
30057
30058 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
30059 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
30060 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
30061 instantiated as:
30062
30063 @lisp
30064 (service sysctl-service-type
30065 (sysctl-configuration
30066 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
30067 @end lisp
30068 @end defvr
30069
30070 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
30071 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
30072
30073 @table @asis
30074 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
30075 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
30076
30077 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
30078 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
30079 @end table
30080 @end deftp
30081
30082 @cindex pcscd
30083 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
30084
30085 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
30086 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
30087 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
30088 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
30089 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
30090
30091 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
30092 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
30093 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
30094 configuration, instantiate it as:
30095
30096 @lisp
30097 (service pcscd-service-type)
30098 @end lisp
30099 @end defvr
30100
30101 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
30102 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
30103
30104 @table @asis
30105 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
30106 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
30107 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
30108 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
30109 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
30110 @end table
30111 @end deftp
30112
30113 @cindex lirc
30114 @subsubheading Lirc Service
30115
30116 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
30117
30118 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
30119 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
30120 [#:extra-options '()]
30121 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
30122 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
30123
30124 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
30125 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
30126 for details.
30127
30128 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
30129 passed to @command{lircd}.
30130 @end deffn
30131
30132 @cindex spice
30133 @subsubheading Spice Service
30134
30135 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
30136
30137 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
30138 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
30139 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
30140 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
30141 @end deffn
30142
30143 @cindex inputattach
30144 @subsubheading inputattach Service
30145
30146 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
30147 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
30148 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
30149 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
30150 Xorg display server.
30151
30152 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
30153 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
30154 dispatches events from it.
30155 @end deffn
30156
30157 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
30158 @table @asis
30159 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
30160 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
30161 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
30162
30163 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
30164 The device file to connect to the device.
30165
30166 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
30167 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
30168 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
30169
30170 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
30171 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
30172 @end table
30173 @end deftp
30174
30175 @subsubheading Dictionary Service
30176 @cindex dictionary
30177 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
30178
30179 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dicod-service-type
30180 This is the type of the service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an
30181 implementation of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
30182 @end defvr
30183
30184 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
30185 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
30186 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
30187
30188 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
30189 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
30190 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
30191
30192 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
30193 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
30194 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
30195 @end deffn
30196
30197 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
30198 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
30199
30200 @table @asis
30201 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
30202 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
30203
30204 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
30205 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
30206 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
30207 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
30208
30209 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
30210 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
30211
30212 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
30213 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
30214 @end table
30215 @end deftp
30216
30217 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
30218 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
30219
30220 @table @asis
30221 @item @code{name}
30222 Name of the handler (module instance).
30223
30224 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
30225 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
30226 the module has the same name as the handler.
30227 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
30228
30229 @item @code{options}
30230 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
30231 @end table
30232 @end deftp
30233
30234 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
30235 Data type representing a dictionary database.
30236
30237 @table @asis
30238 @item @code{name}
30239 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
30240
30241 @item @code{handler}
30242 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
30243 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
30244
30245 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
30246 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
30247 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
30248
30249 @item @code{options}
30250 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
30251 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
30252 @end table
30253 @end deftp
30254
30255 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
30256 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
30257 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
30258 @end defvr
30259
30260 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
30261
30262 @lisp
30263 (dicod-service #:config
30264 (dicod-configuration
30265 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
30266 (name "wordnet")
30267 (module "dictorg")
30268 (options
30269 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
30270 (databases (list (dicod-database
30271 (name "wordnet")
30272 (complex? #t)
30273 (handler "wordnet")
30274 (options '("database=wn")))
30275 %dicod-database:gcide))))
30276 @end lisp
30277
30278 @cindex Docker
30279 @subsubheading Docker Service
30280
30281 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
30282
30283 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
30284
30285 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
30286 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
30287 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
30288
30289 @end defvr
30290
30291 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
30292 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
30293
30294 @table @asis
30295
30296 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
30297 The Docker daemon package to use.
30298
30299 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker-cli})
30300 The Docker client package to use.
30301
30302 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
30303 The Containerd package to use.
30304
30305 @item @code{proxy} (default @var{docker-libnetwork-cmd-proxy})
30306 The Docker user-land networking proxy package to use.
30307
30308 @item @code{enable-proxy?} (default @code{#t})
30309 Enable or disable the use of the Docker user-land networking proxy.
30310
30311 @item @code{debug?} (default @code{#f})
30312 Enable or disable debug output.
30313
30314 @item @code{enable-iptables?} (default @code{#t})
30315 Enable or disable the addition of iptables rules.
30316
30317 @end table
30318 @end deftp
30319
30320 @cindex Singularity, container service
30321 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
30322 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
30323 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
30324 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
30325 service is the Singularity package to use.
30326
30327 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
30328 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
30329 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
30330 @end defvr
30331
30332 @cindex Audit
30333 @subsubheading Auditd Service
30334
30335 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
30336
30337 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
30338
30339 This is the type of the service that runs
30340 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
30341 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
30342
30343 Examples of things that can be tracked:
30344
30345 @enumerate
30346 @item
30347 File accesses
30348 @item
30349 System calls
30350 @item
30351 Invoked commands
30352 @item
30353 Failed login attempts
30354 @item
30355 Firewall filtering
30356 @item
30357 Network access
30358 @end enumerate
30359
30360 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
30361 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
30362 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
30363 of auditctl into a file called @code{audit.rules} in the configuration
30364 directory (see below).
30365 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
30366 to view a report of all recorded events.
30367 The audit daemon by default logs into the file
30368 @file{/var/log/audit.log}.
30369
30370 @end defvr
30371
30372 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
30373 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
30374
30375 @table @asis
30376
30377 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
30378 The audit package to use.
30379
30380 @item @code{configuration-directory} (default: @code{%default-auditd-configuration-directory})
30381 The directory containing the configuration file for the audit package, which
30382 must be named @code{auditd.conf}, and optionally some audit rules to
30383 instantiate on startup.
30384
30385 @end table
30386 @end deftp
30387
30388 @cindex rshiny
30389 @subsubheading R-Shiny service
30390
30391 The @code{(gnu services science)} module provides the following service.
30392
30393 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rshiny-service-type
30394
30395 This is a type of service which is used to run a webapp created with
30396 @code{r-shiny}. This service sets the @env{R_LIBS_USER} environment
30397 variable and runs the provided script to call @code{runApp}.
30398
30399 @deftp {Data Type} rshiny-configuration
30400 This is the data type representing the configuration of rshiny.
30401
30402 @table @asis
30403
30404 @item @code{package} (default: @code{r-shiny})
30405 The package to use.
30406
30407 @item @code{binary} (defaunlt @code{"rshiny"})
30408 The name of the binary or shell script located at @code{package/bin/} to
30409 run when the service is run.
30410
30411 The common way to create this file is as follows:
30412
30413 @lisp
30414 @dots{}
30415 (let* ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out"))
30416 (targetdir (string-append out "/share/" ,name))
30417 (app (string-append out "/bin/" ,name))
30418 (Rbin (string-append (assoc-ref %build-inputs "r-min")
30419 "/bin/Rscript")))
30420 ;; @dots{}
30421 (mkdir-p (string-append out "/bin"))
30422 (call-with-output-file app
30423 (lambda (port)
30424 (format port
30425 "#!~a
30426 library(shiny)
30427 setwd(\"~a\")
30428 runApp(launch.browser=0, port=4202)~%\n"
30429 Rbin targetdir))))
30430 @end lisp
30431
30432 @end table
30433 @end deftp
30434 @end defvr
30435
30436 @cindex Nix
30437 @subsubheading Nix service
30438
30439 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
30440
30441 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
30442
30443 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
30444 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
30445 how to use it:
30446
30447 @lisp
30448 (use-modules (gnu))
30449 (use-service-modules nix)
30450 (use-package-modules package-management)
30451
30452 (operating-system
30453 ;; @dots{}
30454 (packages (append (list nix)
30455 %base-packages))
30456
30457 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
30458 %base-services)))
30459 @end lisp
30460
30461 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
30462
30463 @itemize
30464 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
30465 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
30466
30467 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
30468 @end itemize
30469
30470 @example
30471 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
30472 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
30473 @end example
30474
30475 @end defvr
30476
30477 @deftp {Data Type} nix-configuration
30478 This data type represents the configuration of the Nix daemon.
30479
30480 @table @asis
30481 @item @code{nix} (default: @code{nix})
30482 The Nix package to use.
30483
30484 @item @code{sandbox} (default: @code{#t})
30485 Specifies whether builds are sandboxed by default.
30486
30487 @item @code{build-sandbox-items} (default: @code{'()})
30488 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the
30489 @code{build-sandbox-items} field of the configuration file.
30490
30491 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
30492 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file.
30493 It is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration
30494 file.
30495
30496 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
30497 Extra command line options for @code{nix-service-type}.
30498 @end table
30499 @end deftp
30500
30501 @node Setuid Programs
30502 @section Setuid Programs
30503
30504 @cindex setuid programs
30505 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
30506 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
30507 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
30508 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
30509 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
30510 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
30511 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
30512 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
30513 for more info about the setuid mechanism).
30514
30515 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
30516 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
30517 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
30518 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
30519 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
30520 should be setuid root.
30521
30522 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
30523 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
30524 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
30525 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
30526 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
30527
30528 @example
30529 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
30530 @end example
30531
30532 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
30533 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
30534
30535 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
30536 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
30537
30538 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
30539 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
30540 @end defvr
30541
30542 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
30543 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
30544 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
30545 store.
30546
30547 @node X.509 Certificates
30548 @section X.509 Certificates
30549
30550 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
30551 @cindex X.509 certificates
30552 @cindex TLS
30553 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
30554 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
30555 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
30556 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
30557 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
30558 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
30559
30560 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
30561 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
30562 out-of-the-box.
30563
30564 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
30565 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
30566 certificates can be found.
30567
30568 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
30569 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
30570 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
30571 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
30572 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
30573 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
30574
30575 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
30576 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
30577 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
30578 to the certificates installed globally.
30579
30580 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
30581 can also install their own certificate package in
30582 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
30583 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
30584 OpenSSL library honors the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @env{SSL_CERT_FILE}
30585 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
30586 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
30587 pointed to by the @env{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
30588 would typically run something like:
30589
30590 @example
30591 guix install nss-certs
30592 export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
30593 export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
30594 export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
30595 @end example
30596
30597 As another example, R requires the @env{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
30598 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
30599 something like this:
30600
30601 @example
30602 guix install nss-certs
30603 export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
30604 @end example
30605
30606 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
30607 variable in the relevant documentation.
30608
30609
30610 @node Name Service Switch
30611 @section Name Service Switch
30612
30613 @cindex name service switch
30614 @cindex NSS
30615 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
30616 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
30617 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
30618 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
30619 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
30620 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
30621 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
30622 C Library Reference Manual}).
30623
30624 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
30625 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
30626 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
30627 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
30628 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
30629 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
30630
30631 @cindex nss-mdns
30632 @cindex .local, host name lookup
30633 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
30634 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
30635 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
30636 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
30637
30638 @lisp
30639 (name-service-switch
30640 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
30641
30642 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
30643 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
30644 (name-service
30645 (name "mdns_minimal")
30646
30647 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
30648 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
30649 ;; no need to try the next methods.
30650 (reaction (lookup-specification
30651 (not-found => return))))
30652
30653 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
30654 (name-service
30655 (name "dns"))
30656
30657 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
30658 (name-service
30659 (name "mdns")))))
30660 @end lisp
30661
30662 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
30663 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
30664 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
30665
30666 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
30667 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
30668 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
30669 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
30670 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
30671 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
30672 @code{nscd-service}}).
30673
30674 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
30675 configurations.
30676
30677 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
30678 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
30679 @code{name-service-switch} object.
30680 @end defvr
30681
30682 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
30683 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
30684 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
30685 @end defvr
30686
30687 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
30688 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
30689 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
30690 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
30691 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
30692 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
30693 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
30694 run @command{guix system}.
30695
30696 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
30697
30698 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
30699 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
30700 system databases.
30701
30702 @table @code
30703 @item aliases
30704 @itemx ethers
30705 @itemx group
30706 @itemx gshadow
30707 @itemx hosts
30708 @itemx initgroups
30709 @itemx netgroup
30710 @itemx networks
30711 @itemx password
30712 @itemx public-key
30713 @itemx rpc
30714 @itemx services
30715 @itemx shadow
30716 The system databases handled by the NSS@. Each of these fields must be a
30717 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
30718 @end table
30719 @end deftp
30720
30721 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
30722
30723 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
30724 associated lookup action.
30725
30726 @table @code
30727 @item name
30728 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
30729 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
30730
30731 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
30732 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
30733 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
30734 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
30735
30736 @item reaction
30737 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
30738 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
30739 Reference Manual}). For example:
30740
30741 @lisp
30742 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
30743 (success => return))
30744 @end lisp
30745 @end table
30746 @end deftp
30747
30748 @node Initial RAM Disk
30749 @section Initial RAM Disk
30750
30751 @cindex initrd
30752 @cindex initial RAM disk
30753 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
30754 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
30755 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
30756 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
30757 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
30758
30759 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
30760 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
30761 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
30762 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
30763 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
30764 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
30765 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
30766 file system, you would write:
30767
30768 @lisp
30769 (operating-system
30770 ;; @dots{}
30771 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
30772 @end lisp
30773
30774 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
30775 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
30776 @end defvr
30777
30778 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
30779 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
30780 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
30781 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
30782 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
30783 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
30784
30785 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
30786 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
30787 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
30788 system declaration like this:
30789
30790 @lisp
30791 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
30792 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
30793 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
30794 (apply base-initrd file-systems
30795 #:qemu-networking? #t
30796 rest)))
30797 @end lisp
30798
30799 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
30800 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
30801 volatile root file system.
30802
30803 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
30804 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
30805 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
30806 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
30807 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
30808 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
30809
30810 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
30811 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
30812 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
30813 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
30814
30815 @table @code
30816 @item --load=@var{boot}
30817 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
30818 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
30819
30820 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
30821 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
30822 initialization system.
30823
30824 @item --root=@var{root}
30825 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
30826 name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system UUID.
30827 When unspecified, the device name from the root file system of the
30828 operating system declaration is used.
30829
30830 @item --system=@var{system}
30831 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
30832 @var{system}.
30833
30834 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
30835 @cindex module, black-listing
30836 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
30837 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
30838 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
30839 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
30840 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
30841
30842 @item --repl
30843 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
30844 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
30845 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
30846 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
30847 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
30848
30849 @end table
30850
30851 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
30852 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
30853 here is how to use it and customize it further.
30854
30855 @cindex initrd
30856 @cindex initial RAM disk
30857 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
30858 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
30859 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
30860 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
30861 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
30862 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
30863 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @option{--root}.
30864 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
30865 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
30866 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
30867 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd.
30868 It may
30869 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
30870 the root file system.
30871
30872 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
30873 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
30874 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
30875 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
30876 intended keyboard layout.
30877
30878 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
30879 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
30880 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
30881
30882 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
30883 to it are lost.
30884 @end deffn
30885
30886 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
30887 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
30888 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
30889 [#:linux-modules '()]
30890 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
30891 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
30892 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
30893 on the kernel command line via @option{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
30894 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
30895
30896 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
30897 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
30898 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
30899 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
30900 intended keyboard layout.
30901
30902 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
30903
30904 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
30905 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
30906 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
30907 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
30908 @end deffn
30909
30910 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
30911 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
30912 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
30913 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
30914 program to run in that initrd.
30915
30916 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
30917 [#:guile %guile-3.0-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
30918 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
30919 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
30920 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
30921 automatically copied to the initrd.
30922 @end deffn
30923
30924 @node Bootloader Configuration
30925 @section Bootloader Configuration
30926
30927 @cindex bootloader
30928 @cindex boot loader
30929
30930 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
30931 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
30932 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
30933 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
30934 installed.
30935
30936 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
30937 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
30938 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
30939 field.
30940
30941 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
30942 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
30943
30944 @table @asis
30945
30946 @item @code{bootloader}
30947 @cindex EFI, bootloader
30948 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
30949 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
30950 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
30951 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
30952 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, @code{extlinux-bootloader} and
30953 @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
30954
30955 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
30956 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
30957 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
30958 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
30959 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
30960 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
30961
30962 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
30963 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
30964 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
30965 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
30966 when you boot it on your system.
30967
30968 @vindex grub-bootloader
30969 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
30970 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
30971
30972 @vindex grub-efi-netboot-bootloader
30973 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} allows you to boot your system over network
30974 through TFTP@. In combination with an NFS root file system this allows you to
30975 build a diskless Guix system.
30976
30977 The installation of the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} generates the content
30978 of the TFTP root directory at @code{target}
30979 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{target}}), to be served by a TFTP server.
30980 You may want to mount your TFTP server directory onto @code{target} to move the
30981 required files to the TFTP server automatically.
30982
30983 If you plan to use an NFS root file system as well (actually if you mount the
30984 store from an NFS share), then the TFTP server needs to serve the file
30985 @file{/boot/grub/grub.cfg} and other files from the store (like GRUBs background
30986 image, the kernel (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{kernel}}) and the
30987 initrd (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{initrd}})), too. All these
30988 files from the store will be accessed by GRUB through TFTP with their normal
30989 store path, for example as
30990 @file{tftp://tftp-server/gnu/store/…-initrd/initrd.cpio.gz}.
30991
30992 Two symlinks are created to make this possible. The first symlink is
30993 @code{target}@file{/efi/Guix/boot/grub/grub.cfg} pointing to
30994 @file{../../../boot/grub/grub.cfg},
30995 where @code{target} may be @file{/boot}. In this case the link is not leaving
30996 the served TFTP root directory, but otherwise it does. The second link is
30997 @code{target}@file{/gnu/store} and points to @file{../gnu/store}. This link
30998 is leaving the served TFTP root directory.
30999
31000 The assumption behind all this is that you have an NFS server exporting the root
31001 file system for your Guix system, and additionally a TFTP server exporting your
31002 @code{target} directory—usually @file{/boot}—from that same root file system for
31003 your Guix system. In this constellation the symlinks will work.
31004
31005 For other constellations you will have to program your own bootloader installer,
31006 which then takes care to make necessary files from the store accessible through
31007 TFTP, for example by copying them into the TFTP root directory at @code{target}.
31008
31009 It is important to note that symlinks pointing outside the TFTP root directory
31010 may need to be allowed in the configuration of your TFTP server. Further the
31011 store link exposes the whole store through TFTP@. Both points need to be
31012 considered carefully for security aspects.
31013
31014 Beside the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, the already mentioned TFTP and
31015 NFS servers, you also need a properly configured DHCP server to make the booting
31016 over netboot possible. For all this we can currently only recommend you to look
31017 for instructions about @acronym{PXE, Preboot eXecution Environment}.
31018
31019 @item @code{target}
31020 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
31021 bootloader.
31022
31023 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
31024 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
31025 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
31026 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
31027 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
31028 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}. For @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader},
31029 @code{target} should be the mount point corresponding to the TFTP root
31030 directory of your TFTP server.
31031
31032 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
31033 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
31034 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
31035 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
31036
31037 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
31038 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
31039 current system.
31040
31041 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
31042 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
31043 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
31044
31045 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
31046 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
31047 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
31048 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
31049
31050 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
31051 Layout}).
31052
31053 @quotation Note
31054 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
31055 @code{grub-efi}.
31056 @end quotation
31057
31058 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
31059 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
31060 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
31061 for GRUB.
31062
31063 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
31064 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
31065 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
31066 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
31067 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
31068 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
31069 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
31070
31071 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
31072 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
31073 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
31074 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
31075 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
31076 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
31077 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
31078 manual}).
31079
31080 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
31081 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
31082 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
31083 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
31084
31085 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
31086 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
31087 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
31088 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
31089 @end table
31090
31091 @end deftp
31092
31093 @cindex dual boot
31094 @cindex boot menu
31095 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
31096 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
31097 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
31098 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
31099 along these lines:
31100
31101 @lisp
31102 (menu-entry
31103 (label "The Other Distro")
31104 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
31105 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
31106 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
31107 @end lisp
31108
31109 Details below.
31110
31111 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
31112 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
31113
31114 @table @asis
31115
31116 @item @code{label}
31117 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
31118
31119 @item @code{linux} (default: @code{#f})
31120 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
31121
31122 @lisp
31123 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
31124 @end lisp
31125
31126 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
31127 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
31128 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
31129
31130 @example
31131 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
31132 @end example
31133
31134 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
31135 field is ignored entirely.
31136
31137 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
31138 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
31139 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
31140
31141 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{#f})
31142 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
31143 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
31144
31145 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
31146 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
31147 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
31148
31149 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
31150 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
31151 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
31152 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
31153 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
31154
31155 @item @code{multiboot-kernel} (default: @code{#f})
31156 The kernel to boot in Multiboot-mode (@pxref{multiboot,,, grub, GNU GRUB
31157 manual}). When this field is set, a Multiboot menu-entry is generated.
31158 For example:
31159
31160 @lisp
31161 (file-append mach "/boot/gnumach")
31162 @end lisp
31163
31164 @item @code{multiboot-arguments} (default: @code{()})
31165 The list of extra command-line arguments for the multiboot-kernel.
31166
31167 @item @code{multiboot-modules} (default: @code{()})
31168 The list of commands for loading Multiboot modules. For example:
31169
31170 @lisp
31171 (list (list (file-append hurd "/hurd/ext2fs.static") "ext2fs"
31172 @dots{})
31173 (list (file-append libc "/lib/ld.so.1") "exec"
31174 @dots{}))
31175 @end lisp
31176
31177 @end table
31178 @end deftp
31179
31180 @cindex HDPI
31181 @cindex HiDPI
31182 @cindex resolution
31183 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
31184 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
31185 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
31186
31187 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
31188 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
31189
31190 @table @asis
31191 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
31192 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings,
31193 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
31194 @end table
31195 @end deftp
31196
31197 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} grub-theme
31198 Return the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
31199 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
31200 record.
31201
31202 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
31203 logos.
31204 @end deffn
31205
31206 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
31207 like
31208
31209 @lisp
31210 (bootloader
31211 (bootloader-configuration
31212 ;; @dots{}
31213 (theme (grub-theme
31214 (inherit (grub-theme))
31215 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
31216 @end lisp
31217
31218 @node Invoking guix system
31219 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
31220
31221 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
31222 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
31223 system} command. The synopsis is:
31224
31225 @example
31226 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
31227 @end example
31228
31229 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
31230 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
31231 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
31232 supported:
31233
31234 @table @code
31235 @item search
31236 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
31237 expressions, sorted by relevance:
31238
31239 @cindex HDPI
31240 @cindex HiDPI
31241 @cindex resolution
31242 @example
31243 $ guix system search console
31244 name: console-fonts
31245 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
31246 extends: shepherd-root
31247 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
31248 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
31249 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
31250 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
31251 +
31252 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
31253 + ("tty2" . (file-append
31254 + font-tamzen
31255 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
31256 + ("tty3" . (file-append
31257 + font-terminus
31258 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
31259 relevance: 9
31260
31261 name: mingetty
31262 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
31263 extends: shepherd-root
31264 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
31265 relevance: 2
31266
31267 name: login
31268 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
31269 extends: pam
31270 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
31271 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
31272 relevance: 2
31273
31274 @dots{}
31275 @end example
31276
31277 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
31278 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
31279 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
31280
31281 @item reconfigure
31282 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
31283 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
31284 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
31285 systems already running Guix System.}.
31286
31287 @quotation Note
31288 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
31289 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
31290 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
31291 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
31292 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
31293 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
31294 @end quotation
31295
31296 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
31297 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
31298 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
31299 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
31300 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
31301 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
31302
31303 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
31304 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
31305 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
31306 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
31307 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
31308
31309 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
31310 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
31311 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
31312 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
31313
31314 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
31315 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
31316 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
31317 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
31318 @var{file} itself, when available. You can view it by running:
31319
31320 @example
31321 guix system describe
31322 @end example
31323
31324 This information is useful should you later want to inspect how this
31325 particular generation was built. In fact, assuming @var{file} is
31326 self-contained, you can later rebuild generation @var{n} of your
31327 operating system with:
31328
31329 @example
31330 guix time-machine \
31331 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
31332 system reconfigure \
31333 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
31334 @end example
31335
31336 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
31337 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
31338 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
31339 information on provenance tracking.
31340
31341 By default, @command{reconfigure} @emph{prevents you from downgrading
31342 your system}, which could (re)introduce security vulnerabilities and
31343 also cause problems with ``stateful'' services such as database
31344 management systems. You can override that behavior by passing
31345 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
31346
31347 @item switch-generation
31348 @cindex generations
31349 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
31350 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
31351 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
31352 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
31353 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
31354 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
31355 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
31356
31357 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
31358 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
31359 configuration file.
31360
31361 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
31362 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
31363 generation 7:
31364
31365 @example
31366 guix system switch-generation 7
31367 @end example
31368
31369 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
31370 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
31371 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
31372 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
31373 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
31374 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
31375
31376 @example
31377 guix system switch-generation -- -1
31378 @end example
31379
31380 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
31381 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
31382 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
31383 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
31384 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
31385 like activating and deactivating services.
31386
31387 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
31388
31389 @item roll-back
31390 @cindex rolling back
31391 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
31392 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
31393 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
31394 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
31395
31396 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
31397 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
31398 generation.
31399
31400 @item delete-generations
31401 @cindex deleting system generations
31402 @cindex saving space
31403 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
31404 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
31405 collector'').
31406
31407 This works in the same way as @samp{guix package --delete-generations}
31408 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @option{--delete-generations}}). With no
31409 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
31410
31411 @example
31412 guix system delete-generations
31413 @end example
31414
31415 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
31416 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
31417
31418 @example
31419 guix system delete-generations 2m
31420 @end example
31421
31422 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
31423 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
31424 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
31425
31426 @item build
31427 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
31428 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
31429 This action does not actually install anything.
31430
31431 @item init
31432 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
31433 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
31434 installations of Guix System. For instance:
31435
31436 @example
31437 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
31438 @end example
31439
31440 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
31441 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
31442 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
31443 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
31444 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
31445
31446 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
31447 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
31448 passed.
31449
31450 @item vm
31451 @cindex virtual machine
31452 @cindex VM
31453 @anchor{guix system vm}
31454 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
31455 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
31456
31457 @quotation Note
31458 The @code{vm} action and others below
31459 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
31460 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
31461 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
31462 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
31463 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
31464 @end quotation
31465
31466 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
31467 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
31468 emulated machine:
31469
31470 @example
31471 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
31472 @end example
31473
31474 The VM shares its store with the host system.
31475
31476 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
31477 the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} command-line options: the former
31478 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
31479 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
31480
31481 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
31482 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
31483 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
31484
31485 @example
31486 guix system vm my-config.scm \
31487 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
31488 @end example
31489
31490 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
31491 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
31492 store of the host can then be mounted.
31493
31494 The @option{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
31495 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
31496 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
31497 be created. The @option{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
31498 size of the image.
31499
31500 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
31501 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
31502 @item vm-image
31503 @itemx image
31504 @itemx docker-image
31505 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
31506 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
31507 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
31508 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
31509 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
31510 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
31511 @code{docker-image}.
31512
31513 @cindex image, creating disk images
31514 The @code{image} command can produce various image types. The
31515 image type can be selected using the @option{--image-type} option. It
31516 defaults to @code{efi-raw}. When its value is @code{iso9660}, the
31517 @option{--label} option can be used to specify a volume ID with
31518 @code{image}. By default, the root file system of a disk image is
31519 mounted non-volatile; the @option{--volatile} option can be provided to
31520 make it volatile instead. When using @code{image}, the bootloader
31521 installed on the generated image is taken from the provided
31522 @code{operating-system} definition. The following example demonstrates
31523 how to generate an image that uses the @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
31524 bootloader and boot it with QEMU:
31525
31526 @example
31527 image=$(guix system image --image-type=qcow2 \
31528 gnu/system/examples/lightweight-desktop.tmpl)
31529 cp $image /tmp/my-image.qcow2
31530 chmod +w /tmp/my-image.qcow2
31531 qemu-system-x86_64 -enable-kvm -hda /tmp/my-image.qcow2 -m 1000 \
31532 -bios $(guix build ovmf)/share/firmware/ovmf_x64.bin
31533 @end example
31534
31535 When using the @code{efi-raw} image type, a raw disk image is produced;
31536 it can be copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming
31537 @code{/dev/sdc} is the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy
31538 the image to it using the following command:
31539
31540 @example
31541 # dd if=$(guix system image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc status=progress
31542 @end example
31543
31544 The @code{--list-image-types} command lists all the available image
31545 types.
31546
31547 @cindex vm-image, creating virtual machine images
31548 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
31549 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for
31550 more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine. The
31551 @code{grub-bootloader} bootloader is always used independently of what
31552 is declared in the @code{operating-system} file passed as argument.
31553 This is to make it easier to work with QEMU, which uses the SeaBIOS BIOS
31554 by default, expecting a bootloader to be installed in the Master Boot
31555 Record (MBR).
31556
31557 @cindex docker-image, creating docker images
31558 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
31559 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
31560 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
31561 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
31562 Docker container using commands like the following:
31563
31564 @example
31565 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
31566 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
31567 docker start $container_id
31568 @end example
31569
31570 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
31571 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
31572 start any services you have defined in the operating system
31573 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
31574 using @command{docker exec}:
31575
31576 @example
31577 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
31578 @end example
31579
31580 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
31581 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
31582 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
31583 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
31584 @code{docker create}.
31585
31586 Last, the @option{--network} option applies to @command{guix system
31587 docker-image}: it produces an image where network is supposedly shared
31588 with the host, and thus without services like nscd or NetworkManager.
31589
31590 @item container
31591 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
31592 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
31593 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
31594 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
31595 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
31596 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
31597
31598 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
31599 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
31600 system.
31601
31602 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
31603 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
31604 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
31605
31606 @example
31607 guix system container my-config.scm \
31608 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
31609 @end example
31610
31611 @quotation Note
31612 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
31613 @end quotation
31614
31615 @end table
31616
31617 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
31618 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
31619 following:
31620
31621 @table @option
31622 @item --expression=@var{expr}
31623 @itemx -e @var{expr}
31624 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
31625 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
31626 operating system.
31627 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
31628 Installation Image}).
31629
31630 @item --system=@var{system}
31631 @itemx -s @var{system}
31632 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
31633 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
31634
31635 @item --derivation
31636 @itemx -d
31637 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
31638 building anything.
31639
31640 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
31641 @item --save-provenance
31642 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
31643 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
31644 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
31645 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
31646 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
31647 can run:
31648
31649 @example
31650 guix system vm-image --save-provenance config.scm
31651 @end example
31652
31653 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
31654 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
31655 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
31656 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
31657 of the image.
31658
31659 @item --image-type=@var{type}
31660 @itemx -t @var{type}
31661 For the @code{image} action, create an image with given @var{type}.
31662
31663 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses the
31664 @code{efi-raw} image type.
31665
31666 @cindex ISO-9660 format
31667 @cindex CD image format
31668 @cindex DVD image format
31669 @option{--image-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
31670 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
31671
31672 @item --image-size=@var{size}
31673 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{image} actions, create an image
31674 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
31675 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
31676 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
31677
31678 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
31679 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
31680 @var{file}.
31681
31682 @item --network
31683 @itemx -N
31684 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
31685 that is, do not create a network namespace.
31686
31687 @item --root=@var{file}
31688 @itemx -r @var{file}
31689 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
31690 collector root.
31691
31692 @item --skip-checks
31693 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
31694
31695 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
31696 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
31697 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
31698 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
31699 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
31700 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
31701
31702 @item --allow-downgrades
31703 Instruct @command{guix system reconfigure} to allow system downgrades.
31704
31705 By default, @command{reconfigure} prevents you from downgrading your
31706 system. It achieves that by comparing the provenance info of your
31707 system (shown by @command{guix system describe}) with that of your
31708 @command{guix} command (shown by @command{guix describe}). If the
31709 commits for @command{guix} are not descendants of those used for your
31710 system, @command{guix system reconfigure} errors out. Passing
31711 @option{--allow-downgrades} allows you to bypass these checks.
31712
31713 @quotation Note
31714 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
31715 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
31716 @end quotation
31717
31718 @cindex on-error
31719 @cindex on-error strategy
31720 @cindex error strategy
31721 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
31722 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
31723 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
31724
31725 @table @code
31726 @item nothing-special
31727 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
31728
31729 @item backtrace
31730 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
31731
31732 @item debug
31733 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
31734 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
31735 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
31736 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
31737 a list of available debugging commands.
31738 @end table
31739 @end table
31740
31741 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
31742 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
31743 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
31744 bootloader boot menu:
31745
31746 @table @code
31747
31748 @item describe
31749 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
31750 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
31751
31752 @item list-generations
31753 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
31754 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
31755 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
31756 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
31757
31758 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
31759 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
31760 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
31761 generations that are up to 10 days old:
31762
31763 @example
31764 $ guix system list-generations 10d
31765 @end example
31766
31767 @end table
31768
31769 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
31770 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
31771 each other:
31772
31773 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
31774 @table @code
31775
31776 @item extension-graph
31777 Emit to standard output the @dfn{service
31778 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
31779 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
31780 extensions). By default the output is in Dot/Graphviz format, but you
31781 can choose a different format with @option{--graph-backend}, as with
31782 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph, @option{--backend}}):
31783
31784 The command:
31785
31786 @example
31787 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | xdot -
31788 @end example
31789
31790 shows the extension relations among services.
31791
31792 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
31793 @item shepherd-graph
31794 Emit to standard output the @dfn{dependency
31795 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
31796 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
31797 example graph.
31798
31799 Again, the default output format is Dot/Graphviz, but you can pass
31800 @option{--graph-backend} to select a different one.
31801
31802 @end table
31803
31804 @node Invoking guix deploy
31805 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
31806
31807 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
31808 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
31809 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
31810 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
31811 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
31812 once as a logical ``deployment''.
31813
31814 @quotation Note
31815 The functionality described in this section is still under development
31816 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
31817 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
31818 @end quotation
31819
31820 @example
31821 guix deploy @var{file}
31822 @end example
31823
31824 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
31825 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
31826
31827 @lisp
31828 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
31829 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
31830 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
31831 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
31832 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
31833
31834 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
31835 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
31836
31837 (define %system
31838 (operating-system
31839 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
31840 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
31841 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
31842 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
31843 (target "/dev/vda")
31844 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
31845 (file-systems (cons (file-system
31846 (mount-point "/")
31847 (device "/dev/vda1")
31848 (type "ext4"))
31849 %base-file-systems))
31850 (services
31851 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
31852 (service openssh-service-type
31853 (openssh-configuration
31854 (permit-root-login #t)
31855 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
31856 %base-services))))
31857
31858 (list (machine
31859 (operating-system %system)
31860 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
31861 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
31862 (host-name "localhost")
31863 (system "x86_64-linux")
31864 (user "alice")
31865 (identity "./id_rsa")
31866 (port 2222)))))
31867 @end lisp
31868
31869 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
31870 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
31871 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @code{%system}.
31872 @code{environment} and @code{configuration} specify how the machine should be
31873 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
31874 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
31875 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
31876 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
31877 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
31878 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
31879 @var{environment} type would be used.
31880
31881 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
31882 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
31883 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), though this step is automatic on Guix
31884 System:
31885
31886 @example
31887 # guix archive --generate-key
31888 @end example
31889
31890 @noindent
31891 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
31892 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
31893
31894 @example
31895 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
31896 @end example
31897
31898 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
31899 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
31900 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
31901 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
31902 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
31903 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
31904 @code{user}. That is, the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
31905 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag. This can
31906 be accomplished with the following operating system configuration snippet:
31907
31908 @lisp
31909 (use-modules ...
31910 (gnu system)) ;for %sudoers-specification
31911
31912 (define %user "username")
31913
31914 (operating-system
31915 ...
31916 (sudoers-file
31917 (plain-file "sudoers"
31918 (string-append (plain-file-content %sudoers-specification)
31919 (format #f "~a ALL = NOPASSWD: ALL~%"
31920 %user)))))
31921
31922 @end lisp
31923
31924 For more information regarding the format of the @file{sudoers} file,
31925 consult @command{man sudoers}.
31926
31927 @deftp {Data Type} machine
31928 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
31929 deployment.
31930
31931 @table @asis
31932 @item @code{operating-system}
31933 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
31934
31935 @item @code{environment}
31936 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
31937
31938 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
31939 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
31940 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
31941 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
31942 however, an error will be thrown.
31943 @end table
31944 @end deftp
31945
31946 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
31947 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
31948 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
31949
31950 @table @asis
31951 @item @code{host-name}
31952 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
31953 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
31954 @item @code{system}
31955 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
31956 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
31957 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
31958 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
31959 keyring.
31960 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
31961 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
31962 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
31963 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
31964 remote host.
31965
31966 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
31967 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
31968
31969 @example
31970 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
31971 @end example
31972
31973 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
31974 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
31975 client does.
31976
31977 @item @code{allow-downgrades?} (default: @code{#f})
31978 Whether to allow potential downgrades.
31979
31980 Like @command{guix system reconfigure}, @command{guix deploy} compares
31981 the channel commits currently deployed on the remote host (as returned
31982 by @command{guix system describe}) to those currently in use (as
31983 returned by @command{guix describe}) to determine whether commits
31984 currently in use are descendants of those deployed. When this is not
31985 the case and @code{allow-downgrades?} is false, it raises an error.
31986 This ensures you do not accidentally downgrade remote machines.
31987 @end table
31988 @end deftp
31989
31990 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
31991 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
31992 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
31993
31994 @table @asis
31995 @item @code{ssh-key}
31996 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
31997 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
31998 @item @code{tags}
31999 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
32000 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
32001 @item @code{region}
32002 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
32003 @item @code{size}
32004 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
32005 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
32006 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
32007 @end table
32008 @end deftp
32009
32010 @node Running Guix in a VM
32011 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
32012
32013 @cindex virtual machine
32014 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
32015 distributed at
32016 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
32017 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
32018 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
32019 as QEMU (see below for details).
32020
32021 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
32022 commonly used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
32023 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
32024 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
32025 as @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} (@pxref{Using the
32026 Configuration System}).
32027
32028 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
32029 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
32030 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
32031 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
32032
32033 @cindex QEMU
32034 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
32035 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
32036 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
32037 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
32038 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
32039 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
32040
32041 @example
32042 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
32043 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
32044 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
32045 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
32046 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
32047 @end example
32048
32049 Here is what each of these options means:
32050
32051 @table @code
32052 @item qemu-system-x86_64
32053 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
32054 host.
32055
32056 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
32057 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
32058 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
32059 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
32060 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
32061 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
32062 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
32063 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
32064
32065 @item -enable-kvm
32066 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
32067 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
32068 faster.
32069
32070 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
32071 @item -m 1024
32072 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
32073 which may be insufficient for some operations.
32074
32075 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
32076 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
32077 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
32078 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
32079 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
32080
32081 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
32082 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing
32083 store of the ``myhd'' drive.
32084 @end table
32085
32086 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
32087 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
32088 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
32089 to your system definition and start the VM using
32090 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
32091 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
32092 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
32093 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
32094
32095 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
32096
32097 @cindex SSH
32098 @cindex SSH server
32099 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
32100 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
32101 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
32102 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
32103
32104 @example
32105 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
32106 @end example
32107
32108 To connect to the VM you can run
32109
32110 @example
32111 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
32112 @end example
32113
32114 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
32115 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
32116 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
32117 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
32118 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
32119
32120 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
32121
32122 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
32123 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
32124 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
32125 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
32126
32127 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
32128 VM@. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
32129
32130 @example
32131 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
32132 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
32133 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
32134 name=com.redhat.spice.0
32135 @end example
32136
32137 You'll also need to add the @code{(spice-vdagent-service)} to your
32138 system definition (@pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}).
32139
32140 @node Defining Services
32141 @section Defining Services
32142
32143 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
32144 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
32145 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
32146
32147 @menu
32148 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
32149 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
32150 * Service Reference:: API reference.
32151 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
32152 @end menu
32153
32154 @node Service Composition
32155 @subsection Service Composition
32156
32157 @cindex services
32158 @cindex daemons
32159 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
32160 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
32161 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
32162 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
32163 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
32164 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
32165 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
32166 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
32167 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
32168 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
32169 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
32170 of the system.
32171
32172 @cindex service extensions
32173 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
32174 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
32175 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
32176 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
32177 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
32178 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
32179 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
32180 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
32181 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
32182 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
32183 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
32184
32185 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
32186 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
32187 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
32188
32189 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
32190
32191 @cindex system service
32192 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
32193 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
32194 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
32195 to learn about the other service types shown here.
32196 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
32197 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
32198 particular operating system definition.
32199
32200 @cindex service types
32201 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
32202 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
32203 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
32204 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
32205 different parameters.
32206
32207 The following section describes the programming interface for service
32208 types and services.
32209
32210 @node Service Types and Services
32211 @subsection Service Types and Services
32212
32213 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
32214 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
32215 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
32216
32217 @lisp
32218 (define guix-service-type
32219 (service-type
32220 (name 'guix)
32221 (extensions
32222 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
32223 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
32224 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
32225 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
32226 @end lisp
32227
32228 @noindent
32229 It defines three things:
32230
32231 @enumerate
32232 @item
32233 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
32234
32235 @item
32236 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
32237 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
32238 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
32239
32240 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
32241 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
32242
32243 @item
32244 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
32245 @end enumerate
32246
32247 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
32248
32249 @table @code
32250 @item shepherd-root-service-type
32251 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
32252 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
32253 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
32254 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
32255
32256 @item account-service-type
32257 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
32258 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
32259 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
32260 guix-daemon}).
32261
32262 @item activation-service-type
32263 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
32264 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
32265 booted.
32266 @end table
32267
32268 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
32269
32270 @lisp
32271 (service guix-service-type
32272 (guix-configuration
32273 (build-accounts 5)
32274 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
32275 @end lisp
32276
32277 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
32278 the parameters of this specific service instance.
32279 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
32280 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
32281 value is omitted, the default value specified by
32282 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
32283
32284 @lisp
32285 (service guix-service-type)
32286 @end lisp
32287
32288 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
32289 services but is not extensible itself.
32290
32291 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
32292
32293 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
32294
32295 @lisp
32296 (define udev-service-type
32297 (service-type (name 'udev)
32298 (extensions
32299 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
32300 udev-shepherd-service)))
32301
32302 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
32303 (extend (lambda (config rules)
32304 (match config
32305 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
32306 (udev-configuration
32307 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
32308 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
32309 @end lisp
32310
32311 This is the service type for the
32312 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
32313 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
32314 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
32315
32316 @table @code
32317 @item compose
32318 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
32319 services of this type.
32320
32321 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
32322 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
32323
32324 @item extend
32325 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
32326 the composition of the extensions.
32327
32328 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
32329 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
32330 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
32331 list of contributed rules.
32332
32333 @item description
32334 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
32335 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
32336 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
32337 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
32338 @end table
32339
32340 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
32341 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
32342 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
32343
32344 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
32345 interface for services.
32346
32347 @node Service Reference
32348 @subsection Service Reference
32349
32350 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
32351 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
32352 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
32353 @code{(gnu services)} module.
32354
32355 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
32356 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
32357 below). @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
32358 this particular service instance.
32359
32360 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
32361 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
32362 raised.
32363
32364 For instance, this:
32365
32366 @lisp
32367 (service openssh-service-type)
32368 @end lisp
32369
32370 @noindent
32371 is equivalent to this:
32372
32373 @lisp
32374 (service openssh-service-type
32375 (openssh-configuration))
32376 @end lisp
32377
32378 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
32379 with the default configuration.
32380 @end deffn
32381
32382 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
32383 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
32384 @end deffn
32385
32386 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
32387 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
32388 @end deffn
32389
32390 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
32391 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
32392 parameters.
32393 @end deffn
32394
32395 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
32396
32397 @lisp
32398 (define s
32399 (service nginx-service-type
32400 (nginx-configuration
32401 (nginx nginx)
32402 (log-directory log-directory)
32403 (run-directory run-directory)
32404 (file config-file))))
32405
32406 (service? s)
32407 @result{} #t
32408
32409 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
32410 @result{} #t
32411 @end lisp
32412
32413 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
32414 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
32415 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
32416 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
32417 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
32418 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
32419 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
32420 common pattern.
32421
32422 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
32423 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
32424
32425 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
32426 clauses. Each clause has the form:
32427
32428 @example
32429 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
32430 @end example
32431
32432 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
32433 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
32434 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
32435 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
32436 @var{type}.
32437
32438 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
32439 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
32440 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
32441 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
32442 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
32443 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
32444
32445 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
32446
32447 @end deffn
32448
32449 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
32450 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
32451 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
32452 @code{operating-system} declaration.
32453
32454 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
32455 @cindex service type
32456 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
32457 and Services}).
32458
32459 @table @asis
32460 @item @code{name}
32461 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
32462
32463 @item @code{extensions}
32464 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
32465
32466 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
32467 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
32468 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
32469 services.
32470
32471 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
32472 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
32473 extensions. It may return any single value.
32474
32475 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
32476 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
32477
32478 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
32479 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
32480 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
32481 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
32482 parameter value for the service instance.
32483
32484 @item @code{description}
32485 This is a string, possibly using Texinfo markup, describing in a couple
32486 of sentences what the service is about. This string allows users to
32487 find about the service through @command{guix system search}
32488 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
32489
32490 @item @code{default-value} (default: @code{&no-default-value})
32491 The default value associated for instances of this service type. This
32492 allows users to use the @code{service} form without its second argument:
32493
32494 @lisp
32495 (service @var{type})
32496 @end lisp
32497
32498 The returned service in this case has the default value specified by
32499 @var{type}.
32500 @end table
32501
32502 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
32503 @end deftp
32504
32505 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
32506 @var{compute}
32507 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
32508 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
32509 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
32510 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
32511 @end deffn
32512
32513 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
32514 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
32515 @end deffn
32516
32517 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
32518 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
32519 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
32520 provides a shorthand for this.
32521
32522 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
32523 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
32524 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
32525 service is an instance.
32526
32527 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
32528 an additional job:
32529
32530 @lisp
32531 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
32532 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
32533 @end lisp
32534 @end deffn
32535
32536 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
32537 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
32538 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
32539 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
32540 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
32541 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
32542 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
32543
32544 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
32545 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
32546 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
32547 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
32548 @end deffn
32549
32550 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
32551 service types, some of which are listed below.
32552
32553 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
32554 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
32555 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
32556 @end defvr
32557
32558 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
32559 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
32560 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
32561 @end defvr
32562
32563 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
32564 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
32565 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
32566 passing it name/file tuples such as:
32567
32568 @lisp
32569 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
32570 @end lisp
32571
32572 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
32573 pointing to the given file.
32574 @end defvr
32575
32576 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
32577 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
32578 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
32579 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
32580 @end defvr
32581
32582 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
32583 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
32584 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
32585 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
32586 @end defvr
32587
32588 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32589 @anchor{provenance-service-type}
32590 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
32591 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
32592 in the system itself. It creates several files under
32593 @file{/run/current-system}:
32594
32595 @table @file
32596 @item channels.scm
32597 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
32598 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
32599 to build the system, if that information was available
32600 (@pxref{Channels}).
32601
32602 @item configuration.scm
32603 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
32604 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
32605 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
32606 received on the command line.
32607
32608 @item provenance
32609 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
32610 format that is more readily processable.
32611 @end table
32612
32613 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
32614 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
32615
32616 @quotation Caveats
32617 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
32618 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
32619 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
32620 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
32621 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
32622 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
32623
32624 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
32625 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
32626 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
32627 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
32628 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
32629 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
32630 comparison less trivial.
32631 @end quotation
32632
32633 This service is automatically added to your operating system
32634 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
32635 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
32636 @end defvr
32637
32638 @node Shepherd Services
32639 @subsection Shepherd Services
32640
32641 @cindex shepherd services
32642 @cindex PID 1
32643 @cindex init system
32644 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
32645 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
32646 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
32647 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
32648 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
32649
32650 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
32651 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
32652 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
32653 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
32654 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
32655
32656 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
32657
32658 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
32659 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
32660 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
32661
32662 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
32663 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
32664 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
32665
32666 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
32667 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
32668
32669 @table @asis
32670 @item @code{provision}
32671 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
32672
32673 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
32674 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
32675 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
32676 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
32677
32678 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
32679 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
32680
32681 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
32682 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
32683 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
32684 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
32685 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
32686
32687 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
32688 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
32689 underlying process dies.
32690
32691 @item @code{start}
32692 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
32693 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
32694 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
32695 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
32696 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
32697 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
32698
32699 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
32700 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
32701 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
32702 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
32703 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
32704 @command{herd} sub-commands:
32705
32706 @example
32707 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
32708 @end example
32709
32710 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
32711 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
32712 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
32713
32714 @item @code{documentation}
32715 A documentation string, as shown when running:
32716
32717 @example
32718 herd doc @var{service-name}
32719 @end example
32720
32721 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
32722 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
32723
32724 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
32725 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
32726 @code{stop} are evaluated.
32727
32728 @end table
32729 @end deftp
32730
32731 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
32732 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
32733 Shepherd service (see above).
32734
32735 @table @code
32736 @item name
32737 Symbol naming the action.
32738
32739 @item documentation
32740 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
32741
32742 @example
32743 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
32744 @end example
32745
32746 @item procedure
32747 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
32748 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
32749 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
32750 @end table
32751
32752 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
32753 greets the user:
32754
32755 @lisp
32756 (shepherd-action
32757 (name 'say-hello)
32758 (documentation "Say hi!")
32759 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
32760 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
32761 args)
32762 #t)))
32763 @end lisp
32764
32765 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
32766
32767 @example
32768 # herd say-hello example
32769 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
32770 # herd say-hello example a b c
32771 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
32772 @end example
32773
32774 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
32775 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
32776 info on actions.
32777 @end deftp
32778
32779 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
32780 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
32781
32782 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
32783 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
32784 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
32785 @end defvr
32786
32787 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
32788 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
32789 @end defvr
32790
32791
32792 @node Documentation
32793 @chapter Documentation
32794
32795 @cindex documentation, searching for
32796 @cindex searching for documentation
32797 @cindex Info, documentation format
32798 @cindex man pages
32799 @cindex manual pages
32800 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
32801 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
32802 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
32803 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
32804 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
32805 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
32806
32807 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
32808 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
32809 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
32810
32811 @example
32812 $ info -k TLS
32813 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
32814 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
32815 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
32816 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
32817 @dots{}
32818 @end example
32819
32820 @noindent
32821 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
32822
32823 @example
32824 $ man -k TLS
32825 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
32826 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
32827 @dots {}
32828 @end example
32829
32830 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
32831 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
32832 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
32833 respected.
32834
32835 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
32836 running, say:
32837
32838 @example
32839 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
32840 @end example
32841
32842 @noindent
32843 or:
32844
32845 @example
32846 $ man certtool
32847 @end example
32848
32849 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
32850 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
32851 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
32852 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
32853 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
32854 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
32855
32856 @node Installing Debugging Files
32857 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
32858
32859 @cindex debugging files
32860 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
32861 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
32862 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
32863 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
32864 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
32865
32866 This chapter explains how to use separate debug info when packages
32867 provide it, and how to rebuild packages with debug info when it's
32868 missing.
32869
32870 @menu
32871 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
32872 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
32873 @end menu
32874
32875 @node Separate Debug Info
32876 @section Separate Debug Info
32877
32878 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
32879 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
32880 weighs in at more than 60 MiB@. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
32881 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
32882 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
32883 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
32884 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
32885
32886 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
32887 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
32888 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
32889 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
32890 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
32891 with GDB}).
32892
32893 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
32894 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
32895 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
32896 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
32897 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
32898 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
32899 Guile:
32900
32901 @example
32902 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
32903 @end example
32904
32905 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
32906 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
32907 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
32908 GDB}):
32909
32910 @example
32911 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
32912 @end example
32913
32914 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
32915 @file{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
32916
32917 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
32918 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
32919 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
32920 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
32921 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
32922 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
32923
32924 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
32925 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
32926 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
32927 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages with
32928 definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. To check
32929 whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use @command{guix package
32930 --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
32931
32932 Read on for how to deal with packages lacking a @code{debug} output.
32933
32934 @node Rebuilding Debug Info
32935 @section Rebuilding Debug Info
32936
32937 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
32938 As we saw above, some packages, but not all, provide debugging info in a
32939 @code{debug} output. What can you do when debugging info is missing?
32940 The @option{--with-debug-info} option provides a solution to that: it
32941 allows you to rebuild the package(s) for which debugging info is
32942 missing---and only those---and to graft those onto the application
32943 you're debugging. Thus, while it's not as fast as installing a
32944 @code{debug} output, it is relatively inexpensive.
32945
32946 Let's illustrate that. Suppose you're experiencing a bug in Inkscape
32947 and would like to see what's going on in GLib, a library that's deep
32948 down in its dependency graph. As it turns out, GLib does not have a
32949 @code{debug} output and the backtrace GDB shows is all sadness:
32950
32951 @example
32952 (gdb) bt
32953 #0 0x00007ffff5f92190 in g_getenv ()
32954 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libglib-2.0.so.0
32955 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init_ctor ()
32956 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libgobject-2.0.so.0
32957 #2 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=1, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffcfd8,
32958 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffcfe8) at dl-init.c:72
32959 #3 0x00007ffff7fe2866 in call_init (env=0x7fffffffcfe8, argv=0x7fffffffcfd8, argc=1, l=<optimized out>)
32960 at dl-init.c:118
32961 @end example
32962
32963 To address that, you install Inkscape linked against a variant GLib that
32964 contains debug info:
32965
32966 @example
32967 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
32968 @end example
32969
32970 This time, debugging will be a whole lot nicer:
32971
32972 @example
32973 $ gdb --args sh -c 'exec inkscape'
32974 @dots{}
32975 (gdb) b g_getenv
32976 Function "g_getenv" not defined.
32977 Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? (y or [n]) y
32978 Breakpoint 1 (g_getenv) pending.
32979 (gdb) r
32980 Starting program: /gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/sh -c exec\ inkscape
32981 @dots{}
32982 (gdb) bt
32983 #0 g_getenv (variable=variable@@entry=0x7ffff60c7a2e "GOBJECT_DEBUG") at ../glib-2.62.6/glib/genviron.c:252
32984 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4380
32985 #2 gobject_init_ctor () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4493
32986 #3 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=3, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffd088,
32987 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffd0a8) at dl-init.c:72
32988 @dots{}
32989 @end example
32990
32991 Much better!
32992
32993 Note that there can be packages for which @option{--with-debug-info}
32994 will not have the desired effect. @xref{Package Transformation Options,
32995 @option{--with-debug-info}}, for more information.
32996
32997 @node Security Updates
32998 @chapter Security Updates
32999
33000 @cindex security updates
33001 @cindex security vulnerabilities
33002 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
33003 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
33004 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
33005 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
33006 containing only security updates). The @command{guix lint} tool helps
33007 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
33008 distribution:
33009
33010 @smallexample
33011 $ guix lint -c cve
33012 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
33013 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
33014 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
33015 @dots{}
33016 @end smallexample
33017
33018 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
33019
33020 Guix follows a functional
33021 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
33022 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
33023 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
33024 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
33025 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
33026 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
33027 desired.
33028
33029 @cindex grafts
33030 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
33031 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
33032 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
33033 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
33034 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
33035 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
33036 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
33037
33038 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
33039 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
33040 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
33041 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
33042 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
33043 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
33044
33045 @lisp
33046 (define bash
33047 (package
33048 (name "bash")
33049 ;; @dots{}
33050 (replacement bash-fixed)))
33051 @end lisp
33052
33053 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
33054 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
33055 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
33056 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
33057 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
33058 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
33059 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
33060 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
33061
33062 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
33063 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
33064 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
33065 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
33066 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
33067 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
33068 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
33069
33070 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
33071 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
33072 Thus, the command:
33073
33074 @example
33075 guix build bash --no-grafts
33076 @end example
33077
33078 @noindent
33079 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
33080
33081 @example
33082 guix build bash
33083 @end example
33084
33085 @noindent
33086 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
33087 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
33088
33089 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
33090 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
33091
33092 @example
33093 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
33094 @end example
33095
33096 @noindent
33097 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
33098 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
33099
33100 @example
33101 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
33102 @end example
33103
33104 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
33105 @command{lsof} command:
33106
33107 @example
33108 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
33109 @end example
33110
33111
33112 @node Bootstrapping
33113 @chapter Bootstrapping
33114
33115 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
33116
33117 @cindex bootstrapping
33118
33119 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
33120 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
33121 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
33122 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
33123 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled?
33124
33125 It is tempting to think of this question as one that only die-hard
33126 hackers may care about. However, while the answer to that question is
33127 technical in nature, its implications are wide-ranging. How the
33128 distribution is bootstrapped defines the extent to which we, as
33129 individuals and as a collective of users and hackers, can trust the
33130 software we run. It is a central concern from the standpoint of
33131 @emph{security} and from a @emph{user freedom} viewpoint.
33132
33133 @cindex bootstrap binaries
33134 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
33135 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
33136 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
33137 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
33138 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
33139 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
33140 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
33141 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
33142 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
33143
33144 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
33145 re-create them if needed (@pxref{Preparing to Use the Bootstrap
33146 Binaries}).
33147
33148 @menu
33149 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
33150 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
33151 @end menu
33152
33153 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
33154 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
33155
33156 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
33157 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
33158 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
33159 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
33160 ``taken for granted.''
33161
33162 Taking the bootstrap binaries for granted means that we consider them to
33163 be a correct and trustworthy ``seed'' for building the complete system.
33164 Therein lies a problem: the combined size of these bootstrap binaries is
33165 about 250MB (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing
33166 or even inspecting these is next to impossible.
33167
33168 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a
33169 ``Reduced Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full
33170 Source Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would
33171 be hyperbole to use that term for what we do now.}.
33172
33173 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
33174 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
33175 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
33176 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
33177 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC).
33178
33179 Using these new binary seeds the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU
33180 C Library are built from source. From here on the more traditional
33181 bootstrap process resumes. This approach has reduced the bootstrap
33182 binaries in size to about 145MB in Guix v1.1.
33183
33184 The next step that Guix has taken is to replace the shell and all its
33185 utilities with implementations in Guile Scheme, the @emph{Scheme-only
33186 bootstrap}. Gash (@pxref{Gash,,, gash, The Gash manual}) is a
33187 POSIX-compatible shell that replaces Bash, and it comes with Gash Utils
33188 which has minimalist replacements for Awk, the GNU Core Utilities, Grep,
33189 Gzip, Sed, and Tar. The rest of the bootstrap binary seeds that were
33190 removed are now built from source.
33191
33192 Building the GNU System from source is currently only possibly by adding
33193 some historical GNU packages as intermediate steps@footnote{Packages
33194 such as @code{gcc-2.95.3}, @code{binutils-2.14}, @code{glibc-2.2.5},
33195 @code{gzip-1.2.4}, @code{tar-1.22}, and some others. For details, see
33196 @file{gnu/packages/commencement.scm}.}. As Gash and Gash Utils mature,
33197 and GNU packages become more bootstrappable again (e.g., new releases of
33198 GNU Sed will also ship as gzipped tarballs again, as alternative to the
33199 hard to bootstrap @code{xz}-compression), this set of added packages can
33200 hopefully be reduced again.
33201
33202 The graph below shows the resulting dependency graph for
33203 @code{gcc-core-mesboot0}, the bootstrap compiler used for the
33204 traditional bootstrap of the rest of the Guix System.
33205
33206 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph -e '(@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-core-mesboot0)' | sed -re 's,((bootstrap-mescc-tools|bootstrap-mes|guile-bootstrap).*shape =) box,\1 ellipse,' > doc/images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph.dot
33207 @image{images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of gcc-core-mesboot0}
33208
33209 The only significant binary bootstrap seeds that remain@footnote{
33210 Ignoring the 68KB @code{mescc-tools}; that will be removed later,
33211 together with @code{mes}.} are a Scheme intepreter and a Scheme
33212 compiler: GNU Mes and GNU Guile@footnote{Not shown in this graph are the
33213 static binaries for @file{bash}, @code{tar}, and @code{xz} that are used
33214 to get Guile running.}.
33215
33216 This further reduction has brought down the size of the binary seed to
33217 about 60MB for @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}.
33218
33219 Work is ongoing to remove all binary blobs from our free software
33220 bootstrap stack, working towards a Full Source Bootstrap. Also ongoing
33221 is work to bring these bootstraps to the @code{arm-linux} and
33222 @code{aarch64-linux} architectures and to the Hurd.
33223
33224 If you are interested, join us on @samp{#bootstrappable} on the Freenode
33225 IRC network or discuss on @email{bug-mes@@gnu.org} or
33226 @email{gash-devel@@nongnu.org}.
33227
33228 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
33229 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
33230
33231 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
33232 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
33233 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
33234
33235 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
33236 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
33237 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
33238 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
33239
33240 @example
33241 guix graph -t derivation \
33242 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
33243 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
33244 @end example
33245
33246 or, for the further Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
33247
33248 @example
33249 guix graph -t derivation \
33250 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
33251 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
33252 @end example
33253
33254 At this level of detail, things are
33255 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
33256 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
33257 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
33258 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
33259 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
33260 (@pxref{The Store}).
33261
33262 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
33263 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
33264 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
33265 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
33266 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
33267 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
33268 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
33269 tarball to be unpacked.
33270
33271 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
33272 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
33273 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
33274 is what the @file{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
33275 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
33276 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
33277 in the store, using the original layout. The
33278 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
33279 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
33280 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
33281 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
33282
33283 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
33284 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
33285 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
33286 point we have a working C tool chain.
33287
33288 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
33289
33290 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
33291 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
33292 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
33293 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
33294 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
33295 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
33296 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
33297
33298 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
33299 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
33300 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
33301 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
33302 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
33303 package from source. The command:
33304
33305 @example
33306 guix graph -t bag \
33307 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
33308 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | xdot -
33309 @end example
33310
33311 @noindent
33312 displays the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
33313 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
33314 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
33315 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
33316
33317 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
33318
33319 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
33320 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
33321 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
33322 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
33323 built.
33324
33325 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
33326 tools---i.e., with @option{--target} equal to @option{--host}. They are
33327 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
33328 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
33329
33330 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built. GCC
33331 uses @command{ld} from the final Binutils, and links programs against
33332 the just-built libc. This tool chain is used to build the other
33333 packages used by Guix and by the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash,
33334 Coreutils, etc.
33335
33336 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
33337 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
33338 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
33339 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
33340 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
33341
33342
33343 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
33344
33345 @cindex bootstrap binaries
33346 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
33347 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
33348 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
33349 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
33350
33351 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
33352 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
33353 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
33354 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
33355 command-line tools):
33356
33357 @example
33358 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
33359 @end example
33360
33361 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
33362 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
33363 this section.
33364
33365 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
33366 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
33367 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
33368 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
33369 know.
33370
33371 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
33372
33373 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
33374 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
33375 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
33376 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
33377 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
33378 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
33379
33380 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
33381 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
33382 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
33383 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
33384 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
33385
33386 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
33387 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
33388 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
33389 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
33390 a simple and auditable assembler.
33391
33392 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
33393 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
33394 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
33395 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
33396 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
33397 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
33398 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
33399 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
33400
33401 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
33402 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
33403
33404 @node Porting
33405 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
33406
33407 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
33408 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
33409 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
33410 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
33411 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
33412 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
33413 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
33414
33415 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
33416 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
33417 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
33418 one:
33419
33420 @example
33421 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
33422 @end example
33423
33424 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
33425 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
33426 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
33427 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
33428 taught about the new platform.
33429
33430 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
33431 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
33432 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
33433 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
33434 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
33435 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
33436 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
33437 as well.
33438
33439 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
33440 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
33441 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
33442 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @option{--with-abi}
33443 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
33444 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
33445 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
33446 reason.
33447
33448 @c *********************************************************************
33449 @include contributing.texi
33450
33451 @c *********************************************************************
33452 @node Acknowledgments
33453 @chapter Acknowledgments
33454
33455 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
33456 which was designed and
33457 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
33458 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix). Nix pioneered functional package
33459 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
33460 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
33461 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
33462
33463 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
33464 an inspiration for Guix.
33465
33466 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
33467 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
33468 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
33469 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
33470 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
33471
33472
33473 @c *********************************************************************
33474 @node GNU Free Documentation License
33475 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
33476 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
33477 @include fdl-1.3.texi
33478
33479 @c *********************************************************************
33480 @node Concept Index
33481 @unnumbered Concept Index
33482 @printindex cp
33483
33484 @node Programming Index
33485 @unnumbered Programming Index
33486 @syncodeindex tp fn
33487 @syncodeindex vr fn
33488 @printindex fn
33489
33490 @bye
33491
33492 @c Local Variables:
33493 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
33494 @c End: